medical records in practice
Transcription
medical records in practice
DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH iAl " •iii I U H-328 - New Zealand Department of Health LIBRARY Box 5013Wellington Accession Nq.................... Classification: ............................. Location: ........................................... A Pose, R.J. Public Health Statistician, National Health Statistics Centre Sindlen, A.T. Secretary-Manager, North Canterbury Hospital Board Blood Transfusion Service, formerly Medical Records Officer, Princess Margaret Hospital and Hon. Secretary, New Zealand Medical Records Officers' Association Stuart, J. Medical Records Officer, Palmerston North Hospital Thomson, Miss N. Medical Records Officer, Ashburton Hospital and Hon. Secretary, New Zealand Medical Records Officers' Association Tiller, T.J. Medical Records Officer, Wellington Hospital Vincent, L. Admission Officer, Waikato Hospital Wakely, Gerald. Medical Records Officer, Auckland Hospital Board and Editor, 'New Zealand Medical Record' Wilson, Peter, Medical Records Officer, New Plymouth Hospital and Vice-President, New Zealand Medical Records Officers' Association 3231 wx 173 NEW ZEALAND Medical Records Officers' Association. .Med4Gal ....reoo .r4 5 ... praGtlO .. ... in ....................... WX J1 32318 STACK io 'S / ( MEDICAL ' Contributors Medical Records Practice in New Zealand CONTRIBUTORS Although each chapter was written by one author, or, in some cases, in collaboration, during the editing process each chapter was referred to various authorities - medical, legal and.other - and also to fellow contributors. What has emerged is a combination of the original material and alterations arising from suggestions. The following wrote the chapters shown: Chapter 2: J.R. Clayton; Chapter 3: Peter Wilson, Gerald Wakely, Miss M. Thomson; Chapter +: Ian Davies;. Chapter 5: A.. H. Mulford, Gerald Wakely; Chapter . 6: Max Powell; Chapter 7: L. Vincent; Chapter 8: AT. Sindlen; Chapter 9: Dr. John Cairney; Chapter 10: F.H. Foster; Chapters 11 and 12: T.J. Tiller; Chapter 13: J.R. Clayton; Chapters 14 and 15: J. Stuart; Chapter 16: Gerald Wakely, George Riddiford; Chapter 17: P.J. Rose; Chapter 18: J. Stuart; Chapter 19: A.H. Mulford, Gerald Wakely; Chapters 20 and 21: Gerald Wakely; Chapter 22: R.J. Rose; Editor: Gerald Wakely; Production: Miss P. Blucher. Owl Particulars of contributors: Blucher, Miss P. Stenographer, Auckland Hospital Board Medical Records Office Cairney, late Dr. John, C.M.G., M.D. , F.P.A.C.S. Formerly Superintendent-in-Chief, Wellington Hospital Board and Director-General of Health. Died in 1966 Clayton, J.P. Cancer Statistics Officer, North Canterbury Hospital Board, formerly Medical Records Officer, Christchurch Hospital, President, New Zealand Medical Records Officers' Association Davies, late Ian. Formerly Medical Records Officer, Auckland Hospital. , Died 1967 Foster, F.H. Deputy Public Health Statistician, National Health Statistics Centre Mulford, A.R. House Manager, Te Kuiti Hospital, formerly Medical Records Officer, Waikato Hospital, Powell, Max. Medical Records Officer, Wanganui Hospital and Hon. Treasurer, New Zealand Medical Records Officers° Association Riddiford, George, N.Z.R.N. Medical Records Officer, Masterton Hospital . iL Index WORKERS' COMPENSATION Workers' Compensation Act, 1956 X-ray filing, equipment for X-ray reception and filing, functions of X-ray reception, equipment for X-ray reports, procedure for dealing with late X-rays, retention of, discussed 4$. 15 15, 1 et seq 3.7.8 1.' 3.2.7 3.7.7 • ,. 2.3 1 9,8 Syndrome, defined Synonymous terms System, defined TB clinic appointments method Telephone exchange names, recording of Tendon, described concept Terminal digit filing and the of staff organisation Terminal digit filing method Termination of pregnancy, consent to TERMINOLOGY, MEDICAL TERMS, GLOSSARY OF Tests, Rubins, pre-operative admission for Time clocks, advocated 13 2 '11 9,1. 1.2.2 5.1 Z .23 ' •,. 4.1 •,5,2 2. 1 6.6 13 23 7.8 16 1 5 3.7.6, 3.7.7 .1'. • Tissue, defined 9, 2.1.6. Titles, treatment of, in indexfiling Lng: 1 2 1•4. Tonsillectomy, in relation to operation cod 1. Tools required for making drafts of, forms. Tracer methods 39:. i, 6 Tracing patients 2: . Transfers, as affecting daily census Trays, slide-out, in fixed shelving 'Treatment', in relation to cancer, defined 4.5.3 20, Trial run, desirability of, for forms Tubal insufflation, pre-operative admission for.71 7,8 . .2,3.: Tuberculosis Act, 191+8 14 1 Appx. A. Tuberculosis Regulations, 1951 1+, 7 Tuberculosis notifiable Type defined Type faces, defined 4.1 Unit numbering system described 3•3• Urinary systems explained .2,9: "2 USES OF MEDICAL RECORD Ventricles, described 9, .5 2,6, Violence, coding of r2 1 .8 Waiting list census Waiting lists 7,. 7.6 Waiting time criteria 1,1,2: Waiting time survey, how to conduct To 7' War Pensions Act 1954 War Pensions Appeal Board, information 4, ' , 4 required for, from medical records 7;:,4..., War Pensions Regulations 1956 Appx0 A.. Ward bed report, example of "Appx. C Ward bed state, example of Wardso admissions by 2?.5.k Index Shelving needed for medical records in current use Shelving space needed for terminal digit filing, how determined Similar terms Skeleton, explained Social Security department, lists for Social Security, entitlement to, in relation to admission Space needed for medical records, how to judge. Spacing allowances on forms, handwritten and typewritten copy Specialties, names of, in larger hospitals Specifications for forms, points to be covered in Spelling of medical terms Spirit duplicator Staff coverage, outpatient and A & B departments Staff levels, for planning purposes Staff, medical, full-time, admissions by Staff, medical, visiting, admissions by Staff, organisation of Staff qualifications 1, Skin cancers excluded from Central Registry Stage, in relation to cancer classification, defined Staging, in relation to cancer classification, defined 'Standard Nomenclature of Operations and Diseases,' mentioned Stationery, use of coloured tabs for follow-up Statistical study, for cancer, how to do STATISTICS, HOSPITAL MORBIDITY Statistics, in relation to admissions, discharges, deaths etc. Statutory Regulations on disclosure of medical information Stems, in relation to medical terminology Still-births, procedure regarding Storage Storage and protection of medical records, factors regarding Storage methods Straightnumerical filing method Strip index, for use as waiting list Suffixes Suffixes, indicating surgical procedure, defined Survival checks, for cancer 40 •,2.1 .2'5.2.1 i,9 9, 2 , 5 Z 5.2 •,2.1 Appx. A. 7 13 9 5 5 20, 2.3 6 21 9 3.5 7.5.3 7.2.3 If 6.1 3, 6.-i 1.3.1 1.4.2 1.4.2 10,/ 17, 22 Z ' ?. 5 !L'Lf.1 1 3s 3 7 !4 9 .1L'3.8.2 •,2.1 .2' 5.1 27.6.1 2.3 2.4 1..Z PROCEDURES, OUTPATIENT AND ACCIDENT & EMERGENCY DEPARTMENT -16 Proof correcting, symbols for 20 9 Appx. B Protoplasm, defined 9,1 Punched card method of indexing 3.1 Punched cards used in cancer registry 17, 2.3 Qualifications of Specialist Medical Staff 13, 7 Questionnaires, design of, for ad-hoc studies 22,9.1 Quotations, desirability of calling, for printing 20, 4.3 Pace, required for admission Z' 5 Re-admission, explanation of, for MS18 statistical card 22, 6.2 Re-admission, explanation of, for hospital purposes 23 RECORD, MEDICAL AND ITS USES 2 Referral sources, Accident & Emergency department 16,2.1 Referral sources, outpatients 1.1 Referring doctor, to be noted for admission 5.2 Register, admissions and discharges 7.4 Report forms, late, procedure for dealing with 3, 2.3 -g Report, ward bed, example of Appx. A Reports to be initialled by Medical Staff 3, 2.3 Reproductive or generative system, explained 9,10 Resection, abdomino-perineal, pre-operative admission for ,7.8 Residence in New Zealand, length of, qualifying for Social Security on admission Z' 5.2 Respiratory system, explained .27 RETENTION OF MEDICAL RECORDS 19 Returns, daily, admission office Z7. Returns, daily, outpatient attendances Z7.5.5 Rubins tests, pre-operative admission for , 78 Ruling, pen, use of, for forms 4.3 Rural delivery, insufficient for address for admission purposes z, 5 Schools, boarding, consent for treatment for patients from , 62 Seamen, visiting, necessity to record ship and owners/agents at admission 79 5.2 Section 62, Hospitals Act 1 957, quoted4, 4.1 Self-employed, Workers' Compensation 15, Septum, described 91 Serial numbering system described Serial unit numbering system described 51 Services, effect on planning 21, Sex, as a classification of admission Sex, importance of, in recording bed availability , Shelving, considered, in planning 21, 6.1 2 5 3.1 3.2 3.1 4.1 1 3.7.2 qn Index Operation list, distribution of7, 7.5.5 Operations, authorisation for .:'6 OPERATIONS, CLASSIFICATION OF 12 Operations, gynaecological, pre-operative admission for 7.8 ORGANISATION OF A MEDICAL RECORDS DEPARTMENT 3 Organisation of staff 4 Organisation of staff, 'team' concept in 4.1 I Organs, defined .2' OUTPATIENT AND ACCIDENT & EMERGENCY DEPARTMENT PROCEDURES 16 Outpatient booking office, functions of 21, 3.2.4 Outpatient booking and reception, equipment for 21, 3.7.5 Outpatients, returns of attendances7, 705.5 Outpatient survey, how to conduct221 7 Outpatients, Workers' Compensation, procedure' 159 2.1 Paper, choice of, for economy with forms 201 4.3 Paper, described 20 3 Paper, factors in deciding suitability for job20 3 Paper, sheet sizes 20 3 Paper, weights 20 3 Patient index 3, 2.5 2.1 Patient index, never to be destroyed 19, 9 Period in hospital, method of calculating 229 6.2 Phonetic indexing, described 2.1 Physical planning 219 4 Physician's Index .2 • 4 PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY 9 PLANNING A MEDICAL RECORDS DEPARTMENT 21 Plasma, defined 91 5.1 Platelets, defined 5.1 Population, effect on planning 21, 3.1 Poisonings, coding of 11, 2.5 2.6 Poisonings notifiable 149 3 Poisons Act, 1960 14, 3 Post mortem, importance of Tg, 2.3 Pre-admission procedure 79 3 Prefixes and suffixes 13, 4 Prefixes, treatment of, in index filing 2.1.2 Pregnancy, termination of, consent to7, 6.6 Pre-operative admissions 7.8 Pre-registration, of admissions7, 3 Printing processes, explained 201 2 Prisons, consent for treatment to patients from72 6.4 PROCEDURE, ADMISSION OFFICE 7 Procedure manual, necessity for 3, 4 Procedures, definition of, for planning purposes 219 3.4 PROCEDURES, INDEXING 42 Microfilmed medical records, procedure regarding admissibility as evidence in Court 49 Minor, consent for treatment to, who may give. 7, Mf-il-hio in terminal diit filin g . common errors Monotype, explained Morbidity statistics, explained MS17 summary card 11, MS18 statistical card, care of MS18 statistical card, described 12, Ms18 statistical card, operation details on MS18 statistical cards as an index —, MS38 cards, when to complete Mucous membrane, defined Muscular system, explained 13, Names of diseases 'N' code Neotlasrn, suspected, ruled out or unconfirmed, coding of Neoplasms, coding of 99 Nervous system, explained 'New Plymouth' numbering system described 51 Next-of-kin, recording of, for admission purposes 79 New Zealand cancer case registration 17, 211 Noise level Nomenclature and classification, differences between 4, Non-disclosure of medical information Non-infectious notifiable diseases Nosology, defined 14 NOTIFICATION OF DISEASES Notification of diseases, forms for 14 9 II, Nucleus, defined Number, allocation of Numbering system for outpatient and Accident & Emergency departments flumbering systems Nursing staff reffering to medical records, policy regarding Obstetrics, in relation to coding Occupation, necessity to record., for admission purposes Occupational diseases notifiable Offset lithography, explained Operating schedule Operation Code Operation Index Operation index, retention policy 8 6,1 5.2.4 2.1 2.2 6.4 2.9 6,2 et seq 4 3.1 4.2 1 3 10 2.5 2.2 2.2 4. 3,3.2 5 1.3 3.8.5 4 4.1 2.2 1 2.1 2.3 3 1 3 4 3 3, 14, 7, 2.3.2 2.3 5 4 2.2 7.8 2.3.1 2.3 9.2 Index Medical Records department, function of 3,2 21, 3,2.1 Medical Records department, hours of coverage for .e3 Medical Records department, indexes of, described 2 MEDICAL RECORDS DEPARTMENT, ORGANISATION OF MEDICAL RECORDS DEPARTMENT, PLANNING A 21 Medical Records department, policy regarding access to, out of hours ,3. Medical Records department, procedure for obtaining records out of hours Medical Records department, purpose of .,7 Medical Records department, relationship with other departments , 5 Medical Records department, responsibility for daily census 2.2 Medical Records department, scope of, for planning 21,2 Medical records, factors regarding storage. and protection • 2.1 Medical records, how to judge space needed for 2.1 .39 Medical records in current use, need of.. shelving for ,3.1 Medical records, knowing exact location of •,. 2.2 Medical records, outpatient and A. & E. department, decentralised or centralised, discussed. '. . 16193 MEDICAL RECORDS, RETENTION OF• Medical Records Officer, recommended as controller of hospital cancer registry .17' .3.1 Medical Records Officers place in compilation . .. of the medical record .2, 5 Medical staff, admissions by. .•• •. .. 7 9 7.5.3 Medical staff, notes to••. : 3 9 2.3.1 Medical staff, to initial reports.39 2.3 Medical Superintendent, permitted to give consent for treatment in certain cases •7, 6 Medical Superintendent, relationship with Medical Records Officer .,5 MEDICAL TERMINOLOGY.. 13 Medical typists, functions of. 3.2.1 MEDICO-LEGAL ASPECTS OF MEDICAL RECORDS KEEPING k Meninges, defined. 99 4 Menstruation, date of, affecting booking for Operations , 7.8 Menstruation, explained 910.2 Mental Health Act 1911 ,5.1 Mental Health Amendment Act 1928 Mental hospital, admission to .j,5.1 Mental hospital, consent for treatment to , 6.5 patients from 4" Laparotomy, to be avoided as a term Lay-out of forms, spacing requirements in Lay-out of forms, to be consistent Ledger card, treatment for accident at work LEGAL. MEDICO-LEGAL ASPECTS OF MEDICAL RECORD KEEPING Letterpress, explained Liability, Workers' Compensation Lighting, power and heating requirements Linotype, explained Location index cards, different types described List, operation List, waiting, medical List, waiting, surgical Lists, waiting 'Luhn' numbering system described Lymph, described Lymph nodes, described Lymphatic, or lymph vascular system, explained Machine recording Maiden names, treatment of, in index filing Male reproductive system, explained Maori, definition of, for admission purposes Mark-sensing explained Married persons may give consent for treatment irrespective of age to self, spouse or child Medical Officer of Health, diseases notifiable to Medical record, access to, procedure regarding MEDICAL RECORD AND ITS USES Medical record a privileged communication Medical record and case notes, differentiated Medicalrecord, confidential nature of Medical record, compilation of, Medical Records Officer's place in Medical record, completed, composition of Medical record, contribution of to medical research Medical record, defined Medical record, divulgence of information from Medical record in Court Medical record, ownership of Medical record, policy regarding use of, for study and research Medical record, procedure for patient seeking information from Medical record, use of Medical record, use of after patient's discharge or death Medical Records Committee, discussed 121 4 20 Appx. A 20,4.2, 15, Appx. 2 4 2.1 1.9 3.8.4 2.1 2.2.1 7.5.5 7.6.2 7.6.1 7.6 3.3.3 6 6 9, 6 3 2.1 .7 10.1 5 22, 6.3.1 ,6.1 14, Appx. A '1• 2 .,3 .,I .3'2.4 .,5 .,4 2,6.1 2, 2 i, 3 ',4.1 4, 8 4, 2 3, 2.3.2 4, 2 199 2 5 Index Heart, described Hernia, hiatus, pre'-operative admission for H.I.D.6 weekly return 9, jt, tg Historical importance of medical records Hospital cancer registry, operation of HOSPITAL CENSUS TAKING HOSPITAL MORBIDITY STATISTICS 'Hospital Statistics Handbook', referred to 17, 22 lit 11 9 II, 11 Hospital terms Hospitals Act, 1957 Hours of coverage, suggested Husband and wife required to sign consent for termination of pregnancy Hydatids notifiable I.C.D.A., described, in relation to operation coding I.C.DA. , mentioned Imprest supply of stationery, advocated Incidence of cancer, data on, use made .of Incomplete diagnoses or terms, instanced Index cards, criteria for Index, patient Index, requirements defined Indexes, considered, in planning Indexing, disease Indexing, simple, explained INDEXING PROCEDURES Infant, admission of Infectious diseases notifiable Infectious diseases, procedure for obtaining information from wards Infectious diseases, purpose of notifying Infirm, admission of Injuries, coding of Inter-departmental relationships Intercommunication INTERNATIONAL CLASSIFICATION OF DISEASES 'International Classification of Diseases', application of, to disease coding Laboratory report forms, •procedure for dealing with late 407 9 21, 5 7.8 I 2.1 3 Lf 2 3 2.2 2.3 2.5 2.8 2.9 6. 6 3.5 3 6.6 2.2 12,3 -., 2.3.2 21, 3.8 • 2 17,I ./+.1 I I',2,8 Lf 3, 2.5 I 3.7.2 10, 2 2.2 • 1 5 2.1 2.1 5. 5 11, 2.5 3, 5 21, 3.3 21,3.8.1 25, 3.7.1 10 ill2 •,2.3 emale reproductive system, explained Piles required for hospital cancer registry Filing margin, width of Filing, order of, in index FILING SYSTEMS Flow of traffic Follow-up and cancer registration Follow-up cards, for cancer, details required Follow-up, definition of Follow-up, District Nurses' role Follow-up in connection with dietetics Follow-up, Medical Social Workers' role FOLLOW-UP METHODS Follow-up of inpatients Follow-up of outpatients Follow-up, reason for Food poisoning, notifiable Foreign names, treatment of, in index filing Form, evolution of, steps in Form, for consent for termination of pregnancy Form of Consent for operations FORMS, DESIGN PF Forms for notification of diseases Forms, revision of, procedure Forms, Workers' Compensation, Form 2' Forms, Workers' Compensation, Form 3 Fractures, coding of Function of outpatient department Functional planning Functions of departments Gastrectomy, pre-operative admission for Generative, or reproductive, system, explained Glands, explained Government departments, procedure regarding giving information from medical records to Graft, corneal, pre-operative admission for Group indexing, explained Gynaecological patients pre-operative admission for Haemoglobin, defined Haemaglobin, low, pre-operative admission for Haemorrhoidectomy, pre-operative admission for Health Act, 1956 9, 17, 20, 5 10.2 3,3 Appx. A 2.1.2 21, 3.6 17, 3.3.2 1T 9 T, Tg, IT Tg, Tg, 14, -, 20, 5 1 2,1 1 2,2 2 3 1 2.2, 2'. 1 .3 5 6.6 1, 20 Appx.A & B 14,.• 14,. 2,3 3 11, 2.5 21, .3 3.2 2.1 6 15, i.8 15,, J..8, I 7.8 •,10 1 4 , 7.8 , 2.2.2 7, 7.8 5-1 7, 7.8 7' 7.8 4, 4 4, 5.1 4, 7 1. 2 Health (Infirm and Neglected Persons) Regulations, 1958 5 tJb I Dictating machines, to be Considered in planning 21 9 3.7.2 Digestive, or alimentary, system, explained .2. 8 Digit numbering system, described 5, 3.31 Discharge note, use of 2 Discharge of patient, regulations concerning 7 Discharges, daily list, distribution of 2. 7.4 Discharges, daily return of 7, 7.5.1 Discharges, for daily census 3 Discharges, totalled for MS18 statistical cards 6 Disease coding, application of 'International Classification of Diseases' to 11,2 Disease Index 2.2 Disease index, retention policy .i29.2 Disease indexing 10 1 2 DISEASES, CLASSIFICATION OF 11 Diseases, infectious, notifiable .1.: '2.1 14, Appx. A Diseases, infectious, procedure for obtaining information from wards 2.1 Diseases, infectious, purpose of notifying 5 DISEASES, INTERNATIONAL CLASSIFICATION OF 10 Diseases notifiable 149 Appx. A Diseases, notifiable, other than infectious 2.2 Diseases,notifiable, pattern of iLt, 5 DISEASES, NOTIFICATION OF 14 Diseases, occupational, notifiable 14,1 Doctor referring patient for admission 5.2 Documentation of patients .7, Duct, defined ., I 'E' code - accidents, poisonings and violence I!, 26 Employer's liability, Workers' Compensation 1.9 Endocrine glands, described 9, 11 Endothelium, defined 1 Enquiry Office, equipment for 3.7.4 Enquiry Office, functions of 3.2.3 Enquiry Office, responsibility for daily census 8, 2.2 Epithelium, described 1 .2 Eponymic terms 10 Eponymic terms, cited in 'Code of Surgical Operations! Manual 2.2 Equipment, considerations of, for planning 21, 3.7 Evidence Amendment Act, 1952 7 Factors effecting accuracy of statistics 5 Fees, rates for inpatient treatment 1.1 Fees, rates for laboratory services 1.4 15, Fees, rates for outpatient treatment 1.2 Fees, rates for physiotherapy 1.5 Fees, rates for surgical appliances 1.5 Fees, rates for x-rays 1.3 Fees, recovery of by Board where right of action by patient exists Yof Classification, clinical stage, of cancer CLASSIFICATION OF DISEASES CLASSIFICATION OF DISEASES, INTERNATIONAL Classification of diseases,historical review CLASSIFICATION OF OPERATIONS Clinical attendance, responsibility of clerical staff during Clinic booking methods 'Code of Surgical O p erations' Manual, described Coding of operations, procedure Colour, as applied to forms Colour coding in terminal digit filing Colour, use of coloured tabs, in connection with cancer follow-up Combination terms, coding of Committals Composition of completed medical record Confidential nature of records Confidentiality, necessity for, in relation to cancer registration Consent for operations, form of Consent for treatment, who may give Corneal grafts, pre-operative admission for Coroner, procedure in regard to deaths. Counter, split-level recommended Cremation, procedure regarding Cremation R egulations 1 939 (reprinted 191+9) Cross indexing, explained Daily bed state Daily returns, admission office Daily returns, outpatient attendances Days stay, discharged patients Death certificate, matching cancer registration with Death of patient, regulations concerning Death of patient, use of medical record after Deaths, daily return of Deceased patients, days stay Decentralised filing system Deposition before Coroner Derivation, principles of Design criteria for forms Design dimensions for forms DESIGN OF FORMS Diabetic conditions, pre-operative admission for Diagnoses, incomplete, instanced Diagnoses, suspected, to be coded as if certain Diagram, follow-up appointments, suitable for .1,1.4.2 11 10 2' 1 12 16, 1.1+ 1.1+ 2.4 4.1 5.2.3 5. il l2.4. 5. =2 6 j,:.1.:: 4,4px. A & B 7 .,. 7.8. 3.8.3 t, 7 4,7. 2.2.1 , •Z, 7.4 z,. 7.5.5... 7.5.2. 17, 22 4, 2,6....: 27.5.1. 7,7.5.2 ,4.1 20 1 2 4 .?.2Appx.A 20 7, 7.8 2,8 11,3 Yot Index Blood vascular or circulatory system, explained Boarding Schools, consent for treatment for patients from Bone marrow, described Bones, classified Bookings, bed allocations for Boys employed, Workers' Compensation Bracelets, identity, use of, on admission Brain stem,-described Breastcancer, male, MS38 card for Built-in-fitments, not recommended Business reply envelope, use of in pre-admission procedure. Cancer, basic facts Cancer case follow-up Cancer follow up CANCER CASE REGISTRATION AND CANCER STATISTICS Cancer case registration, necessity for Cancer case registration. procedure, Central Registry Cancer case registration, purposes of Cancer registration and follow-up Cancer site registers Cancer staging Cards, location, index, different types described Case notes and medical record, differentiated Case notes, good, what they should contain Case notes, who takes to ward on admission Cell, described Census, daily, distribution of Census, daily information required Census, daily, patients not influencing balance Census, daily, period covering Census, daily, responsibility for Census, daily, time at which taken Census, daily, obtaining relevant information CENSUS, HOSPITAL Census, national hospital Central nervous system, defined Centralised filing system Cerebellum, described Child, as category of admission Children's age, importance of, for admission Circulatory, or blood vascular, system, explained Classification and nomenclature, differences between V V 9, 5 .2' 2 6.2 2 2 2 7,7.1 4 4.1 21, 3.8.3 3 1.1 17, 2.4 17 5 1.2 17, 2 17,1.4, 1.5 5 3.3.3 17, 4.5.4 3,2.2.1 2,1 2, 7, 7.2 1 7, 7.4 2 8,2.1 2 2.2 2 2.2 22, 8 9, 4 5, 4.2 9, 4 4.1 7, 5 .9 15 10, 4 Admission Office, responsibility for •,2.2 daily census Admission office routine Z' 7 Admission of patients, statutory provisions regarding , 5 Admission particulars Z' 5 Admissions and discharges, for daily census. .,3 Admissions by visiting, and full-time staff Z7.5.3 Admissions by wards Z ' 75.4 Admissions, classification of, by sex, •,4• type and category Admissions, daily list, distribution of Z '7.'+ Admissions, daily return of Z ' 7.5.1 2 Admissions, definition of Admissions, discharges, deaths, daily return of 7, 7.5.1 Admissions, pre-operative 7.8 Adult, as category of admission , Adverse reactions to injections, infusions 2.7 etc. coding of 11, 22, 6.2 Age, method of recording Age, of children, for admission 7, 5 Aids to location in index filing •,2.1.4 Alimentary or digestive system, explained ,8 ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY 9 Annual list for each hospital of morbidity data 4.3 Aorta, described 9, 5 Appointment booking methods 1.2 Appointment clerk, outpatient, importance of i,3 Appointments for Accident & Emergency department follow-up treatment L6 1 2.6 Appointments, outpatient, calculation of dates for -i8,3 Armed Forces, consent for treatment to 7, 6.3 Arrangement, of files 5, 5.2.2 Artificial limbs, fees for 1.6 Artificial limbs, replacement of 1 .6 15, Assault cases, recovery of fees 15,1 Atria, described 9, 5 Baby, admission of 5 Bed report, ward, example of Appx. A Bed state, daily, distribution of 7.4 Bed state, ward, example of Appx. C Bed-time Index 4.3 Births and Deaths Registration Act, 1951 4, 5 Births in hospital, policy regarding admission Blood, described 7 5 5.1 J,1Z Index Medical Records Practice in New Zealand INDEX Entries in CAPITALS refer to chapters, other references are to paragraphs within chapters. Chapter references are underlined and are followed by the paragraph reference. Individual pages are not numbered; to locate a reference look for the chapter number in top right hand corner of recto pages, then locate paragraph within chapter. Example: Maiden names, treatment of, in index filing6, 2.1.7 Locate the figure 6 at the top right hand corner which will bring you to the chapter dealing with 'Indexing procedures'; paragraph 2.1.7 in this chapter deals with this subject. Abbreviated lists in 'international Classification of Diseases' Abbreviations used in case notes Abdomino-perineal resection, pre-operative admission for Abstracting of cancer cases ACCIDENT & EMERGENCY, AND OUTPATIENT, DEPARTMENT PROCEDURES Accident & Emergency department reception, equipment for Accident & Emergency department reception, functions of Accident & Emergency department record, requirements for Accident at work, admission Accident details, to be recorded Accident, motor, admission Accidents at work, scope of Workers.' Compensation Act covering Accidents, coding of Account, treatment for accident at work Act, Poisons, 1960 Act, Tuberculosis, 1948 Act, Workers' Compensation, 1956 Administrative statistics., defined Admission, acute, definition of Admission, booked, definition of Admission office, equipment for Admission office, functions of ADMISSION OFFICE PROCEDURE 10, 5 ,7.8 17, 4 16 3.7.6 1.' 3.2.6 16, 2.2 7, 5.2 2.2 5.2 1.9.2 15, 11,2,6 15, Appx. 1 14, 3 2.3 Appx. A iLL, 15, 1 et seq 2.1 7, 2 2 21, 3.7.3 21, 3.2.2 7 4th mt. CongressThe Proceedings of the Fourth InterReport:national Congress on Medical Records, October 21-24, 1963, Pick-Congress Hotel, Chicago, Illinois, U.S.A. (Chicago, 1964) References Nursing Mirror:Nursing Mirror & Midwives Journal, Iliffe Technical Publications Ltd., Dorset House, Stamford Street, London, S.E.1., England. Weekly Nursing Research: American Journal of Nursing Co., 10 Columbus Circle, New York 19, N.Y., U.S.A. 3 times a year Nursing Times: Royal College of Nursing. Macmillan & Co. Ltd., St. Martin's Street, London, W.C.2., England. Weekly Office: Office Publications Co., •232 Madison Ave., New York 16, N.Y., U.S.A. Monthly Office Magazine: Current Affairs Ltd., Box 109, Davis House,. 69-77 High Street, Croydon, Surrey, England. Monthly. Office Methods & Machines: new title of Office Magazine Radiology:Official journal of The Radiological Society of North Ameria Inc.,. 20th & Northampton Streets, Easton, Pa., U.S.A.. Monthly Official Organ of the Institute of The Hospital: Hospital Administrators, 75 Portland Place, London, W.1. England. Monthly 1st mt. CongressThe Proceedings of the First InterReport:national Congress on Medical Records, King's College, London, 8 - 1-2 September 1952, under the auspices of Association of Medical Record Officers, London, (1953) 2nd mt. CongressThe Proceedings of the Second InterReport: national Congress of Medical Records, October 1 - 5, 1956, Shoreham Hotel,, Washington, D.C., U.S.A. (Chicago 1957) 3rd mt. CongressProceedings of the Third International Report: Congress on Medical Records, Assembly Rooms, Edinburgh, 25 - 29 April 1960, Edited by Elsie Poyle Mansell, F.M.R. & Norman V. Jackson, A.M.P. Edinburgh, Livingstone, 1960 Hospital Topics:Hospital Topics Inc., 30 W Washington Street, Chicago 2, Ill., U.S.A. Monthly Hospitals:Journal of The American Hospital Association, 8k0 North Lake Shore Drive, Chicago 11, Ill., U.S.A. 1st and 16th of each month Jnl. AAMRL:Journal of The American Association of Medical Record Librarians. Bimonthly by the Association at 211 East Chicago Avenue, Chicago, Illinois 60611, U.S.A. Jnl. American535 N Dearborn Street, Chicago, Medical Association:Ill. 60610, U.S.A. weekly Lancet: The Lancet, 7 Adam Street, Adeiphi, London, W.C.2. Englandweekly Medical Record: The Medical Record, official journal of the Association of Medical Records Offióers, 108 Brooksby Road, Ti'lehurst, Reading, Berks., England New title, of Jnl AAMRL from 1962 Medical Record News: Medical Statistics • now National Health Statistics Centre, Branch, Department of Box 6314, Te Aro, Wellington Health, Wellington: Modern Hospital:The Modern Hospital. ' Monthly by The Modern Hospital Publishing Co.: Inc., 1050 Merchandise Mart, Chicago 5+, Ill., U.S.A. National Hospital:Journal of Australian Hospital Assn. Australian Trade Publications, 243 Elizabeth Street, Sydney, N.S.W., Australia. Bi-monthly N.S.W. HospitalsNew South Wales Hospitals Commission, Commn.Sydney, N.S.W., Australia N.Z. Hospital: New Zealand Hospital, the official journal of the New Zealand Hospital Boards and Hospital Officers' Association, Box 981, wellington. Quarterly N.Z. Medical Record: New Zealand Medical Record. • Journal of the N.Z. Medical Records Officers' Association (Inc.) Editorial 'address: Box 2656, Auckland. 3 issues a year. to I References Medical Records Practice in New Zealand REFERENCES Explanation of references (where these are not fully described under 'References' or 'Further reading') Anaesthesia: Anaesthesia & Analgesia. International Anaesthesia Research Society, Wade Park Manor, E 107th & Park Lane, Cleveland 6, Ohio, U.S.A.Bi-monthly Canadian Hospital: Canadian Hospital Association, 25 Imperial Street, Toronto 7, Canada,Monthly Canadian Medical Association Journal: 1 5 0 George Street, Toronto 5, Canada. Weekly H.M.S .00 Hospital Abstracts: Hospital Administration: Her Majesty's Stationery Office, 3 9 High Holborn,, London, W.C.i. England A monthly survey of world literature prepared by The Ministry of Health, London, H.M.S.O. Horwitz Publications Inc. Pty, Ltd. 39 Martin Place, Sydney, N.S.W. Australia. Monthly Hospital Administration and Construction: 1+50 Don Mills Road, Don Mills, Ont., Canada Hospital & HealthVictoria House, Masona Hill, Bromley, Management: Kent, England. Monthly Hospital & Social 27-9 Furnival Street, London, E.C.1+. Service Journal:England Hospital Forum: Hospital Council of Southern California, 4747 Sunset Blvd., Los Angeles 27, California, U.S.A. Hospital Progress:Journal of Catholic Hospital Association of The United States & Canada, 1438 W Grand Blvd., St. Louis Lf Mo., U.S.A. Monthly. 23 Paediatric BedsBeds assigned for regular, use by patients other than newborn who are not classed as adults by the respective Hospital Board Patient A person receiving physician, dentist or allied services in a hospital Patient DayThe unit of measure denoting facilities provided and services rendered to one inpatient between the census taking hour on two successive days Patient Identification FormThe sheet of the papers relating to the inpatient treatment on which are written the patient's sociological data Patient IndexThe index maintained at the hospital of those who are either in the hospital or have been admitted to the hospital and subsequently discharged Pre-admission FormThe form on which a booked patient is requested to give information prior to his admission to hospital Re-admission(1) For hospital purposes: a case that has previously been admitted to the hospital and is re-admitted to the same hospital for any reason. (ii) For MS18 statistical card purposes: a case that has previously been admitted to a public hospital and is re-admitted to any other public hospital in New Zealand on account of a continuation of the same illness or injury. Ward BulletinThe form which is filled in regularly by ward staff for the information of staff answering telephone enquiries regarding patients 406 Medical TypistTypist employed exclusively on the typing of letters and reports for medical staff MS18 Statistical CardThe IBM punch card made out for each hospital inpatient and sent to the Medical Statistician Outpatient One who attends the clinical service of the hospital for diagnosis or treatment on an ambulatory basis in a formally organised unit of a medical or surgical speciality or sub-specialty Outpatient Attendance The formal acceptance by the hospital of the patient who is not to be lodged in the hospital while receiving physician, dentist or allied services at the hospital Outpatient Case Notes The papers relating to an outpatient's attendances at hospital while a patient Outpatient DepartmentThe department responsible for allotting booking times for outpatients and for the reception of outpatients Outpatient Medical RecordThe completed case notes relating to an outpatient's attendance at hospital after final treatment Paediatric AdmissionThose accepted for lodging in a child bed facility (If the distinction is made:No. of inpatient beds regularly maintained in areas intended for the Paediatric Bed Establishment) lodging and full-time care of children and infants other than newborn, during periods of normal operations. This classification would be maintained only by those hospitals providing separate paediatric facilities 23 Daily Average Occupied BedsThe average no. of inpatients •.maintained in the hospital each • day for a given period of time Daily Bed StateThe no. of beds actually occupied by patients in the hospital at a given time. Discharge The termination of the granting of lodging and the formal release of an inpatient by the hospital. Disease Index.The index maintained by the Medical Records Department of patients treated under the diagnosis of the patient Emergency OutpatientOne who attends the Accident & Emergency or equivalent service of the hospital for diagnosis and treatment of a condition which requires immediate physician, dentist or allied services Enquiries The department of the hospital responsible for answering enquiries regarding patients' condition Inpatient A patient who is given 'lodging in a hospital while receiving physician, dentist or allied services in a hospital Medical Admitting Officer The medical officer responsible for arranging for the admission of patients Medical Record• The completed case notes relating to an inpatient's stay in the hospital after discharge Medical Records Clerk(s)The staff member(s) responsible for the day to day routine work of medical records. Medical Records DepartmentThe department of the hospital in which medical records are housed Medical Records Officer The staff member responsible for the department housing inpatient records Average Days' StayThe average no. of days of service rendered to each patient discharged during a given period Average Occupied Beds The ratio of actual patient days to the maximum patient days as determined by bed capacity during any given period of time Bassinettes Beds assigned for regular use by infants newly born in the hospital and which are maintained in areas allotted for newborn infant lodging (If the distinction is made: No. of inpatient beds regularly maintained in areas intended for Bassinette Establishment) the lodging and full-time care of newborn infants during periods of normal operations Bed Space regularly maintained in a hospital for the use of patients Bed EstablishmentNo. of beds regularly maintained for inpatients in a hospital Births Those newly born in the hospital and accepted for lodging in a newborn bed facility Case Notes The papers relating to an inpatient's stay in the hospital while a patient Census (i) The daily count of patients occupying a bed in hospital taken at the same time each day ('Daily census') (ii) The annual count of patients actually occupying a bed in hospital taken for the Department of Statistics as at midnight on 31 March. (iii) The quinqueninal count of patients actually occupying a bed in hospital taken for the National Health Statistics Centre 4..; 23 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand GLOSSARY OF TERMS Term used Definition Accident and EmergencyThe office responsible for the Department reception of emergency outpatients Admission Formal acceptance by a hospital of a patient who is to receive physician, de'ntist or allied services while lodged in the hospital Admission OfficeThe department of the hospital responsible for the admission of patients Admission Officer The non-medical member of the staff of the hospital responsible for the department dealing with the admission of patients Admitting Officer See 'Medical Admitting Officer' Adult Admission]hose accepted for lodging in adult bed facility Adult Bed Beds assigned for regular use by inpatients who are regarded as adults, according to the age specified by the respective Hospital Board (If the distinction is made: The no. of inpatient beds Adult Bed Establishment)regularly maintained in areas intended for the lodging and full-time care of adult inpatients (even though in some instances utilised by children) during period of normal operation Available beds Number of beds equipped and staffed for immediate use by patients Whereas most inpatient hospital morbidity studies are confined to information about patients as they leave hospital in a given time (usually a calendar year) in an inpatient cohort study a group of patients is selected at the time of admission and its subsequent history in terms of readmission, illnesses and treatments over a period of time is recorded and later analysed. References: 10. Hospital Statistics Handbook, Wellington, Medical Statistics Branch, Department of Health (1963) Heasman (Dr. M.A.) Manualon Hospital Morbidity Statistics. Draft issued by W.H.O. National Committee on Vital and Health Statistics, 1963 Hospital Statistics of New Zealand 1 Wellington, DirectorGeneral of Health, annually International Classification of Diseases, 2 vols. Geneva, W.H.O. 1957 Elderly Persons' Accommodation Needs in New Zealand, Wellington, Department of Health. Special Report Series No. 10 (1963) Report on the Medical Statistics of New Zealand Pt. I Mortality & Demographic Data, Part III - Hospital and Selected Morbidity Data, compiled by the National Health Statistics Centre of the Department of Health, Wellington. Wellington, Government Printer, annually Maori Patients in Public Hospitals, Wellington, Department of Health, Special Report Series No. 25 (1965) Further reading: 11. Diagnostic summary sent yearly to each hospital, Special Report Series issued by Department of Health Moroney (M.J.) Facts from Figures, Pelican A236. Harmondsworth, Penguin Books, 1960. ii I expense.Obviously while more accurate answers to questions can be obtained from controls in a medical care environment it would be much more preferable to have comparisons made with people who were not sick i.e. the general population. Smoking histories are an example of this preference because it has been shown that hospital controls invariably yield a higher proportion of smokers for each sex than controls of comparable age drawn from the general population. This points to the fact that smokers have higher admission rates.Tuberculosis, various respiratory diseases and coronary artery disease have all been shown to be associated with a long smoking history and the use of patients with these diseases as controls could easily lead to missing the association with smoking history. However, as cancer of the lung is so very strongly associated with heavy cigarette smoking, the use of hospital controls even with the disease mentioned will only yield underestimates of the degree of the association. The person assigned the job of selecting controls mus.t avoid interview bias which could either obscure or exaggerate an assôciatjon. There is an admitted difficulty in the smaller hospitals that a suitable control may not be readily available; for. ±nterview: at the particular time the diagnosed case is available. However, the problem can always be handled by anticipating that controls of certain ages and sex will probably be required some day and a sensible approach could be the building up of a reference list of patients already interviewed with their histories recorded. In a New Zealand co-operative hospital survey, acute myocardial infarction in Maori women (a high risk group) is compared with the same condition in a control group of European subjects. Stage 2 of the project includes a follow-up examination of each person in the study to obtain the further history. It is not unlikely that Medical Records Officers will in future become involved in the recording of the data for these enquiries so that not only comparisons can be made with cases of any disease in New Zealand hospitals, but also with people of different races in hospitals in other countries of the world. These comparisons are designed to identify racial and environmental (including dietary) causes of disease. 9.6 The cohort study A technique combining aspects of both prospective and retrospective studies of a special type has become popular during recent years. This is known as a cohort study. The term cohort means people banded together. 22 association of the disease with the factor relative to the risk of those without the factor. With factor Free of factorTotal With the disease--Free of the disease --A routine statistical test of association can be applied to the figures entered in this sample table to show whether there is a significantly greater incidence of the disease among those with the factor. We have in New Zealand a collection of data in respect of every cancer of the lung case diagnosed, the object being to uncover the features which led to the development of this disease in these unfortunate persons. If we know that 95 per cent or more of persons who have lung cancer are smokers shall we conclude that smoking in itself brings on lung cancer? Clearly without some knowledge of the background of persons who do not have lung cancer we have no way of deciding whether the proportion of smokers with the disease is unusually high or low. Therefore in order to arrive at any valid conclusions we must plan to have controls who differ in no known way except that of the suspect factor. This system is called "pairing" and it involves the selection of another patient in the hospital of the same age and sex, race, country of birth and social circumstances as the lung cancer victim. In fact, the ideal match for a control would be the identical twin of the patient with the disease if such existed and was available. The ideal control is quite impracticable due to the difficulty of locating a control subject. Doll and Hill in their study of the connection between tobacco smoking and cancer of the lung analysed the results not only by amount of smoking, duration of smoking, method of smoking and type and site of the cancer, but also compared the test and control groups in a variety of factors which might influence the observed association between smoking and lung 'cancer. The two groups were compared with respect to sex, age, occupation, social class, place of residence, exposure to different forms of heating, history of previous respiratory disease and residence near gas works. Smoking was the only factor which showed a highly significant association, the testing of the other factors mentioned serving to add strength to the findings. In actual fact hospital patient controls are not ideal for this type of matched experiment and are only used because Of easier accessibility and lesser '9, forward enquiry has been the dental caries incidence of children in different areas in New Zealand, one group using fluoridated water and the other a non-fluoridated supply. In the same way the subsequent development of babies born prematurely and babies born at term may be compared. The principal data on the death rates of smokers of various types and of non-smokers came from seven large studies of men who were followed-up and whose death certificates were obtained if they died during the period of the survey. Prospective studies, it should be noted, need not necessarily involve a subsequent period of waiting. Provided the information is in the notes one can reconstruct a population as at some past date and study the experience with respect to the occurrence of some event after that date. 905 The retrospective study The retrospective inquiry starts with the event e.g. the patient with a specific disease, and the investigation is an attempt to identify the factors which influenced the development of the disease. The past history method of investivation of causal factors goes back to the time of Hippocrates. With diseases of low incidence the controlled retrospective study may be the only feasible approach. For example, the association between German measles in a pregnant woman and congenital malformation in the child born to her could only. be investigated by a retrospective enquiry since the proportion of women who contract rubella during the early months of pregnancy is so small that a prospective study would be ruled out because of lack of significant numbers to compare with the mothers who had not contracted measles (controls). This retrospective technique is used at Podwell Park Cancer Hospital, New York, for research into causal • factOrs in cancer of various sites, a team of trained interviewers recording the answers to questions put to the cancer patient concerning diet, living habits, general environment, etc. 9.5.1 Choice of a control group When we have details of a group of patients with a particular disease and we are searching for the factors which may be responsible for its development, then the need arises for the selection of yet another group of persons who do not have the disease, so that we can compare the relative occurrences of the suspected causal factors. From comparison of the two groups we produce a table like this showing us clearly the strength of the 3t 22 total cases from which they were drawn. In other words, when doing an ad hoc survey complete coverage of all cases is not always possible or required and is frequently wasteful. Suppose we wished to learn whether the average haemoglobin of the blood of Maori children was the same as that for non-Maori children then obviously it would be impossible to take the haemoglobin value for all Maori and for all non-Maori children. Consequently the question would have to be answered by samples. Hospital statistics in England and Wales are collected on a 10 percent sample basis which is quite understandable when it is realised that discharges per year number 31 million. When carrying out a survey by sampling methods it is inevitable that sampling errors of •a statistical nature are introduced. The organiser must strike a balance between the outlay in terms of time, staff, etc. and the amount and quality of information required. No specific rules can be laid down as to what constitutes a good sample and a number of facts must be considered before an answer can be given. Just as individuals within a group vary from each other so do groups as a whole vary from one another. If, for example, successive groups of children are examined for their haemoglobin level, not only ouid the individuals differ as to haemoglobin values but the mean values would not be identical. For all practical purposes what is known as a quasi random sample is adequate for hospital survey purposes. To pick a sample it is only necessary to use the terminal digits for the serial number to select the requisite records for analysis.. For example, to pick a five percent sample those ending in, say, 14, 34, 54, 74 and 94 could be selected. Tables are published in text-books on statistics to determine the size and adequacy of samples under a variety of conditions, and it is necessary to consult the statistician for a decision on their application to any particular project. The prospecive study: 9.4. A prospective or forward study starts with a defined group of people who are kept under observation over a period of years to determine the frequency with which some disease occurs. A questionnaire is designed to record the same amount of information as regards those who develop a disease and those who do not. This method-has been employed in wide variety of studies. A typical Ui The box' type of question runs as follows Pace: European J N.Z. MaoriJ Asian J Pacific IslanderOther 1 State Against this particular method of completion is the fact that it is rather wasteful of space and it may be preferable to use the traditional type of answer where simple answers such as the age of the patient or the number of weeks on the waiting list are required. A lot depends on the purpose to which the answer is to-be put. For instance it is futile to have little boxes to be ticked for the recording of the period on waiting list in broad groups if the average period is to be calculated. The positioning of the questions should follow a rational plan and as far as possible should be broken into sections which are. plainly distinguishable. Space should be available along the left or right hand margin of the form for code numbers to be inserted. Self-coding forms are those in which the code numbers are placed against the various alternative answers and it will be necessary to transfer the number marked into the coding margin, unless of course the coding boxes themselves are inserted in the coding margin as is done with the Cancer Statistics collection cards. 9.2 The pilot survey When it is thought that the questionnaire is ready for use it is always preferable to get a dozen or twenty peopleto answer it before starting the collection proper. It will generally be found that several questions are ambiguous or not clear and these need to be rephrased. 9.3 Sampling Sampling is the selection of a smaller number of cases which are representative of the whole and an examination of the cases selected so that conclusions drawn from them may. apply to the 2? we mean only New Zealand Maoris and do not include persons of the same race who have their origins in the Pacific Islands. When the questionnaire is filled in during an interview a most satisfactory way of recording the information is to ask for tyesI,11noll "dont' know" answers • For instance, if it is necessary to find out if the person interviewed had a history of epilepsy it would be preferable to ask this question and record the answer as "no", "dont' know" rather than to ask "State Whether there is a history of epilepsy" and ,leave .a blank space for the answer. If the "yes" "no" "don't know" method is used it is possible to separate those cases where , it is known there is no history of epilepsy from those cases where it is not known whether there was Ia history of epilepsy or not. If the blank space method is used, there is usually a fairly large proportion of cases which either have not been answered or have been answered in such a way that it is not possible to interpret the answer with any degree of confidence. To take a hypothetical example, if five perceiit of the respondents in such a. survey said they had a history of epilepsy, 20 percent said there was no history of epilepsy and 75 percent did not answer at all, no worthwhile conclusion could be made from the data collected because of the impossibility of interpreting the 75 percent of "nil" responses. The detail concerning each person should be recorded on a.separate form or card. In this way the person and his numerous characteristics which have been recorded can be manipulated into groups of "like with like". Unless a separate form is introduced for each case, it is necessary to use columns in a register and columns cannot be physically shifted about and sorted.. All the categories in the answer which can be expected should be entered on the form. This is best achieved by providing alternative answers where suitable. When this method is adopted the answer can be given by ticking small boxes, by deleting alternative answers or by circling the required answer. as a consequence stifled at birth, the would-be investigator realising that he does not after all require a mass of information or even if he collects the information he will not find it as useful as he imagined. The seond stage is to frame the questions so that they conform to the following criteria The questions must be written in such a way that the people supplying the answers understand what is required. For example, if expectant mothers were asked to supply information about their diet it would not be advisable to ask questions about proteins and carbohydrates but about meat, cheese, bread and so on. Questions must be unambiguous. The writer of the question might have a clear picture of what information he wants to collect but unless the question he asks cannot be misconstrued he cannot be sure that he will get the right answer. For example, if in a study of the harmful effects of working with x-rays, radiographers were asked, "How many years do youintend to work as a radiographer?", some would probably interpret this as "How many years longer do you intend to work as a radiognapher?" while others would probably interpret this as "How many years do you intend to work as a radiographer including those years already worked?" Another example of ambiguity concerns smoking habits. It would not be much use asking "Do you smoke?" because apart from the great differences there would be in the amount smoked of those answering "yes", the man who had never smoked in his life and the man who had given up smoking only six months ago or perhaps even days ago after smoking heavily for 40 years would both answer "no".The greatest safeguard against ambiguity is to refer the questionnaire for comment to as many people as practicable before the survey proper is made. This procedure is known as a pilot survey and is discussed further below. Special terms should be defined where possible. For instance, if information about Maoris and non-Maoris is being collected the definition of Maori should be given. For some purposes the definition might be a person of half Maori blood or more. Again when we talk of Maoris / 22 The need arises from time to time for morbidity information which is unobtainable from routine statistics. In such instances a special one-purpose, one-time analysis of hospital notes would need to be conducted. For example, information may be desired either at a local level by hospital administrators or at a national level by the Department of Health as to the type of admission (emergency or waiting list), period On waiting list, distance travelled to hospital, type of discharge (for rehabilitation purposes), types of treatment carried out for certain conditions and their outcome or even in respect of problems of nursing or personal care. One survey of this kind to shed light on the respective roles of hospital and home in meeting the medical and social needs of the elderly is documented in a Health Department Report "Elderly Persons' Accommodation Needs in New Zealand" (Department of Health Special Report, Series No. 10, April 1963). •It is conceivable that in the future there will be expansion into new subject areas, in which the answers will not be contained in the patient's notes. The question here will have an epidemiological purpose, background information to the hospitalised sickness being sought in the war of living and eating habits, occupational status of patient, past sickness episodes, etc. In this type of interview survey, probe questions have to be put to elicit the required answers. An ad hoc survey cannot be carried out on the spur of the moment and much careful planning is required at the onset. In particular does this warning apply to the design of the questionnaire or collection form although the necessity for both consultation with a statistician and a trial run are emphasised before the ad hoc study gets under way. The design of . the questionnaire or transcript form: 9.1. The very first move must be to write out the aim of the ptudy and to specify the topics about which information is needed. Too many ad hoc studies are carried through to the point where results have been tabulated from punch cards only to . find that the answers obtained still do not provide answers to the questions that prompted the study in the first place. If on the other hand the aim and topics are written down at the onset the person wanting the information must clarify his own thinking and by putting his thoughts on paper can critically evaluate what he has written.If this procedure is followed some ad hoc studies are The information collected at the time of the census in 1966 was Name of hospital Name of patient Sex Marital status Age Race:Maori/non-Maori Domicile Date admitted Diagnosis (principal disease or injury for which admitted) Speciality (of physician or surgeon under whose care patient was at time of census, e.g. orthopaedic, E.N.T.j psychiatric) Was this a waiting list admission: yes or no For the 1966 waiting list census the information obtained was: Name of hospital Name of patient Sex Age (at time name was placed on waiting list) Date last contacted Principal condition (for which treatment to be given) In most hospitals the night nurse or ward sister in charge Of each ward was the person delegated to fill in the return as at midnight on the date chosen which was 22 March 1966. An analysis of the returns received in 1951 is contained in two tables in the Medical Statistics Report - Part II Morbidity, 1961, One table covers occupied beds in private hospitals and the other beds in public hospitals by disease groups and ages. The analysis shows that the public hospitals are utilised more by persons in the younger age groups. This is evident for every age group up to 65 years, thereafter the private hospitals show the greater proportion of older patients. 9.The ad hoc study There are certain types of investigation and statistical activity in which the Medical Records Officer may become involved other than routine national collections of patient data. p91. 22 The procedure suggested is that as case records are returned for filing the record clerk makes an entry in the appropriate place on a working sheet, one of which is provided for each column in the final table. At the end of each period the figures for the period are written on the final form which is then transmitted to the central office. Tabulation Lack of flexibility severely limits the tabulations and they can be no more than summaries of the information provided forthe whole area covered by the survey, or for different parts of it. Pates can be calculated if the respective populations are available. A series of successive returns can be used to produce time trends for particular aspects or can be summarised to produce a single return for the whole period. National hospital census taking inpatients and waiting-list patients: 8. The routine collection furnishes us with a great deal of information obtained after the discharge or death of the patient. We are able to obtain from our routine statistics for any hospital and for all hospitals combined, a measure of the relative incidence of broad groups of diseases, by sex, age, period in hospital and average stay. These data are sufficient for most purposes but because the records are processed only after the end of the patient's stay, it can be a very long time, in the caseof chronic cases, before particulars of a case in hospital come into the statistics. It is through this influence that the bed requirements for pulmonary tuberculosis of 12 per cent appears from the figure of discharges and deaths to be only 2.7 percent. A census taken of inpatient population involves the completion of a card on a particular day for each patient either in. hospital or on the waiting list for hospital admission. This type of study gives us a cross-sectional picture of both old occupancy and the unfulfilled demand for hospital beds. by type of sickness. This census information is essential for hospital planning on a national basis and for comparison of trends of hospitalisation over a long term. By taking a census at intervals of five years changes in trends of the causes of hospitalisation can be measured and bed requirements for broad groups of diseases can be forecast. STATISTICS OF OUTPATIENT CONSULTATIONS Period ended.............. 19....., Name of hospital........ .... Return for MALES/FEMALES* .................o... New casesOld cases Department -P0 Ho0 xi (tHC.r1 cd +o Ho0 J1. co 10 All -'O1C.rI5•rl -0)-1 (I) Cu 00 C5 Q a) •d 44 Cu (1) .d H ESeS. ESa5 Ed'dOOOP Edd 000 Ci.r-1 Cu 43 U) Cu U) co Q Cu a)CtiCHOZC)110 -H CZ General medicine Paediatrics Infectious disease Diseases of the chest Other medical specialities Chronic sick Geriatrics General surgery Ear, nose and throat Traumatic and orthopaedic surgery Ophthalmology Other surgical specialities Gynaecology Obstetrics. . Special care babies.. Other, specialities' ... General practice units Maternity Other medical Dentistry lUTALi *Delete whichever is not applicable C r1C a)_ZO- cases 22 (c) Disposal For administration purposes, it is important To make some estimate of the number of admissions likely to result from outpatient consultations. To this end it is suggested that new and old cases each be further subdivided as follows (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) for immediate admission; for eventual admission; for further consultations; no further consultation likely. (d) Sex It is preferable to differentiate between the sexes of patients. (e) Age While it is desirable to record' the age of patients, broad age-groupings will usually be sufficient. This item is one which can be dispensed with if it is desired to keep the work of the records clerks . to a minimum. (f) Other items Among these can be counted area of residence, occupation, detailâ of how patient came to be seen, e.g. on recommendation of general practitioner, from another hospital, on patient's own account, etc. If any of these factors are included, then others, e.g. age, will probably have to be dropped. For the normal outpatient survey the following factors will be the maximum if the summary method is to be used: type of case (new or old), sex, department or diagnosis, disposal, or another factor, e.g. age • If more information is required, then a more detailed method should be used. Form design On the following page is shown a suggested design of a form for the survey described above. • Collection of data With the number of. items on this form it is suggested that weekly returns should be made: if less information is required, i.e. if one axis of classification is not desired, then it may be possible to lengthen the period between returns. 14 most that can be expected in any statistical investigation is that some small entry be made as each patient's notes are filed away. It is therefore necessary that the organisation of an inquiry into outpatient morbidity should be highly selective, and with definite aims in view, although certain statistics of a general nature may also be collected. It is necessary with outpatient statistics to distinguish the "new" from the old cases, and it is probably fairly simple to do so. The number of follow-up attendances for any one illness may be quite large but very often old patients attend different sessions to new patients, this making separation easy for statistical purposes.Although epidemiological uses-of outpatient statistical data are many, they are not developed enough for routine use at the present, and therefore the suggestions given below for form design will be centred mainly on routine medico-administrative uses. Data to be collected (a) Total outpatient attendances This should be subdivided into new and old cases. A workable definition of a new case is a patient attending the outpatient department of the hospital for the first time for advice or treatment of a particular condition. (b) Diagnoses or departments Whether a diagnostic hat should be compiled is problematical. Many patients seen are not diagnosed completely on first attendance. They may require several consultations or even inpatient care before a firm diagnosis is made, and therefore any diagnostic list must necessarily be a rather crude one. On the other hand, a list of departments or specialties with number of attendances at each, gives little indication of the diagnosis. Nevertheless, for most medico-administrative needs such a list is probably to be preferred. It is suggested that departments be classified, so that addition is facilitated into four major 'specialties, medicine, surgery, obstetrics and gynaecology and. paediatrics. Thus, medicine may include the departments of cardiology, neurology, diseases of the chest, psychiatry, haematology, endocrinology and geriatrics as well as general medicine. 116, 22 Outpatient analyáes: 7. Outpatient and Accident and Emergency department procedures are described in chapter 16. Some statistical analysis of outpatient attendances at clinics is carried out in each hospital but nothing appears to have been done in this country in the way of a statistical analysis on a national scale. Statistics obtained from hospital boards show attendances at outpatient clinics numbered 2 9 80 7,456 including 66,611 attendances for dental outpatients, in the year ending 31 March 1966. With such large numbers involved there is a need to resort to sampling methods if an anlysis in depth were to be attempted. Dr. M.A. Heasman, author of the "Draft Manual of Hospital Morbidity Statistics" issued by the World Health Organisation, has the following to contribute on the subject of outpatient statistics. He recommends the use of the summary method of reporting to a central authority: " There are certain aspects of general morbidity which may be worth investigation from the viewpoint of outpatient statistics. Some conditions are very often peen in outpatients and yet only rarely admitted to hospital. For example, in well-developed countries most diabetic patients probably attend a diabetic clinic at, one time or another; many patients with varicose veins will have them injected or ligatured in the outpatient departments; much sighttesting is done there, and yet with these conditions it is only rarely that inpatient treatment is necessary. There are, therefore, aspects of morbidity which can be investigated by a study of hospital outpatients, but it is to medical administration that we must turn for the greatest uses of the data. In the design of outpatient departments it is of value to know the distribution of cases between one consultant and another, to know the number of cases requiringradio_therapeutjc treatment or some form of operative treatment. Further, it is of value to know the number of patients who require admission and the number who are returned for treatment under their own doctors. There are, therefore, a large number of uses for the data, but by its very nature the problem demands simplicity of treatment. Too many people are seen in the average outpatient department for any detailed statistical data to be collected relating to individual patients, without special arrangement. The #7 It will be noted that hospitals can send in the statistical cards on either a quarterly of a monthly basis, whichever is preferred. Filling in the card: The figures entered on the MS17 Summary Card do not include normal maternity cases or normal nurslings unless these cases occupied general instead of maternity beds. Line 1 Enter the number of patients in hospital at the beginning of the period Line 2 Enter the number of patients admitted during period Line 3 is the sum of lines 1 and 2 Line Lf Enter the number of patients discharged ,ortransferred during, the period Enter the number of patients dying during the 'period Line 5 Line 6 is the sum of lines Li and 5 Line 7 Enter the number of patients in hospital at the end of the period . .. The figures in line 7 will be carried forward to be entered on line 1 of the MS17 card for the next period. Before the statistical return is sent in the MS18 Statistical Cards must be checked with the totals on the MS17 card. The numbers shown in lines 1 4 and 5 must agree absolutely with the' number of MS18 Statistical Cards that are sent in. Another check that must be made is that the figures entered in line 3 agree with the sum of those entered in lines 6 and 7. If there is not complete agreement between these two sets of figures then there is a mistake in the return. The MS18 Statistical Cards should be sent in, in four groups sorted thus: 1. Male deaths 2. Female deaths 3. Male discharges and transfers together, and 14. Female discharges and transfers together Note: The forwarding of a monthly or quarterly return must not be delayed because a small num1ierof case notes have still to be written up. In this eventuality insert the number of cards which make up the full return in lines 4 and 5 with the words "see over" under line 6. Then write the serial numbers and patients' names of the omitted cards on the back of the MS17 Summary Card. 3,'; 22 Filling-in the MS17 Summary Card: A copy of the MS17 Summary Card is reproduced below. HOSPITAL STATISTICS IL—U.S. 17 SUMMARY CARD FOR MONTHLY OR QUARTERLY RETURN (11 it is more convenient, hospitals may arrange with this oca to send in their returns on a monthly basis.) This card (together with the M.S. 18 statistical cards)is to be not to the Medical Statistkisn Boa 6314 Wellington C. 2 immediately alter the end of the month or quarter. Name of Hospital:._. *Monh/ Quarter ended: .. .... l9.... Nom—The figures entered on this card must not include normal maternity cases or normal nurslings. Males f Females I Total 1.Patients in hospital at the beginning of month/quarter* 2. Patients admitted (or readmitted) during month/quarter* 3. Total. 4.Patients discharged or transferred 5.Deaths- 6. M.S. 18 cards sent in must agree with the figures entered against this (6) heading. Total 7.Patients remaining in hospital at end of month/quarter* Nora—The figures entered in (3) must agree with the sum of tines 6 and 7. Delete whichever does not apply. (Signed)--3,00018/63-74957 W Medkal 6.4. (ii) Sex: Mark M for males, F for females (iii) Period in hospital: Mark all three columns, e.g. for one day in hospital mark 001; for 22 days in hospital mark 022; for 333 days in hospital mark 3334 1,000 to 1,999 days: Mark the '1' in the cage above the first column, and the appropriate numbers in the three columns, e.g. 1,162 days should be marked '1' and '1' in the first column, and 1 6' and 1 2' in the second and third columns. 2,000 days and over: Mark the 1 2' in the cage above the first. column, and the apprppriate numbers in the three columns, e.g. 2,162 days should be marked 1 2' and '1' in the first column, and 1 6' and 1 2' in the second and third columns, (iv) Disease A, and Accident Details:In all cases where there is no fourth digit in the code number the 'X' must be marked in the fourth column, e.g. diabetes mellitus should be marked 1260X'. (v) Discharged, Died, Transferred: Mark the appropriate category in the last column on the front of the card. (vi) Disease B, Disease C, Occupation, Domicile, Operation. A and Operation B: These columns are not to be marked. (vii) First admission: Mark 1. or 2 on column 9 on the bacI of the card. (viii) Race: Mark 1, 2 or 3 (Maori, Pacific Islander or other) in column 8 on the back of the card. (ix) Operations: Mark 1 0' in the unlabelled column .7 on the back of the card according to the instructions below. For statistical purposes it is necessary to distinguish between on the one hand, operations for the, principal disease or for a complication of the principal disease and on the other hand, minor operations and diagnostic techniques. The 1 0' should be marked for an operation to the principal disease or for an operation to a complication of the principal disease. . A complication in this sense is a condition arising out of the principal disease. Please do not mark doubtful cases. These will be decided upon in the National Health Statistics Centre. Operations for conditions other than the principal disease or its complications are not to be marked at all. ;fq. 22 may nevertheless be composed of discontinuous lines, none of which will be sufficient to complete the circuit. (ii) Pass through the centre of the figure inside the cage. (iii) Stretch across the cage from bracket to bracket. A short mark may fail to join up the brushes. (iv) Not extend beyond the cage: If the mark projects outside the cage it tends to encroach upon the adjacent column and the brushes may sense the mark in a column where it was not intended to be. (v) Be made with the card resting directly on a hard surface. Plastic tablets are provided by the National Health Statistics Centre for this purpose. A wooden table top or blotting pad will not do, nor must the top card of a stack of cards be marked on the stack. Unless the card is rested on a hard surface the paper may be dented so that the pencil mark lies at the bottom of a shallow groove. As the card passes through the machine the brushes will ride over the groove and fail to make contact with the mark. (vi) Be done with a soft lead pencil. The pencil must leave enough black lead in the mark on the card to ensure completing the circuit. Therefore the pencil must be a soft one, preferably 2Bor a 'Black Beauty' pencil, or one of those specially provided by the National Health Statistics Centre. An HB pencil must not be used. (vii) Errors may be rubbed out with an ordinary soft rubber, but care must be taken that this is done cleanly and that the surface of the card iè not broken. Smudges may act as conductors and cause false punches. Note: On no account should anything be written in lead pencil on the marking section of the card, because of the possibility that the machine will mistake the pencil writing for nrkirg and punch holes in the card in places where no holes were intended to be punched. Detailed instructions for marking: (i) Age: Mark both columns for six in each column; for age column and 6 in the second; mark 00; for ages 100 years 333 6.33. age; e.g. for age 66 mark six years mark 0 in first for ages under one year, or over, mark as 99. When a patient is transferred from Hospital A to Hospital B for treatment of the same illness the MS18 card from Hospital. B should show the patient as a readmission even if the admission is the first the patient has made to Hospital B. (xvii) Race: Encircle the figure in front of the category which applies. A patient is reported statistically as a Maori if he is of half Maori ancestry or more and as a Pacific Islander if he is of half Pacific Island ancestry or more. A patient of half Pacific Island and half Maori ancestry is to be reported statistically as a Maori. All other patients should be reported as , 'other'. 6.3 Pencil-marking 'the MS18 'Statistical Card 6.5.1 The mark-sensing process The information recorded on the MS18 Statistical Card: is translated onto numerical codes and holes are punched onto the card to correspond to these figures by a special machine 'in the National Health Statistics Centre. The link between the codes and the punched holes is provided by pencil marks which are made in indicated places on the MS18 Statistical Card. Once the cards have been marked, they are passed through, the machine under a line of electrified metal brushes which ,sweep the surface of each card. As soon as the brushes pass overa pencil mark, a circuit is completed and the machine punches a hole in the card. Once the holes have been punchedthe.marking has no further use, the cards later being sorted and counted according to the holes. It is important to remember that the marks are not to look at but are to serve as 'switches.' to work the punching machine. The black lead in the mark acts as an electricity conductor between the brushes at the time the mark passes under them. The system is ingenious and works very well if the marks are well made. 6.3.2 The criteria of good marking Each mark must: (i) Be continuous: A bold pencil stroke back and forth across the cage (i.e. the space between the brackets enclosing the number) is the best way to do this. Pressure should be firm and even. , Do not try to shade in the area, for although shading may look very neat it UZ 22 (xii) Any other disease influencing length of stay: There is no need to record any condition here unless it modified treatment of the principal cause or led to extra or less time being spent in hospital. (xiii) accident details: A. How:State as fully as possible the circumstances under which the accident occurred, not forgetting the agent involved, e.g. lawnmower, axe, fall from ladder. etc. B. Where: State where the accident occurred so that the following code can be applied 0.Home 1 1Farm, orchard 2.Mine, quarry 30Factory, workshop, mill, construction job 4. Playground, gymnasium, park, school-playground etc. Road, highway 5. 6. Public building, office, schoolroom Resident institution, hospital 7. 8. Other places - river, beach, mountain, bush (xiv) Operations: Insert operation descriptions and the dates. (xv) Patient discharged died, transferred: Indicate the category that applies by encircling the figure in front of it. Died means died while staying in hospital. Transfer means transferred to another public hospital which sends hospital cards (Ms 18) to the National Health Statistics Centre. Discharged means all others not died or transferred. (xvi) First admission: The purpose of this question is to differentiate between those patients who are admitted to a public hospital for the first time for an episode or injury and those patients who are readmitted to a public hospital for a continuation of an . illness or injury. In general another attack of an acute condition such as bronchopneumonia is not to be regarded as a continuation of an earlier infection but the reverse would be the case with a chronic condition such as arthritis, heart disease, multiple sclerosis, bronchitis, tuberculosis, etc. 391 (viii) Date admitted, date of departure, period in hospital: Period in hospital can usually be counted by simple subtraction, e.g. admitted 1st June, discharged 13 June,. period in hospital 12 days, Do not include in the total the day the patient was admitted as well as the day of discharge.. If a patient is admitted and discharged on the same day record the period in hospital as one day. A table for calculation of period in hospital is included on page 8 of the Hospital Statistics Handbook. (ix). Waiting list admission: Emergency admission: Encircle the figure in front of the category which applies. Emergency admission includes all cases not admitted from the waiting list. Waiting list includes surgical, geriatric and investigation cases. (x) Principal disease or injury for which admitted: When two or more diseases are recorded on the case notes all may be entered on the card but only the most important is to be coded in space A. The following points should be used as a guide for selection: (a) If one condition is symptomatic of an other, code the underlying condition e.g. admitted f or retention of urine caused by pros tatic hyperplasia - select prostatic hyperplasia. (b) Do not record a provisional diagnosis when a final diagnosis is available. (c). Current injuries and acute poisonings are usually regarded as principal causes except when (i) a serious disease results from a minor injury, as tetanus or septicaemia from a superficial injury, or (ii) a poisoning represents a reaction to therapeutic procedures, in which case the disease under treatment is selected as the principal cause. Reactions from immunisations and other prophylatic procedures are usually sole causes. (d) For multiple injuries a general order of preference is internal injuries, fractures, burns, open wounds, dislocations, sprains, contusions and superficial injuries. Always state.both the nature of the injury and the site. (xi) Principal complications of A: This space is to be used for complications, that is to say additional illnesses following from the same cause, and not merely conditions which are otherwise associated and which should be entered under 'C'. 580 22 Note: If a baby born in hospital needs treatment for any condition (except preventive circumision) it then becomes (statistically) a patient in its own right and a statistical card should be prepared giving full details. (i) Hospital: Insert name of hospital (ii) Serial No.: Insert the number under which the medical record is filed. This number will be quoted on query forms and on medical research questionnaires. It will enable medical records staff to extract medical records from the files without referring to the index. (iii) Surname: Christian name: Names supplied often need to be transcribed onto another form or indexed in a chronic disease register. Write the full name with correct spelling and write clearly. (iv) : Insert the age in complete years at time of admission. For ages under one week show as 1/365, 2/365 etc., for ages one week and under four weeks show as 1/52, 2/52 or 3/52; for ages four weeks and under one year show - as 1112, 2112 and so on. Do not also show half weeks or half months or half years. Where age is not known always write, an estimated age and do not write 'not known'. (v) Sex: Write M for male and F for female (vi) Occupation: Industry: When an occupation such as engineer, labourer, or machinist is only meaningful when linked with the industry add the industry data (e.g. marine, building, clothing) to the occupation space. Never write 'retired' or 'pensioner' but supply former occupation. (vii) Domicile: It is important that this item be supplied with some precision in order that the twofold purpose of identification and allocation for disease incidence may be fulfilled. Each case must be able to be allocated according to the districts as set down in the census enumeration. For city dwellers enter name of suburb (Herne Bay, Miramar, Sumner, etc.) If within a borough or township enter name of borough, but for patients who live close to a borough boundary but not actually within the boundary insert the name of the locality but not the borough or township. If the address is rural write in full as, say, 'Waimate R.D.2. 1 . Where applicable write 'overseas visitor' or 'overseas seaman'. n9 (ii) Babies born in hospital (normal nurslings) who are discharged before they are 15 days old. When a baby born in hospital is formally admitted on the 15th day a statistical card should then be prepared for it. The diagnosis should be shown as Boarder'. n n n n n n n n n Ca U UUU UU "12 ____ fi fi fi fi fi C' fifil_ fi'.C) no c'J 00 "103 N— 00 C) )<o — U U U U U U U U U u U U 0 U U U U U U . 0 U ° . ., a " 0 '.0 N- 00 L - C) — U l U U U •U UUU U UU U 0 U U U U U U U U ___ - I J N— C?') '0 - , '.r) c\ nn fl n fin C' fi C' nn n n n r n '.. fin CT) 00 N- 03 '.C) '0- 0 00 '0- J) 03 N__ ,,. 0 N— — CC) N— U U.0 U U U U U U U U " U.0 U U U U U U -fi.fi• fi fin fi fi fi fi fi n n n C' fi fi fi cm nn .. 0) 00 '.0f) CC)N.J C) ,..) )?) 0)f) '.0 N- 00 0010 $ U U U U U U UU.0 UU U U U LU U UUUJfi fi fi fi C' fi fi fi fi C' ThUcfi c n fin10 00 '.0 Jf) 0 2 0) 00 N— N) '0 ).J') 03 U U U U U U U.— U U U U U U U U U U U U U fififi n fin (\LC) finn fi.-_a N—CD- rn -.s C?) CC) 'D '.0 N- CO C) °_±... C) N— N— N— • -.0 U • U U U U U U U U U-.__ fi fii_ fifl C' C'fiC\ fififi N- 00 0) N—CC) uU ____ U '0 UU U '0 _U f) U '.0 U U U U_UU .., fi Qfi "0 a U_L_U __ -.0c . •- Ui__ -d G NO ssiwav isui tR •.ti U __________ _. C' fi fi fi fi r\ fi fi fi fi-_____fi 0)00 •.....N—CD )J)'.0N-,000) C).-.-.C.JC?) U U.... 'U', U U - U UU U U U U U U U fi n fin. fi•.fi•.fi..fi••fi fi fi n: _C? 03 0)- C)) 00 N--10 .03 '. CC) — NJ CC) '0 Jf) U.0 U .U.U.U,UU.UU U U U U U UU U - _ 2 fi fi fl fi fi fi fi fi fi N—. nn— n )J N) C' 0 . . -•-u. .0i )0________. .. U11•\U 1\(\t\. 00 N— CO NJ,. 2 oU U U U U U U U U U 0 0)_0I ______ wi CM fifi fi , fi fi ,fi fi , fi fi fi 0) 00. N— . CO. CC) '0 CC) N— — C:) CC) CC) . It NOISSIWGV 10 3dAI ____ fi fl fi fi fi fi.Tfi' fi n: Cy fi 0)co-•'.') ,'0 'f?)N— -. .-. cd - ------ -- fi n fi 0) (V 00 . fi (i..(\ . rnr N— — N— '.0 CC) .-. CC) U U U U U U U U U U nnn nnn finn n 0) 00 N— CO CC) '0 (C) N— — 0 U U U UU U U U U U fin 0) 03 ----------- -'so a) U flu - uJ - ILl fi0') U fi 0) U fi 4 00 U N— CO U') '0 C?) U UU U U N— — U U U UU _U , L' I --2 a C C?: Ui 0 !' a • Ca fi 0) U fi0) U 0) U U _U__U - ni —. e 00 N— CO CC) U U fi fi fi fi fi fi fi c fi . , CO N— '.0 Ct) '0 CC) N— — U U U U U U U U U no fl fi . fi fi fi fi C) 00 N— '.0 4') '0 CC) 0'4 — CD U U U U •U U U. U U. fifi nnn nfl n 00 CC- CO CC) '0 C)') N— — CD c_ '0 N) N—C) U U U U U U U U U fi fi fi n fi fi CO N— CO '.0) '0 CC) N- — CD U U U U U U U U U finn n finn nn CO N—' 03 i.l') '0 CC) N— '° C) U U n U UU U U U U fi fifi finn n 3D C CO CC?) '0. 00' N— — 0 U U U U U U U U UU 'if 22 Section 62. Non-disclosure of medical information. (i) Subject to the provisions of the section, no person employed by a Board (whether as an honorary or part-time medical officer or otherwise) shall give to any person not employed by the Board any information concerning the condition or treatment of any patient in any institution without the prior consent of the patient or his representative, whether the patient is still in the institution or not (2) Nothing in this section shall apply with respect to (f) Information required by the Director-General of Health for statistical purposes. Section 82. Duty to furnish information. (1) The Director-General may at any time, by notice in writing, require any Board to furnish to him such returns or other information as may be specified in the notice, and in such manner as he may from time to time require, with respect to any institution or service under the control of the Board, or to the management thereof or any matters connected therewith, or generally with respect to the affairs of the Board. (2) It shall be the duty of the Board so to furnish the returns or other information specified in the notice within such time as may be specified in the notice. The information collected by the National Health Statistics Centre under the authority of the Hospitals Act is used solely for statistical purposes and is regarded as highly confidential by the Department. Filling in the MS18 Statistical Card: 62. page. The M18 Statistical Card is illustrated on the following An MS18 Statistical Card is prepared for each patient, except those shown below, admitted to public hospitals. Exceptions: (i) Normal maternity patients who occupy beds designated as 'maternity' beds whether in a ward, annexe or separate hospi al. 5.2 Selectivity - by the patient There are other factors such as ignorance of disease symptoms and distance from hospital which must be taken into the reckoning in interpreting hospital statistics as an index of communal health. The need for a patient to attend at hospital must be associated with a desire to attend unless the decision is to be taken out of the patient's hands. While they are undoubtedly extreme cases, health surveys taken out in Maori rural communities have shown that much serious illness goes untreated and that all too often acute pain from symptoms and handicapping disabilities are stoically endured. This attitude does not always arise out of poverty and one example was that of a prosperous Maori famer in his forties who had a congenital cleft palate which he had never considered having treated.Club-foot is another relatively common condition in Maori school children, which it is sometimes difficult to persuade parents to have treated. In a number of cases distance. from hospital and the cost and inconvenience involved results in a postponement of hospital admission. It should be noted that resistance to hospital treatment for reasons stated is not confined to Maoris and the same factor, if only to a lesser extent perhaps, would apply to our non-Maori population. Patients living on the perimeter of a hospital board district may be able to choose whether they are treated at one hospital or another.While convenience of access, especially by the patient's visitors, may be the dominant factor such intangiblesas p'ersonl prejudice and hospital reputation may affect the decision. 6.In-patient statistical returns Information contained in this section is a summary of the Hospital Statistics Handbook issued for the use of medical records personnel in all public hospitals. The Handbook gives definitions which cover each item and category on the MS18 statistical card. In addition, the method by which medical data contained in the notes is transcribed into the small spaces provided on the combined written-punch card is set out in detail with examples. Also explained is the way in which accident, homicide and suicide detail is to be furnished in cases of injury. 6.1 Legal authority to collect returns The Director-General of Health is empowered under the Hospitals Act 1957 to collect from hospital boards information for statistical purposes. The relevant sections of the Act are: 176 22 The study of . hospital morbidity has the advantage that records of diagnosis, although by no means perfect, are likely to be the most accurate. obtainable. With few exceptions, all cases will be seen by medical practitioners. In addition, all the routine aids to accurate diagnosis (e.g. radiology) will usually be available in a New Zealand hospital. The quality of diagnosis would be higher in hospital records than in those of the family doctor. We thus have in hospital statistics an easily defined basic concept of hospitalisation, a high standard of diagnosis, but a yield of experience which is by no means representative of the total sickness in a community, although often related to it. Selectivity - by the hospital: 5.1. The first qualification to hospital morbidity collections is the one of selection of patients for admission because of lack of bed space. The 1966 census of hospital patients showed that 31,540 patients were on the waiting lists of all public hospitals throughout New Zealand. Despite the ever-increasing turn-over of patients and heavy expenditure on construction, many hospital boards are faced with an insatiable demand for bedsand there are long waiting lists of people needing treatment. Obviously the severer types of illness are' given priority and this produces an element of bias. New Zealand has a freely available hospital service with hospital situated to serve district needs. Hospitals placed in rural areas, because of the advent of rapid and convenient transport, will tend to remain small, catering only for emergency cases or disorders of a minor or routine nature with the larger base hospitals, equipped as they are with a wide range 'of treatment facilities, accepting cases on transfer or by other 'specific direction.Furthermore, the very largest of our urban hospitals have established units which specialise in the more intricate techniques such as brain, thoracic and plastic surgery. Asa consequence they draw off a significant proportion of the total cases appearing in the whole country. The , effect of all this is that statistics confined to a single hospital or to a group of hospitals under the same board may be selective in character and can present a misleading picture of local or area levels of sickness.The problem is overcome on a national compilation basis by tabulations according to the domicile of the patient, the incidence. rates for each disease being calculated on the denominator of the population as shown at the five-yearly census. Of course re-admissions must be excluded from disease incidence tabulations. A (iii) (iv) (v) (vi) Number of discharges and total days stay Number of transfers and total days stay Number of cases having an operation and total days stay Number of readmissions From this tabulation the following data can be extracted by the hospital about patients treated each year (i) The number of discharges and deaths for each disease (ii) The number of days beds were occupied for each disease (iii) The number of deaths and the diagnosis of thoedying (iv) (v) The number of patients transferred for each disease The number of new cases and readmissions for each disease The summary also provides, the data for such calculations as the proportional hospitalisation ratio, the hospital death ratio, the case fatality rate and the average stay of patients for each diagnostic group. 5.The limitations of hospital morbidity statistics It is well to be cognisant of the deficiencies of public' hospital statistics so that the conclusions we draw from them may not be misleading. A person to be hospitalised is usually ill, physically or mentally, and this illness has reached a stage where his medical advisers consider that a period in hospital is advisable. The universe of hospital patients thus consists of only a proportion of all those persons who are unwell, many others who may have required hospital treatment being either unable to do so or not wishing to obtain it. This proportion varies according to the particular condition under consideration; patients with some conditions are nearly always hospitalised, others only rarely. The severity of the illness before hospitalisation becomes advisable, also differs considerably with each condition. Some patients are virtually well, yet admission to hospital is advisable in order that the optimum condition be present for treatment, such as a minor operation to correct some trifling abnormality.. At the other extreme, a patient with another condition may be admitted only when domiciliary treatment has been tried and has failed and the patient is seriously ill. '1 22 by general practitioners. New drugs have not only reduced the incidence of tuberculosis but they have also shortened the duration of treatment and reduced hospital stay. Some years ago, the demand for hospital beds for tuberculosis cases caused plans to be drawn up for a special tuberculosis hospital in the Horowhenua area. Close to two million dollars was to have been spent on this project, but the dramatic reduction in tuberculosis cases eliminated the need for this sanatorium before it was built. It is necessary that the changing needs and uses of hospital accommodation be kept continually before the planning authorities, and one of the most important, and indeed often the only method of observing these changes is by the intelligent use of hospital based collections of data. For this purpose the Operational Research Unit has been set up within the Department of Health, its objectives being to make the most efficient use of hospital facilities and skilled medical staff. This unit shows how hospitals can be built more scientifically, taking into account the changing functional requirements of outpatient departments, wards, clinical services, laboratories, theatres and all the other components of our present-day hospitals. National statistics routinely compiled have limited uses for this unit and it commonly makes ad hoc studies within selected hospitTs to obtain the basic data. The National Health Statistics Centre prepares a table each year which contains dignostic and length of stay information about patients discharged from or dying in each public hospil;al. A copy of this table is sent to the hospital concerned and has proved to be an extremely valuable research and administrative document. Each year's cases are presented for each of the 806 three digit categories of the International Classification of Diseases. The title to each of these categories has been abbreviated so that it can be accommodated within the limited space available on the printed sheet used by the tabulating machine. The International Classification of Diseases code number is printed alongside each title; thus, if further information is needed about the scope of the title, reference can easily be made to Volume I of the International Classification of Diseases. Against each of these disease headings the following data are printed (i) (ii) Number of discharges, transfers and deaths combined, and the total days stay Number, of deaths and total days stay On applying the relevant average to the number of patients with particular conditions in the different hospitals we obtain the length of time that this group would ordinarily have spent in hospital had they been kept therein on the average for the same length of time that similar •patients were kept in all class I or all New Zealand hospitals depending whether the hospital being considered fell into class I or class II. From this figure it is easy to tell the variation between hospitals, condition by condition, and when the totals are struck there is produced a composite figure which takes into account many conditions in terms of the length of stay to be expected on the average. The Bed-time Index is then calculated by dividing the observed stay by the expected stay and multiplying by 100, The Index is a measure to some extent of the rapidity of turnover of patients in a hospital. It must not of course be concluded that rapid turnover, however, is of necessity good and an indication of an efficiently run hospital, for there must come a stage when over enthusiasm in this regard will lead to patients being discharged so soon that they come to harm or their prognosis is made worse.On the other hand there must be an optimum time for discharge after which no further benefit follows longer hospitalisation, and so far as the Bed-time Index takes into account the average practice obtaining in a wide diversity of hospitals for a considerable number of common conditions, the figure of 100 may be regarded as approximating to such an optimum, with a bias (if it exists) being rather towards a longer stay than is really needed, than the other way round. Certain hospitals with a high index may argue that they cater for .a widely scattered population and that they are unable to discharge many of their cases as early as they would wish , because they are doubtful about their after care in a backblocks area. In practice this argument is not so strong as it may seem for few people live in great isolation.. The advances that take place in both preventive and curative medicine will all have their effect on hospital administration, and often the scientific significance of the advance is out of all proportion to its repercussions on the need for hospital facilities. The introduction of new methods of diagnosis or treatment may increase the demands on hospital care, they may change its type or they may decrease the need. For example, the introduction of thiouracil in the treatment of thyrotoxicosis first reduced the requirement for surgical, and increased the need for medical beds; then as familiarity with the use of the drug increased, the overall requirement was reduced as more and more patients could be treated effectively as outpatients or at home 22 The Bed-time Index first appeared in the 1953 Medical Statistics Report, In the previous year a comparison had been made between large and small hospitals in terms of length of stay in hospital for a number of groups of conditions. These conditions, however, were predominantly surgical and it was felt that greater use could be made of the Index if medical as well as surgical conditions were included. For the next nine years the method of compiling the Index was unchanged. In 1963, however, two important developments occurred in that patients who had been transferred out of hbspital were excluded from the calculations and the selected diagnoses on which the calculations were based were made more representative of all patients treated in general hospitals. The Bed-time Index consists of two groups of hospitals: class I or those having in the particular year reviewed a daily average of over 200 occupied beds, and class II or those having a daily average of between 100 and 200 accupied beds. The Index for the class I hospitals is 'based on the average length of stay of cases in this class only but that for class II hospitals is based on the overall New Zealand averages. This was thought to be fairer to the class II hospitals in any comparison with class I hospitals as it offset to some extent the improved staff and equipment enjoyed by class I hospitals. The method of calculating the Index is simply to apply the average length of stay for class I or all New Zealand hospitals, as the case may be, to the number of patients admitted to individual hospitals with those conditions chosen for the construction of the Index. People dying in hospitals are excluded from this analysis so as to overcome the objection that a hospital where a high fatality rate prevails might for this reason alone have a better index than one where life is more effectively prolonged. In practice this is not found to be an important factor in respect of conditions covered in the Index but nevertheless it is thought better to exclude deaths on rational grounds. Similarly, patients are excluded who were transferred out of hospital to another public hospital for further treatment of the condition for which the original admission was made, . In some hospitals it is policy to transfer cases after surgery to a convalescent hospital under . the control of the hospital board. In such cases the days stay of patients in the convalescent hospital was taken into account when the index for the parent hospital was being computed. 110.20 Treatment Institutional administration 1.6.00 Heat, light, power and water.12.80 50.80 Household Buildings and grounds8.30 0.10 Miâcellaneous 198.20 If hospitals are to be run efficiently then information is required as to the use being made of 'the hospital beds. The populatipn of the catchment area from which each hospital draws its patients is known by age, sex and race so , that proportional hospitalisation rates can be calculated showing the pattern of disease in each area. Hospital construction needs to be examined against the use which would be made of the accommodation in the immediate future as well as in the light of the future load*'. A simple illustration is the need to provide more geriatric beds because of predictions that higher proportions of New Zealand's population are likely to be found in the.,upper age brackets in future years. Facilities of a specialised and costly nature need to be similarly examined against the numbers of expected cases and th demands of the future. Examples are in connection with the installation of super-voltage equipment and the location of specialist' cardio-thoracic and neuro-surgical units as well as 'cent'res for the treatment of spinal injury. It is desirable that length of stay in hospital should be kept to a minimum consistent with the welfare of the patient, in order that waiting lists can be reduced and as many patients as possible treated. A compariBon of the length of stay of patients with the same disease in different hospitals may show that one, hospital discharges patients either earlier or later on the average than the other. This can point the way to better methods of treatment. Differences in stay between individual diseases may be so small as to prevent conclusior being drawn from them and it has been found preferable to select certain groups of conditions that are likely to give some indication of the efficiency of a hospital in terms of the response to treatment and the length of hospitalisation which that treatment has entailed. A popular term for this is "medical auditing" and the end result of the arithmetic calculation is known in New Zealand as the Bed-time Index. 22 As four-fifths at least of all illness hospitalised come into the New Zealand collection scheme an estimate of the incidence of many diseases can be arrived at and the disease itself can be examined in relation to racial, economic (occupation), geographical and climatic factors and thus assist research on pathogenesis and aetiology of disease. The efficacy of health education and preventive measures can be gauged by changes in the rate of hospital admissions. The effect of changes in treatment can be studied by changes in incidence of hospitalised illness, duration of stay and case fatality ratio. Indeed, with special planning the results of different forms of treatment, including types of surgical operations, can be studied in relation to the characeristics of the patient. Educational uses of accident material: 1+,2. Very extensive use is made of the statistics of admissions for accident both by New Zealand and overseas agencies. Most of the enquiries come from government departments as well as the many. societies concerned with accident prevention on the road, in the home, on the farm, and in the factory. In addition to this the New Zealand Standards Institute, the Consumer Institute and sundry manufacturers are supplied with information on request about injuries received while appliances such as electric radiators, washing machines, tractors and types of power equipment were being used or in respect of clothing materials which present fire hazards. The figures of poisonings from the use of sprays, disinfectants and other chemical preparations in homes, market gardens and factories are also closely scrutinised. Health Education Officers of the Health Department throughout the country make very extensive use of accident statistics for propaganda purposes while the World Health Organisation issues New Zealand statistics for use by other countries which do not have this type of information available. Administrative uses, national and local: 43, The hospital system is generally an important unit in a nation's health service. It is also an expensive one, the average daily expenditure for each individual inpatient treated in a New Zealand general hospital being, in 1965-6 close to $13. 00 . On the average each patient costs the taxpayer just under $20100 in 1965-6 made up as follows - At the time of the taking of each population census (every 5 years) statistics are obtained of each patient under treatment. Census methods of collecting hospital material are described in section 8 which follows. From time to time special purpose studies in depth are carried out linked to the routine public hospital collections. The methods employed to carry out a study of hospital case notes or of patients while in hospital are described in section 9 which follows. k. The uses made of hospital morbidity statistics, As mentioned in an earlier paragraph, hospital statistics cannot provide information about the incidence and prevalrice of all types of illness in the community, but they can. give substantial information about many of-the chronic diseases and impairments of a more serious nature. 1+.1 Medical research and epidemiological uses As, under the New Zealand system, the punch card isalso the collection card, when filed away these form a mechanised index to diseases treated. This index is at the disposal o any clinician who is investigating a disease and who wishes t use it. Lists of names, hospital and hospital number.can be supplied to the research clinician concerned. For a selected group of chronic diseases on which particular attention is focussed such as hydatid disease and multiple sclerosis, small registers are maintained. Each treatment undergone over the years is recorded and through this follow-up system the progress of the patient can be studied. This method is sometimes described as longitudinal analysis of sickness ecperienced; for conditions which occur frequently such as myocardial infarction these follow-up studies may be done on a sampling basis. Information, including incidence data, is routinely supplied to overseas medical units which may be carrying out intensive research into severe but relatively uncommon diseases. New Zealand offers an almost unique opportunity to establish the true incidence of many of the severe types of disease because a high percentage, if not all cases, which occur come into our hospital morbidity collection. of 22 Hospital morbidity statistics: 2.2. Hospital morbidity statistics consist of information collected concerning the individual patient: the items fall under three headings (a) Personal characteristics, e.g. name, sex, address, occupation, age, race. (b) Administrative particulars, e.g. date of admission, date of discharge (or death), duration of stay, type of discharge. In some countries such data as type of bed, department in which treated, type of admission (emergency or other) are recorded and it is hoped to extend the New Zealand collectioi scheme along these lines in the future, (c) Medical details, e.g. principal disease for which admitted, complications, other diseases treated, details of operations performed. In some countries items such as nature of other treatment, medical investigations, etc. are covered. The collection of information may relate to either inpatient or outpatient treatment. In the majority of instances the statistical treatment of these two types will be widely different. Outpatients are very much more numerous than inpatients and are likely to become very much more so as domiciliary care services develop to conserve the use of hospital beds for acute cases and to encourage the care of the sick as far as possible in their own homes. Because of their numbers, time and staff are not usually available for more than the recording of the briefest details concerning outpatients. Details concerning inpatients are much more easily collected than details concerning outpatients. For this reason, and, more important still, because the most costly part of hospital treatment is that of the inpatients, most of the development in hospital statistics is in the inpatient field. Private hospitals and solely maternity hospitals do not forward statistical returns for individual patients. Indeed, very little in the way of case-notes are kept in private hospitals, most of the information concerning the patient being in the possession of the surgeon or physician in charge of the patient. Statistical returns are received from all public hospitals. The coverage is about 80 percent of all inpatient treatment. 1. Introduction In order to reveal our health problems and to carry out measures for disease control it is essential to have some idea of the kind and extent of ill-health in the community. Hospital statistics go some way towards meeting this requirement in that while they are largely confined to the severer types of illness (90 percent of sickness in a community is treated outside of hospital) they do cover a wide range of illness, injury and disability. New Zealand, with its free public hospital system, is able to produce hospital statistics which have much more coverage of the population than those produced by most other countries. As a result our hospital statistics do indicate the true incidence of many forms of disease.. New Zealand is a welfare state and the cost of hospital treatment is paid out of taxation. Each day spent in hospital costs the equivalent of a day's stay in one of the country's most luxurious hotels. For this high cost reason hospital statistics are of value to the administrator in making the best use of hospital beds in terms of patient-movement and days of care for specific diseases. Statistics of discharge by diagnosis and length of stay as measured by. the Bed-time Index show variations between hospitals which may be due to factors such as attitudes of physicians or lack of home nursing and other extramural hospital services. 2. The types of hospital statistics Hospital statistics readily divide into two distinct groups with different applications (i) (ii) Hospital administrative statistics which relate to. the hospital. Hospital morbidity statistics which relate • tc the patient whether inpatient or outpatient. 2.1 Hospital administrative statistics Hospital administrative statistics are not usually the concern of a medical records department. Such data are assembled locally by the secretarial and accountancy departments, while on a national level the Hospitals Division of the Department of Health collects. returns from Hospital Boards supplements these with data relating to its own institutions and presents all this information in a publication entitled "Hospital Statistics of New Zealand". The volume is issued as a supplement to the Report of the Department of Health which is presented by the Director-General to the House of Representatives each year.. 22 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand HOSPITAL MORBIDITY STATISTICS 1. Introduction 2. The:two types of hospital statistics 2.1 Hospital administrative statistics 2.2 Hospital morbidity statistics 3. The source of our hospital morbidity data 14• The uses made of hospital morbidity statistics 4.1 Medical research and epidemiological uses 4.2 Educational uses of accident material 4.3 Administrative uses, national and local 5. The limitations of hospital morbidity statistics 5.1 Selectivity - by the hospital 5.2 Selectivity - by the patient 6. Inpatient statistical returns 6.1 Legal authority to collect returns 6.2 Filling-in the MS18 Statistical Card 6.3 Pencil-marking the MS18 Statistical Card 6.3.1 The mark-sensing process 6.3.2 The criteria of good marking 6.3.3 Detailed instructions for marking 6.4 Filling-in the MS17 Summary Card 7. Outpatient analyses 8. National hospital census taking - inpatient and waiting list patients 9. The ad hoc study 9.1 The design of the questionnaire or transcript form 9.2. The pilot survey 9.3 Sampling 9.+ The prospective study 9.5 The retrospective study 9 . 5.1 Choice of a control group 9.6 The cohort study 10. References —'----1-i-i— Further reading Wr Coulam (N.R.) Economy of effort in Medical Record keeping Medical Record, Feb. Denver (J.C.) Thoughts on the open office Office Methods & Machines, May 1965, pp 353-5 1963, pp 615-25 Griffiths (C,M.) People matter Office Methods & Machines, Aug. 1965, pp 615-6 1 630 Heat, humidity, noise, lighting, colour. 1+ steps to efficiency: conference reports Office Methods & Machines, March 1967, pp 19-21 Johns (E.) The Medical Record Librarian: 3. of tomorrow Jnl AAMRL, Dec. 1961, (Lincoln & Naylor) Record department administration, physical plant, functional organisation and other factors end mt. Congress Report, PP 150-67 'Medical Records' N.Z. Hospital, June 1952 Moores (N.M.) Computors and Medical Records Medical Record,.Feb. 1963, Schenthal, Sweeney, Nettleton & Yoder. Clinical application of Electronic Data Processing Apparatus. III. System for processing of medical records Jnl. American Medical Assn., Oct. 12, 1963 pp 101-5 p 257 p6 pp 61+0-i 3"- 21 Holmes (C.N.) Planning a newMedical Record, Nov. Medical Records Department - 11957, pp 283-4 Huffman (Edna K.) Manual for Medical U.S.A., Berwyn, Ill., Reôord Librarians, pp 458-63 Physicians' Record Co., ('Planning a Medical Records 1 959, xxx +604, illus. Department for a specific situation') Knapp (K.N.) Planning a new Medical Records Department - 2 McWilliams (Gordon) Who will plan your department? Medical Record, Nov. 1957, pp 285-6 • Medical Record News, Dec. 1965, pp 327-30, 373-k Mansell (Elsie Royle) A new Medical Records Department Medical Record, May Mellem (P.) Planning the medical record department Hospitals, Oct. 16, 196 2 1 pp 37-42; Hospital Abstracts, March 1963 p 130 Medical Record News, Aug. 1964, pp 142-5, Ramsey (Sister M.E.) Five years to success .1962 9 p. 514-19 172 Report of a Committee of Medical Records in N.S.W. Hospitals Seymour (E.L.) Filing and disposition of records 'Space-saving work stations' in 'Methods at work', pp 64-8 N.S.W. Hospitals Commn., H 1960,5+ pp. 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 91-103 London, Current Affairs Ltd., 1962, 101 pp Stone (J.E.) Hospital organisation and management, pp 814-15 London, Faber, 1952, Tiltman (P.c.s.) Practical aspects of a Medical Records Department ,Medical Record, May 1951, pp 136-9 Jnl AAMRL, April 1961, PP 56-8 Wolney (E.c.) A practical guide to the cost of equipping a Medical Record Department xxii + 1722 Background: 6.2. Clarke (K.W.) The group organis- •1st mt. Congress ation in Medical RecordsReport, pp 117-27 (i) Define the departments for which you are planning. (ii) Establish anticipated load on these departments. (iii) Define the functions of departments, their interrelationship and relationship to other departments of the hospital. (iv) (v) (vi) Think out procedures. Define coverage of departments and the staff needed. Establish flow of traffic both between departments and within them. (vii) Plan the equipment required. (viii) Specify special points in design and planning. These steps represent the foundations and are the basis on • which the architect draws his plans. When these are received go over them by trying out work situations, making scale models or actually chalking them out and checking that everything will work. Be prepared to argue hard for what you think is necessary, but in so doing, make sure that you have facts to back up your requirements. Finally, be realistic. There is no reason why Medical • Records should always be in the basement but its location must be where it is best placed functionally, not just where the view is nicest. 6.Further reading 6.1 Basic Balmer (Marjorie L.) It's time to Medical Record News, join the planners•Aug.. 1966, pp 223-6, 268-70 Biglow (L.A.) Planning a MedicalJnl AAMRL, April Records Department from a Medicalpp 45-8 Record Librarian's point of view 1958, Dunne (J,H.) Planning a new Medical Medical Record, Nov. Recordè Department - 3 1957, pp 286-7 Farmer (Ellen L,) Foresight and Medical Record News, knowledge Aug. 1964, pp 138-4O Hargrave (A.) Application of WorkMedical Record, Feb. Study to Medical Records Services 1962, pp 478-86 761 21 Having got hold of a copy of the plans for these departments, see if they will work by: (i) Taking actual work situations, such as suggested in 3.4 above and following them through on the plan. In doing this take into account other activities going on in the department at the same time. (ii) Making cut-outs of desks, fittings etc. to make sure that there is adequate working room. This is a safety precaution since the architect should haveensured that there is adequate working space. However, you and your staff are the ones who will suffer if there is not. Acquire a scale rule - this saves much unnecessary conversion since, depending on the scale, you can read straight off the measurements in feet. (iii) Checking traffic flow in departments and between departments and how this is effected by doors, for.instance, (iv) Checking elevations to ensure that details requested are included, e.g. clear glazing above a certain height etc. (v) If in doubt about the practicability of an area measure it out somewhere in actual size. If necessary chalk in desks and other fittings and then try out 'work situations in this setting. (vi) Checking vertical as well as horizontal relationships by superimposing floor plans by reference to common features such as columns. (It can be misleading simply to place one sheet above another) At the risk of being called awkward or worse insist on further drawings until you are satisfied that you have got as near to what you want taking other reasonable requirements into account.Your lack of pertinacity here could result in a poorly working department for the next 25 or more years. Summary: 5. As with a building th main work in planning goes into the part that cannot be seen. In either case if the foundations are badly done the result will be useless. It is necessary, therefore, to: I 3.8.8 O.P. booking and reception Split-level counter for part that is to deal with further bookings following a clinic. What arrangements for 'phone bookings? Will these be done by the same or a different person? (This will depend on anticipated number of bookings). Where will intercommunication equipment be? Chime/light system advised for 'phones. 3.8.9 Accident & Emergency department reception Split-level counter is recommended. Where will indexes and records be in relation to this? And intercommunication? A power point will be necessary for time clock if used. What will be needed for provision for booking for return visits? Chime/ light system advisable for 'phones, 3.8.10 X-ray reception Split-level counter is recommended. Provision for intercommunication with filing area? Relationship to index to be stated. Power point necessary if a time clock is used. Provision for counter and 'phone bookings. Chime/light system for 'phones. 3.8.11 X-ray filing State relationship desired to medical records filing if it is expected to cover both departments after hours. If fixed and mobile shelving are to be used indicate how much of each. Specify intercommunication location both for oral/written communication and for despatch of films. 4.Physical planning If the functional planning has been well done the drawings that come from the architect will be much what you wanted, although there will obviously be compromises which will be necessary because the departments with which you are concerned are not the only ones in the hospital. If machine addressing equipment is to be located in this area specify the sort of room required and shelving needed. (This should be such as to allow of holding stationery in original packs and holding some in the order in which it is run through the machine, together with receiving area, assembly working space and despatch trays). Provision must be made for shelves for holding records for various purposes because even the best system needs a halfway house. In the typists' area provision of power points for dictating machines needs to be mentioned, also spaces for photocopier, duplicating machine if located here, envelope bank, etc. It is wise to mention the need for sound-absorbent treatment. Are individual machines to be used or tele-dictation? In addition to dictating cubicles prOvision • needs to be made for medical and nursing staff to peruse notes without taking them out of the department. (For policy regarding this refer chapter 3, para 2.3.2) Admitting: 3.8.6. Specify the type of counter required. Are patients to sit or stand? If pre-registration has been carried out for booked cases then a standing position should he sufficient since all that would be necessary would be for the patient's identity to be established, time of arrival noted and for him to be asked to sit down until escorted to the ward. In emergency admission, however, a desk may be necessary, depending on the system in use. Where should the intercommunication be located? What arrangement is needed for calling orderlies or porters to escort patients to wards? (A callback system to the Head Orderly's office possibly) Provision has to be made for waiting lists, typing and working desks depending on the procedure used. Chime/light system is advisable for 'phones. Enquiry office:3.8.7 A split-level counter is recommended and, unless information on the condition of patients is duplicated, easy access to this information which will chiefly be the concern of the person answering telephone enquiries regarding patients. get up every time a person comes to the counter with consequent lengthening of the time it takes to settle down to work again; (iii) it is better for the public in that they have immediate contact with the staff concerned instead of having to attract their attention. 3.8.4 Lighting, power and heating In filing areas staff working must have good light so that they do not find the shelvesshadowing them. Since, however, flexibility of shelving is required overall lighting is required - ensure that it is not in rows. Similarly, there must be a good light source over indexes. On the other hand, the photocopier requires to be away from bright lighting. Power points will be required for dictating machines and other equipment. Heating will not normally be dealt with in this context but care needs to be taken to ensure that radiators are not planned for spaces where shelving or equipment is to go. 3.8.5 Medical Records If fixed shelving is to be used there should be provision for slide-out work trays, or for trolleys with a small table on which charts can be put easily for pasting in reports. etc. For fixed shelving greater provisionmust be made for circulation. In the case of mobile shelving a space is required for every 5 units. Consider the noise level likely in the department. This could be reduced by having telephones on a chime and/or light system instead of bells. If machine addressing is housed in this department it should be in a soundproof room. Dictating cubicles will need to be soundproofed and protected against noise coming into them. As some staff will be doing work such as coding that requires a high degree.of concentration noise producing factors should be mentioned so that the architect can specify suitable sound absorbent material. Indicate location of patient index in relation to phones and other equipment. It will be necessary to mention what non-architect supplied equipment is planned so that space can be provided for it. Kp 21 Storage: 3.8.2. If stationery is supplied on an imprest system then it is not necessary to provide for statinnery cupboards. (You should ask for such a system since it is the best method to guard against the use of outdated stationery, both in offices and wards). If, however, each department has to requisition at set intervals for its stationery then provision has to be made in each department for storage. Are any of these departments responsible for, (or do they naturally attract) the return of crutches, walking sticks etc. even as a halfway house? If so, and one cannot see an Accident & Emergency department not doing this, provision must be made for this. Are parcels left by patients or visitors at Admitting, Enquiries, Accident & Emergency or Outpatients, for instance? The Board's attitude to this should be ascertained. (Claims for loss could.arise). However, whatever the attitude it is probably inevitable that some things will be left and it is' therefore necessary to ask for some provision for this.. Built-in fitments: 3.8,3. It is often tempting to ask for various built-in fitments which ideally suit the procedure in use in a certain 'department.. This, however, totally overlooks the fact that procedures change. It is better, therefore, to think in terms of movable fittings and, if a special fitment is required, to make sure that space is reserved for it but to have the 'fitment itself made up separately. However, there is a great deal to be said for specifying split-level counters where there i s' direct contact with the public. At a split level counter the public part is at normal counter height whilst the staff part is at desk height with a small recess under the counter part. This has the following advantages: (i) (ii) it saves space since it is not necessary to take up room with a desk; it makes for more efficient use of staff since they can have their work at the counter without having to 3.7.6. Accident & Emergency reception What equipment will be needed for filing of reports and for indexes? What will be required for bookings for dressings? A time clock is advisable for recording time of arrival of patients. Where will forms regarding Worker's Compensation be kept? 3.7.7. X-ray reception What equipment is required for indexes and reports? What is required for bookings? Here again a time clock is recommended for recording patients' actual time of arrival. 3.7.8. X-ray filing What sort of shelving? If terminal digit filing is used with the hospital number then fixed shelving will be required. Where x-rays are filed straight numerically mobile shelving can be used. It should be motorised. Assuming maximum x-ray size of 17" x ik", the unit should have 4 openings, 15" between shelves vertically, shelves 18" deep, with buffer 3" to 6" dpending on how far shelf guides stick out and therefore need to be protected. 3.8 Special points in design and planni ng Although the preceding paragraphs have covered the theoretical aspects of functional planning fully there will be certain points that need to be noted in any planning submissions made. These will arise, not only from the general nature of the particular department concerned, but also from local factors the number and type of beds, outpatient services, methods and equipment used, etc. Some general points follow: 8.1 Inter-relationship Where possible easy horizontal or vertical access should be asked for. It is suggested that clear glazing of partitions is preferable to solid partitions - it is easier to work with people you see all the time than ones who are hidden away, but noise is a factor to be considered here. Handy stair access will be required if the departments are to be on different floors and are to be covered by minimum staff after hours. There should, however, be one office in these related departments where privacy can be obtained - this could be an interview room as part of the Admitting Office, cc Medical Records: 3.7.2. (a) shelving. What filing system is to be used? If terminal digit, then fixed shelving will be required. You will need to work out how much will be required in fixed shelving. If straight numerical filing is used, then mobile shelving is suitable. (Refer chapter para 5.2.1. for method of working out shelving required). If 12 11 shelving is used in mobile shelving a 3" buffer should be allowed for each side. 5, (b) Indexes. What indexes do you hav? Consideration should be given to using deep drawer cabinets - they are easier to use and make better use of space but they do mean concentration of the index in one place. How would this effect your procedure? (c) Dictating machines. What system is to be used? How about after hour coverage? (d) Other equipment. Consider the use of such equipment as photocopiers, small hand printers for envelope bank, developer/printer for microfilm etc. Admitting: 3.7.3. Will machine addressing be used, if so, what sort? Should it be located in Admitting or Medical Records? (Where is your patient index kept? The functional progression is from Admitting, O.P. booking etc. to patient index to machine addressing which would make this logically a part of Medical Records). How will waiting lists be kept? Enquiry Office: 3.7.4. How will cards for patients' condition be kept? What other equipment is needed for additional functions of the Enquiry Office? O.P. booking and reception: 3.7.5. What equipment will be needed for bookings? Will what you envisage be able to be copied for Medical Records without rewriting (i.e. photocopy or carbon)? How much filing will be required? (Generally speaking, this should be a minimum). 3.6 Flow of traffic In conjunction with 3.2, 3.3 and 3.4 above it is necessary, to indicate the flow of traffic both between departments and within them. This needs to take into account patients, staff and paper. If the function, inter-relationships and procedures have been worked out then the flow of traffic will follow logically from this. Obviously, this statement or series of diagrams must be so expressed that the architect has no difficulty in seeing the points between which there is the heaviest traffic and arranging for them to be in close relationship. To take an obvious example, no one who was familiar with the routine of a Medical Records Office would place the phone at the opposite side of the room to the patient index. Your flow chart must indicate this conclusion. 307 Equipment Certain equipment - shelving, built in fittings, intercommunication - is usually part of the building contract and therefore the concern of the architects. Other equipment - desks, filing, cabinets addressing or printing equipment etc. - is supplied under arrangements made by the Board, for which a special Ministerial.. Consent is obtained. Whatever the source of supply, however, equipment to be used must be considered when planning. Information o n equipment and factors governing its choice, occurs from time t o time in 'New Zealand Medical Record'. What follows are some questions for which answers will be required in your planning. 3,7.1 Intercommunication As has been seen these departments are closely related. What will be the nature of communication between them: (a) for paper charts, x-rays etc. Should you ask for a dumb waiter (this could be practicable if there will be vertical relationship) or pneumatic tube? Or will there be an efficient messenger service? (b) Oral or written? If telephone connection, is this to be direct or will dialling be necessary? (If phone is used this involves transcription at the other end and consequent possibilities for error). In some cases a talkback is appropriate, e.g. between x-ray reception and filing for immediate requirements, 21 One should not be prepared (where the size of the hospital warrants it) to have these departments covered by staff who are completely unfamiliar with the work or who cannot leave their posts, e.g. in the first instance, orderlies, and in the second,, telephone operators. - The argument has been made above that one of the causes of inefficiency in the departments under review is the 'them' and 'us' attitude. Where the size of the hospital allows a supervisory position is indicated to ensure practical day-to-day co-operation. The cost of this will be justified through better service to patients who will be the more likely to be contented and co-operative and through improved staff relationships and a reputation for smooth working. In the smaller hospital this function should be assigned to an individual whether the Medical Records Officer or the Admitting Officer with the necessary authority. How can you plan such an arrangement for your hospital? -Is clerical work being done by clerks? In most hospitals far too much essentially clerical work is being carried out by medical and nursing staff. New staffing patterns should plan for this work to be done by clerical staff, thus freeing other staff to do what they have been trained for. - Many routine jobs that are now done during the day could well be done by night staff on roster, e.g. daily filing of cards. -What are requirements for research and teaching - now, and likely to be in the future? Provision should be made for staff under this head alone. If you produce statistics now by adding up columns in a book, for how long will this be adequate? Should not staff and space be planned for against the day when this information might be on data processing equipment? -If you employ part-time staff and their duties overlap this must be included in your planning since space will be required for the maximum at work. (iii) An emergency accident case is brought into the Accident & Emergency department and it is decided to admit him. How is he identified? What is the procedure for admitting? Who checks on old records and x-rays and sees that they go to the ward? 3,5 Staff Having determined procedures the next step is to estimate the staff needed to carry them out. Then get this staffing pattern accepted since it is pointless planning for a department to be staffed to a certain level if, when the hospital opens, less staff are allowed, Here again there will be different requirements in different sized hospitals. However, the following questions and considerations may serve as a b'sis on which to plan for staff: - For what hours is coverage of the department concerned to be given? Where all the rest of the hospital works on a 21+-hour day, 7-day week it is archaic and inefficient for the departments under review to work a 71 hour day, 5 day week. As a guide which could be modified for smaller hospitals the following pattern is suggested: Day o Hours Yj /çLY el •3(JCJ XV ly Mon- 0830-1700 1 X I x x x xx xx I II day1700-1900X I X X I X 1XX I X Ix Ixx 1900-2300Xx I 300_0830 Where physicallyl possible coverage to include 2 1 FridayMedical Records ,l Admitting, Enquiries, A. & E. -reception, X-ray rece p tion and filing Sat-o830-1200X XX I X IXX urday 1200-2300X X XX X I As da y -Frida y 2300-0830 12300-0830 Sun- 0830-1700 X sw•w: day1700-2300 As Monday-Friday 2300-0830 12300-0830 1 Art 21 - What duplication is there? How many people are not gainfully employed part or all of their time because they are checking the work of others? (Some checking is necessary, much continues unnecessarily; determine what is essential and what is not). To what extent do present procedures represent the whims of individuals in charge of departments rather than functional, logical ways of doing a jpb? -• What is the Board's policy regarding retention of records? If Medical Records are to be retained indefinitely will there . be storage for them or should provision be made in these plans for microfilming after a certain period? (Refer chapter 19) -If, to take a hypothetical situation, the staff of a department were all killed or in hospital after a bus crash could the department function efficiently with a completely new staff? (i.e. are duties clear, logical and well defined?) The practical part of looking at procedures can be done by thinking through what would happen in given situations. Here are three situations; others will suggest themselves; every one of them must be capable of logical, simple and straightforward solution (i) A general practitioner's nurse rings the hospital for an appointment for a patient for the Chest Clinic. What does she write down? On what? What does she do then? How are records checked to see if one is held for the patient? What is the arrangement for ensuring that records go to the clinic when the patient attends? What is the arrangement for the doctor in charge of the clinic to dictate a letter regarding the case and to arrange for admission? (ii) This patient arrives to be admitted as a booked case. What papers are ready for him and how was this done? Do any have to be made out then? How does he get to the ward and how does his chart go? What other departments are told that he is in the hospital and how? 4f -What is the nature of each of the relationships indicated? (For in,tance, that between O.P. reception and Medical Records involves the passage of charts from Medical Records to O.P. reception before a clinic and their return, possibly with dictating machine tapes to the medical typists following the clinic. On the other hand, the relationship between . Medical Records and Enquiry Office is mostly a telephonic one). 3.4 Procedures If planning is to be effective procedures must be thought through. It may well be that equipment will become available that will enable streamlining of procedure but it is essential to examine existing procedures and decide how they can be improved. It is suggested that this can be done in two parts: theoretical and practical. The theoretical part of the definition of procedures requires answers to such questions as: -What can I anticipate as the overall national picture? (For instance, it is reasonable to assume that, within two decades, it will be possible to obtain basic medical history for any person in the country wherever he is at a moment's notice. This could come about regionally within a decade. Thus, any system put into a new hospital should be capable of fitting into this picture). -How will the figures obtained in 3.1 above affect present procedures? -Is the organisational structure of these departments such as to lend itself to the answers that seem right for the first two questions? (If not, work out a new one which must be so obviously right that it will be seen to be necessary to fit in with the planning.) -Are medical staff, or nursing staff in particular, carrying out procedures that could and should be carried out by clerical staff? -Are present procedures basically sound or have they, to a large extent, been forced onto the hospital through inadequacies of buildings, equipment, staff? U-', 21 Inter-relationship of departments and relationship to other departments of the hospital: 3.3. The degree to which departments are dependent on each other obviously affects the physical planning. It is therefore necessary to define this so that the physical relationship necessary can be the better understood. It can help to put this first diagramatically: Ward ay reception and filing Adr. O.P. booking En q U i r i e O.P. reception A. Outside agencies The degree of interdependence can be indicated thin lines. by thick or From this one can then go on to define the nature of these relationships. As local conditions can affect this no attempt will be made to do so here. It is suggested that what is necessary is to examine this diagram and pose the following questions to oneself: -Does this represent the inter-relationship in this hospital: (a) now (b) in the future? (If not, then redraw it to do so) I 3.2.k Outpatient booking To arrange for all outpatient clinic bookings, co-ordinate, bookings where attendance at more than one department is required and to ensure that copies of booking, lists are sent to Medical Records and other departments concerned at least 48 hours before clinic. 3.2.5 Outpatient reception To receive patients for outpatient clinics, receive their records for clinic, to ensure that they are called at the booked times (dependent on emergencies etc.) and to supervise dictation of notes and letters regarding clinic visit and subsequent return of records to Medical Records with tapes etc. • (In most cases these departments will be one and the same. It should be recognised, however, that there are two sets of functions). 3.2.6 Accident & Emergency department reception (i) to receive emergency outpatients, establish identity, check on known medical history and raise record; (ii) To book patients for return visits for dressings; (iii) To receive patients returning for dressings at booked times (as advocated in chapter 16, para 2.6); (iv) To maintain A. & E. records. (This should include passing information on attendance to Medical Records). 3.2.7 X-ray reception and filing Insofar as the X-ray department's function affects Medical Records and related departments it should pass information to Medical Records regarding attendance so that the function defined in 3.2.1 (i) can be carried out. It is also desirable that the same number be assigned to x-rays as to medical records and the same system of filing be used. 21 (ii) to be a repository for medical records that are not in current use; (iii) to code information on records for local and national statistics; (iv) to produce records required for research and teaching;. (v) to provide a typing service for all clinical departments of the hospital; (vi) to produce operation lists and similar regular information. Admitting: 3.2.2. Ci) to arrange for the admission of patients: (a) for booked cases off the waiting list by pre-registration; (b) for emergency cases by getting information required from patient or escort on arrival; (ii) to receive patients on their arrival for admission, arrange for their escort to the ward and for the chart to accompany patient to ward in the case of a booked patient; (iii) maintenance of waiting list. Enquiry Office: 3.2.3. The answering of enquiries on patients' condition, either by phone or over the counter, the receipt and sorting of mail, flowers etc. and the daily bed state. (In many hospitals the daily bed state is produced by Medical Records. Is this functionally correct? Is it not reasonable that the department that is required to know who is in the hospital should also be able to produce the daily figures showing how many people are in and were admitted, discharged etc? If the information, normally produced by the Enquiry Office is not satisfactory for Medical Records the corrective is to improve the quality of information not change the department producing it and incur costly duplication, ) (iv) Outpatients A projection will be necessary taking into account anticipated population and new services. Availability of transport and anticipated moves in this direction may also play a part here in that it is not realistic to plan, for instance, for patients to arrive at a clinic at 41- • hour intervals if public transport only comes every -- hour. (v) Accident & Emergency department A projection on anticipated population is necessary taking into account also if these are expected anticipated industries and schools to increase substantially attendance at the A. & E,. department will be higher than for ordinary residential growth. (vi) Special factors such as specialist units, research and teaching, emergency precautions, all of which result in an extra load on most of the departments under review, 3.2 Functions of departments • It is worth the time and trouble to state what may appear to be very obvious: what each department is supposed to do in round terms. This then gives you a base line to which you can refer any of your headier flights of fancy by asking: 'Is this a function of the department?' The following are suggested as functions of the departments under review. Smaller hospitals will telescope the functions of various departments together. The important thing is to be able to see a pattern similar to this in these departments. 3.2.1 Medical Records department including medical typing (1) To be able to answer the question: 'what is known about this patient?', to produce the records giving this information.immediately, to raise • a record for any department of the hospital where cases are new to the hospital and to • up-date information for old cases. (The integration of inand out-patient notes, if not yet accomplished, should be an aim in all new planning. However, it is questionable whether this should include Accident & Emergency, x-ray, laboratory and physiotherapy outpatients because of sheer weight of numbers.This is discussed in chapter 16, para. 3); 21 However, having said this one must point out that the person in charge of the department should do the detailed planning. This chapter should be read in the context of giving thought to the functions of Medical Records and related departments with the object of making the 'medical clerical' side of the hospital function as an integrated whole. Functional planning: 3. This is the process of assessing the anticipated load and of examining the functions and inter-relationships of the departments concerned, not in terms of what is adequate for today but of the demands that will be made in 25 years' time. It is probable that needs beyond this period will be met by the provision of new hospitals when the problem becomes twofold but still governed by the principles put forward here: planning the new hospital and integrating it with other hospitals. Anticipated load: 3.1. Before any review of functions is made it is necessary to get an idea of the numbers for which you are planning. 'This involves answers to these sort of questions: (i) Population What is the population of the district served by the hospital? What is its rate of growth? What, therefore, is the anticipated population in 10, 15, 25 years' time? This will give you a proportion from which other projections can be made. It is not, however, sufficient to take births only into account. Other factors occur such as immigration, anticipated new industries, towns, housing areas and other developments which will attract population, or similar developments in a nearby area which might result in a relative standstill in population. (ii) Services What new services are proposed? A new clinic, for instance, will involve extra movement of records, extra staff etc. (iii) Inpatients The increase will depend on the number and type of beds and the anticipated increase in population. 6. Further reading 6.1 Basic 6.2 Background 1, Introduction The object of this chapter is to indicate how to go about planning a Medical Records Department. It stresses the necessity of thinking out the function and inter-relationships of the department and other departments of the hospital. It involves looking at existing procedures, questioning them, looking for better ones and thinking through the upshot of any changes contemplated.' It is then necessary to put this in writing. If your statement is clear, logical and reasonable then your requirements are the more likely to he met, and the architects will understand what you want and be able to translate it into a functional building. If you dodge the issue and surrender to the temptation to play around with plans your department, will find that its requirements are cut and you and your successors will be left with the consequences of your sloth for a long time. 2. Scope • What, is the scope of the Medical Records Department as far as planning is concerned? Is it merely concerned with the department that has 'Medical Records' on the door? It is suggested that one of the main causes of inefficiency in the 'medical clerical' side of hospital administration is the departmentalising of interdependent offices. When opportunity is presented through new planning to co-ordinate the working of these departments it should be taken. This chapter assumes, therefore, that in planning a Medical Records Department plans for the following related departments will be included: Admitting Office; O.P. Booking and reception; Enquiry Office; A. & E.reception; X-ray reception and filing. Although laboratory is not included in this chapter the possibility of its inclusion in the 'medical clerical' side should be investigated. Some or all of these departments may have separate heads or the planfling of their offices may be considered to be part of another department - X-ray and Accident & Emergency, for instance. Insofar as their relationships with' Medical Records are important the criteria to make these smooth and efficient 'should be put forward with a view to integration with the plans made by individual departments. F "I 21 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand PLANNING A MEDICAL RECORDS DEPARTMENT 1. Introduction 2, Scope 3, Functional planning 3.1 Anticipated load 3.2 Functions of departments 3.2.1 Medical Records Department including medical typing 3.2.2 Admitting 3.2.3 Enquiry Office 3.2.4 Outpatient booking 3.2.5 Outpatient reception 3.2.6 Casualty reception 5.2.7 X-ray reception and filing .3.3 Inter-relationship of departments and relationship to other departments of the hospital 3.4 Procedures 3.5 Staff 3.6 Flow of traffic 3.7 Equipment 3.7.1 Intercommunication 3.7.2 Medical Records 3.7.3 Admitting 3.7.4 Enquiry Office 3.7.5 O.P. booking and reception 3.7.6 Casualty reception 3.7.7 X-ray reception - 3.7.8 X-ray filing 3.b Special points in design and planning 3.8.1 Inter-relationship 3.8.2 Storage 3.8.3 Built-in fitments 3.8.4 Lighting, power and heating 3.8.5 Medical Records 3.8.6 Admitting 3.8.7 Enquiry Office 3.8.8 O.P. booking and reception 3.8.9 Casualty reception 3.8.10 X-ray reception 3.8.11 X-ray filing 4. Physical planning 5. Summary SAMPLE PROOF CORRECTED ART TRAINING needs today to be co-ordinated with workshop practice. The artist is apt to deplore the absence of good taste in the workman and technician, and the technician, in turn, is irritated by the artist's ignorance of the technical processes for which he is designing.. The artist is too ready to design with but a vague idea of technical limitations and possibilities. The workman, in acquiring technical training, gets little chance of cultivating good taste or artistic judgment. What is needed is art training based on a knowledge of workshop practice; shop-trained artists, not studio-trained craftsmen. Art training can only define principles, stimulate imagination, teach appreciation of abstract lines and forms. A basis of technical experience for practical and constructive work is needed. The counterpart of the skilled technician in the school of art and industrial design is the student of design working in the factory— if necessary on a voluntary basis—so that he may acquire the necessary knowledge of the process for which he intends to design. Printing is the chief means by which messages are multiplied and disseminated. There is no point in multiplying a message if it is not easily understood. It is useless to say a thing three times with a mouth full of marbles or to shout in a language that your listener does not understand. The cultured accents of a pleasantly readable type effect their object where the asthmatic raucousness of a type face with meaningless frills or obesities fails. The essential considerations cannot be decided without careful thought. For this task it is necessary to acquire some familiarity with type forms which express the words, appreciation of apt illustration, and ability to arrange these elements into a comprehensive and logical 'design which will express the thought so that it will lose nothing of its effect and informative content. Every printed item has a job to do. . Its purpose should be the first thing to consider. Green ink on green paper, for use under artificial light; rattling paper at a classical concert; cumbersome menu , cards that fall into the soup—such are examples of failures on the part of printers, examples where the printer was not thinking of the purpose of the work. These pitfalls, these waste-paper-basket fillers, can only be avoided by visualising the intention of the finished work before deciding the first. detail of its format. —From the preface to How to Plan Print, by John Charles Tarr. Crosby Lockwood and Son Ltd. 20 SAMPLE PROOF TO SHOW PROOF-READER'S MARKS ,4 gc.rt training needs today to be co-ordinated with workshop practicej 0/ 4The artist is apt to deplore the absen/e of good taste the workman and 9/ c/technifian, and the technician, in turn, is irritated by the artis4 ignorance of the technical processes forjswhichl designing. The artist is too / ready t© design with but a vague idea of technica1imitations and possi- I bilities. (he workm/n, in acquiring technical training gets little chance 4ultivatinoo ast xtrtistiudgment.What L is Lneeded L is Z art training based on a knowledge of workshop practice; shop-trained artists, not studioJle craftsmen. Art training can only define principles, stimulate imagination, teach appreciation ofa abstract lines and forms. A basis of technic4xperience for practical and con–structive work is o #% needed/ The counterpart of thkilled technician in the school of art and industrial design is the student of design working in the factory— if ncfrssary on a voluntary basis--so that he may ac'uire the necessary knowledge /of itheL process L for / which /he j intends L to /design. ne.'/z LPrinting is the chief means by which messages are multlPlIeU and disseminate?. There is no pointØin multiplying a message i it is not = easily understood It is useless to say ajgg .tistiT] w1th a m ii ,(4o/=== -full of marbles or to shout in a language that your listener does not - understand. The cultured accents of a pleasantly readable type effect their object where the asthmatic raucousness of a type face with meanir / /less frills or obesities fails. The essen/al considerations cannot be decided without careful / thought) For this task ijj11 necessary to acquire some familiarity with type forms which express the words, appreciationf at illustration, and (%abty to arrange these el/ements into a comprehensive and logical degn which will express the thought so that it will lose nothing of its effect ff/ and informative content. Eprinted item has a job to do. Its purpose youlcl be the first thing to consider. Green ink on green paper, fi use under artificial light/erraulinat a classical concert; cumbersome menu cards hat fall into the soup/ such are examples of failures on tbe®a rt ofrinters, x/X/ i/ examples 4re the printer was not thinking of the purpose of the work. These pitfalls, thee waste-paper/basket fillers, can only be avoided/ visualising the intention of the finished work before deciding the first detail of- it!& format. bf Pq No.Marginal Mark Meaning 49. /Substitute semicolon so Insert period 51 Substitute period Corresponding Mark in Text / / / 52..Insert colon 53 . Substitute colon 54 Insert question mark .55 Substitute question mark .56 Insert exclamation mark 57 Substitute exclamation mark / Insert parentheses ( /4 ) Insert (square) brackets 59 [ ,(] Insert hyphen 60 , Insert en (half-cm) rule 61 58 62 /4 63..2..1 , 64- Insert one-em rule A' A' -A' A' Insert two-em rule Insert apostrophe 65 Insert single quotation marks 66 Insert double quotation marks 7 A' / A' I - Insert marks of ellipsis A'. xx A' 68 Insert leader / 69 Insert shilling stroke / .70 Refer to appropriateEncircle words, etc., that authority anything theare queried accuracy or suitability of which is doubted I 2 Marginal Mark Meaning J 9 Place in centre of lineIndicate position 30 Indent one ern 31 Indent two ems 32 Corresponding Mark inText L J 33 Move to the left Move to the right 34 Take letter or word from end of one tine to beginning of' next 35 Take letter or word from beginning of one line to end of preceding line 36 I Raise linesover lines to be moved 37 Lower lines 38 Correct the vertical alignment 39 Straighten lines under tines to be moved through lines to be straightened Push down space 40 /through space - /affected Begin a new paragraph 41 before first word of new paragraph n€iáa4 L 42 No fresh paragraphhere 43 The abbreviation or figure Encircle words or figures to to be spelt out in fullbe altered 44 Insert omitted potion of- lou-t 4,6W - between paragraphs NOTE.—The relevant seelion of the copy should be returned with the proof, the omitted portion being clearly indicated 45/after matter(Caret mark). Insert /omittedmatter indicated in margin .15 1 46 Insert comma 47 Substitute comma 48/ Insert semicolon - No.Marginal Mark Corresponding Mark in Text Meaning 11.j' Change to italics ________ under letters or words to be - altered 12 Underline word or words________ under words affected - 13 Change to romantypeEncircle words to be altered 14 Wrong fount; replace by Encircle letter to be letter of correct fountaltered 15 } Invert type 16 Replace by undamagedEncircle letter to be altered character 17 Substituted letters or signs Cross out letters or signs to be Encircle letter to be -altered which this is placed to altered /under be ' superior 18 .Inserted letters or signs /under which this is placed to I be 'superior' 19 1 Substituted letters or signs Cross Out letters or signs tobe over which this is placed to altered be ' inferior' Inserted letters or signs over 20..-, this is placed to be /which ' inferior / 21Pabove theUse ligature (e.g., flu) or,-.above the letters to be altered ligature ordiphthong (e.g., ce) diphthong required 22 Write out separate, letters followed by- / Substitute separate letters/through ligature for ligàtureor diphthong7ordiphthong to he altered Close up—delete space linking words or between letters -....._-letters Insert a space 23 24 Space between lines or 25 >paragraphs required; the of space may be iT amount indicated Make spacing equal 26 2.7 74t Reduce this space Transpose z / between words between words between letters or (numbered when necessary) 20 SYMBOLS FOR CORRECTING PROOFS AND MARKING NEW COPY (Words printed in italics in the marginal-mark column below are instructions and not part of the marks.) The standard symbols and marks shown below are the only ones. that should be used when proofs are corrected. They may also be used for correcting copy before it is sent to the printer. Do not use anymTks;bt her than these standard ones, for strange marks of uncertain meaning may easily lead to errors and increased costs. Author's alterations should be made in ink of a different colour from that used by the printer's reader. The symbols and marks should be studied in conjunction with the sample of a corrected proof. In copy other than tables every correction or alteration should be made in the margin, not in the body of the printed matter. An appropriate mark is placed in the text to show the printer where the correction is to be made. No.Marginal Mark Meaning Corresponding Mark in Text 1/Sign to show that marginal mark is concluded2 c9J Delete (take Out) Cross out letter or word to be -deleted-- 3 Delete and close 4 through Delete character and leave character to be space /deleted - Leave as printed 5,o'tet 7 8 /cclftl / - '' above and below letters to be taken /Out under letters or • • • words to remain Change to capital letters under letters or words to be altered Change to small capitals under letters oC words to be altered Use capital letters for initial and small capitals for & 4/;. letters rest of words Change to lower case Change to bold type under initial letters and - under the rest of the words Encircle letters to be altered -under letters or words to be altered 20 APPENDIX A.Spacing requirements in forms 1. For handwritten copy: As a general rule allow 8 characters to the inch horizontally and " per line vertically for hand written forms. It may be necessary to allow a little more than this if forms are to be filled in by non clerical people, but over generosity seems to encourage bad handwriting. 2. For typewritten copy: Typewriters normally type 10 or 12 characters to the inch; check which yours does. Allow 6 lines to the inch, or multiples thereof, vertically. Allow a minimum margin of " at the bottom of a form to give typewriter rollers sufficient area to grip the paper. Where possible allow 1" margin at the top of the paper to allow paper holder to hold paper down. 3. Filing margin: Filing margins should be at least " but can often be used to accommodate information which does not need to be read when the document is filed. Li. Further design points Sequence. Wherever possible information should be entered in a 'natural' left to right sequence; this applies particularly to handwritten forms but also affects the number of times the tabulations indexes •and carriage returns are required in typing. (a) Transcribing. If information is to be transcribed routinely from one form to another ensure that each •is in the same sequence. (b) (c) Puled lines. When it is necessary to have a great many ruled lines on the form whether vertical or horizontal break up the mass by having heavy lines dividing out natural or arbitrary sections to reduce eye strain for those using the form. (d) Punch holes. If the forms are eventually to be filed using a punch hole method then the punch holes should be put in in the printing process. 20 Background: 8.2. Shoemaker (C.o.) How forms control can cut paper work Ryder (J.) Teach yourself printing for pleasure Hospitals, May 1, 1961, pp 81-4, 111; Hospitals Abstracts, Aug. 1961, p 512 London, E.U.P., 1957, 1+2 pp, illus. Associative: 803 3;c Hollinworth (J.) Kardex in a psychiatric Hospital 10 Patients' records Nursing Times, April 28, 19619 pp 520-1; Hospital Abstracts, Aug. 1961, pp 513-4 Bennett (A.C.) Methods improvement in hospitals. Chapter 17 U.S.A., Philadelphia, J.B. Lippincott Co., 1964, xi ± 157, Wagner (Prof. G.) The development of the standardised medical record in Germany The Medical Record, Nov. 1965, illus. pp 183-8 Guide to the organisation of a Hospital Medical Record Department' pp 31-5 Hargrave (A) Application of Work Study to Medical Records 'Services U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., American Hospital Assn., 1962, vii + 83 Medical Record, Feb. 1962, pp 478-86 U.S.A., Berwyn, Ill., PhysicHuffman (Edna K.) Manual for ians' Record Co., 1959, Medical Record Librarians, pp 33_1+ ('Order in which to xxx + 604, illus. assemble the Medical Record') 35-100, ('Basic records'), 1+64-5 ('Quality of record forms') 'Is that form essential?' in 'Methods at work' pp 93-4 London, Current Affairs, Ltd. 1962, 101 pp MacEachern (M.T.) Medical Records in the Hospital, pp 60 -70 , 87110 U.S.A., Chicago Ill., Physicians' Record Co., 19371 'Medical Records & Secretarial Services' Hospital 0 & M Service Report No. 2 pp 7-12 xvi + 374, illus. H.MS.O., 1959 32 pp Oldham (K.W.) Anaesthetic andAnaesthesia, April 1963, pp operation records: a description213-6; Hospital Abstracts, of a new type of combined formJune 196 3, pp 331-2 'Paper making' Medical Record, August 1951, Report' of a Committee on Medical Records in N.S.W. Hospitals N.S.W. Hospitals Commn., Rogers (L.C.) Take advantage of paper Medical Record, Nov. 1960, PP 346-49 Shoemaker (D.J.) California's new fast record Medical Record News, Aug. 1 9 6 5, pp 200, 2021. pp 218-22 1960, 51+ pp 203, 233-5 xxii + Stone (J.E.) Hospital organisation and management, pp 112932, 148015 1+1 9 1542-9 1 1611 London, Faber, 195 2 , The design of forms in government departments H.M.S.O., 1962 9 173 pp., 1722 illus. 'lit 20 (v) Observe these criteria: uniformity, comprehensibility, economy. (vi) Spend time on a form before you send it to the "printer. Further reading: 8. Basic:8.1. Anna (Sister) Pediatric records Hospital Progress, April 1961, pp 122-3; Hospital Abstracts, Sept. 1961, pp 583-1+ Berkbuegler (J.w.) Too much paperwork in medical records? Hospital Progress, Jan. 1963, pp 60-1, 100; Hospital Abstracts, July . 1963, p 396 London, Blandford Press 1961, Biggs, (J.R.) An approach to type 136 pp Bothwell (P.w.) Routine, records and research. Pta, I - III Medical Record; Aug. 1960, pp 2 9 8 -302 ; Nov. 1960 pp 320-7; Feb. 1961, pp 359-61+ Breadmore (R.G.) Paperwork simplification, 2. Designing an efficient form Office Methods & Machines, June 1966, pp 1+41-41+4 Clarke (K.W.) A practical index for clinical notes Medical Record, May 1958, p 351 Champer (J.) Weiss Memorial cuts Hospital Topics,'April 1962, admitting time in half with new pp 1+1-3; Hospital Abstracts, forms, simplified procedureSept. 1962, p 567 Coulam, N.R. Economy of effort in Medical Record Keeping. Section on 'Design of forms' pp 621-2 Medical Record, Feb. 1963, Garner (P.) & Hollings (D) Forms for beginners; initial review Office 'Magazine, Sept. Garner (P.).& Hollings (D) Forms for beginners: layout and design Office Magazine, Oct, 1963, pp 615-25 pp 699-700 pp 798-9 Government Printing Office Style Wellington, Government Book: a guide addressed to all Printer, 195 8 , 1 71 pp writers, editors and public servants who prepare manuscripts for publication by the New Zealand Government Printing Office 1963, (ix) When you receive the corrected proof back go over it to make sure there are no errors - transpositions, misspelling, wrong founts, capitals in place of lower case and so on. Make your corrections, and those of the initiator of the form, in ink using the correction marks for printers' proofs shown in Appendix B. (These are taken from 'Preparation of Copy' in New Zealand Government Style book by kind permission of the Government Printer) (x) Give the corrected proof back to the printer and, if you have not already done so, give him instructions regarding keeping copy standing etc. (xi) When a reprint of the form becomes due - say, 3-'-f months before you expect your stocks to run out - refer the form to all those using it for suggestions for revision. If necessary, make a "mock-up" of the revised form and refer it to those concerned before taking it to the printer. 6. Revising a form If your forms do not live up to the criteria given above of uniformity and comprehensibility you will need to revise them Again, you may need to revise them as suggested in the last paragraph. Unless the revision is a radical one involving changes of type face and lay-out use the existing form as much as possible. As part of your tools of trade you should have a hobby knife, a steel rule and a gum bottle. Take a sheet of plain paper the size of your form and cut up an existing form where either the same lay-out or the same type face is to be used; paste in position. Use pen for the parts that are to be changed. 7. Summary (i) Any object is well designed that is suitable for the job. (ii) Is the new form , necessary? (iii) Know the printing processes - see them in action, if possible. (iv) Know the different sorts of paper and the sizes that it comes in. 20 form with him making sure that you know exactly what it is to do and what the originator has in mind. (iv) Block out a rough copy in pencil to make sure that the copy will fit on the forms (v) Do a copy in pen the size of the proposed form with lettering the same size as it will appear on the form. If there is any doubt about legibility of words (medical terms, drugs etc.) do a larger copy to make this clear. (In the same sized copy I use a blue ink for light or medium print, capitals or lower case, and black ink for bold. This is easier for the printer to follow and gives one a reasonably good idea of the finished article. Lower case = small letters) (vi) Show your draft to the initiator of the form. Ask him to make any corrections now and accept the necessity of redrawing the whole form with as good a grace as possible l Before giving or sending copy to the printer give the form a name and number and preferably, alao month of printing. (Keep a register of form names and numbers) (vii) Take the form to your printer and, discuss it with him paper, type faces, colour of paper or print - and ensure that he understands your copy. Ask him to let you have a proof and sample of paper. Confirm in writing what you have discussed, ensuring that you give your printer specifications and keep a copy of what you write. Although this is not an exhaustive list it will show some of the questions that should be covered in a standard specification: size of paper. Is form single or double sheet? Is it to be punched, if so precisely where? Write out clearly any words that may not be plain. State order of leaves for more than one page • Is form to be numbered'? Where and how? Is it to he padded or gummed? (Both add to cost and are frequently unnecessary). If form is to be made up in books is it to be interleaved with blank white or coloured stock? How many forms are to be packed together? How are they to be labelled? Where are they to be delivered and when? (viii) When the proof is received give it to the initiator of the form asking him to make any corrections necessary in pencil. Also show him a sample of the paper for his approval. Consider whether the number of copies of the form that are to be used justify setting the copy in print. Could you use lithographed typewritten copy? (The paper used presents a good surface for writing; your own typists produce the copy for photographing). Many forms used internally could well be produced in this way. Get alternative prices for the job. In this way you will be getting more experience and knowledge directed onto the problems of doing your work as well and as economically as possible. (If printing resources are limited it is worth considering printers in other towns or cities. Some, for instance, specialise in particular lines of work). Having more than one head on the job may suggest alternative, and better, ways of doing it - few jobs are so simple that they allow of only one approach.Consider whether another Board's forms may not be suitable. Preparatory costs might be saved by using the body of another Board's form with your heading by dealing with the other Board's printer. 5. Steps in the evolution of a form Everyone has their own way of going about things so one can only put this forward as a suggested procedure which has been evolved over the years and works reasonably well: (i) A doctor comes to you in great excitement with much scribbling-and a few lines on a piece of paper completely different in size to your normal forms. This. is a new form which he must have immediately. You ask him whether this has been tried out as a duplicated form. If not, suggest to him that he do this. This will give him the chance to judge the practicability of it and change it accordingly without much cost. (Because duplicating paper does . not take ink satisfactorily it should only be used for trials or for forms that are little used but still considered essential) (ii) If he has tried this out as a duplicated form, ask him whether the Medical Superintendent and his colleagues agree to it being printed. (iii) Assuming that this and similar obstacles have been cleared and that you have checked that no existing form does, or can be changed to do, the same job go over the 20 - Use one colour ink only where possible. The use of a second colour involves putting each form through the press • a second time and can involve an increase of cost of up to 20 %. A general rule is that a second colour should only be used where it is clinically essential, e.g. the normal on a temperature chart. It is often possible to use. a reverse block to give prominence to a heading instead of a different colour.(A reverse block is one where the letters appear as the colour of the paper against abackground the colour of the ink). - Choose your paper from a sheet size that will give the minimum of cutting to waste, not forgetting that you normally need a blank binding margin. (A. good printer will do this but you should be 8ure. that you are choosing a paper that is economical)For instance, suppose that your form size is1-" x 8--" (medium 4to); this will cut economically out of double medium, 23" x 36 11 , but wastefully out of double large post, 21 11 x 33". You pay for the waste. - Choose the right paper for the job. If you choose too good a paper you will be paying more than you should; if you choose a poor paper you will probably find that the users of the form are dissatisfied with itand insist on it being reprinted immediately on better paper. On any job involving duplicating paper remember that it is a more expensive paper than a bond and that its cost in relation to the total cost of the job is far higher. Therefore, if your form is one-sided use a lighter weight paper; only use a heavier duplicating paper where copy is to go on both sides. . - Make sure that your draft of the form is clear and unambiguous for the printer to follow. His misinterpretations of your draft will cost you money. -. Make sure. that corrections are done to the draft of the form before it goes to the printer. Changing the printer's proof is known as 'author's corrections' and can be costly. - Many forms require pen ruling which is a separate process often carried out by another firm. Do not have the form pen ruled until the printed copy has been approved. be provided and there should be no doubt to which choice it .refers - Space. Use space intelligently; you do not have to fill every part of the paper. It is usually better to use smaller type with space left around it than filling up the comparable space with printing. Layout. Keep this consistent,Most forms ask for sex, ward, name, number. Make sure that they do this in the same order on each form. If the form is to be used with a typewriter, ensure that it is spaced vertically so that the typewriter platen does not have to be adjusted, by hand every other line. (Refer Appendix A.for spacing' measurements for forms) Type. A form, and even a notice, is a communication between two people. Be sparing in your use of bold type and capitals. When you design a form read the copy aloud to someone the other side of your desk, Emphasise capitals, raise your voice to a public speaking level every time you have bold type and to a shout when it is in bold capitals. Having done this, recast the copy with more thought for good manners!Underlining type is ugly and unnecessary. You can often make the point as well by using a larger' size of type or even using a different type face - your object is to gain the reader's attention but not his animosity.' 4•3 Economy Good printing does not have to of thought and preparation on your between you and your printer. Some be economical in the production of be expensive, it is the fruit part and mutual understanding suggestions follow on how.to printed matter - .- Trial run. Try to persuade whoever initiates a form to have a trial run of, say, two months as a duplicated'form. This will let him see, in practice, how his form works out. He will then be able to give you a . form for printing. which should be good for a year. Long runs. Remembering that the main charge in printing is in composition ensure that the number of forms printed each time is the maximum compatible with possibilities of change etc. 20 Unless you go consistently to the same printer and insist that he stick to one or two type faces for your job you will find it very difficult to maintain uniformity with a serif face. Many printers do the equivalent in type of putting two clashing colours together. If you specify sans serif faces this is less likely to happen since the choice is less. The overall effect of a choice of sans serif faces only for your forms is to help to make them easier to read and tidier. Printers like to mix serif and sans serif; if you have decided on sans serif don't let them introduce a serifed type. - colour, Colour can be used to achieve, difference whilst maintaining uniformity in size, weight of paper and type face. For instance, you might like all forms relating to examinations (as opposed to treatment, operations etc.) to be prominent.You can either do this by using a coloured paper or coloured ink. Differences in coloured papers have been mentioned; you will be careful which you select. Coloured inks can be more exactly defined by reference to an ink maker's colour code book. However, in choosing a coloured ink choose one of a definite enough colour to take all the printing on your form; the use of a colour and black on a form is uneconomic and adds anything up to 20% to the cost of the job. Colour can also be used effectively in the form of a band or a coloured edge - but the form should be printed overall in the same colour. Similarly, red should normally only be used in conjunction with black print as a 'danger signal'. Comprehensibility: 4.2. Form filling can be difficult; your job is to make it as easy as possible, usually by persuading the initiator of a form that you can set it out so that it's plain and uncluttered. Here are some important points Instructions. Make them simple, easy to see and short. Don't be afraid to use a symbol if it can replace a sentence. Where possible, let the form-filler indicate appropriate entry by a tick rather than having to write something, but ensure that it is clear in a multiple choice question whether he is required to tick, underline or circle. If ticking, a box or short dotted line should bondover 15 lbo in weight in colour and few manifold or air mail banks in colour. +. The three criteria of design Our three design criteria are uniformity, comprehensibility and economy. Uniformity is needed aesthetically and for ease of handling and storing. Far too many forms are difficult to understand; your job is to see that the form is made up so that it is easy to fill in and to read.. 'Economy is obvious. Now let us see how these criteria can be applied. 4.1 Uniformity .'.. From the practical and aesthetic angles you should aim at uniformity in your forms - not only should they be the same size, or related proportionately but they should look as if they belong together. These requirements are considered under - size. All forms that go into the notes should be the same size, except for ones thatare held :onbacking. sheets (x-ray and lab. reports) when. thebacking sheets themselves should' be the same: size as 'the others. Daily notes kept by.the nurses which usually go into a pocket holder formof fixture' are the exception since their. àize is dictated Different' sizes: by the holder, usually 8" x have their advocates; the, important things is that all should be the same ' size - any waste, of paper will be made good by the facility with which the whole bundle of notes can be 'handled. 5".' . - weight of paper. Consistency in weight of paper makes for ease of reference; it is difficult to flick through different thicknesses of paper, - type face. For our purposes type faces can be divided into two sorts: serif and sans (without)' serif. The serif is the little cross-line finishing off a stroke of a letter thus: serjfII'GiA sans serif.I C A. 20 weights of ledger paper since the flat sheets are in up to 20 different sizes). - newsprint, which is usually porous and therefore unsatisfactory for our purposes. - special purpose papers such as duplicating, the paper used for offset lithography, gummed, papers and so on. The printer receives his paper in different sized flat sheets. The banks and bonds come in three different sizes: 21" x 33" ('double large post'); 23" x 36" ('doubLemedium'); 1 7" x 27" ('foolscap'). The weights quoted for banks and bonds are based on a large post sheet. We shall see later that the sheet sizes have a relation to the sizes of our forms because it is uneconomic to choose a sheet size which will result in waste. In deciding on the paper for a job consider what it is to do. Is it to carry handwriting? (Most of ours will). Try all sorts of pens and inks to see whether ink smudges 'easily and whether it blurs. Does the paper tear too easily? Is it the right thickness? Will carbon copies be required? - if so, is the paper thin enough to allow of copies being taken? Will it stand rubbing out? Will it be too thick and cause unnecessarily bulky notes if several sheets are together? Other questions will occur to you as you consider what the paper is to do. Finally, a word of warning regarding coloured papers. Colour is, as I shall indicate later, an important tool in the good design of forms. It is, however, on the whole easier to obtain consistency of ink 'colour rather than paper colour. Therefore, be very sure that the colour you choose is a consistent one before you decide to standardise on it for a certain use. Anything including red in its make-up is unreliable. For instance, "salmon" can be any one of a different number of shades in different batches of paper. All colours are of varying strengths, thus giving one yellow which is a strong, positive colour and another which is anaemic. Coloured papers also cost more and restrict one's choice of paper. In a long printing run paper can absorb 3Trd of the cost. of the job; an extra 2c. or 3c. a lb. for a coloured .paper is obviously going to make an appreciable difference. Currently, there are no 14 -to 3,Paper As anyone who has seen a paper mill in action (or even done a social studies project on one) knows paper is formed from wood pulp after it has gone through various "cooking" processes with different chemicals; some of these processes differ depending on the type of paper that is required. Paper, for our purposes, comes in these forms: Firstly, boards or cards: - board, such as is used for file backs. - paste - or pulp - boards (described as 1, 2, 3, k, 6, 8 or 10 sheet), as used for some index cards. - card, pulp used flat which is a better quality than paste - or - board and mainly termed index boards and for index cards (described by weight of 100 sheets: 110 lb., l LfO lb., 170 lb., or 220 lb.) - manilla, as used for file covers. Paper as used for forms et.c: - bank, divided into: - manifold bank (up to 8 lbs./ream of flat sheet described as 11 8 lb.") - flimsy paper - air mail bank (7-10 lb) - flimsy paper of better quality than manifold - lightweight (ii lb.: 'D.P.L.22 1 ) - used for copy paper, x-ray and pathology reports, single sided forms etc. - bond, divided into: - 15 lb ('D.p.L,301) - a super grade bank of better quality and therefore slightJr dearer - 18 lb. ('D.P.-L.361) - suitable for double-sided forms ledger paper, which is usually produced in azure or buff and is any paper heavier than a bond but not a board or, card - it can go in weight up to 82 lb. which is machineposting ledger paper. (The patient identification form of a medical record is often on a 54 lb. ledger paper. There is little consistency in the description of 20 2.2 In offset lithography copy is photographed and transferred to a paper or light aluminium plate which is then put on a printing machine which works on the principle of the incompatibility of water and oil - the parts to be printed retain the printing ink, a film of water on the blank areas prevents them from being printed.Offset lithography allows of greater versatility in that it can be used for typewritten, even handwritten, copy and much copy can be made up by pasting letters onto a white background. It has the advantage that once a plate has been made it can be used again and can be renewed from the original negative or by making another plate from one of the forms - and, in the latter case., changes can be made quite easily, if necessary. Plates can be stored easily and for nothing. On the other hand there are disadvantages in this method.If your final job is to be in type (rather than reproducing type- or handwritten copy) then the :letterpress process has to be gone through to produce, one good print which can be photographed. New developments, such as the use of the "headliner" and varityper, are making the use of a full letterpress "pull" unnecessary in many cases but their effect on cost has yet to show a pronounced saving.Offset lithography lacks the clarity of imprint of letterpress because in letterpress ink-carrying metal is biting into paper whereas in offset lithography the paper picks up ink from a rubber roller which has picked it up from the flat surface of the plate (i.e. it is set off from the rubber roller onto the paper).Depending on the process whereby the copy is transferred onto the plate the image can come out in varying degrees of fuzziness; this can be particularly noticeable where small print is used. 2.3 Most readers will be all too familiar With the duplicating process.It should not be forgotten, however, that the spirit duplicator is included in this type of equipment. The spirit duplicator is a simple machine that can produce copy in different colours from a typewritten or handwritten original. Its permanency cannot, however, be guaranteed. These are the three main proôesses of getting copy onto paper; letterpress is the most commonly used and, as we shall see, abused The Medical Records Officer is the only person in the hospital who has an overall view of medical records forms; you must ensure that there is nothing that is already doing the job or could easily be made to do it - before going ahead with a new form. On the other hand there is no point in trying to make an existing form do when it obviously won't. Before examining the criteria given below it is necessary to take a look at the tools for doing the job: type and paper. What follows is an extremely simplified description of two complicated subjects. 2.Type In general, printed matter is produced in one of three ways: letterpress, offset lithography or some form of duplicating. 2.1 In letterpress the copy is made up into type metal which is put on a printing press, inked and produces an image direct onto the paper. The type metal is either set by hand which is a long and therefore expensive process - or by one of two machines: a linotype or monotype. The linotype produces a line of type in a slug which is fitted into place by hand. The monotype casts each character separately; it is thus more versatile and often more appropriately used in form work. It is, however, a more expensive process though less so than handsetting. The question of which process is used will be decided by the printer who will be guided by availability, cost and practicability. Type metal can either be left standing or distributed after the job is completed; if you go to the same printer you should let him know whether you want the type kept standing or not. If type is to be kept standing you will pay for it - the current rate is lc per lb. of metal a month; this covers the cost to the printer of the type metal and the space that he has to keep for it. On the other hand, if type is distributed it will have to be set again if the same copy is to be reprinted - and setting, or composition, is the most expensive part of the printing process. 20 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand DESIGN OF FORMS 1. Introduction 2. Type 2.1 Letterpress 2.2 Offset lithography 2.3 Duplicating 3. 4. Paper 5. Steps in the evolution of a form 6. Revising a form 7. Sumrhary 8. Further reading 8.1 Basic 8.2 Background 8,3 Associative The three criteria of design 1+.1• Uniformity Lf 2 Comprehensibility 1+.3 Economy Appendix A. Spacing requirements in forms Appendix B. Symbols for correcting proofs and marking new copy Introduction: 1. The Medical Records Officer is in the middle of the chain in the business of producing a form. In the design of forms your job as a Medical Records Officer is to interpret the ideas of medical staff so that they meet the criteria of form design: uniformity, comprehensibility and economy. Different people will have differing ideas on the make-up of their forms and will put them forward vaguely, minutely or as a compromise between the two; your job is to apply criteria to each draft so that the end product will form a well-designed part of a series.You should not hesitate to suggest a new form if you consider this is necessary but beware of spawning too many forms - unfortunately, there is no closed season for this activity and you must, therefore, always examine the necessity for a form before going ahead with its design. This duty of examination applies irrespective of the source of the request. To microfilm or not to microfilm (in 'What do YOU do?') Medical Record News, June 1 965, pp 121-4, 126, 128 14.2 Background Doran (M.T.) The need for research in Medical Record methods 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 129-41 Document disposal: details of office shredding machines Office Magazine, Nov. 19 6 3, p 1004 Medical Record, Nov. 1962, pp 583-4 Dudley (H.A.F.) The consultant's need for Medical Records 'Into the W.P.B. with safety' in 'Methods at work' pp 11-16 Luck (J.H.) Work study as applied to Medical Records Londo,, Current Affairs Ltd., 101 pp 'Medical Records' N.Z. Hospital, June 1952, p64 3rd mt. Congress Report, pp 88-106 14.3 Associative Benedon (w.) Records management Jnl AAMRL, Aug. 1957, pp 145-8 (Flavian, Hoovler, Murphy & Nuss) 'We need more space' (in 'What do YOU do?') Medical Record. News, Oct. 1962., pp 220-1 19 Further reading:14. Basic:lk±-i. Bernhardt (P.) How long must medical records be kept in the hospital? (Translation from German; abstract) Hospital Abstracts, Aug. 1963, p Bothwell (P.w.) Routine, records and research Pt. III Medical Record, Feb. 1961, pp 359-6k Eastham (G.),. Formy (E,w.) & Brown (R.J.) An investigation into the demand for old records Medical Record, Feb. 1954, pp 269-7k 'Guide to the organisation of a Hospital Medical Record Department' PP 59-60 U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., American Hospital Assn., 1962, vii +83 McBride (D.M.) Ohio's clean sweep (Record retention) Medical Record News, June 1963 MacEachern (M.T.) Medical Records in the Hospital. pp 33_4, 198 U.S.A., Chicago', Ill., Physicians' Record Co., 1937, xvi + 374, illus. Nemec (F.C.) Microfilming techniques 3rd Int. Congress Report, pp 193-206 Pajala (A.M.) & Brody (S.A.) Mistakes in microfilming Medical Record News, Oct. 1 9 6 3, pp 199- 2 00, 220 Medical Record, Nov, 1961, pp k3-52. Ready (J.B.) Microfiche Report of a Committee on Medical Records in N.S.W. hospitals N.S.W. Hospitals Commn., 1960, Skpp Retaining records: how long? Medical Record News, Feb. 1 963, p 9 S.pringei (E.W.) Retention of the record Medical Record News, August 1964, pp 166-7 London, Faber', 1952, xxii + 1722 Stone (J.E.) Hospital organisation and management, pp 791-2, 797-8 wI 45 (ii) Shredding. By this process paper is cut up into strips varying from -a" to 1/16" wide and up to 6" long. Theit shredded paper is used for packing material. Even strips are not wide enough to convey any significant information and the strips are so tangled that attempting to reconstruct a sheet would be virtually out of the question. Shredding can be done on contract by a firm dealing in waste paper. In this case destruction will have t.o be supervised by a member of the Medical Records department. Alternatively, there are office shredders which could be installed in the Medical Records department. The price range would be $120- 2 5 0 ; these could cope.with all types of medical records and most do not require the prior removal of staples, pins etc. Under no circumstances should destruction be unsupervised by Medical Records staff. 12, Conclusion Finally it should be remembered that much effort is expended in securing the medical record of the patient and many departments of the hospital organisation are concerned with its production; all this effort is wasted unless the record is preserved in such. a manner as to be readily available when required. What is preserved depends on legal, medical and sociological considerations; how it is preserved is largely a question of economics. 13. References Huffman (Edna K.) Manual for Medical Record Librarians, 1959 edn. pp 19 1 - 2 ('Numbering and filing medical records') 2nd International Congress Report. Medical Record News, Feb. 1963 Medical Record, May 1958, November .1959 The Standardisation of Hospital Medical Records. Report of the Sub-Committee of the Standing Advisory Committee of the Ministry of Health of England and Wales. London, H.M.S.O. 1965 19 U Disease index & operation index: 10.2 These would be needed for as long as records kept for research, probably longer because they do give certain basic information about the incidence of disease. Patient summary cards: 10.3 These give identification data, date of admission and discharge, final diagnoses and operations. They are mainly of value after discharge as an alternative to the record shou:L1, this not be available for ascertaining final diagnosis, ope:ra-. tions etc. If kept in chronological order they can replace tthe. admission and discharge register and, as such, should be kept indefinitely, though this could be on microfilm. If, however, they are merely an additional card they should be destroyed after 2-3 years. Means of destruction: 11, Medical records are confidential. It follows that much care must be taken to ensure that, when they are destroyed, destruction is complete, (i) Burning. Unless this is done in a furnace it is useless. Incinerator type destruction can result in charred, but still legible, records being left around the incinerator site or going up the chimney partly burned and being blown over the surrounding countryside. Destruction in a furnace when it is fully operational is absolute. However, steps must be taken to see that records are unloaded straight into the furnace and not left lying around near it. This method may become less available as boilers are converted to automatic stoking and fueling. Some local bodies provide destructor services where documents in bulk can be destroyed under supervision, which would he by a member of the Medical Records staff. 3r Until a local survey has established whether a significant enough proportion of A. & E. patients are part of the 'hospital population' it seems that policy should be retention for a minimum period of 7 years and a maximum period to be fixed locally depending on storage facilities, and the views of the medical staff on the value of A. & E. cards over 7 years old. 'A local survey' is written advisedly. If a hospital is in a primarily residential area, serving possibly several schools but little industry, then the likelihood of A. & E. patients being general hospital patients also is high; conversely, a department in a central city hospital or one in an industrial area is more likely to attract patients who would go elsewhere for general hospital treatment. 9. X-rays Storage of x-rays - as long as the majority are the 17" x 1 5" size - presents a bigger problem than storage of medical records. If mobile shelving is used it must, generally speaking, be motorised; if not motorised, a bay must not be more than 6' wide otherwise it is too heavy to move. It is generally agreed that x-ray report cards should be kept indefinitely or as long as clinical records are kept. The time that x-rays are kept depends largely on storage available. The English report already quoted considers that they can be destroyed after 6 years, maintaining that the majority are of ephemeral interest, such as simple fractures. A compromise between destruction and indefinite retention is to mark each x-ray in one of three categories: to be kept for 7 years, 15 years, indefinitely. This depends on radiologists making a decision at the time the x-ray is taken, which they may not be prepared to do. 10. Medical Records department indices 10.1 Patient index This should never be destroyed. Even if the patient is dead it is often of value as establishing that a person was at a certain place at a certain time. 34 6 19 Nursing notes: 6. The nursing notes are the ones made by nurses in the ward during a patient's time in hospital. They record what actually happened to the patient. There has been a great deal of discussion as to the value of the nurses' section of the medical record after it has served its immediate usefulness, and the necessity for preserving it temporarily or permanently. The report quoted in para 3.1 above considered that they should be classified as primary records and therefore kept for 20 years after the date of last attendance. The Auckland Hospital Board considers them clinical records which should therefore be retained indefinitely. The value of microfilming them is, however, questiohabie. Outpatient records: 7. If, as recommended in chapter 16 ('Outpatient and A. & E. department procedures'), the outpatient records are integrated with the inpatient notes then the one policy will cover both. If, however, they are kept separately in clinics physical considerations, allied with the interest or otherwise 'of the clinicians in the material in the notes, will be the deciding factors. Accident & Emergency department records: 8. The question of retention of A. & E. records is discussed in chapter 16 para 3.2 ('Outpatient and Accident & Emergency procedures'). Some American hospitals, and at least one in Australia, consider that the A. & E. record should form part of the patient's unit medical record. The English report quoted in paragraph 3.1 above states: 'Because the majority of patients will be seen only in the Accident & Emergency department for incidents having little or no significance in the patient's future medical care we agreed that this department should have separate records with a series of numbers separate from the unit system of numbering for the rest of the hospital records'. No recommendation was made on retention. 3'c (iii) (iv) (v) Protection. Film cannot be easily tampered with. Misfiling risk, Misfiling of a chart after it has been put on microfilm is impossible. (This is not the case with microfiche, nor with microfolio or aperture cards, obviously) Saving of time. Filmed records held in the records department eliminate the necessity of having to go to outside storerooms for charts. A study of the two methods - microfilm or microfiche - has shown that a big advantage is obtained with the microfiche. The great advantage of this system is that the whole of a normal patient's file may be recorded on one card. Hard paper copies of an old record - or part thereof- can be made for attachment to a new record on readmission if this is considered necessary. The disadvantages are as follows - Ci) Inconvenience for study purposes. This is not easily done if records are microfilmed, although this depends on the equipment available for viewing or the production of hard paper copies. Not being able to keep a patient's record under one file. On readmission of a patient it would be necessary for the doctor to see the films through a viewer unless a reader-printer was available to print a hard paper copy. (iii) There is a marked aversion to consulting microfilmed records even where a hard copy can be made available easily. The report on 'The Standardisation of Medical Records in England and Wales' stated that there was 'a slump in recall rate which seemed to follow the limitation of recalled records to micro-filmed copies even when copies enlarged to full size were available. This seemed to indicate that micro-filming inhibits the recall of records which might-otherwise be useful.' (ii) (iv) Stationery should be designed with microfilming in mind otherwise the preparation of material can be time-consuming and therefore expensive. 3, 19 Microfilming: 5. Definitions: 501. Microfilm is a 16mm film onto which full-sized pages have been reduced. Microfilm has the main disadvantages that the whole reel has to be •gone through to get the record required and the record cannot be updated - a necessity with a unit record system. On the other hand once on microfilm a record cannot be lost, short of losing the whole film. Microfiche is a 6 x + card of transparent mylar with longitudinal pockets which will take pieces of microfilm cut off in. lengths. Microfiche is adaptable to the unit system and can be easily updated. Strips of film could, however, get lost. Microfolio is a 5 x 3 clear acetate card with up to 60 microfilmed images of Lito sheets (as part of the card as opposed to the microfiche which holds the cut-up film in a pocket), being only one thickness of acetate ittakesup less space than microfiche and its size is more convenient. It is less convenient than microfiche to update. Aperture card is a punch card into which a 35mm film is inserted, the film carrying reduced copies of original papers up to 8 foolscap sheets. Aperture cards have the twin convenience of being capable of use with punch card machinery, (since they can be punched) and with microfilm viewers and reproducers. . Microfilm reader is an illuminated groLLnd glass screen onto which the image of a document is projected in its original size from the microfilm. . Hard paper copy is a permanent copy, in the original size, of a document on bond-weight paper magnified from the microfilmed copy. Reader-printer is a microfilm reader incorporating an automatic process for producing hard paper copies in 6-10 seconds* Advantages and disadvantages: 5.2. The advantages are as follows (i) (ii) Saving of space. 3,000 pages of records can he photographed on 1 100 foot roll of 16mm film, or if microfiche is used about 60 exposures may be reduced to the size of an ordinary index card. . . Accessibility. Microfilmed records can be stored in the. department itself and are readily available. (ii) with the advent of mechanisation methods of recording would change and, from the accretion point of view, a review should be made within 5 years, or possibly earlier; (iii) the culling and destruction of 'management' records should be subject to local rules of the hospital but the Medical Records Officer was to assess the percentage of storage space that would be saved if culling was carried out; (iv) that modern microfilming methods should be supported'. +.Methods Medical records can be kept in various ways most of which are dealt with elsewhere in the manual. Suffice it to mention the main ways and to comment briefly: (i) (ii) wooden bins - wasteful and should have been discarded long ago; wooden drawers - wasteful and should be discarded; foolscap filing cabinets - wasteful of, space and money for general record storage; only to be contemplated in exceptional circumstances where the need to keep records separately and not in shelves can be justified; ,( iv) wooden shelving - takes up more space than steel, is usually difficult to dismantle satisfactorily and is frequently as expensive to provide as steel shelving; there are proprietary makes of adjustable wooden shelving which can be dismantled easily, but which would probably be open to the first objection and possibly the last; (v) fixed steel shelving - best solution for current records and essential where terminal digit filing is used; optimum height is 7 openings, 12" between shelves, if high shelves used then kicksteps will be necessary; (vi) mobile sheel shelving- for older records; on chassis mounted across rails so that the records lie in the same direction as the rails; not more than 6 openings (12" between shelves); if 9 ft. wide should be motorised; (vii) microfilming - for old ' records for which there is insufficent room for the originals. 3i, 19 Type of record Period kept Remarks A. & E. records variesmedium sized hospitals tend to keep indefinitely, unless space very cramped, and larger ones for 10 years X-rays of particular interest indefinitelythough a few hospitals with pressing storage problems have to make a time limit of inpatients ) of outpatients) considerablea few hospitals: particvariationularly well endow.ed with storage space keep indefinitely. Most keep for periods from 4-15 years. Report cards usually kept indefinitely. Medical Record summary cards variesWhen plentyof storage space retained indefinitely but the majority 5-20 years with one large hopital microfilming Patient Index Cards indefinitely The Auckland Hospital Board's Medical Advisory Committee investigated this matter in 1966 and recommended the following policy: (i) patients notes, from the clinical and academic point of view, should be retained indefinitely; (ii) (iii) A. & E. cards should be retained to conform with the Statute of Limitations, i.e. 7 years, and then destroyed; X-ray films should be retained for a minimum period of 20 years but the reports kept indefinitely. The Committee also considered: (i) that the storage problem should be measured on a statistical basis having regard to population growth and expansion of the hospital services; survey showed that twenty-nine states have either no less a term or no specific policy for the retention of medical records, five states have established 25 years as the limit, three states 10 years and one state 21 years. Three states have decided to retain all records permanently. The report on the standardisation of hospital medical records (in England and Wales) recommended that 'on the patient's discharge from hospital all transitory documents should be discarded together with all secondary documents, where copies of essential information would be available elsewhere for 6 years; otherwise secondary documents would be retained in the case folder for 6 years before discarding. Primary records except those of special medical importance should be discarded 20 years after the date of last Primary records were defined as: patient identification form; discharge summary; standard discharge letter; post-mortem report; General Practitioner's letter of referral; history sheet and continuation sheet; operation sheet and authority for consent; anaesthetic sheet; nursing record; social records. Secondary documents: mount sheet (for x-rays and path reports); pathology report form; x-ray report form; E.C.G. report form; E.E.G.••repert form; drug sheet; pharmacy request form (inpatient): pharmacy request form (outpatient) (these mounted on drug sheet); communications sheet (request form); other secondary documents, to be given a suffix locally according to need. Transitory documents: temperature, pulse, respiration and blood pressure chart; other transitory documents to be given a suffix locally according to need, such as electrolyte, fluid balance, urine charts etc; standard envelope. 3.2 In New Zealand A survey of representative large and medium-sized hospitals throughout the country in 1966 indicated the following pattern: Type of recordPeriod keptRemarks Inpatient notes: Medicalindefinitely Nursingindefinitelybut some hospitals destroy because of space limitations - one after 18 months, another after 5 years Outpatient notes variesthe majority, indefinitely, but some 10 years 19 coming into hospital for terminal care with conditions such as bronchopneumonia, general debility, residual hemiplegia etc. If surveys show that these are seldom, if ever, referred to for their medical content they could be treated as if the only requirement was the legal one provided thereis information retained elsewhere establishing identity and dates of admission and death. It is in the field of research and study that the requirements are ill defined. If a doctor is doing a retrospedtive study he wants records as far back as he can get them and he often wants those parts of the record which may appear of no great moment after the patient's discharge. In the treatment of codition A What was the response to and what were the side effects from drug X? This will often require consistency of recording of factors which may have appeared unimportant at the time. However, to compare treatment by drug X with treatment by drug Y such information is necessary. The research workers' main complaint is that these vital clues are missing in old notes, or are often only to be found, or hinted at, in the nurses' notes which the administrator would like to destroy because they usually form the bulk of the notes. The policy that is adopted on the retention of medical records must therefore try to take this into account and balance it against the realities of storag space and maintenance of storage areas0 There is also an historical consideration which administrators may not consider of much importance. However, medical records are documents reflecting medical procedures of the time and also social background. As such some should be kept indefinitely as historical documents even if a policy of destruction after a set number of years has been decided on. Depending on numbers possibly one in every 100 or even 500 or 1000 should be kept for this purpose. There is a cultural, obligation on us to see that. posterity is handed down original contemporary documents. General policy: 3 Overseas: 3.1. In the United States of America the medical records of patients are usually retained for clinical and scientific purposes, either in the original or a reproduced form, for a period of twenty-five years after discharge or death of the patient. Even this varies from state to state. A recent providing storage for medical records for ever and therefore some records must be destroyed or microfilmed but nobody agrees on which records should be kept. 2.Factors involved The question of how long medical records should be kept is governed by three factors (i), the length of time they must be kept to serve the needs of the patient; (ii) the length of time they must be kept to meet legal requirements; (iii) the length of time they must be kept for research and study. Serving the needs of the patient means having records available to provide information if the patient returns to the hospital for any reason - ideally, from the cradle to the grave. They are also required to answer enquiries about previous medical history from other hospitals or by the doctor being consulted by the patient. Legal requirements are governed by the Statute of Limitations which states the period within which an action must be taken -. normally 6 years but this -can be longer in the case of a minor. From a practical angle the time is usually regarded as 7 years The occasions when a person would have grounds for sue.ing for negligent treatment while a minor after he had obtained his majority for treatment over 7 years before occur so seldom as to he negligible; his parents or guardian can be. deemed to have taken care of his interests at the time. Although hospital administrators are often reluctant to destroy old medical records few seem to have any information about what use is, in fact, made of these notes. A study was made at Wellington Hospital in which information about the date the record of first admission was commenced and the reason for current retrieval were obtained. In one month 5,500 medical records were retrieved, of which 107 were for admissions occurring between 10 and 40 years previously. 33 of these were for readmissiors, 19 for outpatient attendances, 51 for research and + for other purposes. It is suggested that Medical Records Officers could assist hospital administrators by compiling similar local data so that facts are available on which storage versus destruction decisions can be based. Studies could also be done specifically into the use made of medical records of patients 19 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand RETENTION OF MEDICAL RECORDS 1. Introduction 2. Factors involved 30 General policy 3.1 Overseas 3.2 In New Zealand 40 Methods 5. Microfilming 5.1 Definitions 5.2 Advantages and disadvantages 6. Nursing notes 7. Outpatient records 8. Accident & Emergency department records 9. X-rays 10. Medical Records 10.1 Patient 10.2 Disease 10.3 Patient department indices index index & operations index summary cards 11. Means of destruction 12. Conclusion 13. References 14. Further reading 14.1 Basic 14.2 Background 14.3 Associative Introduction: 1. Spiraling costs in the hospital field have led hospital administrators to question the value of keeping medical records indefinitely. If they are not to be retained indefinitely, when is it safe and sane to destroy them? Storage of medical records presents not only problems of space, economy and efficiency, but also of correct atmospheric conditions, accessibility to authorised staff and cleanliness. There is a financial as well as the medical administrative problem,which is that of deciding which records are to be retained and which destroyed. The issue is not a clear cut one and can probably be summed up as: everyone agrees that, for economic reasons, we can't go on 8.Further reading 8.1 Basic 'Medical Records and Secretarial Services': Hospital 0 & M Service Report No. 2. Follow-up, p 20 H.M.S.0., 1959, p 32 8.2 Associative Schulz (M.D.) & Wang (C.C.) A simple method of follow-up, disease indexing and filing of radiation therapy records. Radiology, Nov. 1962, pp 8'+2-7 18 ceedings of the 1st International Congress on Medical Reàords" cancer registration and follow-up is recommended. Following up cancer patients is done also by obtaining all newspaper clippings of deaths and comparing them with the cancer register of the area.For cases thought to be deceased and not listed in the papers, a letter to the local Registrar of Deaths or to the Registrar General, Wellington, will bring positive proof. Tracing patients: 6. When attempting to conduct a survey or review of selected diseases it is necessary to forward a questionnaire to the patient. Naturally, quite a number have moved on and it is necessary to find forwarding addresses or by writing to the private doctor. If these are not successful the Reference Department of the Public Library will hold electoral rolls (national and local), telephone directories and other directories which could help and tracing techniques are covered in the article by K.M. Laurence referred to below. References: Berkowitz (N.H.) Patient follow-through in the outpatient department. Nursing Research, 1963 v 12, No. 1 p. 16.22 and Hospital Abstracts, July 1963 p 417.418 Jackson (N.y.) Hospital discharge reports,Medical Record, Nov. 1 959, p 191-194 Laurence (K.M.) Tracing patients, Medical Record Feb. 1960 p 22+/231 MacEachern (M.T.) Medical Records in the hospital, p 50,52 Turnpenny (R.W.) Calculation table for follow up appointments Medical Record, Aug. 1960 p 312 Operational Research Unit No. 1Outpatient Services S.Y.Q.C. (Pam) OXF Logan (Dr. W.P.D.) Cancer registration and follow up. 3$' 7. 1+ 0Dietetics In selected diseases, follow-up of diet is most important. This is carried out either by giving the patient a diet chart on his discharge from hospital or by arranging an appointment at a dietary clinic.These clinics can be held in the outpatient department or in a suitable room in the diet department. 50Cancer Registration and follow-up Readers will be aware of the procedure in registr.tion of new cases of cancer in New Zealand (which is covered in chapter 17). The question of cancer follow-up is perhaps the most widely known form of follow-up technique. All hospitals that maintain a consultation clinic, Radium or Therapy department make a practice of following up all cases, 'of cancer that have been registered in their area. This is done by the clinic itself at regular intervals, say 3, 6 or 12 monthly: by writing to the patient himself enquiring as to his present state of health or by writing to the private doctor. In practice, this latter method has proved to be the most used. To operate such a scheme it is essential to institute an adequate bring-up system so as not to omit any patient. A printed form is used with a space at the bottom for the private doctor to reply. A self addressed envelope is also included as it helps to expedite the reply and place the request on a sound footing. On reply by the doctor, the details are recorded in the patient's consultation case notes and a further bring-up is made for, say, six months. The use of coloured tabs can come in useful here. As the letters are despatched a coloured tab is placed on the outside of the record.. As the letters are returned this tab is removed. One can tell at a glance the outstanding replies. Next month a different colour tab would be used. A suitably ruled book in month order with an alphabetical index will suit a medium sizehospital admirably. Once a month the letters are sent out as stated and as they come in the names are crossed off and particulars entered.Cancer follow-up is the only means available in New Zealand of finding out the survival rate of forms of cancer. By this means, the National Health Statistics Centre can ensure the accuracy of its statistics. For. general research within the hospital these forms of follow-up can prove most illuminating.One may tell at a glance what the survival rate on, say, cancer of the rectum would be after ten years. For a wider form of follow-up page 203 of the "Pro- 18 book would be required for leap year. To compile the tables a sheet is prepared for each month of the year, showing the days of the month at the top and giving time intervals 1, 2, 3, 4 and 6 weeks and 2, 3 1 6, 9 and 12 months ahead down the left hand side. A strip of x-ray film i ll wide secured to a bulldog clip is then clipped to the sheet on the particular day of the month and thus the calculated appointment dates are available at a glance through the film strip. 1 2 3 1 6 2 3 6 9 1 1 2 3 47 6 7 8 9 10 11 1213 1415 16 17 18 19 May week8 910 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 . 22 23 2425 26 May weeks 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 2728 29 30 31 1 2 May June weeks 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 1 2 3, 4 5 6 7 8 9 MayJune month 29 30 31 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 June weeks 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 JuneJuly months 26 27 28 29 30 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 11+ JulyAugust nonths 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 October Nov. months 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 1 2 3 Jan, months 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 May year7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 2324 25 (a moab1e strip of x-ray film) To ensure the patient does not leave without making a fresh appointment it is general to hand him a slip of paper roughly the size of a visiting card, asking him to report to the Outpatient department for an appointment in .......time. All the doctor does is to fill in the number of weeks. This subject is also covered in chapter 16, section 1.2. completed in the ward, one copy given to the patient, the other to Medical Records or Outpatient department or both, or else the ward sister rings the Outpatient Department to book the appropriate appointment. Some hospitals ensure that patients are seen before discharge when such things as O.P. appointments are checked. It is here that mistakes can occur. Sometimes, if sister is busy, she entrusts the booking to a nurse who might forget to make it or else ask for a booking at the wrong clinic. Conversely the appointments clerk may book the patient into a wrong clinic.These mistakes may not be found out until the records have been withdrawn for the clinic, or, worm still, when the patient arrives at the clinic itself. Every effort should be made to ensure accuracy at this point. The job of appointment clerk is most important; a good clerk, with a sound knowledge of clinic routine can save hospital boards many pounds as well as ensuring . that the doctor in charge of the clinic has no waste time. To achieve this, one must have the co-operation of all from the nursing sister to the porter who will have to carry wet films to the clinic. It is indeed a team effort. •Outpatient attendances have increased as a result of Health Department policy to reduce bed stay. Many tests can be carried out as an outpatient which, previously, were done whilst an inpatient. To ensure coverage of these tests, a repeat appointment must be made for a date following completion of these tests. For example..... a patient may have been referred to clinic with symptoms suggestive of a duodenal ulcer. The visiting physician will order the appropriate x-ray and perhaps occult blood tests to be carried out and request the patient to return on completion of these tests. The appointments clerk will ensure a reasonable time for the results to come to hand and make an appointment accordingly. All these results should be placed in the outpatient case notes before the clinic starts so that the information will be available. A further example may be, say, a chest case with a repeat appointment in one year. Therefore, all clinic books should be kept ruled up a year ahead. This is easy if clinics are held only on set days and times. it is usual, at this time, to check off the appointment dates with a calendar, striking off those days which are public holidays, such as Anniversary day, Queen's Birthday, Labour Day, etc. (Obviously this would not apply in those hospitals which continue to operate clinics on public holidays). Alternately, the diagram below which is a calculation table for follow-up appointments will help. This could well be used in hospitals where appointments books are not ruled up for one year ahead. A separate 18 specified period to continue treatment. This note should be done the same day as the patient is discharged. The same applies if the patient is ambulant and is required to attend the Accident and Emergency Department daily for dressings. A note, similar to the above, should be sent to the Accident and Emergency Department. This, plus the availability of the patient's medical record should enable treatment to be carried out. Medical Social Workers: 2.2. This department has grown rapidly over recent years. Its main task in connection with follow-up is to see-that the patient has somewhere to go on discharge, that there will be adequate supervision of treatment, that, in the case of unemployed, there will be a Social Security benefit or, better still, a job to go to.In the case of psychiatric patients the home background is investigated to ensure that the patient is returning to a congenial atmosphere. Medical Social Workers will pay visits to check on progress and report back to the medical staff concerned. Most of the above can be done while the patient is still recovering in hospital, thus ensuring an early discharge and a happier patient. Poet Mortem: 2.3. Quoting MacEachern once more in the case of Reports of Autopsy he states "In the case of death, every possible effort shall be made to secure an autopsy. The attending physician is the one person who can be most successful in this, but should he not wish to take the initiative, a resident, or some other member of the hospital personnel may be allowed to act." This is generally the practice in New Zealand, where it is recognised that by conducting a post mortem conclusive findings are found of suspected diagnoses. Outpatients: No patient should be allowed to depart from hospital, unless provision has been made for his future care. This may be either by follow-up by the family doctor, appointment at an outpatient clinic or referring specialist's rooms or by readmission at a later date. The first has been covered above. Reference to an O.P. clinic is done by the ward sister before the patient leaves the hospital. The ward sister accompanies the visiting physician or surgeon on the ward round and makes a note when the patient is to return to clinic. A form can be 3. covering all details of treatment etc. and does not worry about follow-up reports except in certain cases as for research work or for cancer which is dealt with under 'Cancer Registration' (Chapter 17) 2.Inpatients With short bed stay the continuation of treatment for patients about to be discharged from hospital is necessary. The period from discharge until an appointment either at clinic or doctor's surgery is covered by, firstly, an interim discharge note which is sent to the family doctor on the day of discharge from hospital using N.C.R. (no carbon required) paper, or a pad with carbon paper. This sheet has the bare essentials, namely: private doctor's name, patient's name and address, diagnosis, treatment given and treatment to be continued, house surgeon's signature and date. The form is completed by the house surgeon whilst on a ward round and either posted out the same day or .handed to the patient although the latter course is not recommended, as the patient may either lose it or forget to deliver it. If carbon copy is made this is filed in the medical record. The medical record is forwarded to Medical Records for assembly and it is usual for the house surgeon to do enlarged notes to the family doctor, other than for certain routine minor surgery, e.g. Ts and As, D and C etc. Some hospitals use photostat copying apparatus, dictating machines, tape recorders, or just plain long hand. One or two hospitals omit the interim discharge note and send out one letter to the family doctor with a note at the bottom that a fuller report will be furnished on request. Whatever the scheme or method adopted, the aim is to provide the doctor who is going to carry on treatment with some facts on the case in the shortest possible time. Different sized hospitals will obviously have different methods but all will agree that whatever the method the human element counts in the long run. The most modern equipment in the world is rendered. useless unless used regularly and methodically. 2.1 District Nurses • Often patients are discharged from hospital to continue daily dressings or treatment by the District Nurse. The house surgeon or ward sister contacts the District Nurse, preferably on a standard form, requesting that the District Nurse call for a 00 18 Medical Records Practice' In NewZealand FOLLOW-UP METHODS 1. Introduction 2. Inpatients 2.1 District Nurses 2.2 Medical Social Workers 2.3 Post Mortem 3. Outpatients 4Dietetics 5. Cancer registration and follow-up 6. Tracing patients 7. References 8. Further reading 8.1 Basic 8.2 Associative Introduction: 1. The general interpretation of the above heading means the various methods for continuing treatment for patients. Reference to other publications cited will give access to a wealth of diagrams, flow charts, etc. which it would be impossible to reprint in this manual. In most cases, when the patient is discharged from hospital, the disease is not entirely cured, and it is necessary to follow him through a period of convalescence of treatment. varying from days to many years. The immediate result is known. at the time of discharge but it is of greater importance to know the end result. This is the correct evaluation of the work and can be determined by a systematic follow-up. This can be done in the outpatients department, by the Medical Soôia]. Worker, or by the private doctor. According to'MacEachern in 'Medical Records in the Hospital' private patients can be followed-up only with the consent of the attending physician and the best method is to see the patient at intervals and report the results to the hospital where they will be incorporated in the medical record. In general, where a patient desires to attend his private doctor for follow-up, the hospital provides a discharge note j4q ' . 17 different selection of patients. Few hospitals in New .Zealand will have sufficient cases available for this type of detailed survival. Crude or observed survival rates discussed in the previous section do not take into account mortality from other causes nor the effect of sex and age on the calculation. For example, skin cancers such as rodent ulcers and squamous cell are not considered particularly dangerous, yet the crude 5 year survival rate is around 73 per cent in males. This result comes about because of the high proportion of very old persons who suffer from skin cancers and old people have a high risk of dying from other causes. Ideally, it would be desirable to have survival rates based on deaths due to cancer of the particular site alone, but it is considered too difficult to define to what. degree the cancer affected the outcome irrespective of the eventual certified cause of death. A more satisfactory way of handling the problem is to produce a corrected or adjusted survival rate which makes allowance for the normal processes of mortality. Under this system the skin cancer 5 year survival rate rises to around 95 percent. Briefly, it is calculated, for each site independently, by multiplying the number of male or female registrations in each age—group by a percentage worked out from the New Zealand Life Tables. This percentage represents the probability that a person who reaches that age will live for another interval, of three or five years, The sum of these products gives a total of the expected number of survivors in the site. This total is then divided by the number of registrations or persons at risk in the site. A factor is thus obtained which, when applied to the crude survival rates, provides the corrected survival rate. The effect of so dividing a crude survival rate by this corrective factor is to adjust upward by a certain percentage. 6, References International Classification of Diseases (1958 revision) Hospital Statistics Handbook Statistics Handbook for Hospital Tumour Registries. State of California Department of Public Health Wilson (Peter E.) Operating a cancer registry in the Taranaki district. N.Z. Medical Record, December 1966 iq3 in the remaining groups. This is the number to be entered in column 2 of the sample table. The rest of the living group, that is, the (s) subgroup, plus the (a) (5 or more) subgroup of the dead group makes up the total individuals who survived 5 or more years. This number is entered in column 3. The 5-year survival rate is obtained as the number in column 3 x 100 divided by the number in column 2. EXAMPLE OF TABLE FOR PRESENTATION OF SURVIVAL RATES (Source: California Tumour Registry Handbook) Period,TotalAlive atSurvival years5 yearsRate ( -1)(2)(3) (i+) 520615675.7% The same procedure can be used to obtain rates for other years of survival, that is, the three-year survival rate or the ten-year survival rate, as long as the appropriate group exposed to risk is selected and the untreated cases are excluded. It is emphasised that the simple type of survival rate' described above while useful can be most misleading if compared with similar figures compiled for other hospitals. The series will comprise a heterogeneous collection of cancers in all stages of development, some cases treated for cure, some for palliation and some not treated at all. The hopeless cases included in the series reported at a stage in the illness when the physician can have little or no influence on the outcome will have a depressing effect on survival rates, and much depends on the extent to which a series is made up of those cases,Thus for comparison with data from other registries, to have some validity, it is essential that survival be examined in the light of the stage or degree of malignancy of the disease at first diagnosis by the intention of first course of treatment, by the reasons for non-treatment and by the precise type of treatment or combination of treatments undertaken and by the sex of the patient. Only with survival information available in these breakdowns will it be possible to measure whether differences in the rates are real or due to chance because of a 27 17 By survival we mean the probability of a group of,-patients suffering from cancer living for a specified number of years. The question to be posed in respect of every case included in the series is: "Was the patient exposed to the risk of living or of dying over the whole of the period specified - usually three, five or ten years?" Survival calculations are confined to new registrations only, all recurrences or cases treated prior to registration being omitted. Survival is calculated from the date of the first course of treatment in treated cases and from the date of initial diagnosis in untreated cases. It is the number of cases alive at the end of the period expressed as. a percentage of the total number of cases alive at the beginning of the period.This calculation is termed the crude survival rate and makes no allowance for cases which died of causes other than cancer of the site in question. The following method can be followed .1. Make out a card on which, is entered the following (a) Date of first treatment or diagnosis 'if Suntreated. (b) Date of last follow-up report. (c) Whether living at last report or 'dead at last report (L or D). (d) Interval from date of first treatment to last report in completed years. With a card bearing this information, proceed as follows 2. If you are compiling 5-year survivals include only cases which , had a chance of follow-up on or after their fifth anniversary. For example, if you are computing 5-year survival as at 31 December 1967, exclude all cards treated or diagnosed from 1963 through to 1967- .3. Subdivide the remaining cards into two groups on the item last report: those marked (living at last report); those marked D (dead at last report). .k. Take up these two groups (living, dead) and subdivide each according to interval : (a) those marked 5 or more: (b) those marked k or less. The (b) cards in the "living" pack are untraced for the full five-year period. Exclude cards for those untraced cases. Count the number of cards consists of making the clbsed hole into open "V" shaped slots. When a needle is inserted through a batch of cards correctly stacked and the batch is raised, those cards which have been slotted at the needled position will fall away. Cards thus separated can then be counted. In this manner, through passing the needle in succession through, say, four holes marked for precise anatomical site of cancer, individuals can be separated out and then further subdivided by age, sex, stage, etc. Approximately one thousand cards can be needled through any one position in one minute.The body of a marginally punched card can be printed and used as an ordinary record card, utilising both the front as well as the back of the card for this purpose. At the New Plymouth Hospital Registry a marginally punched card printed locally is used as an abstract form to summarise all the details of each case. The system is described by Mr. P. Wilson, Medical Records Officer, as follows " The Brown Punch Card contains personal details, duration and type of symptoms, diagnosis, stage, pathology, treatment and follow-up reports. It condenses all the essential information from the inpatient medical record, outpatient medical record, x-ray department and treat 'ent at other units (for example neurosurgery at Dunedin or Cobalt 60 at Palmerston North).Thus there is available a document that serves a threefold purpose - for filling in the MS38 abstract form, as a comprehensive hospital cross-index for cancer, and as a patient and site index. Cards are stored alphabetically by patient's name while the patient is alive and under follow-up. All deaths and survivals of more than ten years (called discharges) are stored alphabetically by patient's name in site groups. Thus we have all lung cancers A to Z, all stomach cancers A to Z, etc. This method keeps the current cases down to a manageable number in a comparatively small cabinet. It will be seen that the Brown Card is the "heart" of the register and all other cards and forms are the means of keeping it up-to--date. " 5.3 Calculation of survival rates at the Hospital Registry The two most important aspects of cancer registration are incidence and the survival experience. Incidence is a matter for the Central Registry but the hospital registry is in a position to measure the effectiveness of treatment for cancer within the hospital. 17 EXAMPLE; OF CARD FOR SORTING AGE PATIENT NAME Jones, John TYPE Adenocarcinoma STAGE Growth limited to lower bowel DATE OF ADMISSION 6-9-57 YEARS SURVIVED 5 59 SEX SITE .1. Abdominoperineal resection Alive 7.5.63 TREATMENT DATE OF LATEST INFORMA TION STATUS (ALIVE . OR DEAD) (h) Marginally punched cards, When information is collected on a large number of items for a large number of individuals, devices must be introduced to reduce the burden of work. Only the Central Registry and the very largest hospitals will have mechanical punched card systems for punching and tabulating the individual cards for each patient's history. However, there is another system employed in at least one hospital in New Zealand (New Plymouth) which can be recommended. The marginal punched card is known as the Para-punch Card (a proprietary name). Made of light cardboard, it has perforations along its edges. Each hole represents an item of information and is identified by either a numbered or lettered code.When the required information has been entered on the card (the use of the holes is different for each project) the relevant hole is slotted with a pair of clippers similar to a bus conductor's clippers. Slotting For males and females? For children and adults in defined age-blocks? 5.2 Methods of collecting and tabulating data (e) Sources of data to be checked .1. .2. .3. Hospital case notes Hospital Registry abstracts The site index register .k. Central Cancer Registry reports and data (f) Tally sheets. When many items are to be counted, and especially where there are different categories which must be kept apart, it is advisable to use a tally sheet. This system is described in chapter 22 (Hospital Morbidity Statistics). (g) The card system of analysis. When the number of cases is large, or when the number of categories into which the cases are to be grouped is large, the process of tabulation is facilitated by transferring data onto a separate card for each individual, each fact being indicated in the same place on each card. The cards can then be sorted into piles according to the age, or sex, or type of treatment, or into other groups or classes. It is then necessary only to count the number of cards in each pile and enter the totals into each table. In this way the inter-relationship of two or more factors can readily be studied. .17 In many instances it will be more efficient and certainly quicker to carry out local statistical studies in the registry itself and certainly by so doing the registry worker will gain a clearer insight into the material which he is recording from day to day. Some ideas on how to collect data for a statistical study and how to express medical facts by figures are well set out in the Statistics Handbook for Hospital Tumour Registries compiled by the State of California Department of Public Health, This section is an adaptation of the Californian Handbook. Planning a study: 5.1. (a) First of all the objectives must be stated ' in terms of questions which could be answered with, statistical data. Example: What is the five-year survival rate for leukaemia patients in your register? (b) Investigate the availability of data. Is it possible to obtain the information you want on all the leukaemia cases admitted for a specific period ending at least five years prior to the date of the investigation? Where will the information come from - abstract forms, the site index register, the medical record itself, or a combination of them? Is this information accessible and complete? Are there enough cases to make the investigation worthwhile? (c) Define the population and the items to be studied. Should you include only cases diagnosed and treated in your own hospital and exclude cases diagnosed elsewhere or treated previously elsewhere? What period of time is to be included? (d) Describe the variables to be used in the study. Should rates be calculated separately for acute and chronic leukaemias? 21Z Cases where malignancy is strongly suspected can be inserted in the registry.The preliminary diagnosis will either be confirmed or rejected through follow-up or death information. 4.5.6 Histologic type of cancer The precise histologic type of cancer will usually be revealed by microscopic examination of tissue. The.pathologist's report is referred to for this detail. The code used, fairly universally, for histologic coding is the Manual of Tumour Nomenclature and Coding published by the American Cancer Society. 4,5.7 Corrections and additions The Central Registry records in respect of each case must match up at all times in essential detail with the corresponding record in the individual hospital registry. From time to time further or amending information concerning a case will become available after the case has been registered with the Central. Registry. The obligation is on the Medical Records Officer to inform the Central Registry of any additions or corrections to the initial report. :5. 'Methods of tabulating data The Medical Records Officer is in a position to provide valuable information routinely to both medical staff and to lay administrators in his or her hospital. By doing so he will undoubtedly impxove his standing in the hospital. Some part of the service he can render will come through requests for data, but there still remains the opportunity to show a positive approach to the job by compiling and presenting a report on. registry activities at the close of each year. The Central Registry will, if it is able, provide figures covering any particular registry, and is in a position to contrast those for any geographical area with the national picture. However, the Central Registry has its , own list of functions to carry out and the machine time available for cancer tabulations is restricted by the demands for other types of medical facts. 1-,I 17 - second, assignments to each of these three components of a series of numbers to indicate degrees of extension or involvement, e.g. TO, Ti, T2, etc. - third, grouping the T.N.M. assignments into a small number of clinical stages Tumours occurring in five sites - breast, buccal cavity, pharynx, larynx, and bladder have been classified and defined by the International Union. Proposals regarding seven further sites are now outlined and were to be considered at a meeting in July 1965. These are - thyroid, bronchus, oesophagus, stomach, colon, rectum and corpus uteri. The classification adopted for carcinoma of the cervix in New Zealand is internationally recognised and there is no suggestion that it will be supplanted by T.N.M. Actually the four stages (see N.S.38-6) do correspond to the four degrees of T. The staging internationally accepted for tumours of the body of the uterus is as set down in M.S.38--7 and is really a simple T classification. Like the stomach and colon this is not a site at which a clinical assessment of the extent of the primary or the involvement of regional nodes can be accurately made. Indeed it may be difficult to say whether a growth arises from the cervix or the body of the uterus, though the histology may resolve this. Confirmation of diagnosis: 4.5.5. Cases will fall into three categories A. B. C. Cases confirmed microscopically Cases confirmed clinically Cases not confirmed as malignant The big majority of cases (over 90 per cent) will be confirmed microscopically. Positive microscopic findings are revealed by biopsy, surgical specimen, bone marrow aspirations, cytology and blood studies. In general it will be found that cancers of the inaccessible sites will be microscopically confirmed less frequently than cancers of the relatively accessible sites. Cases confirmed clinically will largely comprise far advanced cases for which surgical removal was deemed inadvisable and biopsy considered unnecessary. 2D nationally accepted criteria become available these are accepted as being more suitable. Three of the MS38 cards, Larynx (part only), Kidney and Ureter, Other Female Genital Organs, and General provide for the simplest of breakdowns into three categories of stage as follows .1. Localised- tumour that appears to be confined entirely to the organ of origin. .2. Regional and/or Node Involvement - tumour that has extended beyond, the limits of the organ of origin (1) into regional lymph nodes (2) into surrounding organs or tissues or (3) a combination of (1) and (2) and appears to have spread no further. .3. Remote or Diffuse Metastases - tumour that has 'spread to parts of the body remote from the primary tumour. Distant metastases, tumour tissues growing in parts of the body remote and disconnected from the organ of origin, are known to reach their distant positions by three modes of transport.These include travel through the bloodstream, the' lymph channels, and the body cavities. A further category of stage which is used is that of Stage O - In Situ - also called intraepithelial, preinvasive, noninvasive, or noninfiltrating. This is a tumour that fulfils all the microscopic criteria for malignancy, except invasion. The e International Union Against Cancer,. which is considered to be the authority on these specialist matters, has evolved the T.N.M. system of classifying malignant tumours. The T.N.M. system is in effect a medical shorthand system of breaking down the "extent of disease" and involves three steps - first, identification' of extent of disease by the.use of three symbols: T = Extent of primary tumour N = Condition of regional lymph nodes M = Distant metastases 17 F. OTHER TREATMENT Anytumour directed treatment that cannot be assigned to one of the above categories. it Staging: 4.5.1+. It will be necessary to study the medical record very thoroughly to establish the stage of the tumour. Evidence will come from the physical examination of the patient, especially in regard to lymph nodes or other palpable organs or masses and also from the pathology report. X-ray reports will describe findings that may represent metastases to lungs and/or bones, or other internal abnormalities such as organ shadows that appear to be displaced due to pressure or increased size as a result of malignant involvement. Other evidence may be seen directly from procedures such as bronchoscopy, cystoscopy, gastroscopy, oesophagoscopy and sigmoidoscopy. Staging a case is a matter for a physician and the wise registry worker should provide for an entry to be completed worded precisely in the way that he requires the staging to be assessed, rather than attempting to interpret anumber of statements presented in narrative form. The purpose in grading tumours is to provide a measuring rod on which the results of treatment and prognosis of malignant growths can be assessed and compared both as between different regions within New Zealand and between New Zealand and the rest of the world. The Central Registry definition ae is the extent to which the disease has progressed as established at the time of first clinical examination prior to treatment and must not be changed by any findings at operation at any later time. It is not uncommon to find in the case of internal cancers that the tumour is more extensive than had been adjudged through clinical examination.However, the ruling of the Research Commission Committee of the International Jnion Against Cancer is that the staging categories assigned should not be changed when the histological findings of the surgically removed tissues, especially the lymph nodes, become available, but such information may be used in a supplementary pathological classification. The MS38 abstract cards employ different staging criteria and systems for individual sites. The systems adopted were decided upon by New Zealand specialists, but whenever inter- If w Mannitol-mustard Phenylalanine-Mustard Mechiorethamine Purinethol 6-Mercaptopurine (6 MP)Stilboestrol Methotrexate TEM (Triethylenemelamine) Mus targen TEPA Myleran Thio-TEPA Nitrogen Mustard (HN 2 )Uracil-mustard Oestrogen Urethane D. STEROIDS/HORMONES Included here is any type of therapy which exercises its effect on tumour tissue via change of the hormone balance of the patient. Thus we have hormones, anti-hormones, steroids, surgery for hormonal effect, and radiation for hormonal effect. Steroids and hormones are primarily used for breast cancer, prostatic cancer, leukaemia, Hodgkins' disease, lymphomas, lymphosarcomas, and multiple myeloma. Surgery for hormonal effect includes such procedures as Adrenalectomy(anysite other than adrenal) Hypophyectomy(breast) Oophorectomy(breast) Oophorectomy plus adrenalectomy (breast) Oestrogen with orchidectomy (prostate) Radiation for hormonal effect would include such procedures as x-ray therapy to ovaries. E. SUPPORTIVE PROCEDURES Supportive procedures are not tumour directed. Provision is made in some instances on the MS38 abstract form for supportive procedures to be marked (e.g. colostomy on the Colon and Rectum Card), but it is emphasised that on the MS38 General Card box "k. Surgery" is not to be marked if the operation could be considered as supportive only. Examples are Surgical short circuiting of neoplasm, such as colostomy, cholecystoduodenostomy, ureterosigmoid transplant, etc. Vasectomy (testes, prostate or bladder) Blood transfusions for leukaemia Surgical cutting of nerves for relief of pain Removal of fluid (thoracentesis, paracentesis) 27 17 I B. RADIATION Radiation-Beam includes all teletherapy directed to tumour tissue regardless of the source of radiation. Examples are X-ray therapyNeutron Beam Cobalt Bomb Betatron Cycloto:xin Spray radiation Linear Accelerator Radiation,, not otherwise specified Radiation - Other includes all forms of radiation therapy other than beam therapy, such as Radium insertion Colloidal gold Radon seeds Radioactive gold (Au phosphorus P32 Yttrium 198, iodine (1131), In other words, all implants, moulds, seeds, needles, or applicators of radioactive material are included in this category. Exception: Any radiation to endocrine glands for cancer of another site should be considered radiation for hormonal effect and listed under "Steroids and Hormones". (Radiation to an endocrine gland because of a primary tumour would of course be listed under "Radiation"). C. CHEMOTHERAPY Chemotherapy covers any chemical which is administered to attack or treat tumour tissue and which is not considered to achieve its effect through a change of the hormone balance. Substances quoted are Aminopterin Cytoxan Amethopterin Degranol Actinomycin D DON Azaserine Endoxan 6-Azauracil 5-Fluorodexyurine Chlorambucil 5-Fluorouracil 6-Chloropurine Leukeran ilk planned to be initiated within four months after diagnosis. The first course of treatment may have been completed as an inpatient in your hospital or may have been continued on an outpatient basis at your hospital or may have been completed at a private hospital or radiotherapy unit. It is extremely important that the full course of treatment be obtained and recorded at another hospital. Under the existing system whereby most cases treated in private hospitals are not reported to the local cancer registry, some cases will appear either as inpatients in public hospitals or as outpatients in radiotherapy departments in which the details of the original or first part of treatment are unknown.In all such cases a note, "full treatment detail not available", should be written across the treatment section of both the hospital and MS3 8 abstract so that the case can be left out of survival by type of treatment calculations. The MS38 abstract card asks for a division to be made. between "palliative" and "curative" procedures. There is .no general agreement on the definition of these terms, and it is admitted that intent is often difficult to establish from medical records. However, most cases are clear-cut from the type of operation or procedure carried out. "Treatment" in the statistical sense is strictly interpreted as being aflcedures_or ther ,^yi eij which aim to modify, control, remove or destroastic tissue,whether prima ati C • The following definitions are extracted from the "Californian Tumour Registry Handbook" 'Ii A. SURGERY This category is restricted to surgery which partially or totally removes a tumour (excluding a biopsy for diagnostic purposes only).Surgical procedures where tumour tissue is not removed, such as exploratory laparotomy, caecostomy or cholecystoduodenostomy are not included as surgery.. Extion: Removal of endocrine glands for hormonal effect such as oophorectomy and oophorectomy plus adrenalectomy and hypophysectomy for breast cancer or orchidectomy and simple adenectomy for prostate cancer would be listed on the hospital abstract form as "Steroids and Hormones" and would be included as this form of treatment in any statistical analysis of the MS8 abstract form. 17 The Public Health Statistician, National Health Statistics Centre, Department of Health, Box 6314, WELLINGTON Notes on abstracting and abstract items: 4.5, Identifying information: 4.5.1. Even in a Country with a small population like New Zealand there are numbers of persons with exactly the same surname and Christian or first name, while many others have very similar names. Each hospital registry should have available the local Electoral Roll(s), and this should be referred to for verification of the spelling of names, the accuracy of the address and the correctness of the stated occupation. For medical purposes the occupation provides a guide . to the environment and the economic status of the patient, which means that it is essential to elicit, in the case of elderly patients in particular, the occupation followed for the greater period of the person's working life. Death information: 4.5.2, It is a very good policy to • check all names in the death columns of the local newspapers with the alphabetical index of registered cases. The date of death would then be entered on the abstract card as well as on the follow-up , reminder card so that unnecessary letters would not be sent out. It is emphasised that the Quarterly Death List supplied by the National Health. Statistics Centre is issued up to six months after the date of registration of the death and still further this list contains :nly the names of persons whos deaths were due to the malignancy either directly or as an associated cause of death. Deaths of registered patients dying from causes other than cancer will not be covered by this quarterly list. Treatment: .405.3, Treatment for cancer can cover a very long period of time, and for statistical purposes at the Central Registry it is necessary to limit any analysis by type of therapy to the first course of treatment, which is defined to include all treatment Z14 (a) Every case, inpatient or outpatient, public hospital or private hospital, with a diagnosis of a malignant neoplasm as defined in the International Classification of Diseases is to be registered at the local hospital registry. Skin cancer cases, basal cell and squamous cell, I.C.D. code 191, are not required by the Central Registry but it may well be that hospital registries will wish to cover these types of lesion. Malignant melanoma of the skin, I.C.D. No. 190, requires to be reported to the Central Registry. (b) The first admission to your hospital or attendance at an outpatient clinic with a diagnosis of cancer should, be abstracted. Readmissions for the same neoplasm constitute follow-up, and another abstract should not be prepared. (c) When a patient has two or more unrelated primary neoplasms each should be registered on a separate abstract card. (d) Cases first discovered at post mortem with'no previous suspicion of neoplasm should be abstracted with the notation "First discovered at post mortem" entered under "No treatment, specify reason" on the hospital abstract form. On the MS3 8 abstract card there is already provision for this' in a box in Section X, "Reason for No Treatment". (e) Possible, probable and suspected diagnoses are registered only if tumour-directed treatment is given. If tumourdirected treatment is not given and the diagnosis is suspected only, the cases should not be registered. In the latter instance, if the patient is readmitted and the diagnosis confirmed then the case becomes reportable for this later admission. The previous admission should be disregarded. 1+.3 When to abstract Allow sufficient time for obtaining complete diagnostic and treatment information before abstracting. The MS38 cards should be sent to the Central Registry at the close of each quarter. 1 , 4 Where to send MS38 abstracts Completed M S3 8 abstracts should be sent to the Central Registry addressed - 17 used to preparereports of survival and end-results by site groups.To take out such statistics a coding system would need to be employed for detailed anatomical site, stage and treatment and for this purpose, of course, the codes employed on the MS38 abstract card would be generally the most suitable. There are two column headings only on the suggested site index register illustrated in Figure 3, which are not self-explanatory. These are, with suggested codings, as under Type of admission Code1 - Inpatient 2 - Outpatient 3 - Private hospital case Previous diagnosis or treatment Code 1 - First diagnosis and treatment of case 2 - Diagnosed elsewhere earlier but no previous treatment 3 - First diagnosis and treatment elsewhere Directions for abstracting: 1+, The Hospital Statistics Handbook; 4.1. Fairly precise instructions concerning the completion of the MS38 abstract card forwarded to the Central Registry are contained in the Hospital Statistics Handbook, Part II. The points mentioned here are pertinent both to abstracting onto forms used in hospital registries as well as to the abstracting for Central Registry purposes. Note Ommission from Handbook: Abstract card MS38-5 was specially designed for female breast cases. Abstract card MS38-12 should be used for male breast cases. Cases to be abstracted: +.2. The following cases require to be registered in the Hospital Registry and a corresponding MS38 abstract card forwarded to the Central Registry - International List No, Site 14o-148 Buccal cavity and pharynx Oesophagus 150 Stomach 151 Large intestine (except rectum) 153 154 Rectum Biliary passages and liver 155 Pancreas 157 All other digestive organs 15 2 9 156, 158, 159 162 Lung bronchus and trachea 160, 164, 165 All other respiratory system Breast 170 Cervix 171 172-3 Other parts of uterus Ovary 175 All other female genital organs 176 Prostate 177 178-179 All other male genital organs i8o-i8i Kidney and bladder. 190-191 Skin. . .. 192-199 All other sites and gene±a1ised carcinomas.. 20k Leukaemia and A1eukaemia 200, 201, 202, 203, 205 All other Lymphatic and . haematopoietic tissues.. An alternative design of Site Index Register is the .one illüstrate.d in Figure 6. This type is recommended to all .the large registries in that it permits the extraction Of statistical. data concerning the cancer load in the hospital.Patients seen for the first time are listed by major anatomical sites, with the following information recorded a, the hospital number b, the patient's name c. diagnosis d. date of diagnosis e, age at diagnosis f. stage g. type of treatment h. survival in years i. date of death The Medical Records Officer could readily prepare summary reports by anatomic sites by age, sex, stage, and method of treatment from this register (see section k). It may also be SITEINDEXREGISTER— 170'BREAST 0 c4 0c E OFNAME OF PATIENTHOSP. LDIAG ISSION SERIAL I SITE NO. YR. ILASTFIRST AGE SEXDATE OFLATEST FOLLOWo2$ I.C.D. INITIALTREATMENT UP INFORMATION J TYPE CODE NO..DIAGNS.. MO. yp : STAGE TYPE CODE YEARS AFTER TR p.z El FIG. 6— SUGGESTED SITE INDEX REGISTER F DEATH INFORMATION ATE OF YEARS OF DEATH SURVIVAL HOSPITAL LETTERHEAD Name of Relative or Friend, Street Address, City or Town Dear (Date) ______ This hospital is carrying out a special study of the state of health of patients who have been treated for some types of disease. We have lost contact with (name of patient) and we are seeking your help. Would you be kind enough to fill out the requested information as set out below, and return this letter to us. We are especially interested in the whereabouts of (name of patient), so that we can keep in touch with him for the purposes of our study. We are enclosing a stamped, self-addressed envelope for your convenience. Sincerely, End. Present whereabouts of: for Medical Superintendent (name of patient) Street address:____________________ City or Town: Present condition: Apparently well FIG. 5- Not well SAMPLE FOLLOW-UP LETTER TO RELATIVE OR FRIEND 17 HOSPITAL LETTERHEAD Name of Patient, Street Address, City or Town (Date) Dear We are writing to enquire how you have been feeling since you were last seen at this hospital. We are very interested in the progress of our patients after treatment and it would be helpful if you would give us a brief report on your Condition and return this letter to us in the enclosed envelope. Thank you for your co-operation, Sincerely, End. for Medical Superintendent 1. Date 2, What is the state of your present health? 3. What doctor do you attend (if any): Name of doctor Doctors address FIG. '+ - SAMPLE FOLLOW-UP LETTER TO PATIENT 271 HOSPITAL LETTERHEAD Name of Doctor, (Date) Street Address, City or Town Dear Doctoro*osoec000e PATIENT FOLLOW-UP Name of patient: . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . Address: . • • • • • • • • 0 • 0 0 • 0 S 0 S 0 0 S 0 S ••_0 S S 5 0 Diagnosis: * . . . . . . . . . . Hospital No.: . . . . . ••••••••••S0000S50 • • • • 0 • • • • • • • • • • • • . . Date of registration :.../..../..o In order that we may keep our cancer records up-to-date and produce an accurate composite measure of survival experience in different sites, it is necessary to have a simple follow-up report at yearly intervals. I would be grateful therefore if you would furnish the information set out below in respect of the above patient.. If you are unable to trace this patient I would be glad if you would return this form noted accordingly. With thanks for your , co-operation, Yours faithfully, for Medical Superintendent IF ALIVE IF DEAD 1. When was the patient last1. Date of death known to be alive? ... /.../...2 Place of death 2. Condition of patient (if known) ..................... FIG. 3 — SAMPLE ' .../..../... PATIENT FOLLOW-UP LETTER TO PRIVATE DOCTOR 17 F date when the patient was last seen or reported on G the name and address of the attending physician H the name and address of the nearest relative or friend Forms suitable for sending out to enquire about the state of health of the patient are as illustrated. Figure 3 is the type of form which is used to contact a private doctor and Figure Lf is for contacting the patient who has not been seen by the doctor named-on the Follow-up Card for a long period of time (usually a year). Eventually it may be necessary to obtain information from relatives or a friend, and Figure 5 is an example of the type of letter which could be sent. The Central Registry does not require annual follow-up information to be furnished to it in respect of each patient, but in a proportion of cases only, those who cannot be traced at the registered address on Parliamentary Election Rolls, confirmation of survival will be required at the end of each five-year period. In its turn, the Central Registry will routinely supply to each hospital registry a quarterly list in alphabetical order of persons who have died on whose death certificate a malignant condition was mentioned. This list allows the Medical Records Officer to enter death details on the abstract form and remove the case from follow-up. The site index register: 3.3.3. This type of index in a simple form is kept in most New Zealand hospitals for every disease treated, being termed the "Disease Index". The index of cancer cases may be maintained in the hospital registry as a means to facilitate access to the full hospital medical record so that it is ready immediately it is required by surgeons and other medical staff. The index would be kept by primary site in I.C.D. classification number order with provision to enter on the site card such items as name, hospital number, sex and precise diagnosis. The following are the major specific sites and site groups by which abstracts may be filed according to primary lesion - in Auckland.. Copies of their forms may be obtained from: The Herald Centenary Cancer Registry, Box 5546, Auckland. Small hospitals will not wish to keep detailed records, and in such cases it is recommended that a duplicate of the appropriate MS3 8 form be used as the hospital abstract form. In any of the larger registries it will be found convenient to maintain two separate alphabetical files for abstract forms one file for the live cases and the other for the dead cases. Alternatively a card index system could be maintained with the abstract form filed in numerical order, 3.3.2 The follow-up reminder index. . ... The prime purpose behind this index or diary is to ensure continuing - contact with the patient. During the first year, following discharge from hospital, this is ideally at three, six and twelve month intervals, depending. on theièp.t's condition. Follow-up during the first year will often be obtained from re-admission or outpatient records of clinical examinations.After each patient is discharged from hospital a follow-up card is filed, nominating a return appointment. If the patient breaks the appointment a new date is set and the card is removed and refiled under the advance date. Patients breaking two or more appointments should be followed through other means, such as home visits, etc., and encouraed in every way to return to the hospital or clinic for check-up. After the first year follow-up for statistical purposes is necessary only at yeaily intervals. Each case should be filed alphabetically by month of first treatment or diagnosis so that the Medical Reä.ords Officer is alerted to the requirement to either post available, follow-up information onto the Hospital Abstract Form or to the need to communicate with persons outside the hospital to obtain , simple follow-up information. If the patient is no longer under the care of a physician, then the Medical Records Officer should obtain permission from him to communicate with the patient's family,` The follow-up card should contain the following items A the patient's name and address B the patients case-note number. C the patient's assigned abstract form file number site of the cancer E date of diagnosis and date of treatment FOLLOW-UP INFORMATION NAME AND ADDRESS OF NEAREST RELATIVE: E4 NAME AND ADDRESS OF PHYSICIAN RESPONSIBLE FOR FOLLOW-UP: DATE OF INFORMATIONSOURCE OFCONDITIONSUBSEQUENT. - CONTACT TREATMENT OR REMARKS / /19 //19 / /19 //19 / /19 / /19 //19 z //19 //19 / /19 //19 //19 //19 / /19 / /19 / /19 CLINICAL NOTES FIG.- 213 - SUGGESTED HOSPITAL REGISTRY ABSTRACT FORM - BACK gy HOSPITAL REGISTRY CANCER ABSTRACT FORM •Date Abstract M.S.38 forwarded to Central Registry NAME: Surname MR., MRS./MISS Christian Names ADDRESS: El z DATE OF BIRTH: H El COUNTRY OF BIRTH: RACE:Na OF CHILDREN:____________ (Female genital & breast cases only) HOSPITAL: PATIENT'S DOCTOR:______________________________ SERIAL NO. Date of admission Date of discharge (Private Case) PRIMARY SITE: - DATE OF DIAGNOSIS: NATURE OF GROWTH: MICROSCOPIC DIAGNOSIS AND HISTOLOGIC TYPE (STATE) to STAGE (Describe): SIZE:______________________ .••CODE NODES:___________________ H METASTASES:_________________ RE WAS CASE POSITIVELY DIAGNOSED AS CANCER IN ANY HOSPITAL SERVICE BEFO THIS ADMISSION? . . IF SO, DATE AND NAME OF HOSPITAL: uu El WAS TREATMENT GIVEN? IF SO, TYPE OF TREATMENT AND .HOSPITAL:...... 4 03 PRESENTING SYMPTOMS AND POSSIBLE AETIOLOGICAL FACTORS (e.g. smoking habits): f—M—o— n-t h___Y_e_a_r_1Interval between 1st symptoms and diagnosis: obDate of first symptoms: I// Presenting symptoms (state): Aetiology (state): months .. . INTENT(state reason if palliative) DATETREATMENT (describe) A. Surgery Radiation - Beam Radiation - Other D. Chemotherapy z B. C. Z E. Steroid-Hormone El El - F. Supportive only G'. Other NO TREATMENT . (Specify reason) z CONDITION AT DISCHARGE: Alive Dead IF DEAD, DATE AND CAUSE OF DEATH FIG. 2A - SUGGESTED HOSPITAL REGISTRY ABSTRACT FORM - FRONT m'p 21 17 (iii) To make readily available to medical staff analyses and statistical reports concerning the management of cancer cases in the hospital. These reports' should cover the details of treatments used, the survival as from the date of such treatment, broken down according to the stage at which the disease was diagnosed. Figures of stage at which disease was diagnosed and the trends in the percentages diagnosed early provide an evaluation of the results of educational activities in the area. (iv) . To make readily available to physicians and research workers the relevant detail about particular types of cancer so that studies in depth can be carried out. Filing and indexing: 3•3• No specific system for maintaining a registry is to be laid down. However, certain basic files must be maintained in order that the objectives, or at least some of the objectives, set out in section 3.2 may be achieved. A register of cases must of necessity he maintained in alphabetical order so that all cases can be checked for duplication. This can be done in two ways, (a) by filing the detailed hospital cancer case abstract forms in alphabetical order or (b) by employment of an index card system giving access to filed numbered hospital case abstract reports. The hospital registry abstract form file: 3.3.1. A suggested design of hospital registry abstract form is illustrated in Figures 2A and 213. The file of cancer registry abstracts is the most important element in all cancer registry programmes. It is a concise summary of significant data derived from the full hospital medical notes. It should not be a duplicate of details concerningsyrnptoms, diagnostic techniques and particulars of medical procedures. The form illustrated provides what is considered to be the minimum of recorded information, and yet lends itself to being summarised still further onto the specific site MS38 abstract card forwarded to the Central Registry. Clearly no standardised method of documentation will be capable of answering every question which may be asked. A more complex type of Hospital Abstract Form is in use in The Herald Centenary Cancer Registry 112 3. The operation of a hospital cancer registry The base on which our national cancer scheme rests is the individual hospital registries. Registries as an entity in themselves are a feature of most large hospitals in America, Canada and Europe. The hospital cancer registry, located in a separate room (or corner) should contain the special cancer records of all cancer patients attending at the hospital either as inpatients or as outpatients. The hospital registry forms the active file of pertinent information on the diagnosis, treatment follow-up and end-results of all cancer patients0 3.1 The control of the hospital registry The key person in the operation of a hospital registry is likely to be the officer who acts as secretary and abstracter. The most obvious person advantageously placed to carry outall the necessary clerical functions and to maintain a liaison with the Central Registry is the hospital Medical Records Officer. In the larger hospitals where the volume of the cancer load warrants it, and especially in those where Consultation Clinics operated by the Cancer Society of New Zealand exist, then aPegistrar would probably need to be appointed. The Registrar's duties would in general be to co-ordinate the gathering in of records from the Consultation Clinic, the radiology department, the pathology department and from outside doctors. The Registrar would also act as advisor to the records of on medical queries in the filling in of the abstract cards. A trained Medical Records Officer should have no difficulty in carrying out the day-to-day operations of a registry in conjunction with his main hospital duties provided that he has the continuing assistance and guidance of a physician registrar and the co-operation of the medical staff. 3,2 The functions of the hospital registry The fundamental reasons for the existence of a cancer registry in each hospital are threefold (i) (ii) To provide continuing supervision and patient care. To of to in routinely furnish accurate statistical summaries each case registered to the Central Registry and work closely with the Central Registry so that it, turn, can achieve its objectives, 27/ INFORMANTS PUBLIC HOSPITALS CANCER CONSULTATION . PRIVATE HOSPITALS .. CLINICS ABSTRACT CARDSFORWARDED MATCHED WITH REGISTER TO SEE WNETHER PREVIOUSLY REGISTERED N5i8 HOSPITAL RETURNS CHECKED AGAINST CENTRAL REGISTRY ABSTRACT CARDS TO SEE WHETHER RETURN HAD BEEN FORWARDED PATIENT PREVIOUSL'iJ NEW CASE NEW CASE REPORTED INFORMATI ON I INFORMATI OJ\FOR WHICH ADEQUATE JINADEQUATE ABSTRACT SENT FOR COMCARD NOT PLETION OR FORWARDED LETTER OF ENQUIRY SENT (PICKED UP FROM MS 18) ABSTRACT CARD CORRECTED . ABSTRACT CARD INSERTED IN INDEX AND - IF NECESSAI .. jREGISTRATION NUMBER GIVEN ANNUAL CHECK WITH DEATH CERTIFICATES AND POST MORTEM DETECTED CANCER CASES INSERTED IN REGISTER 1. NEW REGISTRATIONSDEATH DETAILS COMPLETELYPUNCHED INTO PUNCHED,OLD CASE (LIVE AND DEAD).REGISTRATIONS 4, .4- [CARDS ARE HANDLED BY THE PUNCH-CARD MACHINES COMPLETED STATISTICS ARE PRODUCED Fig. 1 - schematic presentation of the Central Pegintry organisation .z7o 2.4 Survival checks and follow-up In all overseas registries a yearly follow-up report is obtained on each case. This is done by forwarding a followup list of names to each contributing hospital with provision for the recording of the latest information. The advantage of this system is that it stimulates periodic medical checkups of the cancer patient, acting as a reminder to call in cancer patients for an annual examination. At the inception of the cancer collection scheme in New Zealand a yearly follow-up system was carried out but this turned out to be the rock on which the scheme nearly came to total destruction. In practice, many hospitals and clinics found themselves unable to cope with the volume of work involved.It was decided then to take advantage of New Zealand's isolation and the smallness of its population and to depend upon a careful check of the death registers along with periodic references to the electoral rolls. No record of death and an entry in the electoral roll can be taken as proof of survival, but in the absence of the roll entry and a death entry there are other possibilities. These, are (1) Patient died under another name or under an alternative. spelling of the furnished name; (2) In the case of a female patient, has married or remarried; (3) Patient has left the country. To check on these possibilities it is necessary to refer a small percentage of the total cases surviving in each site back to the hospital or clinic for confirmation of survival. Another reason for the referring back of cases.is where .the patient is known by the Central Registry to have survived and yet at the time of diagnosis the prognosis was unfavourable. In a high proportion of these cases the diagnosis proves to have been an incorrect one and it is necessary to remove the case from the series. 2.5 Schematic presentation of the Central Registry Organisation In figure 1. is sketched in diagram form the consecutive steps taken at the Central Registry from the time the abstract form is received through to the production of statistical reports. i4f 17 death or as an associated cause of death (in Part II of the International Death Certificate). A copy of this Quarterly List of Cancer Deaths is forwarded to all clinics and will be sent to any Hospital Registry on request. The second step. is at the close of the year when all post-mortem reports received into the National Health Statistics Centre have been examined and those cases detected after death are also added to the register. Clearly-the majority of cases in the register found at the routine matching will be deaths from intercirrent conditions, although, of course, there will also be instances of death from malignant disease where the original cause of death was amended as a result of post-mortem findings coming to hand after the death certificate was filled in; on the other hand, there will be, of course, cases where the death certificate was provisional and recorded malignant disease which was confirmed by the post-mortem findings. Still further, the postmortem results not infrequently alter the primary site of invasion. One very valuable result of the matching of cases on the register with death certificates and post-mortem reports is the establishment of the primary site of the cancr, as there is frequently disagreement as between the various records. Some sites where incompatability between records is encountered are rectum and colon, oesophagus and stomach, cervix and body of conditions of the lymphatic and haematopoietic tissues. The punched cards: 2.3. • Except for the current year, a punched card is in existence for every case registered since the inception of the scheme in 1948. When not in use for statistical analysis, those cards are maintained in registration number order in the groups 'alive,s' and 'deads'. The punched cards are readily available for amendment, for cancellation or for the insertion of additional detail in order to conform with the abstract card in the Index. As soon as •possible after the end of each year (delays result from the non-receipt of outstanding. returns from a few hospitals) death details are punched into all previous registered cases who have died during that year and the information on all new registrations is transferred to punched cards. All registrations are then available for the compilation of statistical reports, special studies and in response to requests. (c) Each patient's card with a diagnosis of cancer, sent in under the routine system operated in New Zealand since 1873 by which returns are supplied by the public hospitals for all inpatients no matter what the disease for which the patient was admitted, is checked with the register to verify whether the cancer abstract card has been forwarded in respect of that patient. (d) All new cases are checked with the names on the Parliamentary Poll for the district in which domiciled as a check on the spelling of the name and the accuracy of the address. (e) All information on the abstract card not already self-coded is then coded, the site by the W.H.O.. Classification of Neoplasms according to the Anatomical Location of the Lesion (an adaptation of the International List) and the pathological nature of the growth by the Manual of Tumour. Nomenclature and Coding, published by the . American Cancer Society. The address of the patient is coded according to Hospital Board District and the individual hospital. making the diagnosis is coded by a devised code. (f) The card is filed away in the alphabetical index of cases constituting the 'live' or action series in the National Cancer Register. A series of dead cases other than those in the current year's series is maintained in a separate filing cabinet. . .. . . 2.2 Matching with death certificate. The matching of all cases on the register with death certificates is undertaken every year. This is a very tedious task, as all alternative spellings of names must be tested. Maori names present a special problem in this respect. The system involves the sorting of the certificates of all deaths totalling close on 23,000 per year into alphabetical order and the matching of these with 50,000 names on the 'live' register. By this means, other details besides name which all assist in the identification of the patient, such as address, age, date and cause of death are visible to the searcher, which would not be so if working from an index of names such as is available at the Registrar-General's office. In practice, the procedure reso] . s itself into two steps. Each quarter in each year the records of deaths are perused and a list made of all cases where cancer is mentioned, either as the direct cause of 17 survival related to early and late diagnosis, and the diagrammatic presentation of cases occurring in the community are only three aspects of the cancer problem which lend themselves to education uses by field workers. Confidentiality: 1.6. The methods and practice of safeguarding the confidential nature of the information about individual patients suffering from cancer at all points in the registration scheme must be kept under constant review. It is a recognised principle that information can be reported by a hospital inrespect of an individual patient to the National Registry without that patient's consent, but all such information must-always be maintained as a matter of confidence between the Department and the reporting hospital. Case registration procedures at the Central Registry: 2, The central registry is a section of the National Health Statistics Centre which is in the Ford Building, Courtenay Place, Wellington. The central registry staff includes a senior clerk and two female assistants. Medical Consultation is provided by physicians with the Department, The National Health Statistics Centre is equipped with I.B.M. machines. Case regisration and indexing: 2.1, (a) The abstract card is received from the clinic or hospital' for each first or new cancer patient who attended at a cancer consultation clinic or who was admitted to the hospital. (b) The abstract card is checked against the alphabetical register of live cases to verify that the case is a new case, and if so, is given a sequence registration number, as well as being stamped with the year of registration. If the case is found to have been already registered by some other hospital, details of any further treatment administered are transferred onto the existing registration card and the record brought up to date. I .5.2 Epidemiologic investigations Registry data can be used to investigate possible relationships between cancer and environment and living habits. Eminent authorities overseas consider that epidemiology is the line we should take in New Zealand because of the advantages we possess in being in close touch with treating hospitals and in not having too wide a range in our social structure. Epidemiologic investigations call for special surveys based on a hypothesis or "hunch". The hypothesis once formulated can be tested by taking a group of cancer patients and questioning them in regard to the likely causative factors. The findings are then compared to the occurrence of the same factors in a group of controls which are matched with the cancer patients in certain chosen respects.A collection of this nature has been in New Zealand in connection with the cancer of the lung, sponsored and carried out by a group of thoracic surgeons. Specific items covered in the collection include-smoking habits, occupational history, pre-existing respiratory disease and presenting symptoms. There is much scope in New Zealand for investigation into the high incidence of cancer in the stomach in Maoris of both sexes, and of course of the lung in Maori women. 1 .5.3 Genetic studies The material of a cancer register may also be helpful in genetic studies on the existence of possible •inherited traits and the occurrence of particular types of cancer. 1,5. 4 Local cancer control The register of cancer patients allows for an examination of the various factors important to those concerned with local cancer control, e.g. the proportion of patients receiving treatment, the stage at which they were diagnosed, the reasons for delay in the diagnosis of cancer, the waiting period before treatment, and the type of treatment given, and where. 1 .5.5 Provision of facts for educational use Cancer registration data when suitably presented have in many instances a great deal more impact than mortality data. The probabilities of developing cancer in various sites, lif 17 and are not usually part of the planned first course of therapy. New Zealand has a collection form for most of the specific sites in each of which the common treatments are set out in terms of the operation or operations performed or the kind and quantity of radiation given, or the other therapeutic agent or agents used. This differs from the procedure adopted in most registries oversease where the treatment categories are generally grouped under four broad headings: surgery, radiation, surgery and radiation and other or none reported. The treatment headings adopted in New Zealand were selected and grouped according to the decisions of a group of New Zealand specialists. Where a patient is not treated except for palliative treatment it is essential that the principal reason for this be noted on the abstract card. Other purposes of cancer case. registration: 1.5. A cancer register offers very much more than its use for comparing the efficacy of different methods of treatment or for measuring trends in incidence. There istoday an awareness that various circumstances combine in many cases which trigger off the process known as cancer. Evidence of this is, of course, the considerable variation in the incidence of many of the common cancers, not only as between the various countries of the world, but also as between different parts'of the same country. An investigation into the possible underlying causes of cancer comes into the field of epidemiology. Clinical and Laboratoty studies: .1.5.1. The register is used as a source of information, enabling studies in depth to be carried out by research workers into certain types of malignancy. All leukaemia cases reported are passed on to a research centre set up under the aegis of the Cancer Society in Christchurch. The specialist centre for cancers of the cervix is in the Postgraduate School of Obstetrics and Gynaecology in Auckland. Each year details of rare types of cancer are supplied to physicians who are making a contribution to the medical literature of their particular interest. dition. To take a realistic view, besides knowing the best results obtainable by surgery and radiotherapy, we also want to know the average prospect for patients living in different regions of the country who are receiving such treatment as is available to them in respect of cancer of each site. Only a small proportion of cancer patients in the whole country can hope to be treated at the best institutions or be operated upon by the surgeons with outstanding experience. Statistics of results of treatment from one hospital or a group of hospitals in any particular area can be misleading. •The selection of the type of treatment given to a prticular patient depends, of course, upon many things: age and general condition of the patient, stage of disease, site of origin, location of the tumour, histological type of tumour, and other complicating conditions. In planning therapy a very important decision which has to be made in many cases is whether to try to cure the patient of his disease or simply to prolong life and relieve symptoms. These two concepts, the concept of cure and the concept of palliation, are exceedingly important in the management of cancer cases. Especially is this so when radiation therapy is introduced, for upon it will depend not only the patient's chance of survival, but also his degree of comfort and disability resulting from treatment. It is important to observe whether treatment is confined to surgery, radiotherapy, hormones, or chemotherapy directed to the destruction, removal or delay in growth of malignant tissue. Treatment under one or combinations of these headings can be divided into whether the intent was for cure and complete eradication of the growth or merely to prolong life and delay the inevitable progress of the disease. Treatment does not include methods, surgical or otherwise, concerned with the relief of symptoms. Treatment refers to the first treatment or series of treatments received by the patient, whether as an inpatient of a hospital or as an outpatient. In general it covers all treatments within four months of the date of the admission for treatment. The reasons for limiting first course of treatment to a specific time period are that (1) cases for whom treatment has been delayed are not comparable to cases treated shortly after diagnosis and (2) additional treatments begun after a greater lapse of time generally represent treatment for a recurrence or an initial treatment failure 17 as "the apparent extent of disease" when the patient is examined clinically and "staging" as the division or classification of cancer cases into groups or categories by degree of apparent extent of disease, according to some agreed plan. What is needed is simply an agreement for each site on the recording of such precise information on the extent of disease as to make possible the combination or re-combination of cases ac'ording to any agreed plan. The objectives of staging cases at time of diagnosis may be defined as (1) Aid the clinician in the planning of treatment (ii) Give some indication of prognosis (iii) Assist in the evaluation of the results of treatment (iv) Facilitate in the exchange or comparison of information between treatment centres or nationally over periods of time - (v) (vi) Provide an evaluation of the effects of detection compaigns designed to diagnose cancer at the earliest possible stage Enable studies to be carried out on the correlation between early diagnosis and the survival rate Data about treatment survival after treatment: 1.+.3. The primary objectives of cancer therapy are to eradicate the disease and to prolong the life of the patient. There is a need in every country for more exact knowledge of the outcome of treatment for cancer than we have at present. A cancer register offers the material for evaluating the relative merits of different types of treatment. Central cancer registries, posting the data from hospitals all over the country, are better situated to make comparisons on treatment than are certain centres or groups of centres. Notwithstanding that large numbers of patients may be involved inevitably each centre will constitute 'a selected sample, and biases will be introduced.. Some cases of cancer never present themselves at particular centres or, if seen, will be sent off for treatment elsewhere; others are not treated for various reasons; amongst those treated the typeof treatment given will at times be influenced by factors quite apart from the malignant con- 26Z A question is asked about the occupation of the patient partly for identification purposes. The occupation is also coded and related to the data supplied by the Department of Statistics showing the numbers of males at risk in each occupatient. The question to be answered here is Q . Are there hazards in respect of the development of cancer in particular occupations? 1.4.2 Data about the extent of the disease (Clinical Stage Classification) The extent of the disease at time of first diagnosis must be classified in some way before it can be used for statistical purposes - that is to say, before it can be grouped .with data from other cases so that conclusions about categories of patients may be drawn in contradistinction to conclusions'about individual patients. There are now internationally accepted criteria established for classifying the extent of disease for a number of particular sites put forward by the International Union Against Cancer. The International Union has, through its Committee on Clinical Stage Classification and Applied Statistics, produced draft recommendations in regard to the breast,, the pharynx and larynx and the urinary bladder and is considering a further group of sites.These are thyroid, bronchus,. oesophagus, stomach, colon, rectum and corpus uteri. New Zealand has been quick to adopt internationally accepted staging systems and we are using these in classifying breast, cervix, body of uterus and larynx. In all the other sites the criteria has been established by specialists in the particular anatomical area of .the body. In no other area of cancer registration is there so much difference of opinion as there is concerning the classification of malignant neoplasms. This is because data about the extent of the disease at the time of diagnosis are a static concept and present a snap-shot picture of a chronologically continuing process. The malignant condition is a dynamic phenomenon proceeding with varying speed at different times in different individuals. This is well recognised from a clinical point of view, and is only dwelt on here for its significance from the statistical angle. The unpredictability of certain forms of cancer is evidenced to anyone dealing with large numbers of cases of cancer of the breast in that cases with apparently good prognosis die of cancer quite soon after operation and others whose chances appear poor survive for many years. These qualifications are best expressed if the word "stage" be defined 21,01 Once private hospital cases were included the coverage would be almost complete as it is assumed that almost every case of cancer (skin cancers other than melanomas are not collated) would sooner or later be admitted to a hospital for treatment. Those cases not treated or which were discovered at postmortem would be picked up from the official death certificate. The uses made of registry data: 1.4. Data about the incidence and prevalence of cancer: Data in the cancer registry are used to show the incidence (i.e. number of fresh 'cases a year) and the prevalence (i.e. total number of cases present in the population at a particular time) of cancer of different sites according to the age, sex, domicile and race of the patient. Figures on incidence and prevalence are needed to show the public health authorities and the Cancer Society the cancer problems of the population of New Zealand. When the data can be given separately for various sub-groups of the population, such as occupational groups, or for different geographical areas of a country, they will help ensure a national distribution and utilisation of diagnostic and treatment facilities and personnel. They will also indicate high-risk groups in the population for which preventive measures or special case-finding programmes, such as mass screening, may be required. Again, the study of incidence data, their time trends, and their variation between different population groups, may often serve as the starting point for research into the aetiology of cancer. Incidence data can only supply an accurate assessment of the position if it has complete coverage. Provided an accurate count can be made, the following questions are able to be answered Q . How many cases of cancer of each site occur at particular ages and in each sex in this country? Q . Are there differences in the occurrence of cancer in certain sites as between districts, which would suggest that environmental factors could be responsible? Q . Are there any marked differences in the occurrence of cancer in our Maori and European populations? 260 and as more and more people are getting cured of cancer or are surviving for longer periods of time then death figures become of less and less value for incidence assessment purposes. For comparisons of trends over a period of time or for international comparison purposes something better than death statistics is needed. Just as an example, three reasons would present themselves for an explanation of a fall in the death rate from a particular form of cancer: (a) an improvement in therapy, (b) an increased proportion of earlier or curable cases presenting for treatment and (c) a decrease in incidence (number of new cases coming forward). 1.3 The New Zealand case registration scheme There exist here in New Zealand ideal conditions for the establishment of a Cancer Registry on a national basis at very low cost. The foundations for a central registration scheme have long existed in the shape of the public hospital inpatient return furnished routinely to the Nalional Health Statistics Centre (MS18 statistical card). Still further there are in each of our large regional hospitals cancer consultation clinics established and controlled by the particular local division of the Cancer Society of New Zealand. In addition our population is small, making for a handy-sized registry, while our geographical isolation makes for stability in that a high proportion of cases remain in the country under supervision and very few are lost to follow-up because of crossing with adjacent countries or states.Finally, we have a strong and active Cancer Society which is vitally concerned with the production of comprehensive statistics. 1 ,3. 1 Public Hospital and Private Hospital cases As has already been said, the registration of public hospital cancer cases is obligatory. The registration of cases seen at outpatient Consultation Clinics is carried out by arrangement with the Cancer Society. These two sources provide an overall coverage of about four-fifths of all cancer in this country (it varies as between sites). Added to this, a number of privately treated cases are reported voluntarily by interested surgeons. With the backing of the Cancer Society of New Zealand preliminary steps are being taken to devise legislation so that surgeons would not be committing a breach of confidentiality in supplying details of their patients treated in all private hospitals. rq 17 exposed to the cancer risk. Indeed, in most important sites the death rates are on the decline; in some other sites the rates are fractionally higher, but whether this is a reflection of a decline or increase in true incidence or a reflection of improved methods of therapy is not able to be stated with certainty in the absence of reliable and complete case reporting. It is true for certain that the incidence is rising in cancers of the lung and bronchus, while on the other hand stomach cancer incidence and uterine cancer incidence is clearly on the decline.There is a tendency also for types of cancer in the leukaemia and lymphosarcoma groups to increase at the older ages. In summary, although the absOlute numbers of deaths from cancer will continue to: increase because of the increasing proportion of old persons in the populatiori,we may reasonably anticipate a substantial reduction in the death rate from cancer in the next decade. The reasons for this expectatioi are lowered incidence, more effective treatment, recognition of pre-invasive cancers and development in virology. We must be in a position to measure these changes.. The organs and tissues of the body which are : affected by cancer in the first twenty years of life differ strikingly from those most susceptible during the later years of life,: These differences and others indicate that we.are not correct in considering cancer as one disease. The many forms that tancer takes is itself an indication that the disease is:one of multiple aetiology. Why we need case registration: 1.2. The World Health Organisation hasset up a Sub-Committee on Cancer Statistics comprising a number of the world's experts on this speciality. This committee has stressed the need for the establishment along uniform lines of national cancer registers in all countries, in order that comparison may possible between the cancer experience in various parts of the world. At the present time there exist cancer registries in all the advanced countries but very few: indeed are population based, i.e. cover all cases occurring in the whole country or in a. defined area of that country, •.One of the important reasons for case registration in cancer is the limitations of death statistics. If everyone who was affected by cancer died from the malignancy then and only then would death figures tell us the true incidence of these forms of disease, • Fortunately this is far from being the position, 4 •5. 1+ Staging 4.506 Histologic type of cancer 1+.5.7 Corrections and additions 5. Methods of tabulating data at the hospital registry 5.1 Planning a study 5.2 Methods of collecting and tabulating data 5.3 Calculation of survival rates at the Hospital Registry 6. References FIGURES Figure 1- Schematic presentation of the Central Registry Organisation(2.5) Figure 2A - Suggested Hospital Registry Abstract Form - Front (3.3.1) Figure 2B - Suggested Hospital Registry Abstract Form - Back. (3.3.1) Figure 3- Sample Follow-up Letter to Private doctor (3.3.2) Figure Lf- Sample Follow-up Letter to patient (3.3.2) Figure 5- Sample Follow-up Letter to relative or friend (3,3.2) Figure 6- Suggested Site Index Register (3.3.3) 1. The background to cancer case registration 1.1 The basic facts about cancer Malignant disease accounted for 3,657 out of 22,861 deaths in New Zealand in 1964, one sixth of the total mortality. At old ages cancer is quite expectedly the second leading cause of death to heart disease, but it is rather surprising to find malignant conditions to be the leading disease cause of death (accidents rank in first place) among children at pre-school and school ages (1 to ik years). In 1962 a total of 9,860 inpatients were treated in our public hospitals (4,896 males and 4,964 females); the aggregate days stay of these hospitalised cancer patients was 229,352 days. While the number of cancer cases diagnosed and the numbers of persons dying from cancer are increasing in absolute numbers, they are not doing so out of proportion to the population 2S7 17 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand CANCER CASE REGISTRATION AND CANCER STATISTICS 1. The background to cancer case registration 1.1 The basic facts about cancer 1.2 Why we need case registration 1.3 The New Zealand case registration scheme 1 .3.1 Public hospital and private hospital cases 1.4 The uses made of registration data 1.4.1 Data about the incidence and prevalence of cancer 1.k.2 Data about the extent of the disease (clinical stage classification) 1.4.3 Data about treatment and survival after treatment 1.5 Other purposes of cancer case registration 1 .5.1 Clinical and laboratory studies 1.5.2 Epidemiological investigations 1.5.3 Genetic studies 1 .5, 4 Local cancer control 1 .5.5 Provision of facts for educational use 1.6 Confidentiality 2. Case registration procedures at the Central Registry 2.1 Case registration and indexing 2.2 Matching with death certificates 2.3 The punched cards 2.4 Survival checks and follow-up 2.5 Schematic presentation of the Central Registry organisation 3. The operation of the Hospital Cancer Registry 3.1 The control of the Hospital Registry 3.2 The functions of the Hospital Registry 33 Filing and indexing 3.3.1 The Hospital Registry Abstract Form File 3.3. 2 The follow-up reminder index 3.3.3 The site index register +. Directions for abstracting 4.1 The Hospital Statistics Handbook +.2 Cases to be abstracted 4.3 When to abstract Lfk Where to send MS38 abstracts +.5 Notes on abstracting and on abstract items 4.5.1 Identifying information 4.5.2 Death information 4.5.3 Treatment Welch (J.D.) Appointment systems in hospital outpatient departments. (Abstract of pubin.) Hospital Abstracts, Sept. 1963 9 pp 514-5 9.2 Background 'A visit to outpatients' Hospital & Health Management, Nov. 1962, p 1023 Ball (A.M.) The general hospital outpatient department Jnl. AAMRL, April 1959 'Clinic accommodation': Abstracts of Efficiency Studies in the Hospital Service, No. 17 H.M.S.O., 1961, 2 pp pp 55-7 9 79 Takahashi (N.) Storage and Hospital Abstracts, July 1962, filing of outpatientpp 423-4 medical records. (Translated from Japanese: abstract) z' c4 16 'Maternity department: appointment system for clinics': Abstracts of Efficiency Studies in the Hospital Service, No. '+k H.M.S.O. 1962, 2 pp; Hospital Abstracts, May 1963s Morgan (J.H.) Medical Records Departments: the Cardiff Royal Infirmary Medical Record, April 1951, 'Outpatients Appointment Systems' (at 3 hospitals) Medical Record, May 1955, pp 90-5 pp 439-4 3, 460 Piddiford (George H.) New Zealand Hospital, May, Masterton Hospital Survey .1966, pp 5-19 of patients waiting time in outpatients and casualty departments Rossiter (W.J.c.) Registration and reception of outpatients The Hospital, June 1959, Ryan (J.A.) Seven guides to better emergency department records Hospitals, March 16, 19639 Schankula (H.J.) Identification cards for outpatients Canadian Hospital Sept. 1962, p 56.; Hospital Abstracts, Jan. 1963,.P 51 Hospital Administration, Nov. 1960,;pp 22 9 25; Hospital Abstracts, April Spence (A,R..w.) The duties of the outpatient clerk call for many qualifications pp '+79-83 pp 66, 68-9,71; Hospital Abstracts, Sept. 1963 9 p 537 1961, p 272. Stone (J.E.) Hospital organ- London, • Faber, 1951,. isation and management, xxii +1722 pp 198-245 9 805-6, 15k2-9 Turnpenny (.w.) Calcu-Medical Records Aug. 1960, lation table for follow-.pp 312-3 up appointments Villegas (E.L..) OutpatientHospitals, April, 16, 1967, appointment system savespp 52-71 120 time for patients and doctors Walker (P.M.) Outpatient waiting time or 'Why are they waiting?' Medical Record, Feb. 1965, Weilerstein (J.,) Outpatient record development Medical Record News, April pp 67-71 1962 9 pp 55-7 9 87 Brockis , (R.J.) Pre-Registration - is it worth it? (Pre-Registration for O.P. clinics) Medical Record, Feb. 1955, Camille (Sister Mary) Emergency room records Medical Record News, Oct. 1962, Carr (Mary Beth) & Finnigan (Pita). Controlling outpatients and emergency loan records (in 'What to YOU do?') Medical Record News, Feb. 1965, Eastham (G.) Out-patient Waiting Time Medical Record, Feb. 1962, Fraser (N.A.) Consultant's view of medical records Medical Record News, Nov 1963, Gibbins (c.H.) & Cashmore (V.F.) Control of appointments and records Medical Record, May 1957, pp 1+02-5 pp 9 9 11-12 pp 1+87-97 pp 583-8 pp 201-6 'Guide to the organisationU.S.A., Chicago, Ill., of a Hospital MedicalAmerican Hospital Assn., Record Department' pp 1921+ 1962, vii + 83 Hill(P,A.) Public relations Hospital & S ocial Service in the out-patient depart-Journal, No, 3, 1961, ment pp 1277-8; Hospital Abstracts, Feb. 1962, p123 Hinds (n.J.) Appointment survey pinpoints causes of clinical delays Hospital Topics, Dec. 1962, pp 1+2-5; Hospital Abstracts, June 19 6 3, p 331. MacEachern (M.T. )Medical Records in the Hospital, pp 173-87 U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., (Marshall, Wright, Booker, Bald & Fieber) O.P. diagnosis & operations indicies (in 'What do YOU do?') Physicians' Record Co., 1937, xvi + 371+ illus. Jnl AAMRL, Dec. 1961, pp 282-/+ 'Maternity department:H.M.S.0., 1962, 3 pp; appointments system for Hospital Abstracts, Aug. 1962, clinics': Abstracts of p 519 Efficiency Studies in the Hospital Service, No.29 16 While it is true that our hospitals do attempt to have an organised appointments system, there is always room for improvement so it is advisable 4 in the interests of the patient, to conduct a periodical survey no matter how time consuming this may be. The Medical Records Officer, however hard pressed, should treat: this as a matter of priority and when the facts are before him face up to them,particularly when it is found that part of the cause for delays is due to inadequacies within his own department. References: Waiting in Outpatient departments. Nuffield Hospital. Trust, 1965 Manning (D.P.) & Pugh (w.v.N.) A casualty appointment system. Lancet,-14 March 1964, 601-03 Tatham (c.) Experience with an appointment system in a Casualty Department. Lancet, 28 May 1966, 1201-03 Further reading: 9. Basic:9.1. Anspach (M.) The hospitalMedical Record, May 1953, service in Belgium with pp 154-61 special reference to the .. administration of a Records Department 'Appointments system for H.M.S.O., 1962, k pp (Maternity) Clinics': Abstracts of Efficiency Studies in the Hospital Service No. kk 2fZ Betts (B.H.) Waiting in Outpatient Departments Hospital & Health Management, Sept. 19571 pp 322-4 Bott,(T.H.) New systems, new equipment speed clinic appointments Hospitals, Feb. 1, 1962, pp 47-8; Hospital Abstracts, June 1962, pp 352-3 Brockis (n.J.) Casualty records Medical Record, July 19519 pp 189-90 , 205 The form is arranged primarily for ease of completion and extraction of the necessary information from which tables can be complied to give the required information, i.e. Table 1.1 Total time in minutes spent at hospital 1.2 Minutes between reporting time and start of consultation 1.3 Duration of consultation time in minutes Table 2.1 Total time in minutes spent in Accident & Emergency Department 22 Minutes between arrival and start of examination 2.3 Duration of examination Table 3.1 Time in minutes spent in dressing clinic Table 3.2 Minutes between reporting time and start of treatment in dressing clinic 3.3 Duration of treatment in minutes in dressing clinic 3.4 Minutes between appointment time and start, of treatment in dressing clinic Lf Diagnosis of patients treated in Accident & Emergency Department Table 5.1 Transport of patient to hospital by domicile 5.2 Domicile by category of patient These tables give a break down for each clinic for each day that the survey is conducted. This then allows one to see if an atypical distribution occurred on any one day which affected the overall pattern of that clinic. Transport to hospital and domicile by category of patient is necessary in order to determine whether the arrival time differed to any' great extent from the appointment time as these are factors which must be taken into consideration when making appointment times so as to reduce overall waiting time. As all medical records and appointments lists are prepared in advance for clinics, particulars on the form, numbers I - 10 and 12 - 16 can be filled in at the same time thus being in readiness for when the patient reports, and as a time saver during the actual survey. 16 - HOSPITAL WAITING TIME SURVEY Note: In multiple choice answers please encircle the figure in front of the category which applies Name: 1Address:___________________________ 2 - 5Serial No.: 6-7Age: 8Sex:1 Male2 Female 9-10 Date: /1 11 Transport to hospital:I Ambulanôe i--I • -U 1 2 Public transport 3 Other (includes taxi) FOR OUTPATIENTS 12 Clinic: 13 Was this consultation booked? 1 Yes 2. No 14 -. 16 Time of appointment: 17 - 19 Time of arrival at patient reception: • 2021 Time consultation began: • 22 - 24 Time consultation ended: FOR ACCIDENT & EMERGENCY PATIENTS 25 Was patient referred? 1 Yes 2 No 3 Don't know_________ 26 - 28 Time arrived at A. & E. Dept.: 29 - 31 Time examination began: 32 - 34 Time patient left A—& E. Dept.: 35 Was patient admitted? 1 Yes2 No 36 - 38 Nature and site of injury: 2 rd I (i) Patient Participation In this case patients are given a form which they are requested to take with them and present it to the various staff, who will insert the appropriate details. (ii)Direct Observation The movement of each patient is recorded by staff stationed at vantage points in the department and the form completed as above. Method For outpatients clinics - direct observation is the more practicable0 During the clinic session a clerk should be stationed in the outpatients reception area where all patients should beinstructed to report to on their arrival, and again on their departure, each patient being given a form on which the necessary data required is recorded. If there is more than one clinic. session being held at the same time then a clerk should 'be. stationed near each clinic. For Accident & Emergency department pattents,:and outpatient dressing room attendance 's, this information can be recorded by the nursing staff on duty. Information Form It is necessary to design a form to record the information. The following would meet the requirements of most hospitals:. 2q 16 Staff coverage: 6. Outpatient department clerical staff coverage is normally between 8.30 a.m. and 4 .3 0 or 5 p.m. though if clinics are held outside these hours it is desirable that clerical staff should be on duty. Similarly, clerical staff should cover the Accident & Emergency department for as much of the 24 hours as possible. The determining factor will probably be size of the departments concerned so consideration should be given in planning new hospitals to making the departments inter-related with the Admitting department so that one person can cover both Admitting and A. & E. reception during the evening or night hours. When nursing staff do the clerical work in the absence of clerical staff procedures must be simple and capable of easy checking by clerical staff when they come on duty. Clerical staff qualifications: 6.1. It will be obvious that, particularly in the Accident & Emergency departments, personal qualities required in the clerical staff are important and can be summed up as: (a) Calmness and efficiency in dealing with patients and emergency situations. (b) Tact in dealing with relatives and friends. (c) Ability to understand and carry out instructions quickly. Condudting a waiting time survey: 7. The conducting of a successful survey, can only be achieved by tackling the problem as a team. In this case such a team would normally consist of medical, nursing, medical auxiliary, portering and clerical staff, but the size of the team would naturally depend upon the size of the institution. A survey can be done, either by patient participation or by direction observation: 24 doctor when filling in the •record whereas a car accident with ? concussion and extensive abrasions face and arms would be permanent. Temporary records could be kept. in the A. & E. department for 7 years to comply with the Statute of Limitations whereas permanent ones would be filed in the Medical Records department once their. visits in connection with the first attendance had finished. In each case an index card would need tobe kept indicating into which category the patient came should he return to the hospital. Other systems will suggest themselves. The important thing is that they must be in the best interests of patients whilst being practical to operate in the hospital. k.Numbering The method of numbering records will depend on whether they are centralised or decentralised. If centralised it is obviously desirable that one number only should be used for each patient otherwise the confusion of trying to trace a patient through a succession of numbers would undo much of the advantage of having a central record. If the records are decentralised then each clinic or department will probably run its own series of numbers which will be meaningless and will tend to confuse through duplicating othet' departments' numbers if used outside the department. If, for reasons of local hospital politics, decentralisation is insisted on blocks of numbers or prefixes which could distinguish departments or clinics should be advocated. 5.Time of arrival It is particularly important that' this be recorded accurately in the Accident & Emergency department. The majority of complaints about the A. & E. department concern the amount of time that a patient was kept waiting before seeing a doctor. It is therefore preferable to have a time clock for recording time of arrival of the patient since this disposes of any arguments concerning the accuracy of the clerk's recording of time of arrival. 16 therefore present no more difficulty for the Medical Records department in providing the record than a booked readmission or. an outpatient clinic attendance. At the other extreme a card is made out for the A. & E. patient on first attendance and kept in the department until the visits in connection with that attendance have finished when it is filed numerically or alphabetically serially or by year of attendance. For all practical purposes it can only be found again if the patient remembers when he attended previously. Few, if any, hospitals in New Zealand haie•madé a survey to establish the relationship between A. & E. patients and those attending other departments of the hospital as outpatients or inpatients. Are the majority of A. & E. patients'oncers' Or are asubstantial proportion part of the 'hospital population', visiting this department or that fairly regularly? If the latter is the case then visits to Accident & Emergency are obviously as important as other outpatient attendances in the overall helth picture of the patient and should be so regarded. If, however, most A. & E. patients only attend the hospital for genuine accidents or emergencies and are otherwise looked after by their own doctors and do not therefore usually come near the hospital is one justified is going to much trouble over the records for only a minority?. A large number of patients come to the Accident & Emergency department and the sheer physical job of filing and pulling a medical record for each on each visit would call for extra staff and extra filing space in Medical Records with doubtful benefits to patient or hospital. On the other hand virtually 'writing-off' a patient because be cannot remember when he last attended could have serious consequences. Some hospitals overseas maintain that surveys have shown that 35% and more of patients attending the Accident & Emergency department of the hospital are referred to other services, either as inpatients or outpatients and that this justifies treating A. & E. records as normal outpatient ones. Until a local survey has been done it seems. that a compromise is called for. Depending on the seriousness of the accident or. emergency the. record:could be regarded as permanent or temporary. For instance, a schoolboy referred for abrasions (L) knee and contusion (L) upper arm would be marked 'temporary' by the examining lqb 3.Records - decentralised or centralised? If records are decentralised this means that each clinic or department maintains its own records and there will not, generally speaking, be any reference on inpatient notes to indicate that the patient has been attending an outpatient clinic. On the other hand centralised records are those maintained in the Medical Records department for all attendances of the patient at the hospital whether as inpatient or outpatient. 31 Outpatients There can be no argument on which is preferable for general management of the patient as a whole person. The central record, showing outpatient as well as inpatient, treatment gives a complete health picture. The policy should therefore be to register a patient on his first attendance at the hospital, whether as an outpatient or inpatient, and to raise a medical record for him then. This record should be in the same format as that for . inpatient notes so that a chronological history of the patient can be made and easily referred to. The objection to this policy put forward by those against it is that it is inconvenient - if the records are kept in the clinic or department they are immediately available to answer questions by referring doctors or. for research whereas having to ask the Medical Records department for the record means delay. There is validity in this argument only if the patient is looked on as 'a case' belonging to that particular clinic or department, but all the information including possible drug reactions, obtained by that clinic is wasted if it is not immediately available should that patient be treated elsewhere in the hospital. 3.2 Accident & Emergency patients In principle the same argument applies but practical considerations may force a compromise. Ideally, an accident & emergency patient should receive a number as for a normal hospital admission on his first visit, the record of treatment should be in the same format as the inpatient notes, immediately following treatment the notes should go to Medical Records and begot out from Medical Records for each successive follow-up visit which should be by appointment and 16 Referrals to other departments: 2.4. Most referrals will be to the X-ray department. Some hospitals have a mobile x-ray machine in the A. & E. department. As with outpatients it is important to see that patients are brought or sent back from another department and that they are attended to when they return to the A. & E. department. ' Further treatment: 2,. This should normally be carried out by the patient's , own doctor, the job of the Accident & Emergency department being to cope with the initial accident or emergency and to complete treatment following from the first visit. There may, however, be further treatment required, such as physiotherapy, which would be arranged by the hospital who would not the patient's own doctor by letter from the medical officer in the A. & E. department, Follow-up appointments: 2.6. Opposition to an appointment system for follow-up appoint-, ments in an Accident & Emergency department dies hard. Experience has shown, however, that an appointment system can work and helps to spread the 'peaks and valleys' if devised having regard to local factors such as the experience of when the department is normally most crowded, convenience for patients as far as transport and working hours are concerned,other staff commitments, how long patients are kept waiting at different times of the day etc.Before an appointment system is introduced a survey must be done to establish the above factOrs. This is 'something which clerical staff can do on their own initiative as part of the reception process. With the facts of what actually happens in the department (as opposed to what people think happens) medical and nursing staff should be more ready to try an appointment system for follow-up cases which will make their work easier. However, the very nature of the department means that there are liable to be interruptions and doctors are likely to be called away to emergencies, it is essential that clerical' staff be 'aware of what is going on and explain to patients with bookings who are delayed the cause of the delay. 1Wi clerical staff is normally responsible for obtaining this information. The record should show': (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi) Name and address, sex, age and occupation, What patient is complaining of, e.g. 'lacerations face and CE forearm'. The time the patient arrived The time the patient was seen by a doctor and by whom The patient's own doctor If an accident at work, the employer's name and address Allythe above would normally be filled in by clericalstaff. (vii) (viii) Details of the accident, including location. (This is normally filled in by medical staff as part of the medical examination of the patient. As, however, this information is needed for coding should the patient be admitted there is much to be said for including headings which will ensure that the information required is given). Diagnosis, notes of first and any subsequent treatment, x-ray and other reports. The clerical staff are, as with Outpatients, responsible for recording figures of attendances at the department. It is important that accidents at work are not overlooked. It is good practice to put 'accident at work' with a rubber stamp in a space provided for this on the form. This will help ensure that the information is transcribed for revenue purposes. 2.3 Notifying relations The clerk taking particulars from a patient following an accideht should find out if the patient wishes anyone to be notified that they are at the hospital. If the patient is admitted and/or transferred to another hospital the next of kin should be notified. 2i3 16 Referral sources: 2.1. (i) Accidents. Traffic or domestic accidents or accidents at work coming straight to the A. & E. department. Accidents at work are covered under the Compensation Act which is explained in chapter 15 ('Workers' Compensation'). Most domestic accidents are covered by Social Security unless it is an obvious case of assault when the proàedure below applies. Where it can be shown' that another person is to blame for an accident* - and this applies mostly to traffic accidents - the onus is on the injured person to recover hospital costs from the person injuring him. If the injured person declines to do this he must be warned that his hospital costs are not covered by Social Security' and that he can be. held'responsible for paying them. In practice, these costs are usually met by insurance in traffic cases. The point to note, however, is that the patient no longer 'has the option, where blame for an accident, can be established,. the costs being met on Social Security by default and the responsibility is on clerical staff to explain this.' (ii) General practitioners, Usually for domestic accidents. (iii) Hospital emergency admissions. In some hospitals all emergency admissions are admitted through'the Accident" & Emergency department before being sent to a Ward. This ensures that the patient is examined by a doctor immediately on arrival in the hospital. (iv) Other organisations. Schools, sports clubs, other institutions bring accident cases to the A. & E. department. Records: 2.2. The Accident & Emergency department record must give sociological as well as medical information. By its very nature it is apt to be badly filled in but, conversely, because of the likelihood of legal. and insurance claims it is all the more important that it should be completed accurately. Furthermore, where there is an admission as a result of an accident the details of the accident will be required for the MS,18 statistical card. The and he is handed a numbered disc. The board for these discs is kept on the table of the Sister in charge of the Clinic. Appointment cards are handed to the Sister, who calls the patients into the Clinic from these cards. When the patient answers his numbered disc is taken from him and placed on the board on the Sister's table so she can then easily see if any numbers are missing and find out the reason. If a patient has been referred to another department from which a report is required for the patient's next visit the clerical staff, when doing the pre-clinic check of records, must ensure that the report is available. 1.6 Further treatment The patient is told by the clinician what the arrangements for further treatment are; if an appointment with another department of the hospital is required the outpatient clerk should either arrange this or explain to the patient where togo to make the appointment. 1.7 Doctors' reports and letters During or following each clinic the clinicians either dictate entries for the patient's records or write them in long-hand. They also dictate a letter to the patient's doctor stating what they recommend for the patient. Alternatively, a form letter can be completed in long-hand, stating the essential facts: patient; when seen; diagnosis; disposal; any further remarks •and whether a fuller letter is to follow. In each case a copy of the letter should be filed as part of the patient's record. 2.Accident & Emergency department The name of the Casualty department was changed to "Accident & Emergency" to stress its function: to care initially for accidents and genuine emergencies, because patients had got into the way of regarding 'Cas.' as a free version of the doctor's surgery, which moreover, was open 24 hours a day. Although most Hospital Boards have a rule requiring that all people presenting themselves at an Accident & Emergency department must be seen by a doctor clerical staff should bear in mind the function of the department and try to impress this on those who are trying to use it frivolously. ziti 16 Hospital Clinic: Mr/Mrs/Miss Hosp. no.: To return in time For admission. Priority:____________________ Medical Officer Where the bottom line is filled in the slip should not be given to the patient to take to the office since it is liable to give rise to unprofitable discussions on the interpretation of priority. As explained in chapter 18 it is important that the outpatient clerk turn up the date required immediately if, say, another appointment is tobe booked in 6 weeks time. If a system incorporating pockets (1.2.1 (iii) and (iv) ) is used there is no difficulty as it is easy to count pockets. If, however, a book is used in addition to the methods mentioned in chapter 18 a simple method for use with a loose leaf system is to have pieces of card long enough to have 2 punch holes for holding in the fixture and also to protrude above the booking sheets marked "1 week", 11 2 weeks", "1 month", "3 months" etc. putting them in the relevant position in the book and moving them up one each morning. Referrals to other departments: 1.5. Where patients are sent to another department, e.g. x-ray or laboratory, it is the responsibility of the clerical staff to see that they are not 'lost sight of' and that they are seen again when they return although, here again, the remarks made above regarding co-operation between nursing and clerical staff apply.In some . hospitals with large clinics hostesses are employed to take patients to other departments and to maintain liaison with them. A method which is used at one large hospital to overcome patients 'getting lost' or being overlooked: when the patient reports to the Clinic, his appointment card is taken from him Igo relieving professional staff of work of a non-medical nature. Obviously, as with many other procedures described in this manual, this is a dual effort of co-operation between clerical and medical or, in this case, nursing staff. Clerical staff are also responsible for producing statistics regarding clinic attendances required by Administration. Where mechanical patient documentation is in use for outpatients it is assumed that labels only will be printed to allow the clinic to use them on successive visits and for different purposes, e.g. heading-up forms, laboratory or x-ray requests etc. Depending on the size of . ,the clinic, the accessibility of the hospital or whether a phone call is a toll the procedure, for obtaining the information required for the label will needto be varied. There should be astandard form the lay-out of which corresponds to the label and which can be sent to the patient's octor or used internally. If the clinic booking is some time ahead a booking can be made and the doctor or his nurse can be asked to fill in the O.P. booking form which would previously have been supplied in pads; the form needs to be designed so that it incorporates business reply post (payable by the hospital). If there is insufficient time the information required can be taken by the booking clerk on the phone on a form for internal use with the same lay-out. If neither of these methods is possible or practical then the patient would be asked to attend j hour before the clinic appointment for documentation. It is stressed, however, that this is a poor solution from two points of view: it keeps a patient waiting; it makes bad use of the machinery inIthat it requires that what should be done at a slack period as routine has to be treated as an emergency and, consequently, a genuine emergency might be delayed. Following the clinic visit it is the responsibility of the clerical staff to book the patient for a further visit if this has been requested by the medical staff or to put him on the waiting list for admission. A simple form (which can be duplicated) is used between the clinician and the outpatient clerk along the following lines;... 234 16 3rd Notice: Health Dept. Copy eeoeoee.eo•eo....e,. Mail to M.O.H., Blanktown, Don't use Window Envelope As the previous appointment was not kept, a re-appointment for Chest Clinic for the above has been made for between to 3 p.m. on Friday, the .....,,i96..... (pink copy) No more reminders will be sent to this patient Records: 1.3. The requirement of an outpatient record is that it should clearly record progress where there are several visits. Whether this should be done by keeping.separate records in the clinic or integrating them with inpatient records is discussed in para. 3 below. Where mechanical documentation is in use it will be necessary to decide whether this is to be used for outpatients and, if so, to what extent and the procedure to be followed. This is covered in the following paragraph. Clinic attendance: 1.4. The responsibility of the clerical staff is to receive the patient on arrival for a clinic and to check identity. It should also be the responsibility of the clerical staff to ensure that patients are seen as near their appointment time as possible as it is usually the clerical staff who bear the brunt of the complaints if clinics are running late or patients are taken out of turn. In many hospitals this is the responsibility of the Sister-in-Charge. Whilst medical or nursing staff must always be able to make changes for clinical reasons the clerical staff should keep control of the situation, informing patients of delays and the reasons for them (emergencies etc.), seeing that the appointments system is not abused by patients being seen in order of arrival rather than by time of appointment and otherwise 20 . . •....I I • •I•••S. - I 2nd Notice REMINDER: Your Chest Clinic appointment is for 2 to 3 p.m. on Friday, the......,196..... It is in your interests to keep this appointment becaus (old gold copy) The report on your x-ray film was: If the patient still fails to attend the Public Nurse Health has statutory power, in the case of a TB patient, to compel attendance. The patient is rebooked using the following forms; by agreement with the local Medical Officer of Health the onus can be placed on the Public Health Nurse to ensure attendance as soon as she receives the pink copy: BLANK HOSPITAL.BOARD Blank Hospital, Hospital Pd. Blanktown ....../..../6..... 3rd Notice As you did not appointment has BLANK HOSPITAL, 2to 3 keep your last appointment, another been made for you at the CHEST CLINIC, between p . m. on Friday, the 0 ........ ,i96..... DON'TBREAKTHISDATES(yellow copy) Z7 16 at one writing by varying the copy on the forms, ensuring that the part regarding time and date registers through the different forms, having them either on different coloured stock or printed in different coloured inks; the second notice is sent out about a week before the clinic: HOSPITAL Blank Hospital, Hospital Rd. Biankto.wr / - list Notice An appointment has been made for you to attend the CHEST CLINIC, BLANK HOSPITAL,.between 2 to 3 p m. on Friday the ...... , 1960 If you want to change this booking, please ring Outpatient Office NOW ('phone 123k5 or 56789) The report on your x-ray Sputum tests: • • OS 00 eiee S S SO • S 0 10 • • • S •S • SO IS • • e copy)-: (white Advice:, . . . . . ...... . . • . . . . . . . . • . .(whit ............ •0•OSS S S • SO 0SS•S•CS IOIOSQS000SSI 0•0 0I0000I•S9000 S•••ISIS••SS•S05505•05S 5 0 I 5055•IS•SS•S - Sister-in-Charge, Outpatient. Clinics (perforation)-----____ list Notice: Health Dept. Copy Mail to M.O.H. -B-ia•nktown. Don't use Window Envelope Thest Clinic appointment has been made for he above for 2 to 3 p.m. on Friday, the .........,i96.... T.B. Cases only. Non-TB., destroy this copy. The following is report on this case given to patient: (green copy) X — Ray. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0 • • • • • . . . . . . . . . . . . -. . . . . Sputum tests: .•••••• S. •OI555SSS• SO •ISIS There should be a limit set to the number of new patients seen and the number of follow-ups for each clinic and this limit should only be exceeded with the agreement of the consultant. It is important that the outpatient booking clerk insist on this to avoid the odium of booking patients into an over-full clinic unnecessarily. Where the transition is made from a 'first come, first served' clinic to one with proper appointment times patients who come early expecting to be taken 'in turn' must not be seen ahead of someone who has come later but in time for a booked appointment. A copy of the clinic list will be required by the Medical Records department for getting out records beforehand. Where patients ask for an 'urgent' appointment the patient's doctor must either endorse the note 'urgent' or this must be said by him or his nurse when making the appointment and no such appointment should be given until either the doctor's note or his phone call has been referred to the Consultant's registrar or other appropriate medical.officer. 1.2.2 For the patient The essential is that the patient knows where to go and when. Where a patient is returning regularly to a clinic it is usually better to have a card with his name and hospital number. The instructions regarding the clinic are printed and space is left for appointments to be entered following each clinic visit. The card itself should be about 3" x 2-i-" folded or single - not too large to fit into a pocket or wallet comfortably, not too small to get missed in a handbag. For clinics where the visits are usually single ones or at long intervals it is preferable to give the patient a form, a carbon of which can be sent to the Medical Records department with the clinic list for records. The form needs to be laid out so that it not only tells the patient when to come and where but also gives sufficient information about the patient for the Medical Records department to use the carbon copy to identify the patient if he has been to hospital before or to prepare new papers for him if he is a new patient. (See also chapter 18, 'Follow-up methods') In some cases, such as TB clinics, it is usual for the hospital to work closely with the Public Health Nurse to ensure that patients come to hospital when they are supposed to and it is usually good practice to send reminders of appointments since those concerned tend to be casual about dates. This can be done 16 will tend to make the carbon copies very dirty); NCR paper could be used, depending on the supply position, although similarly the .•lower copies will tend to get marked. (iv) Separate 8 x 5 sheets which can be held in pockets in 'Papidex' type books or, less conveniently, 'Kardex' type trays.As with the book system depending on the organisation of the clinic there is a separate bOok for each clinic and possibly each consultant. The sheets held in the pockets project sufficiently under a celluloid protector to show date, consultant, time (assuming a separate book for each clinic,e.g. one book for Allergy Clinics, another for Hypertension etc.): This system has the advantages of the loose laf book one with the added advantages that the sheets are easily held in the fixture and the fixture is convenient. It has the disadvantage that the sheet is small for a Large clinic. Another firm has metal cabinets with up to 9-drawer trays. Each tray contains 45 holders which can be filled by specially printed forms and dated for subsequent clinics. The dates are visible when the tray is opened, as above. The forms fitted into each holder can be 2-, 3- Or 4page with carbons as required and an overall size of 13" x 9 11 . Headings across the paper could be: Reporting Surname Christian or Age Address If new patient timefirst nameswrite N.P. Previous X-rays Previous records required? Required? Supplied Returned ExistingNew hosp. hosp. no. no. (old patients) (new patients) irp 9 September 1966 Mulcahy Dr: Hosp. no Address TimePatient N. P. 17 Fanfrolico St. 8.30 a.m. Mrs. Edna Morris Makatana R.D. N. P. Mrs. T.J. Stone Date. 10.30a.m. Mrs. J. Bell 3428 Mr. F. Ladden 1562 Miss B. Cumming 4265 The main disadvantage of this method is its inflexibility. If more people come to the clinic than usual there is 'oftenno room to write them in tidily, consequently the whole page becomes very difficult to read. It does, however, have the advantage that reference.can always be made immediately to previous clinics, although this is often a time-wasting method of getting information that could be got quicker elsewhere. A bound book also has the further disadvantage that lists required for medical records wanted for the , clinic have to be transcribed. Specially printed and bouñdbooks are expensive and do not justify their cost. (ii) A loose leaf book. This has the advantage that extra leaves can be put in if clinic arrangements are 'changed. The lay .out would be similar. It has the further advantage that sheets can be easily photocopied for Medical Records to draw ''the records required. Loose leaf books tend, however, to get untidy, the holes enlarge and frequently the pages tear out. This can, to a large extent, be overcome by having the pages tightly held which, however, results in an .uneven writing surface; if held in a ring binder paper reinforcing rings can be used to guard against tearing. Specially printed pages will be needed but thought has to be given to type and weight of paper and printing method, e.g. most people use ballpoint pens which write satisfactorily on duplicating paper. Should you not have your sheets run on the hospital duplicator instead of sending them to a printer? (iii) A printed pad in triplicate. One copy is sent to the Medical Records department, one to the clinic concerned and the bottom copy is kept in the outpatient booking department. These pads can be assembled with one-time carbons (although the considerable amount of handling which they will receive V.; -16 however, one has to qualify it by emphasising that appointment times must be realistic - if there is only one bus service an hour then inevitably many patients for the clinic are going to arrive hourly. Booking for clinics is done either by telephone, personally or by letter. Phone bookings may be done by the patient or someone on his behalf, the general practitioner or specialist or his nurse or other wards, departments, hospitals or organisations. If the Ward Sister makes an appointment for an inpatient to return to clinic following discharge it is essential that this be done through the appointments clerk. Counter bookings are usually made by the patient himself for follow-up visits but, depending,on how convenient it is to get to hospital, the patient may make the first booking himself.He must have a •note from the doctor 'referring hIm stating the purpose for which he is referred. In general, it is preferable for all, clinic bookings to be done by one department. This enables visits to be co-ordinated and also means that the same method can be used for all clinic bookings. It is recognised, however, that certain 'clinics may have a case for doing their own booking and alsothat hospital lay-out often precludes a centralised booking system. For the information of the hospital: 1.2.1. When a phone call is received or the patient comes to the counter to, make a booking the outpatient booking clerk must be able to refer to a book or fixture from which an appointment time can be given. The following methods may be used: (I) A bound book which may be an exercise book, a larger and thicker book with ruled, cross lines or a diary. The name of the clinic is on the outside. Different lay-outs will be needed depending on the size of the clinic and the number of medical staff running it; medical staff usually prefer to bring new patients in at the beginning of the clinic, setting aside more time for them. The lay-out of a day's clinic sheet could be: Outpatient departments serve a double function either for pre-admission assessment to determine whether a patient is to be admitted and, if so, to determine urgency for waiting list purposes or to continue treatment for which a general practitioner, would not have facilities and which saves the patient being admitted as an inpatient. In some cases certain pre-admission procedures are also done on an outpatient basis to improve bed utilisation and allow the patient to be admitted nearer the date of his operation. Outpatient follow-up is covered in para. 3 chapter 18 ('Follow-up methods'). 1.1 Referral sources (i) General practitioners. The main source of referrals to the outpatient department is from general practitioners either direct or through a specialist. (ii) Wards. Following discharge the ward may arrange for a patient to attend a clinic for follow-up visits. (iii) Other departments of the hospital may arrange for a patient to attend a clinic. (iv) Other hospitals may refer outpatients or discharged' inpatients to the outpatient department either because' the hospital to which the patient is referred has more specialised facilities or because it is more convenient for the patient, although there may be local arrangements of 'zoning' which limit this. (v) Other organisations such as Medical Officers of Health, Public Health Nurses, mental hospitals, prisons, the Armed Services refer patients direct to the outpatient department. 1.2 Appointment booking methods It is assumed that all outpatient departments operate an appointments system bringing patients in in 'blocks' of so many to a quarter or half hour. Anything less than this should not be tolerated. The British Ministry of Health's criteria are that 50% of patients should be seen within 15 minutes of their appointment time, ',)5% within half an hour and less than 3% should wait for more than half an hour. Having said this, 2;, Medical Records Practice in New Zealand OUTPATIENT AND ACCIDENT & EMERGENCY DEPARTMENT PROCEDURES Ii 1. Outpatient department 1.1 Referral sources 1,2 Appointment booking methods 1.2.1 For the information of the hospital 1.2.2 For the information of the patient 1.3 Records 1.4 Clinic attendance 1.5 Referrals to other departments 1.6 Further treatment 1.7 Doctors' reports and letters 2. Accident & Emergency department 2.1 Referral sources 2.2 Records 2.3 Notifying relations 2.4 Referrals to other departments 2.5 Further treatment 2.6 Follow-up attendances 3,Records - decentralised or centralised? 3.1 Outpatients 3.2 A & E patients 1•Numbering 50Time of arrival 6. Staff coverage 601 Clerical staff qualifications 7. Conducting a waiting time survey 80References 9.Further reading 9.1 Basic 9.2 Background Outpatient department: 1. It is in the outpatient department that most patients make their first contact with the hospital. It therefore follows that it is one of the busiest and that care should be taken to see that it is also one of the most efficient. Much of the success or otherwise depends on the clerical staff who make the first contact with the patient. '4.) to Hospital Regd. Id .r4 (tia) Patient's.Christian or Name: .........• o..0.O... ...00First Names:,,, Address: 00• •.. •• Employer: E4 0000000000 0 0000 ass • a a a a ..o,000 •• 000 00050 0000010050000000 000000 000500050•00005•0OG • . Date First Attended: 0Dept. : ..00000 .Occupation.: Employer's How did Accident Address: ......••••.... 0 0ccur: .......... 00 0 00000000.050..5550 0 0 00000000000000 0 •SS0 0$ 000 .•. 0000090005050..0,. I nsurer: . . • . . . . . . . . • 0 • 0 • • • • • 0 • • • •• • • • • • • . . 0 0 0 • • • 8 • • • • • • • • • • • • • LEDGER CARD No0 000 oa.•••••••a••• 0••••• No. 5588 Month and Department 1 2 3 123 1 23 1 23 k 5 6 7 8 9 10 1112 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 25 2123 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 . 31BALANCE 9 10 11 12 13 1+ 1516171819 20 21 22232k 25 26272 9 . 3031- - 1+5 678 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 6 1718 19 2o 21 2223 2+ 25 26 27 28 2931 1 56 78 910 1112 131k 15 16 1718 192J 2122 232k2526 27 28 29 30 31 , k567 8 Medical Certificate0......,i&t visit•,,.....,. Emergency and Accident Dept. .....0......vlslts@$1.5o .... ....... Diagnostic X-ray...0 ... Physiotherapy Dept. .......,..055............,..... ............05...00.. 0 000000 00 0005 •00•000 •, ...•. •.......... . •....... .... visits @ $1.50 •0.....o .. ........ .. .... ...... a ••S0•000 00 0050500 05 0050 TOTAL$ Hospital Regd. Co Ha) 'H aia) Patient's Christian or Name: ...................... ..-.....First Names: Address: . e • •. • •.•, •.o..... No00....,..,.,., o.....,.,....o..o...,..,,,o,.00000.o,0000 •• • • •. •. ., .Date First Attended: • • ••,•,• 55,05,0000 Employer: 0000 0 , • 000•S• • • •..... . Dept. : . .. ....... .Occupation: •.... . . Co a) E-I Employer's How did Accident Address: • , •• S • • , •, • 0 0 0 0 • • • • , • • • Occur : . . • • . . . . • • • • • • o Insurer: , . . . . . . . . . . . • • • • • • • •0 • • • • • 5 0 S I • S 0 0 0 I 0 5 0000I0 0 0 0 0 0 0 I 0 0 S S I 0 0 0 0 0 5 5 00 0050•5550505S00•0I00S000SI50 Dr. to - AUCKLAND HOSPITAL BOARD Phone 32-690 P.O. Box 5546, Auckland, C.1. When communicating please return this account or quote name of Patient and Account No. 5588 TO TREATMENT OF THE ABOVE PATIENT ON THE DATES SHOWN Month and Department 2 3 Lf 5 6 7 ö 9 10 11 12 13 14 1 5 16 17 16 19 20 21 22 19 20 21 22 2 3 1 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ILF 15 17 -1-7-177 Ii 2 3 + 5 6 7 b 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 16 19 20 21 22 23 2 Medical Certificate issued by ....,.........1 visit © $2.50 SSSISSSSSSSO 00555 Emergency and Accident Dept. ................ visits @ $1.50 S.I.I00000.. 50005 Diagnostic X—ray. . . .. . . os-.. . . . 0 5 • • SO 0 00 0 II SOS 0 5 I I 0 5S• S 050000I006SS 00555 Physiotherapy Dept. ........o.....00.000...00 visits1.50 S S S S S • ••S • S S S I S S S S S S S I 5 0 It0 0 0 0 • S S5 0 5 SI 0 5 0 0 S • S 55 5 • S S I S I S I 0 - - - .-. I' TOTAL$ t:x1 b Stone (J.E.) Hospital Organisation and Management. London, 1952. Further reading:.1. Background Hess (A.E.) Can he work or not? Your work holds the answer Jnl.AAMRL, Aug. 1961, Information to insurance companies (in 'What do YOU do?') Medical Record News, August 1 963, p 170 pp 160-i sheet for accounts staff or in some way, such as by preparation of card or entry in register for inpatients, records the admission for future costing.As stated earlier the daily rate for inpatients is based on the annual accounts of the individual board. Some very ticklish problems occur on this side such as hernias, occupational diseases such as lead poisoning, leptospirosis, poisoning etc. In all these cases, it is not within the sphere of a Medical Records Officer to determine whether or not the claim is in order. The principle is the same as with outpatients queries: make out a Form 2 to the insurance company and argue later. In practice it will be found . that if the insurance company is in doubt, it will request a special report. 3. Conclusion When one considers the total number of accidents at work• treated each year in one's own hospital one realises the substantial source of revenue this provides to hospitals. In a few of the major hospitals there are special claims departments set up solely to implement the Act from the hospital angle. However, the majority of hospitals generallyrely on an accounts clerk to devote some of his time to this work each week.The largest amount of work required from Medical Records personnel is to keep the medical record up to date by. inclusion of all reports and by direct contact with the insurance company when further progress medical certificates are required. Indeed, one can generally tell when the insurance company intends paying out by the number of rings requesting further reports. No mater.,what the job is, whether it be routine filing or the preparation of a comprehensive report, accuracy is essential so that a true and correct record is always available. Remember, this is one of the few sources of income for hospitals, and errors mean lost money.. kReferences Partridge (J0S0) Some thoughts on Workers' Compensation and Public Liabilities affecting Hospital Boards. N.Z. Hospital, Dec. 1955- zz6 record plays its part. The record should always be kept up to date, complete with all x-ray and laboratory results, dates of outpatient attendances and finally whether or not the patient is cleared for work or had to return at some future date; if the latter, this should be stated in the account. Naturally some accounts extend over several months and sometimes it is preferable to forward an interim account to the insurance company. During the time the worker is off work, a medical certificate must be completed certifying his incapacity for work. The Form 2 is good only for the estimated time stated by the doctor examining for the first time. Thereafter certificates should be made on Form 3, until the final clearance which is given on Form 3.It has been found that most insurance companies insist on the final Form 3 before they pay out on an account. A further point crops up in the nature of special reports. These usually originate from the company or firm of lawyers requesting a detailed report on the injuries sustained. These reports are chargeable at a higher rate and may be paid in full or in part to the doctor or specialist providing such report. In larger boards considerable paper work can be involved in workers' compensation cases and also in folloing treatment for patients. A method has been evolved to cut down the paper work. It consists of an 8 x 5 sheet padded with a similar card and with carbon paper in between (refer appendixes 1 and 2)Whilst the patient is still receiving treatment both parts of the form go to the department treating him and attendances are noted. When the treatment is finished the complete form is sent to the accounts department in the board office, the upper part is sent out to the employer or insurance company as the account and the lower part becomes the accounts department ledger card, thus saving a considerable amount of transposing and unnecessary record keeping. Such a system could also be used in smaller hospitals. Inpatients: 2.2. This is usually originated in the Admission Office. Among the questions asked of all patients is whether the admission to hospital is a result of an accident, and, if so, what nature? If the Admission Officer is satisfied that admission is a result of an accident he either types a copy of the record :zc it6. Boys employed on milk rounds, paper runs, Post Office1 and also those employed after school delivering goods etc. 7 Persons working on own account but whose business is a private Company. e.g. John Brown employed by John Brown. All persons working for an employer including staff of hospitals. NOTE Commercial cleaning staff are employed by Commercial Cleaners, a separate company. Persons referred to this hospital for treatment by a private doctor should •have a Form 2 completed. Form 2 should be made out whether the employee will b6 off work or not and for persons admitted to hospital. Where the treatment takes more than 30 minutes 1 this should be recorded on the outpatient card. The foregoing may be considered a general background. How does one extract all this information? Naturally, this varies from hospital to hospital due to size etc. Generally, however, the best place to commence a claim is right at the start, in the Accident and Emergency Department. ;^.1 Outpatients The Casualty Officer or Visiting Physician or Surgeon (in the case of an outpatient clinic) completes Form 2 in duplicate from information obtained from the injured worker. The original is either entered in'a register or in the case of larger hospitals, is passed direct to accounts staff in Board Office who invoice it and post to the employer or insurance company concerned. The onus is not on the Casualty Officer at this stage to determine whether or not the accident occurred in the course of worker's employment.Now that the case is entered on a workers debit card the subsequent treatment is watched and, periodically, normally fortnightly, the accounts staff, or Board Office staff in company with Medical Records personnel extract all information from the medical record and prepare an account for submission to the insurance company, or where this is not known, direct to the employer. In practice it has been found preferable to deal direct with the insurance company whose business it is to handle compensation accounts. As seen earlier in the chapter, all relevant services must be extracted and costed and it. is here that the medical 15 Act, which is statute law.According to the nature of the accident a worker may commence an action in the court for Workers' Compensation, and obtain a judgement; he can then go ahead with his common law claim if he so desires, but in this latter claim he must take into account what he has received under Compensation.. Similarly, he may have-a common law claim for full wages. (Workers' Compensation being restricted to 4/5 wages). He may also obtain special damages for his out of pocket expenses, medical expenses and costs. Practical considerations:. 2. The question of whether or not an accident comes within the scope of the Act does not generally concern Medical Records personnel. Most Boards work on the assumption, , and with the Health Department's approval, that the best way is to issue an account to the insurance company and argue later. There are many fine points to be considered such as: workers cycling to work (generally this would not be accepted under the Act but there are some awards that include this provision), accidents occuring during meal times, accidents caused through skylarking etc. These examples would also be considered outside the Act. As a guide to readers of this Manual, the following instructions are reprinted from our own Workers' Compensation . Register , as a guide for House Surgeons:The Casualty Officers should ascertain from patients on their first visit to Casualty whether the accident happened at work, and if so, fill in Workers' Compensation Certificate, Form 2, and enter the particulars in this Register. Form 2 should not be given to the worker but retained in the Register for subsequent despatch by the Accountant. The following persons come within 'the scope of the Workers' Compensation Act 1. 2. 3. Jockeys and Apprentices Sharemilkers Boys employed by father provided they are receiving remuneration, especially farmer's sons. Lf Civilian members of the Armed Forces. Note:. Uniformed members do NOT come within the Act. All Government Departments. State name of Department and in the case of RAILWAYS and POST OFFICE, the Branch concerned. 5. Commercial Travellers. Form 3 Workers' Compensation Act 1956 FURTHER MEDICAL CERTIFICATE To .......................... (Employer or Insurance Company) (Address of Medical Practitioner) (Date) THIS is to certify that .......................................................................................................................................... incapacitated for it further • is still unfit for work and will be totally period. of ........................................................................................................................................................................ • is fit to resume work on ............................. (Date) ........................... .......... ...................i9............ Remarks..................................................................................................................................................................... Signature:.................................................................................................... * Complete one paragraph and delete the other... 1.9 Scope of the Act . . Workers' Compensation insurance is compulsoryo Protection is assured the worker, however, by a provision in the Act that the worker will receive compensation even if the employer has failed, to insure.There are actually three bodies of law. The Workers' Compensation Law covers the employer's common liability for an unlimited amount, it covers any liability which he may have in equity, and covers his liability under the Workers' Compensation 15 Form .2 Workers' Compensation Act 1956 FIRST MEDICAL CERTIFICATE (To be used in all cases of injuries at work and industrial diseases) To ............................................................................................................................................................ Name and address of Employer or Insurance Company (Please Print) Dr ............................................................................................................................................................. Name and address of Medical Practitioner (Please Print) This is to certify that I have today examined................................................................ ....................................................employed by Hehe states that was accidentally injured whilst at work on......../.... Sheshe h - 19............at................a.m./p.m. and thatceased work on......../.... she 19............at................a.m./p.m. Worker's account of accident...................................................................................................... hepartially his I find that - is incapacitated from following shetotally her occupation as a result of the following injuries....................................................... The probable length of his incapacity will be............................................................... her I am of the opinion that the above injuries areproperly are not attributable to the accident in the worker's account. I shall see him/her again on ............................................................................................. 19 at..........................................a.m./p.m. . Remarks: ......................................................... ; .................... I ....................... .......................................... ............ Date:.......................................Signature............................................................................................ 1.2 Outpatient attendances $.2.50forthe first visit, $1.50 for the second and each succeeding visit with a proviso .that anything over thirty minutes shall be charged at 50c for each fifteen minutes. 1 .3 X-rays The amount chargeable for X-rays is double the charges prescribed in the schedule of the Social Security Regulations (X-ray Diagnostic Services) as being the relevant fee payable to Radiological Specialists. In practice, x-ray fees vary, but the standard fee payable for, say, an x-ray of the armor leg is $i+. 1.4 Laboratory services Same as prescribed above for x-rays, but not double. 1.5 Other services Physiotherapy treatment, artificial aids, teeth, loss of clothing, splints, boots are all chargeable as set out in the Act. 1.6 Artificial limbs .. The employer is required to pay a lump sum into the consolidated fund based on age of worker at the time of accident. This covers repairs and replacement limbs only; the worker is then entitled to receive free repairs and replacements from the Board. 1.7 Ambulance fees Come under the Section of Transport Expenses. i..8 Forms The forms used are set out below. Form 2 is the form used for the initial visit. Subsequent progress reports and the final Medical Certificate are completed on Form 3. . 2W 1 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand WORKERS' COMPENSATION 1. Application of the Act 1.1 Inpatient treatment 1.2 Outpatient attendances 1,3 X-rays 1.4 Laboratory services 1.5 Other services 1,6 Artificial limbs 1.7 Ambulance fees 1.8 Forms 1.9 Scope of the Act 2, Practical considerations 2.1 Outpatients 2.2 Inpatients 3. 4, Conclusion References Further reading Application of the Act: 1. The method of obtaining the information required varies from Board to Board. The whole field is governed by the Workers' Compensation Act, 1956, and its yearly orders. The theory of the Act as it affects hospitals is that the medical services afforded an insured worker as a result of an accident within the scope of the Act, are payable by the insurance company subject to certain limits. It is the usual policy of self-employed workers to take out an insurance policy against accidents or sickness so that, In the event of injury, the worker has some financial relief. This means that any services, apart from special reports, rendered by the Board are free to the insured. Fees are recoverable by the Board if the patient has right of action against another for negligence, e.g. assault cases, motor vehicle accidents and in other cases where this right exists. A brief survey of the chargeable items as at end 1966 is as follows Inpatient treatment: 1.1. Amount per day is ascertained by the individual Board's Annual Accounts. This amount varies from Board to Board and has no maximum. III NOTIFIABLE DISEASES OTHER THAN NOTIFIABLE INFECTIOUS DISEASES UNDER THE HEALTH ACT 1956 Notifiable to the Medical Officer of Health 1. Actinomycosis 20 Anchylostomiasis (hookworm disease) Beriberi 3° 4 0 Bilharziasis (endemic haematuria, Egyptian haematuria) Chronic lead poisoning 5. 6. Compressed air illness arising from occupation 76 Damage to eyesight arising from occupation 8. Dengue 9. Diseases of the respiratory, system arising from occupatidn 10. Eclampsia 11. Food poisoning 13. Impaired hearing arising from occupation 1. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. Malaria Phosphorus poisoning Poisoning from any insecticide, weedicide, fungicide, or animal poison met with at work Poisoning from any gas, fumigant, or refrigerant met with at work Poisoning fromany solvent met with at work Poisoning from any metal or, salt of any metal met with at work Skin diseases arising from occupation Tetanus Trichinosis NOTIFIABLE DISEASES UNDER TUBERCULOSIS 'ACT 19+8 Tuberculosis (all forms notifiable to the,Medical Officer of Health) (Correct at February 1 968, III 11+ APPENDIX A. NOTIFIABLE INFECTIOUS DISEASES UNDER THE HEALTH ACT 1956 Section A. Notifiable to the Medical Officerof Health and to the Local Authority 1. Anthrax 2, Cholera 3. Cysticerosis Lf, Diphtheria 5. Dysentery (amoebic and bacillary) 6. Encephalitis lethargica 7. Enteric fever (typhoid fever, para-typhoid fever) 8Infective hepatitis 90 Leptospiral infections 10. Meningococcal meningitis 11. Ornithosis (psittacosis) 12. Plague (bubonic or pneumonic) 13e Poliomyelitis 11+. Puerperal fever involving any form of septicaemia, sepsis or sapraemia 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20, 21. 22, 23. Rabies Relapsing fever Salmonella infections Smallpox (variola, including varioloid and alastrim) Taenisis Trachoma (granular conjunctivitis, granular ophthalmia, granular eyelids) Typhus Undulant fever (brucellosis) Yellow fever Section B. Infectious diseases notifiable to the Medical Officer of Health 10 Leprosy 2, Ophthalmia neonatorum 30 Pemphigus neonatorum, impetigo or pustular lesions of the skin of the newborn infant 1+. Puerperal infection involvingany form of sepsis, either generalised or local, in or arising -from the female genital tract within 1 1+days of childbirth or abortion 50 Streptococcal pneumonia or septicaemia of the newborn infant Although the schedule states 'infectious diseases notifiable to the Medical Officer of Health and Local Authority" in practice few cases are notified direct to the Local Authority. The District Health Offices are aware of this and they, themselves, take the precaution of notifying the Local Authority, Z17 7.2. Background Stone (J.E.) Hospital organisation London, Faber 1 19529 and management, pp 490-2 xxii + 1722 Trends in Notifiable DiseasesWellington, Department of Health, Medical • • •Statistics Branch, •••Special Report Series. No. 18 21 14 notified by the hospital and, if note why not. Secondly, the death certificate eventually filters through the Registrar General's office to the National Health statistics Centre,who are able to check off the disease with their MS18 statistical cards for comparison. Any complicated test that cannot be performed in the hospital laboratory, in addition to specialist's tests for viral infections and salmonella infections, is generally forwarded to the National Health Institute in Wellington. The results of these tests take some time but when received back at the hospital, should be acted upon, even though the patient may have subsequently been discharged from hospital. All positive results are also sent to the appropriate Medical Officer of Health.. It will be seen, therefore, that notifications should never be overlooked. The whole purpose of notifying cases of infectious diseases is to allow departmental and local authority staff to investigate home conditions etc. in order to prevent the outbreak or spread of any such disease, The Medical Officer of Health, if authorised by the Minister, is given wide powers under the 'Act to achieve this. For example, he has power to isolate, quarantine or disinfect. He may order insanitary things to, or forbid people to leave the district, ' Besides the..mainpurpose of preventing the spread of infectious disease, the 'notifications also form the basis of a weekly New Zealand Bulletin (H.I.D.42) which sets out the number of actual and suspected notifiable diseases and the Health Districts in' which they occur, References: 6, Health Act 1956, Section 74 and - first schedul.to the Act 1962/76, 1964/39, . Poisons Act 1960/39 Tuberculosis Act 1948 Further reading: 7. Basic: 7.1. Benjamin (B'.) Tuberculosis 1st mt. Congress Report, notification and registration pp 215-20 yr cases of poisonings admitted or discharged from hospital during the past week up to Saturday midnight, are included. The method of obtaining such information would be the same as with the other notifiable infectious diseases, that is, through the daily admission lists. It is suggested that poison notifications be entered in red ink in the Infectious Disease Register whilst other notifiable diseases are entered in blue ink. This has the immediate advantage of comparing admissions for the different diseases. It has been found in practice, that organisations such as Women's Institutes, clubs etc. will willingly use information of this nature in an endeavour to bring to parents' notice the danger of leaving poisonous objects within a toddler's reach. Where it is undesirable for the Health Department to make further enquiries in the case, the weekly returns of the Department should be marked 'investigation not required' (this is covered in paragraph 2 of Health Department Circular Letter 1961/18 of August, 1961). 4• Occupational diseases These are usually confined to the bigger cities where there is a danger of occupational hazards such as lead poisoning or poisoning from insecticide spraying etc. Notifications are made on the usual weekly H.I.D.6 form. 5. Conclusion A perusal of the Infectious Disease Register shows how inpatient patterns have changed in New Zealand over the past few years.. In the early 1950s diphtheria and poliomyelitis were responsible for a large portion of the total notifications. However, with the introduction of immunisation programmes and public health campaigns by the Health Department, those diseases were, largely eradicated. Instead the pendulum swung towards infectious hepatitis, although a few years ago there were many attacks of influenzal pneumonia especially in young children. It is important to follow up positive laboratory findings in connection with deaths. There is provision on the back of every death certificate for the disease at the time of death. This provision has a twofold purpose. F irstly, the local Medical Officer of Health is notified by the funeral director of a positive case of infectious disease. There is a statutory obligation for the funeral director to do this, The Medical Officer of Health can then check his files to see if the case has already been 1+ outpatients seen at his clinic. This form is usually prepared at the Chest Clinic Office by the District Health Nurse in attendance at the Clinic and contains all information necessary for the Health Department to maintain a Tuberculosis Control Register. H.T.B.10 This form is. used by the Hospital to notify any new case of Tuberculosis. For method of notification see below. H.T.B.11 This form is sent to the Department when a case is discharged, died or denotified. H.T.B.12 This form is virtually a half yarly survey, to the Department, containing all the names etc. of every case in hospital at that date.. The method of obtaining the new notification is the same as with notifiable infectious diseases above. However, this group includes all outpatient notifications so a careful scrutiny must be made of all outpatient chest files for any new cases. In the case of this disease it is usual to wait until clinical or , x-ray or bacteriological proof of the disease has been established before notification is made. Once a notification has been made the name is entered on the T.B. Control Register in the Health Department and subsequent follow-up is maintained by means of the Outpatient Forms H.T,B.8. The question of new T.B.'notifications should not be taken lightly. Once a new case has been registered, an investigation is made not only to check contacts of the case but also to search for the likely source of the infection. This is usually by x-ray or laboratory tests. The patient's name remains on the Tuberculosis Control Register until the patient is denotified. The register serves as the. main record within the local , office of the Health Department by which officers of the Department and the District Health Nurse are able to check that the necessary supervision has been given.,. Poisonings: 3. Under the Poisons Act (1960) there is a statutory obligation for hospitals to forward to the Medical Officer of Health, all cases of poisonings. As the circular does not specifically state that it requests only cases of children swallowing poisonous ingredients, it has been the practice for hospitals to list all cases of poisonings, whether attempted suicide or otherwise. Thus, on the weekly return of Infectious Diseases (H.I..D.6) all 113. Mr. Mrs. Hosp. No. Miss ( rname)(Christian name) Age Permanent aaress Sex Admitted from Admitted byWardDoctor Date admittedProvisional diagnosis Date DischargedFinal diagnosis Discharged to Notes receivedH.D. notified NOTIFICATION OF NOTIFIABLE DISEASE Every Monday a complete return of all notifications is.prepared from the working book and transposed into an Infectious Disease Register on to Form H.I.D.6 for despatch to the Health Department. Any discharges or deaths of previously notified cases are also recorded on H.I.D,6. This return is complete up to the previous Saturday night. Some Health Authorities require form H.I.D.,1 to be completed and forwarded immediately a patient is admitted with a notifiable infectious disease.. However, this is not the general rule, the normal method being the weekly H.I.D.6. 2.2 Notifiable diseases other than infectious diseases. The main diseases of this group occurring in New Zealand are food poisoning and hydatids. In the latter case the question of domicile and maiden name in the case of a married woman play an important part. When completing an MS18 statistical card the maiden name of the patient is included. This is necessary.to follow through an old notified case and also to distinguish between town and country for notifiable cases. The campaign against hydatids is waged on a national scale and there is no need to enlarge on it here; . suffice it to say that all notifications must be prepared by the Health Department for use by the National Hydatids Council and any other interested body. 2.3 Notifiable diseases under the Tuberculosis Act 1948 A different set of notification forms are used here, namely H.T.B.8This form is used by the Chest Physician to notify the District Office, Health Department, of all 211 14 Dr. Ward •.•..............,.... R e:•........ • . • . . •... . . . . . • 1•• Hospital No.: The above named was admitted to your ward sulfering from — • • S S •SSSOSSS 1001550555e0s0 •0S•S•O If this is diagnosed as a disease notifiable under the Health Act or the Tuberculosis Act, (see over) will you please notify Medical Records Department. Suspected cases of cancer and notifiable diseases should also be notified. Date: MEDICAL RECORDS DEPARTMENT Note: If the patient is admitted as a suspect case of notifiable disease the final diagnosis must be notified to the Medical Records Department as soon as possible - also any change from a notifiable disease to a disease which i5 not notifiable, REPLY: A card index system instead of a register is also used by some hospitals.A 5t x 3" card, as laid out below, is used — 211 2.1 Notifiable infectious diseases This work is normally handled by the Medical Records department, mainly on the grounds of convenience. Some hospital regulations and standing orders for house surgeons state that it is the personal responsibility of the house surgeon to supply the information to Medical Records departments. This is the most desirable method but it is a counsel of perfection in many cases. Various systems of checking new admissions are used in New Zealand ranging from the Enquiry Office Register through to the individual ward lists. Both systems have advantages and drawbacks but the important thing is that whichever is used should work. By this I mean that a new case may be admitted as a pyrexia of unknown origin (P.u.o.) This case may turn out to be a brucellosis or just an otitis media. The important point is, however, not to overlook this case in the space of a few days. Experience has led me to keep my own system of bring-ups and not to rely on nursing staff to notify new cases to the office. This latter system may work quite well until staff changes take place but then it is apt to break down. The following system could well be used in a hospital of medium size.Daily, a perusal is made of all daily admissions making a note in a book of any likely cases of infectious diseases. The Ward Sister is then contacted and asked to confirm the diagnosis. In the case of a positive diagnosis the local office of the Health Department is rung. It is advisable to confirm, with the local office of the Health Department that preliminary telephonic advice is required for notifiable diseases. Where the diagnosis is in doubt the ward is rung daily until the diagnosis becomes positive or negative. Some of the larger hospitals adopt a slightly different arrangement; instead of ringing a ward a form similar to that shown below is forwarded to the house surgeon concerned: the form is self-explanatory. Ifo 14 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand NOTIFICATION OF DISEASES 1. Introduction 2. Diseases notifiable 2.1 Notifiable infectious diseases 2.2 Notifiable diseases other than infectious diseases 2,3 Notifiable diseases under the Tuberculosis Act 191+8 3. Poisonings 1+. Occupational diseases 5e Conclusion 6. References 7. Further reading 7.1 Basic 7.2 Background Appendix A. List of diseases notifiable Introduction: 1. Under the provisions of the Health Act 1956, Section 71+ (1), it is the responsibility of medical practitioners to give notice of cases of notifiable diseases to the local Medical Officer of Health and, where applicable, to the local.authority of the district, . Section 71+ (2) of the Act sets out the action to be taken by the Medical Superintendents of hospitals. In the case of public hospitals, returns are made weekly on form H.I.D. 6 to the Department. This form is numbered serially,i.e. the first return of the year would be 1/67 ending with 52/67 for the last. Diseases notifiable: 2. Diseases notifiable change from time to time; the list at the date given is shown-at Appendix A. Any changes can be ascertained from the nearest Medical Officer of Health. jo, 16.2 Background Quin (M.P.) Those off-beat abbreviations can mean. lost time, lost friends Jnl. AAMRL. Feb. .1961, pp 10, Gordon (B.L.) Growth of medical terminology to meet the day's needs (review of 'Current Medical Terminology') Medical Record News 1 August, 39. 1965, pp 223- 2 4, 226, 233 2$ 13 International Classification of Diseases Geneva, World Health Organisation, Palais des Nationa, 1957. Hough (John N.) Scientific Terminology New York Rinehart & Co. Inc., 1953 Durham (Robert H.) An Encyclopaedia of Medical Syndromes New York.-Paul B. Hoeber, 1960 Further reading: 16. Basic 16.1. Agee (Mrs. Mary L.) A medical U S A, Dayton, Ohio, Grandstudy guide and reference view Hospital, 1959, 165 +:.'23 Current Medical Terminology American Medical Association, 1966..•. Davies (Paul M.) Medical London, W. Heinemann Medical Terminology for Radiographers Books Ltd., 1960 'Guide to the organisation U S A , Chicago, Ill., of a Hospital Medical Record American Hospital Assn., Department' pp 77-831962, vii + 83 International Study Project:3rd mt. Congress Report, International Glossary of pp 151-89 terms and definitions . . ,. (Mostly 'Medical record', rather than 'Medical'),.. . Marks, Jean, edit. MedicalNew York, Marks Publishing Terminology: a handbookService, 1961, viii + 822 for Physicians, Nurses,line ills. Medical Record Librarians, .. .. . Medical Secretaries, . Attorneys, Insurance. Brokers, Students Stanton (A.I.) A dictionary.U.S.A., Springfield, Ill., for Medical SecretariesThomas, 1960, vii + 175 The ftirtcher Word Book: , U.S.A., Los Angelos, Calif., a short cut to understand-Birtoher Corpn., 1962, ing medical and surgical 32 pp. terminology Ui so that the knowledge acquired will create an ever-increasing interest in Medical Records. In recent years, ' medical research has become a most important factor in medical activities in New Zealand hospitals. A well-trained Medical Records Officer, with a good knowledge of medical terminology, and the ability to read case notes intelligently, is a great asset to medical men undertaking research work. Specialists are the first to acknowledge the value of an experienced layman. Medical recording work is a worthwhile occupation and the greater one's experience the greater interest one takes in this useful work. With better training facilities and fuller recognition by medical staff and hospital authorities the more important will the fully trained Medical Records Officer become, Already the - demand for trained staff in many of our hospitals cannot be satisfied. The chances of promotion to other and larger hospitals for the fully trained Medical Records Officer can be looked forward to in the near future. 1 5, References Huffman, (Edna K.) Manual for, U.S.A. Berwyn, Ill.,.Physicians Medical Records LibrariansRecord Co. 1959 Dorland's Illustrated Medical 23rd Ed. Philadelphia, W.B. Dictionary Saunders Co. 1957 Harned (Jessie K.) Medical Terminology Made Easy Chicago, Physicians Record Co. 1961 Bollo (Louise E.) Medicine and Medical Terminology W.B. Saunders Co. Philadelphia 1961 Roberts (Dr. Ffrangcon), M.A., London, W. Heinmann Medical Books Ltd., 1954 M.D., F.F.R. Medical Terms (Their Origin and Construction) Perkel (Louis Leo) Medical Terminology Simplified Springfield, Ill., Chas C. Thomas 1958 Skinner (Henry Alan) The Origin of Medical Terms Baltimore, The Williams & Wilkins Co. 1949 13 The terms syndrome and disease are often unwittingly used interchangeably although they are not synonymous. In general, a syndrome evokes more interest and is more challenging than a disease because its relationships are more obscure and its etiology is less apparent. If, subsequently, a specific etiologic factor ddes become manifest, the condition should then be reclassified as a disease. As an example of a relatively common syndrome we may take purpura. This is characterised by bleeding into the skin and mucous membranes, and from the body orifices. It is often, but not invariably, associated with deficiences of the blood platelets0 Purpura is a syndrome which may be caused by a large variety of diseases ranging from septicaemia to cancer, as well as by the toxic action of drugs, industrial poisons or x-rays. Conclusion:it-i-. The use of medical terms from Latin or Greek may create difficulties for the beginner, but in many cases it actually makes for brevity and directness in preparing medical records and articles. For example "arteriosclerosis", in one word, conveys the same idea as the more common but longer expression, "hardening of the arteries", "Infectious hepatitis", "epidemic hepatitis" and "viral hepatitis" are short ways of sying "inflammation of the liver due to virus". It will be seen from the above how necessary it is for a Medical Records department to keep a well-stocked library containing books of reference - refer to books mentioned under heading of References. The beginner should be encouraged to read all reference books available at the hospital where he or she has commenced work. Few Medical Records offices possess any books of reference other than the odd medical dictionary - a sa3 state of affairs which should be brought to the notice of all Medical Superintendents. If good medical recording is required, then staff should have the tools to work with. Medical terminology should be the first subject taught when a person commences work in Medical Records. It will be seen that medical terminology is largely a heritage from the past. It is essential that the student makes an early study of stems, prefixes, suffixes, and the derivation of medical terms icc In medicine Bright's disease (chronic nephritis) and Pott's disease (tuberculosis of the spine) are examples. A' disease may be named for the place in which it was first or most importantly or particularly identified, as tularaemia from Tulare County, California, Rocky Mountain Spotted Fever was at first thought to be limited to theRocky Mountain areas but is now known to occur throughout the Western Hemisphere.. 12. Synonymous Terms A single disease may have several names. In fact, this is the rule rather than the exception, especially when the condition has been known for a long time. The problem of recognising synonymous terms is sometimes a difficult one, especially for the beginner. .. A condition may be called one thing by certain workers in certain places, and something else by physicians of other times and placesIt may be expressed as a lay, term, or in.a more. learned and scientific fashion. The term brucellosis serves as an example. This disease ia a generalised infection caused by a, bacillus, Brucella, named for Sir David Bruce. While.'brucellosis appears to be the preferred term, there are many other names foz'. this condition, including, undulant fever, continued fever, Malta fever, Mediterranean fever, goat fever, and Bruce's septicaemia, The modifiers "continued" and "undulant" express the fact that the disease is often chronic and occurs in waves of attacks. The geographic names indicate that the fever was at first, considered peculiar to the Mediterranean areas, but we now know that it occurs in America and other countries. In fact it is quite common in New Zealand. The name goat fever derives from the fact that the condition is essentially a disease of domesticated goats, cattle and pigs, but it can affect a person who drinks the milk' from diseased animals, 13 Syndrome, The word Syndrome has been in recognised use since 15 4 1 when it appeared in Copland's English translation of Galen. It is usually defined as a concurrence or running together of constant patterns of abnormal signs and symptoms. A symptom complex.' 13 Similar Terms: 9, The following is a short list of medical terms which will alert the student to the dangers of mistaking these terms for one another Arthritis Arteritis Bronchitis Br onch io lit is Carbuncle C.aruncle Empyema Emphysema Hydatidiform Hydatid Hypertension Hypotension Ileum Ilium Perineal Peroneal Spondylolisthe sis Spondylo iys is Urethra Ureter Operation: Mastectomy Mastoidectomy Keep your medical dictionary handy - there are'many more medical terms Which appear similar. Never guess Names of Diseases: 10, The art of naming diseases has developed along with progress in all branches of medicine. Before so much was known of the true causes of disease, illnesses were Often described in terms of how the patient looked or acted, and some of these names continue tobe used. Scarlet fever, yellow fever, smallpox, leprosy ("scaly skin") and apoplexy ("a striking down or seizure", a "stroke") are examples. Eponymic Terms: 11. Certain diseases are named in honour of the first or early discoverers or teachers of the theories of those diseases. Names of persons forming the base of any term are called eponyms, 205 incr.increased or increasing I.V.P.Intravenous pyelogram L.F.T.Liver function test L.M.P.Last menstrual period M.O.Medical Officer N.A.D.No abnormality demonstrated N.E.C.Not elsewhere classified N.E.I.Not elsewhere identified N.O.S.Not otherwise specified O.E.On examination P.D.Provisional diagnosis P.D.Patent Ductus P.H.Past History Para,Parity (Para. 1, 2 or 3 = number of children) PN. Post natal P.U.O. Pyreda of unknown origin R.B.C. Red blood count R.H.D. Rheumatic heart disease R. S. Respiratory system R.T. Radiotherapy S.M.P.Submucous resection S.O.B.Shortness of breath T.N.P.N.Total nonprotein nitrogen,.''. T.P.R.Temperature, pulse rate Ts & AsTonsils and adenoids V.D.Venereal disease V.S.D.Ventricular septal defect W.B.C.White blood count is greater than is less than 13 B/P Blood Pressure B. S. Breath or bowel sounds B.U.N. Blood, Urea, Nitrogen C with C.H.D. Congenital heart disease c/P. Complains of C.N.S. Central nervous system C.S.F. Cerebrospinal fluid C.V.D. Cerebrovascular disease. C.v.s. Cardiovascular system, C . Xr. Chest X-ray D. & C. Dilatation and currettage D.O.A. Dead on arrival. . . decr. diminished or decreased Diagnosis disch. Discharge E.C.G. Electrocardiograph E.E.G. Electroencephalogram. E.F.I. Evacuation for incomplete (abortion) E.S.P. Erythrocyte E.U.A. Examination under anaesthetic F.B.C. Full blood count F. H.Family history G.P.I.General paralysis of the insane G.U.S.Genito Urinary System Gra y .Gravida (Gra y . 1, 2 or of pregnancies) 3 = number Hb.Haemoglobin H.P.House Physician H.P.I. .History of present illness H.S.House Surgeon M.Rad.(T)Master of Radiology (Radio - therapy) M.R.C.P.Member of the Royal College of Physicians M.R.C.O,G.Member of the Royal College of Obstetricians and Gynaecologists M.R.C.S.Member of the Ro y al College of Surgeons Surgery- That branch of medicine which treats diseases, wholly or in part, by manual or mechanical means. (see also medicine) Therapeutics - The science and art of healing. Thoracic Surgery - The study and surgical treatment of diseases of the thorax, inclüding the lungs, pleura, oesophagus, mediastinum, and heart. Urology - The study and treatment of diseases of the female urinary system and of the male genito-urinary system. Venereology - The branch of medicine which deals with venereal disease. -I. Abbreviations used in case notes The following are some of the abbreviations used by the medical staff in writing up a patient's case notes:abd.abdomen adm.admission Alim.S.Alimentary system AN.Ante natal A.P.H.Ante Partum Haemarrhage. A.S.Arteriosclerosis A.S.D.Atrial Septal defect Ba.Barium meal B.N.R.Basal metabolic rate zoo 13 D. 0. Diploma in Ophthalmology D.O.M.S. Diploma in Ophthalmic Medicine and Surgery D.P.M, Diploma in Psychological Medicine F.C.Path, Fellow of the College of Pathologists F.C.R.AO Fellow of the College of Radiologists of Australia F. F. A. R. C Fellow of the Faculty of Anaesthetists of the Royal College of Surgeons FF.R. Fellow of the Faculty of Radiologists F.R.A.C.P. Fellow of the Royal Australasian College of Physicians F.R.A.C.S. Fellow of the Royal Australasian College of Surgeons F.R. C .O.G. Fellow of the Royal College of Obstetricians and Gynaecologists F.P.C.P. Fellow of the Royal College of Physicians F.P.C.S. Fellow of the Royal College of Surgeons M.Ch.Orth. Master of Orthopaedic Surgery M.C.P.A. Member of the College of Pathologists of Australia M.D. Doctor of Medicine M. P. A. C .P. Member of the Royal Australasian College of Physicians M.Rad. (D) Master of Radiology (Radio - diagnosis) Pathology - The study of the modifications of function and changes of structure caused by diseases Paediatric The study and treatment of children under 14 years, Pharmacology The study of the nature and properties of drugs. Plastic Surgery - The study and treatment, by surgical repair, of diseases and malformations of the soft tissues, often involving the transferring of tissues from one part to another, Proctology - The study and treatment of the diseases of the anus, rectum, and sigmoid colon. Psychiatry - The study. of the mind and its diorders. Radiology The science of radiant energy and radiant substances; especially that: branch of medical science which deals. with the use of radiant energy inthe diagnosis and treatment of disease. Rhinology - The sum of knowledge regarding the nose and its diseases. Specialist - A qualified medical practitioner who' hs specialised knowledge and experience in any of the recognised specialties of medicine or surgery. This includes general medicine (Physicians), general surgery, E.N.T. surgery., Obstetricians and Gynaecologists, Psychiatrists, Ophthalmologists, Dermatologists, Paediatricians, Anaesthetists, Pathologists, Radiologists and Radiotherapists. Specialists in the above subjects usually hold one or more of the following postgraduate degrees or diplomas D.0 .P. Diploma in Clinical Pathology D.D.M. Diploma in Dermatological Medicine D.L.O. Diploma in Laryngology and Otology 13 Pathological (or morbid) histology -The histology of diseased tissues. Medicine The art and science of healing diseases by internal remedies. (see also surgery) Neurology The study and treatment of diseases of the central, peripheral, and sympathetic nervous systems, except those which require operative treatment. Neurosurgery The study and treatment, by surgical measures, of diseases of the central, peripheral, and sympathetic nervous systems. Obstetrics The study and treatment of women during pregnancy, labour and the puerperium . - (the period or state of confinement, after labour) Occupational Therapy The teaching of patients useful occupations, such as weaving, printing, knitting, basket-work, etc. for remedial purposes. Odontology The sum of knowledge regarding the teeth; dentistry. Ophthalmology The study and treatment of all diseases of the eye and its supporting structures. Orthopaedics That branch of surgery which deals with the correction of deformities and with the treatment of chronic diseases of the bones, joints, muscles, fasciae, tendons, and their nerve control. Otology The study and treatment of the ear and its diseases. Part-time VisitingStaff: (sometimes erroneously referred to as 'Honoraries') Appointments made by the Hospital Board of specialists to part-time positions (designated in 'tenths' of a 35-hr week) entitling them to beds in the hospital. Bacteriology- The science which treats of bacteria. Bacteriology as a term is becoming replaced by "Microbiology", which more correctly covers the microscopic parasites and the viruses as well as bacteria, Cardiology Cytology - The study and treatment of the cardiovascular system and its diseases. The scientific study of cells, their origin, structure, and functions. Exfoliative cytology is the diagnostic study of cells which have desquamated (become detached) from the external or internal surfaces of the body as a means of detecting cancer, estimating the influence of hormones, and determining sex, etc. Dermatology - The study and treatment of the skin and its diseases. Dietetics - The science and regulation of diet. Endocrinology - The study and treatment of the glands of internal secretion. E.N.T. - The study and treatment of diseases of ear, nose and throat. Gastroenterology- The study and treatment of all diseases and conditions of the digestive system except the anus, rectum and sigmoid colon. Geriatrics - The study.and treatment of diseases of old age. Gyna eco logy - The study and treatment of the diseases of the female generative and urinary organs. Haematology- That branch of biology which treats of the morphology of the blood and blood-forming tissues. Histology- That department of anatomy which deals with the minute structure, composition and function of the tissues. Called also microscopical anatomy. Normal Histology The histology of normal tissues. "I 13 another directly or indirectly. Contagious Disease- One communicable by contact with an individual suffering from it, or'by contact with an object touched by him. Infectious Disease- One due to an infection caused by parasites, such as bacteria, protozoa, or fungi; it may or may not be contagious. Follow-up -. The periodic examination of a patient following disease or injury to determine the progress being made toward complete recovery and normal health and to study end results. In cancer cases "follow-up" can also have a meaning in establishing that the patient is still alive and symptom free with no further need for medical examination. Legal Liability Responsibility . before t law for reasonable care of patients and for reasonable maintenance of facilities for that purpose. Medical Social - Most hospitals employ Medical Social Services Workers for the sociological investigation of a patient and his environment tb ascertain any factors which might have a bearing on the diagnosis, treatment and after care of the patient. Postmortem Examination Autopsy, NecropsyThe scientific examination of the body after death to determine the direct and indirect or contributory causes of death through a study of the physiologic, histologic, and pathologic examination of the organs of the body and their structure. Prognosis- The estimation of the probable course, duration, and outcome of a disease. Department of - For the study of anaesthesia and Anaesthesiaanaesthetics. SuffixMeaningExamples -pexyFixation ofurethropexy, orchidopexy, gastropexy -plastyRepairarthroplasty, oophoroplasty, oesophagoplasty blennorrhagia, metorrhagia, Burst forth -rrhagia menorrhagia herniorrhaphy, perineorrhaphy, Sewing of -rrhaphy colporrhaphy diarrhoea, menorrhoea, Running from -rrhoea pyorrhoea anuria, glycosuria, polyuria Urine -uria 5. Spelling The spelling of medical terms varies in different medical dictionaries. English dictionaries usually use the Greek and Latin spelling,-e.g. haemorrhage, diarrhoea, haemorrhoids, etc. American usage differs from the English in such respects as reversal of P and E, for instance fiber for fibre. The English fibre is strictly correct.Again American spelling Of examples shown above, e.g. hemorrhage, diarrhea, and hemorrhoids show the suppression of a and o in the diphthongs ae and oe. However, in New Zealand in most cases we remain loyal to the original Greek and Latin spelling. Probably the best all-round dictionary for use. in a medical records department is the American Illustrated Medical Dictionary by W.A. Newman Dorland which gives both the American and English spelling of medical terms. The intelligent use of a good medical dictionary by medical records staffs is essential for accurate coding and classification of diseases. 6. Hospital terms The following are some of the terms most commonly used - Normal Nursling- A normal infant born in hospital. Communicable Disease - One whose causative agents may pass or be carried from one person to 'ft 13 Prefix Meaning pyo- Pus Suffix Meaning - a e mi a -coele Blood anaemia, uraemia, leukaemia Hernia rectocoele, hydrocoele, meningocoele Skin neuroclernia, scieroderma, xerodermna Excision gastrectomy, lobectomy, mastectomy Inflammation appendicitis, bronchitis, otitis Science of biology, cardiology, psychology Mass carcinoma, haematoma, lipoma Examining broiichoscopy, gastroscopy, sigmoidoscopy Make opening colostomy,, nephrostomy, into i leo s to my Cut hysterotorny, laparotomy, valvotomy Examples pyoderma, pyogenic, pyenephrosis retro- Behind retroperitoneal, retroposition, retroversion sub- Under subcutaneous, subarachnoid, submaxillary supra- Above suprarenal, suprapubic, supracondylar tachy- Rapid. tachycardia, tachylalia, tachypnoea thronibb- Clot thrombosis, throniboarteritis, thrombophiebitis vaso- Vessel vasoconstriction, vasodilation, vasovagal -derma -ec tomy -itis -010 gy -oma -oscopy - Os t omy -0 to my Examples PrefixMeaningExamples neo-Newneonatal, neoplasm neothalamus nephr-) Kidneynephritis, nephrosclerosis, nephro-) nephrectomy neur- ) neuro-) Nerveneuritis, neurology, ,neuralgia Ophthalm- ) Ophthalmo-) ophthalmia, ophthalmodynia, Eye E ophthalmoplegia ortho- Straightorthodontic, orthopaedic, Correctorthostatic osteo- Boneosteomyelitis, osteotomy, Os t e ama at- or oto- Ear otitis, otologist, otorrhoea pan- All panhysterectomy, panosteitis, panophthalmia para- Beside, Beyond paracentesis, parametriuni, paravertebral pen- Around periapical, periarteritis, pericarditis phieb- ) phiebo-) Vein phlebitis, phlebothrombosis, phlebotomy p n e u mo -. Lungpneumonia, pneumothorax, pneumococcal p- Many or muchpolyarthritis, polycythemia, polyuria post- After orpostpartum, postauricular, Behindpostmenopausal pre- Beforepreauricular, precordial, preeclamptic proct- ) procto-) Rectumproctocoele, proctoscopy, proctospas m pseud- ) pseudo-) False, orpseudoarthrosis, pseudoSpuriouscyesis, pseudomucinous psych- ) psycho-) Of the mind pyel- ) pyelo-) Pelvis orpyelitis, pyelogram, pyeloKidneycystitis psychoneurotic, psychoanalysis, psychopathology 13 PrefixMeaningExamples enter- ) Intestinesenteritis, enterocentesis, entero-) enterostasis erythro- .Rederythroblast, erythrocyte, erythrodermatitis extra-Outside ofextradural, extramural, extrasystole fibro-Fibrefibroma,, fibrositis, fibromyositis gastr- ) Stomachgastritis, gastro-enteritis, gastro-) gastroscopy haem- ) haemo- ) Bloodhaernatoma, haematology, haemato-) haematopoietic he mi One half . hemianopsia, hemiplegic, •hemisphere hepat-) hepatitis, hepatomegaly, hepato- ) Liverhepaticotomy hepatico-) hydro-) hydr- ) I1I Water hydrocarbon, hydrocoele, hydrocephalus hyper- Above, excessive hyperemesis, hypertension, hyperpyrexia hypo- Under, deficient hypochondrium, hypodermic, hypotension infra- Below infraduction, inframarginal, infrapatellar inter- Between .interauricular, interphalangeal, intervertebral intra- Within intra-atrial, intracranial, intra-orbital leuko- White leukocyte, leukodermia, leukoplakia myel- ) myelo-) Marrow Spinal cord myeloma, myeloid, myeloblastoma my- ) my o -) Muscle myoma, myocarditis, myotonia PrefixMeaningExamples bi-) bin-)Two or twicebifocal, binocular, bisacromial bis-) bio-Lifebioloy, biomedicine biosynthesis' brady- Slow bradycardia, bradyplasia, bradypnoea cardio- Heart cardiology, cardiogram, c ardioven al chol- ) chole-) cholo-) Bile cholangitis , cholelithiasis, cholochrome chrom- ) chromo- ) chromato-) Colour chromocyte, chromosome, chromatophobia cr an io - Skull craniotomy, craniomalacia, craniospinal cyano- Blue cyanoderma, cyanotic, cyanuria cysto- Bladder cystitis, cystoscopy, cyanuria cyto- Cell cytobiology, cytogenetic, cytology derma- ) dermato-) Skin dextro- Right dextrocardia, dextrogastria, dextroposition di- Twice Double didactylism, dioxide, diphonia dys- Difficulty Painful dysentery, dymenorrhoea, dyspnoea encephalo- Brain encephalocoele, encephalitis, encephalogram end- ) end o -) Within dermatitis, dermatophytosis, dermatology endocarditis, endocrine, endometrium 13 is called appendicectomy? The "ectomy" terminal of the word is from the Greek to "cut out", or "excise". Another example: tonsillectomy - removal of tonsils. Having once learnt the meaning of the terminal "ectomy", students will know firstly that it applies to an operation and that a patient has had a partial or complete removal of an organ. Stems: 3. " In medical terminology we are concerned mainly with the 'stems' of words, the forms to which inflectional endings, suffixes, and prefixes may be added. By learning the meanings of the important stems, suffixes and prefixes and by analysing medical terms into their component parts, the meanings of many terms become quite obvious, and the study of medical terminology becomes a fascinating subject even for those who have no previous knovtr ledge of Greek or Latin. Let us take the word 'endocarditis' to illustrate this. In this word the stem is 'cardi', from the Greek kardia, heart; the preceding 'endo', the connective form of the Greek endon, within, is the prefix; and 'itis', from a Greek adjectival termination which has come to denote inflammation of. the part indicated by the noun to which it is attached, is the suffix. Hence 'endocarditis' signifies an inflammation of the endocardium (the epithelial lining membrane of the heart). " Prefixes and suffixes: +. The following is a list of prefixes and suffixes PrefixMeaningExamples a- (or an-)Without or notasocial, atresia, anencephalic ab Away from abduct, aberrant, abnormal aden- ) Gland adenitis, adenoma, adenocarcinoma adeno-) 'sq ante- Before antenatal, antepartum, antecubital anti-) ant- ) Against anticoagulant, antihistamine, antiseptic arthrarthro-) Joint arthritis, arthrodesis, arthrolgia 2. The principles of derivation At this stage I could do no better than quote from a very useful little book written by Dr. Ffrangcon Roberts, M.A., M.D., F.F.R., "Medical Terms, Their Origin and Construction". Dr. Roberts in the following lines illustrates so simply the origin of many words in daily use in all our hospitals: "Innumerable names are derived from resemblance to"buildings, animals and plants or their parts, to musical .instruments, articles of adornment, agricultural implements, tools and weapons. In order to illustrate the derivation of names from surrounding objects we may reflect upon domestic life, in GraecoRoman times. An open space for assembly or marketing was called agora (hence agoraphobia, .fear of open spaces). An enclosed space, 'if large, was called claustrum (claustrophobia, fear of being shut in) and, if small, areola •(areolar tissue,i.e... tissue of small spaces). . In a house the vstibuium led into the atrium (to us synonymous with auricle). This may have been so called. because it had a fire in the middle of the room and therefore had blackened walls (ater black). An inner room or bedroom in Greece was called thalmos, a term applied by (4alen .to the':in'ner chambers of the brain. A wall or partition was called phragma (hence diaphragm). The fireplace was called focus, hence the modern meaning - centre of heat and light. A beam (in the roof) .was called trabs, dim. trabeculum. Passages were called fauces. Outside there would be via, road, fornix, arch, stylos, pillar (styloid process). Water was conveyed by a ductus,, .fossa (ditch), fistula(pipe), or cloaca (sewer). A large house would have a fountain, fontana, in the court, hence fontanelle (dim. through French), so called from the pulsation resembing bubbling. Examples of musical instruments are salpinx, 'trumpet, tympanum, drum; of articles of adornment, fib'ula, brooch; of agricultural implements a vomer, ploughshare; of tools, malleus, hammer, incus, anvil; of weapons, ensis, sword, (ensiform, sword like). The above examples by Dr. Roberts are sufficient to show the strong Greek and Latin influence in medical terms. Most laymen are familiar with the word appendix, but few would know it is an appendage of the 'caecum. How many know that appendicitis is an inflammation of the appendix? Many people talk, about having their appendix "out"How many know this operation 'SI Medical Records Practice in New Zealand MEDICAL TERMINOLOGY 1, Introduction 2, The DrinciDles of derivation odo 3 e Stems 1, Prefixes and suffixes 50 Spelling 6, Hospital terms 70 Names of Specialties met with in larger hospitals 8 Abbreviations used in case notes 9, Similar terms 100 Names of diseases 110 Eponymic terms 12 Synonymous terms 17Syndrome 11+, Conclusion 15, References 16, Further reading 16.1 113a&c 16,2 Background Introduction: 1. In an attempt to help the student Medical Records Officer to understand something of the origin and meaning of medical terminology, this chapter must necessarily be kept within reasonable limitsSo I propose to write on the more elementary aspects of the subject to enable the student to gain some knowledge of what his or her work in a Medical Records Department will entail. The newcomer to medical records must remember that most medical terms have been derived directly or indirectly from the Greek and Latin, and we are concerned here mainly with terms of those language origins. International Classification of Diseases, Adapted -.U.S. Department of Health Education and Welfare 7. Further reading 7.1 Basic Loy (Ruth M.) A code of surgical operations Medical Record, Feb. 1956, pp 28-31 7.2 Background MacEachern (M.T.).Medical Records in the Hospital, pp 230-33 U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., Physicians' Record Co., 1937, xvi374 illus. 4. 12 Summary; 5. (i) All hospitals should keep a list of classified operations. The necessity for a hospital to keep aclassified index of operations may be seen from the fact that in Wellington Hospital over a twoyear period ehare been asked to produce records for the following operations: Gastrectomy for malignant and non-malignant condition, appendicectomies for appendicitis with peritonitis,-vascular surgery, adrenalectomjes, to mention but a few. We have also been asked how many operations such as craniotomies etc. have been performed over a given period, (ii) How this list is kept is mentioned elsewhere in this manual as here we are only concerned With the actual coding. While the "Code of Surgical Operations" may seem difficult to apply, in reality the coding process is exactly the same as that applied to the disease from the International Classification of Diseases, (iii) The "Code of Surgical Operations", in spite of some shortcomings, has been in use for operation coding in the Wellington Hospital for fifteen years and is recommended for use in all hospitals as it is well suited to New Zealand conditions. (iv) Operations may be classified alphabetically but this method, while simple, can lead to trouble. (v) "The Code of Surgical Operations" being based on a uniform pattern throughout and also being based on a decimal system allows of ready expansion by additional digits to meet local needs.. The same can be said for I.C.D.A. which has the additional merit of corresponding to the International Classification: of Diseases. Also included are the classification of Radiotherapy and Anaesthetic procedures. Referenced: Hospital Organisation and Management - (Stone) Manual for Medical Record Librarians - Huffman The Code for Surgical Operations - H.M. Stationery Office, London 6. k, Operation details on MS18 statistical cards Operations should always be entered .on the MS18 at the same time as the diagnosis. As far as possible the use of the term Laparotomy should be avoided if other surgery was performed at the same'time An example of this has been the recording of the term Liaparotomy where the diagnosis was recorded as ectopic pregnancy. On reading the operation record we find the procedure given as Laparotomy and removal of ectopic pregnancy. It is therefore necessary to ensure that the surgery carried out is recorded on the case notes and also on the MS18 card with , certain exceptions as below. As in accordance with the Hospital .Statistioe. Handbook, certain terms are not to be marked as operations it has been found that there is no point in coding these as operations. The list. includes 1. Any term ending in -oscopy 2 4 Laparotomy (see above) 3. Episiotomy k, Diagnostic procedures e.g. biopsy, lumbar punctures 5. Washouts and aspirations 6. Insertion Radium 7, E.U.AO 8. X-ra y and dee p x-ray 9. Exploration sinuses 10. Application of plaster 11, Injections 12, Dressing burns 13. Dilatation strictures 14. Orthopaedic manipulations (other than open fractures and elevation of fractures) The operation of removal of Ts and As need not be coded for the operation index as it will be shown in the disease index as 510,1 with tonsillectomy or 510.0 without tonsillectomy. When in doubt about any coding, always ask for advice from the Registrar or the surgeon who performed the operation. AO "4' 12 40Repair of hernia +O.O Repair of inguina]. hernia except recurrent 4001 Repair of recurrent inguinal hernia 402 Repair of femoral hernia except recurrent 4o. 3 Repair of recurrent femoral henia '+0.1+ Repair of epigastric hernia 4o. 5 Repair of ventral or inc . isional hernia 1+0.6 Repair of, umbilical hernia 4o.7 Repair of diaphragmatic hernia, abdominal approach 1+0.8 Repair of diaphragmatic hernia, thoracic approach Other hernia repair The alphabetical index is very compléteandit . js interesting to note that no eponymic terms are used. Another interesting feature, and in fact a ',. very desirable feature, is the proyision of inclusion and exclusion notes as in the International Classification of Diseases.An example of these notes is the operation enteréctorny, Code. 4603.. the inclusion and exclusion notes inthe Tabular List reading Enterectomy1+6.3 includes:Caecectomy Duodenectomy Enterectomy, N.O.S. Ilectomy. etc. excludes:Colectomy (1+6.1+) Diverticulectomy (1+6.2) Gastroduodenectomy (44,2) etc. This code of operations, following closely 'along the lines of the International Classification of Diseases, has much to commend it. The code will be found in two volumes of the International Classification of Diseases, Adapted, Volume 1. Tabular List, and Volume 20 Alphabetical index, published by the United States Department of Health Education and Welfare, 1962, 1s example, skin graft 942, but if the skin graft is after the removal of a breast it is coded to 385. In fact, thea Index should be consulted always until the coder is wefl . con-versant with the code numbers. The reason for this is that there are no inclusion or exclusion notes as given in some sub-titles of the International Classification of Diseases. A further example of the necessity of checking the Index is the coding of the operatior Dilatation and Curettage (D. & C.); there are two codes for-this procedure as will be seen from the Index which reads Dilation: Cervix: Obstetrical.789 non-obstetrical - 732 Another example is the operation of-Hysterectomy: Hysterectomy: abdominal- 722 partial.- 721 radical- 723 with ealpingo-oophorectomy - 721 In brief, to code operations it is simply a matter of looking up the Index to get the number making sure that the number chosen fits in with the operation, as shown in the above examples. It is not recommended that an operation code number be recorded on a list as a means of remembering a code number as this often leads to a case of "familiarity breeding contempt". It will be found that once the coder becomes acquainted with the coding manual, code numbers will be readily remembered but it is always a good policy to consult Parts 2 and 3 of the manual-as described above.. 3'International Classification of Diseases, Adapted' (I.c.D.AJ Although no practical application of this code has been made by the writer, it appears tohave some advantages, over the Code of Surgical Operations but instead of using three digit categories, • two •digit system is used with the addition, where necessary, of • decimal point, e.g. operation for a repair of hernia is coded as ko with the following sub-divisions I,z 12 Trendelenberg ' (varicose, vein) Ramstedt'(correction of'congenital pyloric stenosis) Wertheim(radical hysterectomy). Bassjnj. (radical cure o' inuinal hernia.) Gilliam,(ventro-suspension of uterus) Suffixes: 2.3. Some examples of suffixes indicating surgical procedure which may be of value 'when coding are: -ceitesis - a punctuze or aspiration, a "pricking", e.g. abdomino centesis - puncture of the abdominal cavity for aspiration of fluid.. -desis - a fusion or stabilisation - arthrodesis -. fusion of a joint by removing the articulate surface and securing bony union. -ectomy - excision, remove or cutting out, e.g.appendicectomy, removal or appendix (code k'+i), nephrectomy, removal of kidney (code 605),. -lysis - -, st omy - -otomy - a cutting or an incision. Nephrotomy - incision into the kidney. -plasty - a forming or repair ,f plastic surgery, e.g. Phinoplasty - plastic operation on nose (code 217). -rrhaphy - a stitching or suturing, e. g. Herniorrhaphy suture repair of hernia. a loosening or freeing - Tenblysis - freeing of adhesion of tendon (code 869) denotes the making of a mouth e.g.'proctostomy, the making of an artificial opening in the rectum. Coding of operations: ,2.4. Until certain where a' given operation is coded in the Tabular List, (Part 2) it is advisable to refer to the Index (Part 3) of the "Code of Surgical Operations" first and then to look in the Tabular list to get an idea of the contents of each section and its layout. Failure to consult the Index first may lead to the wrong code being given to the operation as, for 'SI 002. Leucotomy Lobotomy T opec to my Tractotomy: medulla oblongata mesencephalon 2. 930 Incision and Drainage, Superficial Exploration: sinus tract wound (operative) Incision (and drainage): abscess N.O.S. skin boil carbuncle cellulitis cyst: N. 0.S. pilonidal skin gangrene of skin scar (skin) ulcer: N.O.S. skin unspecified In each of these examples the use of the parentheses ( ) and colons (:) and of the term N.O.S. (not otherwise specified) should be noted. These have the same meaning and use as in-the International Classification of Diseases. 2.2 Eponymic terms With some exceptions these have been avoided but those included are provided for in the Index. Some examples of eponymic terms used in the code are: Biliroth(partial gastrectomy) Caldwell Luc(Antrostomy) Fothergill(correction of uterine prolapse) Keller(correction of hallux valgus) 12 9. 10. 1+00 - 599 Gastro-Intestinal and Abdominal Surgery Genito-Urinary Surgery 600 - 699 Gynaecological Operations 11, Obstetric Operations 12. Orthopaedic Surgery 760 - 799 800 - 899 13. Operations on Peripheral Blood Vessels and Lymphatic System 900 - 929 14. Operations on Skin and Subcutaneous Tisues 930 - 91+9 Other Surgical Procedures 950 - 999 8, 15. 700 - 759 These fifteen main sections comprise Part I -List of three digit categories of the code, and each main section is further divided into a number of groups or sub-groups as necessary to give more precision to the site, as fOr example 1. Neurosurgery (001 - 01+9) which is divided into: Brain and Cerebral Meninges (001 - 019) Spinal Cord and Spinal Meninges (020 - 029) Peripheral Nerves and Sympathetic System '(00 - 01+9) This order of arrangement of the three figures within each group is broadly: Incision, Drainage, Local excision, Plastic operation and other operations. The Tabular list of Inclusions finds each section broken down still further as will be seen from the following examples: 1. NEUROSURGERY (001 - 01+9) Brain and Cerebral Meninges (001 - 019) 001. Craniotomy Craniéctomy Craniotomy Decompression: Brain Cranial Exploration of Cranium Trephinatioñ (cranial) 171 Another classification of operations has been compiled in the United States. This is an adapted version of the International Classification of Diseases as at present used in New Zealand and its title is "International Classification of Diseases, Adapted" orAs well as diseases, it contains a tabular list of operations in Volume I and in an index in Volume 2. The fact that it can be used in conjunction with the International Classification of Diseases makes it worthy of consideration for hospital classification and operation coding. It is further described below, 2. 'Code of Surgical Operations' Manual This Code of Surgical Operations was first issued in a draft form in 1950 and prepared for circulation and trial in certain hospitals and a number of statistical offices in the United Kingdom. The draft code was based on "The Basic Diagnostic Manual of Diseases and Injuries" prepared for use by the Medical Services of the United States Armed Forces. Later the code was issued for general use by the General Register Office after suggestions. and improvements from various sources had been included. This Manual has been in use in Wellington Hospital since 1952 and has proved successful for the purpose of classifying operations. It is simple to use and has the advantage of being built on a uniform pattern throughout, and also, being based on a decimal system, it allows of ready expansion by additional digits to meet local, needs. 2.1 The structure of the operation code The operation code is referred to the two axes of site and operative procedure and employs a three figure classification. It is divided into 15 main sections according to the broad anatomical site of the operation or the surgical specialty, to each of which is allotted a series of numbers. These 15 main sections and code numbers are code 001 - 049 1, Neurosurgery 070 - 099 2. Operations on Endocrine System 100 - 199 3. Ophthalmic Operations 200 - 24-9 . Operations on Ear, Nose, Throat 5. 6. 7. Operations on Buccal Cavity and Oesophagus 250 - 299 Thoracic Surgery 300 - 379 380 - 399 Operations on Breast fly 12 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand THE CLASSIFICATION OF OPERATIONS 1. Introduction 2, 'Code of Surgical Operations' Manual 2.1 The structure of the operation code 2.2 Eponymic terms 2.3 Suffixes 2.4 Coding of operations 3.International Classification of Diseases, Adapted (I.C.D.A.) 1, Operation details on MS18 statistical cards 5. 6, 7. Summary References Further reading 7.1 Basic 7,2 Background Introduction: 1. As with diseases it is frequently necessary for Medical Records staff to produce case notes for research or study purposes on different types of operations performed. Two methods are open to produce such records:- (1) By referring to the Operation Register kept in the theatre, or, .(2) by referring to the classified Index of operations kept in the Medical Records department. This can be kept either on a yearly or perpetual basis. Except perhaps in smaller hospitals the first method would prove to be an extremely inefficient way of doing such a task and in the case of a large hospital practically a hopeless one. The classification of operations can be carried out in two ways, one by classifying the operation alphabetically and the other by using a classification manual similar to the International Classification of Diseases. Whilst the first method would operate satisfactorily for a small hospital, it is not one to be recommended for general use as there are too many pitfalls and classification can be somewhat perplexing at times especially with eponymic terms. An ideal classification is one which follows close to the International Classification of Diseases, and this classification will be found in the manual "The Code of Surgical Operations" published by H.M. Stationery Office, London. 117 MacEachern (M.T.) Medical Records in the Hospital, pp 209-15 U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., Physicians' Record Co., 1 937, xvi + 371+ illus. Morgan (J.H.) Medical Records Departments: the Cardiff Royal Infirmary Medical Record, April 1951, pp 90 - 5 Background: 52 liv Doran (M.T.) The need for research in Medical Recording methods 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 129-1+1 Expert Committee on Health Statistics 8th Report, W.H.O. Technical Report Series, No. 261 Geneva, W.H.0., 1963, 31+ pp 'Hospital Records Systems in relation to the Statistical Classification of Diseases treated in Public Hospitals' N.Z. Hospital, Sept. 1948, pp 23-9 Kurtz (D.L.) Examples of research in Medical Recording methods 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 11+3-57 Lincoln (Helen B.) Disease classification for diagnostic indexing 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 53-7 Report of a Committee on Medical Records in N.S.W. Hospitals N.S.W. Hosps. Commn0 1960, 54 pp (v) Until certain where a given disease is coded in the International Classification first refer to the Alphabetical Index. As one becomes familiar with the Classification, the Alphabetical Index will be used less frequently but it is not advisable to guess where a specified condition will be classified. (vi) Look upon the Index only as a key to the 'Tabular List. The greatest help in successful coding is given by the inclusion and exclusion notes which are to be found under the titles in the Tabular List. (vii) Code suspected diagnoses as if they were certain. (viii) Never make up a list of code numbers to be memorised or to refer to. (ix) Coding should only be done when a final diagnosis is. known. k.References International Classification of Diseases Volumes 1 and 2 Manual for Medical Records Librarians - Huffman Hospital Organisation and Management - Stone Hospital Statistics Handbook - N.Z. Health Department 5. Further reading 5.1 Basic Brown (R.J.) Disease classification (Dunn, Baehr, Felton & Winfield) Principles of selection and use of morbidity and mortality classification 1st mt. Congress Report pp 59-74•. 2nd mt. Congress Report pp 8Li_112 I.C,D.A: answers to queries on Medical Record News,. August 1964, pp 162-4 and subsequent issues Ingram (Prof. J.TJ Clinical approach to the nomenclature and classification of diseases 3rJ. mt. Congress Report pp 274-84 '75- 11 Read the inclusion as well as the exclusion notes under each number. As an example of this take the coding of Keratitis 371+, which includes several types but excludes many others. If one condition is symptomatic of another then the rule is to code the underlying cause e.g. a diagnosis of retention of urine caused by prostatic hypertrophy - code prostatic hypertrophy and disregard retention of urine. Further rules for coding will be found on pages 16 and of the Hospitals Statistics Handbook. 17 The coding or classification of diseases cn be a frustrating or often perplexing business, and correct coding calls for well written records, correct diagnoses and intelligent use of the International Classification of Diseases. For new or strange diseases, it is advisable to refer such a diagnosis back to the initiating medical officer for a suggested code number. It is important that MS18 statistical cards are carefully handled since damage will prevent them going through the IBM machine. This is referred to in the Hospital Statistics Handbook (page 19). Summary: (i) An accurate study of disease treated in a hospital cannot be made unless a classification of diseases is carried out. Such classification or coding can be carried out in all hospitals by using the International Classification of Diseases. (ii) Medical Records staff should not diagnose. Never use provisional diagnosis when a final diagnosis is available. (iii) (iv) 17t Avoid the use of incomplete or vague terms. The numerous notes and cross references in the Tabular List of Inclusions and the four digit sub-categories in Volume 1 help the coder to understand the general principles and methods of classification underlying the code. 3. Neuritis- state nerves involved and cause, e.g. alcoholism. Oesophageal stricture - state cause if known and whether acquired or congenital. Salpingitis - state whether acute, chronic, tuberculous, whether followiig abortion or childbirth. Aneurysm - state whether aortic, arterial, arteriovenous, or cardiac, whether syphilitic or not. Arthritis - state whether acute, pyogenic, acute infective, non-pyogenic, rheumatoid arthritis or osteo-arthritis etc. Bright's Disease- state whether acute, subacute, chronic nephritis and cause if known. If arising during pregnancy this fact must be noted, Cellulitis- state cause if known and whether associated with lymphangitis. Colic- state whether intestinal, biliary or renal. Dementia.- this term should not be.used unqualified when coding. State the disease or type of dementia e.g. epileptic, praecon, presenile, senile etc. Eclampsia - when did fit occur? e.g. before onset of labour, during labour, or after delivery. Glioma - state site, histology if known, and whether benign or malignant, if unknown. then state this fact. 2.9 General When looking through both volumes of the International Classification, the use of abbreviations, symbols and parentheses along with age abbreviations, must be understood and references to these will be found in the introductions to Volumes 1 and 2. When coding look consistently in the Index under the disease or condition and not the site, ri 11 For coding poisonings by a drug under a proprietary name, it is good policy to ask at the Pharmacy the nature of the drug. Late effects of injury, poisonings and violence are brought together under E 960 - 965 where the late effect is one year or more after recurrence. The date of accident should always be shown. Always state as fully as possible how and where the accident occurred as the information recorded on MS18 statistical cards is the principle source for accident statistics in New Zealand. If the place or cause is not known, use the term "N.O.S." Coding of adverse reactions to injections, infusions etc: 2.7. Code numbers for adverse reactions along with inclusion and exclusion notes will be found on pages 33 0 -333, Volume 1. Incomplete diagnoses or terms: 2.8. A list of incomplete terms or diagnoses appears on page 20 of the Hospitals Statistics Handbook. The additional information needed to code the term satisfactorily will be found' to the right of each term. A few more incomplete or undesirable terms are given below together with further information required to .give a satisfactory code number Abortion- was it with sepsis? Was it therapeutic, incomplete, complete or threatened? Anaemia- state type if known; if not known the diagnosis to be coded should read Anaemia N.O.S. (not otherwise specified) Hepatitis- state whether infective, serum or associated with pregnancy. Laryngitis- state whether acute or chronic (note acute laryngitis is coded 474, chronic laryngitis is coded 516). State also if due to infection e.g. syphilitic or tuberculous etc. Leukaemia- state type e.g. lymphocytic, myeloid, monocytic. 172 Falls (accidental) Other accidents Complications due to non-the rape utic medical and surgical procedures Therapeutic misadventures and late complications of therapeutic procedures Late effects of poLsonings and injury Suicide and self inflicted injury Homicidal and injury purposely inflicted by other persons Injury from war operations E 900 - 904 E 910 - 936 E 9+0 - 946 E 950 - 959 E96O - 965 E 97 0 - 979 E 980 - 985 E 99 0 - 999 Before actual coding is commenced, it is again necessary to read through the section on 'E' coding to obtain a general background and the layout. An alphabetical index is given in Volume 2. on pages 4.70-510 plus an alphabetical index to place of occurrence of nontransport accidents on pages 511-512. The place of occurrence should be shown by the fourth digit for injuries etc. coded under numbers E 870 - 936. The fourth digit classification will be found on pages 264-266 Volume 1 as well as in Volume 2 as above. Examples of the 'E' Code using 4th digit Burnt in fireat homeE 916.0 Bitten by dogat farm926.1 Cave in of earthquarry910.2. Caught hand in machineryat factory912.3 Fall from "jungle jim"school ground902.4 Fall on footpathstreet903.5 Cut hand with knife while cutting meatbutcher's shop913.6 Fall same levelhospital903.7. Exposure to coldon mountain9328 For all other I E I code numbers use X e.g. E 979X. For example:suicide, by jumping in front of a train E 979X.. For all poisoning cases the coding must be qualified by the term accidental or suicidal as these are different codes: e.g. Nembutal poisoningAccidentalE 871 Nembutal poisoningSuicidalE 970 171 11 In coding fractures, a fracture dislocation should be coded to the bone involved in the fracture. Occasionally when cQding orthopaedic diagnoses, the term fracture of condyle, fracture of ramus etc. is used. These terms merely indicate the portion of the bone fractured and are not the names of the bones involved. When coding pathological or spontaneous fractures it should be remembered that they must be coded to the condition causing the fracture (e.g. metastase.s of neoplasm, multiple myeloma etc.) The following example is taken from the Hospital Statistics Handbook, page 16: A patient with osteitis deformans fractures his femur in a fall at home. Disease A is coded 73 1 X (osteitis deformans) Disease B is coded N821X along with the appropriate accident code. When looking up a single fracture in the Index, make sure that it is a single fracture site and not 'fractures multiple'. The instructions at the beginning of each chapter and the inclusion and exclusion notes in the Tabular List are of particular importance when using the 'N' code. The 'H' Code - accidents, poisonings and violence: 2.6. This section of the International Classification has a dual classification according to the external cause (E) and to the nature of the injury (N). When both classifications are employed simultaneously for primary cause tabulation, each case must be included in both lists, numbers E 800 - E899 and N800 - 999, e.g. a patient admitted with a fractured neck of femur sustained by being knocked off a pedal cycle by motor vehicle would be coded and recorded Fracture neck femurN 820x Knocked off pedal cycle by motor vehicleH 813X Here again when using the 'H' code, it is necessary to read and apply the inclusion and exclusion notes and also the definitions and examples given on pages 2+3 - 250, Volume 1. Transport accidents are coded by numbers E 800 - 866 Accidental poisonings by solid and liquid substances E 870 - 888 Accidental poisonings by gases and vapours H 8 90 - 895 lb so the required code number for the coding of a diagnosis influenza with pneumonia is +80. The code for chronic bronchitis with emphysema follows the same way: Bronchitis chronic502,1 with emphysema 502.0, which is the required 'number In short, when coding multiple diagnoses look up the index to see if they are coupled together as in the above examples. In the section Diseases of Early Infancy, code numbers 760each category is divided into two sub-categories designated .0 without mention of immaturity and .5 with mention of immaturity. 776, 2.5 Coding of fractures, injuries and poisonings (the 'N' code). The most difficult section of coding is probably. this section dealing with accidents. The 'N' code is quite comprehensive and as it cannot be memorised as easily as the remainder of the. classification, there is, perhaps, a greater tendency to. guess at the wanted number. . Code numbers for fractures, injuries and poisonings.are prefixed by the letter 'N' e.g. N800X N931+X etc. and :will be found. in the alphabetical portion of the term describing the type of injury e.g. fracture appears under F with the codenumbèrsfor the various anatomical sites and bones fractured. As an example:. Fracture of hip N820X.. Similarly "wound open" appears under 'W' followed by a list of anatomical sites. To code such diagnoses as cut finger, laceration leg, etc. the coder will be directed in the alphabetical index as follows: "cut (external), see also wound open", "laceration, see also wound open" Where multiple sites of injury are to be coded, the word "with" indicates involvement of both sites. The word "and" in all these titles indicates that either one or both sites are involved e.g. N813X fracture of radius and ulna, N823X fracture of tibia and fibula, fracture nose, with either bone, N802X etc. '11 11 An undetermined primary site can be coded to 199.2 and codes for metastatic sites can be located under 199 by referring to the amendment which will be found on page 96, Volume 1 and page 22 of the Hospit'al Statistics Handbook. It should be noted that the fourth digit should not be used for coding on statistical cards sent to the Health Department, but can be used for local needs if necessary.A suspected neoplasm ruled out or unconfirmed should be coded to 793.1. Obstetrics: 2.3. A comprehensive arrangement for disease that frequently complicates pregnancy, childbirth and the puerperium is listed under "pregnancy, delivery and puerperal". The diagnoses under these terms are listed also under the disease name with codes for both those of puerperal and those of non-puerperal origin. All uncomplicated deliveries are coded to 660.0 (660.5 if caesarean section). This number should not be used where a complication covered by code numbers 6 7 0 -678 exists, A caesarean section would be coded by the addition of the fourth digit .5 to the code number e.g a diagnosis of delivery complicated by placenta praevia and caesarean section would be coded to 670.5; delivery complicated by uterine inertia and a caesarean section performed would be coded 675.5, etc. New born infants delivered in hospital would be included in the code Y20-Y29 e.g. normal nursling, Y20. These code numbers are, however, for internal hospital use only. As far as the MSI8 statistical cards are concerned the International Classification of Diseases ends at y18. Other notes for coding obstetric diagnoses will be found in Hospital Statistics Handbook, page 17. Coding of combination terms: 2.4. In the alphabetical index will be found a considerable number of categories in the classification which include a combination of two closely related diseases, or a disease with frequent complications such as influenza with pneumonia, chronic bronchitis with emphysema etc. The alphabetical index records these codenumbers as: Influenza 481 with pneumonia (all forms) 480 ibS (3) Looking up T for Tonsillitis, chronic, this leads us to the choice of two code numbers 510.0 and 510.1. Looking up 510.0 in Volume 1 we note that this reads "without mention of tonsillectomy or adenoidectomy" and 510,1 reads "with tonsillectomy and adenoidectomy", as in this case. 510,1 is therefore the code number. (4) To code perforated gastric ulcer we look up U - ulcer not under perforation or gastric (see note in (2) above) and under, ulcer 'gastric we find the code 540 which is sub-divided. .0 without perforation and .1 with perforation.' In this case the code number we require is 540610 Other examples of coding which require reference to inclusions and exclusions will be found in many sections of Volume 1 and these must be read and applied'. From the foregoing examples it will be noted that when using the index look under the disease or condition and' not the site e.g. to code anal fistula look under fistula, tuberculosis of hip, look under tuberculosis and chronic bronchitis, look up bronchitis and not chronic, 2.1 Eponymic terms These will be found listed under "disease" followed by the name of the person after whom the disease is named, e.g. Bright's Disease (chronic nephritis) will be found under disease, Bright's, similarly, for Pott's Disease etc. 2.2 Coding of neoplasms While terms such as carcinoma, sarcoma, and epithelioma appear in their own alphabetical places in the index along , with their code numbers, it will be noted there is an instruction "see Neoplasm, malignant", where the complete listing of anatomical sites appears with the code numbers. Benign tumours are indexed in the same way except that they have the reference "see also neoplasm, benign". Sites are listed alphabetically with the appropriate code numbers shown against them in , three columns, depending on whether the neoplasm is malignant, benign or unspecified on pages 75 - 78 1 Volume 1. 1•1 which, before a code number is applied, must be stated whether associated with childbirth or not. The code number for breast abscess is 621.0 but if associated with childbirth its code number becomes 689. An example of the application of the International Classification to coding may be shown as follows. Suppose we are to code the following diagnoses from the medical record (1) Right Inguinal Hernia (2) Acute Appendicitis (3) Chronic Tonsillitis (with Tonsillectomy) (k) Perforated Gastric Ulcer these being the final and correct diagnoses. (1) Turn up the alphabetical index, Volume 2, and under "H" we find hernia and this refers us to the number 560 in the tabular list Volume 1. We find that 560 is divided up into five sub-divisions: .0 (inguinal .1 (femoral), .2 (umbilical), .3 (ventral) and .+ (other specified site). As the hernia we are to code is an inguinal type and there is no mention of gangrene., incarceration, obstruction or strangulation, then the code number is 560,0. If, on the other hand, the diagnosis to be coded was strangulated inguinal hernia, then the code number would be 561,0 as obtained from looking up the alphabetical index and referring to the note given on page 214 "Code as below all hernia with mention of gangrene, incarceration, irreducability, obstruction or strangulation". (2) Turning up the alphabetical index under "A" we find appendicitis which refers us to the code 550 in the tabular list Volume 1, This code number is sub-divided into .0 (without mention of peritonitis) and .1 (with peritonitis). As the term peritonitis is not included in the diagnosis to be coded, the requisite code number is 550.0. If, however, the recorded diagnosis was recorded as appendicitis with peritonitis, the code would be 550,1. Chronic appendicitiswould be 552 but the word "chronic" would have to be included in the diagnosis. Note:- If instead of looking up 'appendicitis' we looked for acute - this would read "see condition" which means that the disease name is to be looked up rather than the adjectival modifier (see note On page xiii, in the introduction to Volume 2, Alphabetical Index), 16 The structure of the International Classification is described in chapter 10 and its relatively simple numerical code of three digits which cover the major categories or titles, with four digit sub-divisions in some instances to permit classification of greater detail, make it simple to use, provided that the Index, (Volume 2), is used in conjunction with the , main volume - Volume 1,'and that the inclusion and exclisionnotes are understood and applied. 2.The application of the International Classification to disease coding Before the manual is applied to disease coding it is advisable and necessary to read the introduction to both volumes. In Volume 1 will be found the general principles of, classification, the difference between a nomenclature and a classification, a general description of the manual, together with certain aspects of classification. Also to be noted in Volume 1, page 44, is a note on the use of parentheses, colons, etc. This is of particular importance and should be read 'and understood before disease coding is attempted. The introduction to Volume 2 (Alphabetical Index) is particularly important as it contains the structure and use of the alphabetical index, criteria for assigning a given code, number, how to use the index to find code numbers, adjectival forms and modifiers, eponyms, the indexing of combination terms and once again the special use of parentheses. Also of importance in the introduction to Volume 2, are the details of abbreviations, symbols and other devices used in the Index. In order to carry out coding itis necessary that all the' above be understood which will lead to both volumes of'the Classification being used efficiently and will make the location of code numbers simpler. Before actually coding a disease it is important that the diagnosis must be final and complete e.g. the diagnosis on the notes may read abdominal pain and an appendicectomy performed, the pathological report reading acute appendicitis. In such cases the matter should be brought to the notice of the appropriate Registrar or Surgeon in a diplomatic manner. In practice, experienced Medical Records staff will be trusted by medical staff to pick up and code correctly such inconsistencies but they must always be sure that what they are doing is within their competence. In such a case code acute appendicitis and disregard abdominal pain. Another example of an incomplete diagnosis is breast abscess 16 11 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand THE CLASSIFICATION OF DISEASES 1.Introduction 2,The application of the International Classification to disease coding 2.1 Eponymic terms 2,2 Coding of neoplasms 2,3 Obstetrics 2.k Coding of combination terms 2.5. Coding of fractures, injuries and poisonings (the 'N' code) 2.6 The 'E' 1 code - accidents, poisonings and violence 2.7 Coding of adverse reactions to injections, LnIusions etc. 2,8 Incomplete diagnoses or terms 2,9 General 30Summary k,References 5 °Further reading 5.1 Basic 5.2 Background Introduction; 1. In order that Medical Records departments may readily, be able to produce information about diseases treated in a hospital, it is necessary that a disease index be kept. This index, or as it is sometimes called, the Classified Index of Diseases, is described in chapter 6 of the manual and here we are only concerned with the classification or coding of diseases so that they may be entered in the correct section of this Index or Register. There are many ways of classifying diseases and for hospital purposes the most efficient classification is one which permits the location of a maximum number of pertinent records with the review of the least number. A classification system for a disease index should anticipate most requests for patients' records in all hospitals and the present classification manual in use in all public hospitals in New. Zealand, "The International Classification of Diseases, Injuries and Causes of Death", together with the Alphabetical Index, suits the purpose admirably, .'Efficiency in hospital indexing of the coding systems of the International Statistical Classification and Standard Nomenclature.. report of a collaborative study Jnl AANRL, June 1959, pp 95-11, 129 Expert Committee on Health Statistics. 8th Report, W.H.O Technical Report Series* No. 261 Geneva, W.H.O., 19631 31+ pp International Study Project 1: 2nd mt. Congress Report., Diagnostic Indexes andpp 59-83 Classifications Kline (Dr. H.M.) World Health Problems and Programs 2nd mt. Congress Report, pp-35-46 Olsen (F.E.) Use of the International Classification of Diseases for reporting hospital morbidity Jnl AAMRL, Feb. 1960, pp 11-159 37 Report of a Committee on Medical Records in N.S.W. Hospitals N.S.W. Hospitals Commn., 1960, 54 pp. ( 163 10 Moriyama (Iwao M.) The International Classification of Diseases4th mt. Congress Report, pp 130-37 Rolleston H.D. "The classification and nomenclature of diseases with remarks on diseases due to treatment", Lancet, May 22, 1 9 0 9, pp 1437-43 Sutherland I. "John Graunt: A tercentenary tribute" Journal of the Royal Statistical Society - Series A. Vol. 126. Part 4 pp 537-56 Further reading: Basic: 9.1. Hospital Statistics Handbook Wellington, Medibal Statistics Branch, Department of Health ( 1 963) 36 Pp Huffman (Edna K.) Manual for Medical Record Librarians PP 266-9, ("Grouping by International statistical classification number" under "Indexing Procedures), PP 319- 24 "International statistical classification of diseases, injuries and causes of death" under "Collection of statistical data") - U.S.A., Berwyn, Ill,, Physicians Record Co., 1959, xxx + 604, illus. Knight (J.) The InternationalMedical Record, Feb. 1956,. Statistical Classification ofPP 25-28 Diseases and its uses in diagnostic indices Background: 9.2. Cakrtova (Dr. M.) The value of medical records to the World Health Organisation Mot 3rd mt. Congress Report, Pp 29-39 6. Revisions The International Classification of Diseases is revised every ten years.The revision is undertaken by the World Health Organ-. isation which calls together committees of experts for this purpose. To give an illustration, there was a certain amount of dissatisfaction among psychiatrists with that section i the International Classification of Diseases dealing with mental disorders. A committee of experts , from several countries was appointed under the chairmanship of a leading authority. Alternative classifications were collected and studied. From these deliberations the better classifications were selected and distributed to member nations for comment. The comments were considered by the committee and a final classification of mental disorders agreed upon. 7. Additions and amendments From time to time it becomes necessary to accommodate newly recognised conditions within the framework of the International Classification of Diseases. Sometimes the question originates from a Medical Records Officer, sometimes the query arises in the Health Statistics Centre. It is the usual practice to consult such references and authorities that are available and then to acquaint hospitals with the decision of what code number should be used to classify the new condition. This is perhaps a suitable place to mention that, if in retrospect it appears that more appropriate code numbers could have been selected than those to which some of these new conditions were allotted in the past, it should be remembered that the circumstances under which the decisions were made were not ideal.When new diagnostic terms first find their way into medical records there is often very little known about the terms. Sometimes an article in a journal is the sole reference. Moreover, at this stage there is frequently conflicting evidence about etiology. If the findings of subsequent research were available at the time the decision must be made then the task would be much easier. 8. References International Classification of Diseases (1955 Revision) Volume 1 pp ix - xviii I',' 10 indexing diseases and injuries than that provided for in the Classification, certain titles have been expanded within the' framework of the existing Classification so that it is possible to show finer shades of difference. The need to make such modifications, however, has been infrequent. In North America the Standard Nomenclature of Operations and Diseases is used in many hospitals to classify medical records. Its capacity for showing detail seems to be both a strength and a weakness because so much of its usefulness depends upon the skill of those who use it. It has been reported that so much time must be spent in training staff in the use of the nomenclature that medical records systems have been. in danger of breaking down completely when confronted by unexpected changes in staff. As a consequence many hospitals have now turned to the International Classification of Diseases for indexing medical records on the grounds that although the Classification might not be so fine an instrument as the Nomenclature it is at least easier to-keep it operating. Abbreviated lists: 5. In Volume 1 of the International Classification of Diseases. three special tabulation lists are shown which are useful for preparing special summaries. List A. is known as the "Intermediate" list and consists of 150 titles. It has been designed for both morbidity and mortality tabulations. List B. is the "Abbreviated list of 50 causes and is for mortality tabulations. List C. is the "Special" list of 50 titles for both morbidity and social security purposes. The three figure • code numbers that have been assigned to each title in these three lists are specified, so it is an easy matter to decide which of these tabulations is the more appropriate for any particular purpose. In addition to special tabulations, the list A has been used in some hospitals in New Zealand as a basis for the disease index. The hospitals concerned have found that although there was no need to have an elaborate or very detailed index there was a need to have some means of quickly locating medical records when information about certain disease groups was required. List A. can easily be modified to meet the needs of such hospitals. 160 3.2 Statistical In New Zealand the International Classification of Diseases is used by the Social Security Department, the Department of Statistics, and the Armed Services, as well as by the Department of Health. The prime advantage of using the Classification i of course that it enables comparisons to be made with a precision which would be otherwise lacking. If one classification was used to code all the deaths registered at the Registrar-General's Office, and another to code admissions to public hospitals, and a third for admissions to mental hospital--, little imagination is necessary to visualise the complications that would accompany attempts to get the national picture of conditions such as alcoholism, epilepsy or psychotic illness. In spite of this it is not uncommon to hear pleas for the production of classifications tailored to meet the particular needs of different disciplines. For example, the psychiatrist finds that although most of the statistical headings with which he is concerned are grouped together in one section of the Classification he must venture out of this group of code numbers everytime he diagnoses a case of psychosis due to syphilis or following encephalitis or of puerperal origin. Similarly, the researcher in cause of death statistics finds little interest in statistical headings such as those relating to the musculo-skeletal system or to fractures and open wounds or to symptoms. It is only when it is vital to have information about diseases as a whole that the necessity of using a standardised classification is fully realised. Apart from death, public hospital and mental hospital statistics the International Classification of Diseases is used to classify post mortem reports, causes of stillbirth and cancer statistics0 k.Differences between a classification and a nomenclature The prime aim of a classification is to bring together like conditions.The scope and limits of each group of like conditions are known and are precisely defined. On the other hand the function of a nomenclature is to list every single known variety. A nomenclature must of necessity be constantly growing in size as each newly recognised conditior is added and new code numbers allotted. In New Zealand the International Classification of Diseases is in general use. The Classification meets the needs of the hospital service very well. In a few hospitals where it was felt that there was need to have a more detailed method of cross- 1',F9 10 contain ill-defined conditions and conditions infrequently reported. To some extent the "other and unspecified" titles is a "wash-up" group. To many of the titles and sub-titles included in the list notes have been added for the guidance of the coder. These notes define the scope of the particular heading and direct the coder to other titles which might be more appropriate for a particular case. Uses of the International Classification of Diseases: 3. The two main uses of the International Classification of Disease.s that concern us here are disease indexing and statistical. Disease indexing: 3.1. The purpose of disease indexing is to have a means of readily locating all the cases of a particular disease. It is important that all the cases of that disease., no matter by what terms they are at times described, should be included under the one heading and not distributed by chance among several headings.For instance, if we want to trace all the cases of measles we do not have to look for cases under each of the three headings, morbilli, rubeola and measles. By using a classification we know that all cases of measles, no matter which of these three diagnoses may have been chosen, will have been indexed under a particular heading and that we do not need to be concerned about the possibility that some cases of measles could have been indexed elsewhere. It is sometimes claimed that the International Classification of Diseases is not detailed enough to enable fine shades of difference to be shown between similar, but nevertheless slightly different, conditions. The answer to such criticism is that for a very few purposes no classification, or nomenclature either for that matter, has yet been designed that would be detailed enough to provide the material required without some preliminary selection of cases. The largest hospitals in New Zealand have found that a disease cross-index based on the International Classification of Diseases is satisfactory to meet the demands made on it to provide medical records for both specialist and general enquiries. This topic is discussed under 'The Classification of Diseases' (chapter -ii). 9. Diseases of the digestive system 10. Diseases of the genito-urinary system 11. Deliveries and complications of pregnancy, childbirth and the puerperium 12. Diseases of the skin and cellular tissue 13. Diseases of the bones and organs of movement 1k 0 Congenital malformations 15. Certain diseases of early infancy 16Symptoms, senility and ill-defined conditions 17. Accidents, poisonings and violence (external cause) 18. Accidents, poisonings and violence (nature of injury) 19. Special admissions without sickness Each section is divided into sub-sections which in turn contain between one to 27 statistical headings or titles to each Of which a three figure code number has been allocated. Some of these statistical headings are further sub-divided by the addition of fourth digits and sub-titles. To illustrate, the section dealing with diseases of the digestive system has six sub-sections 1. Diseases of buccal cavity and oesophagus 2 Diseases of stomach and duodenum 3. Appendicitis. k. Hernia of abdominal cavity 5. Other diseases of intestines and peritoneum 6. Diseases of liver, gallbladder and pancreas The third sub-section contains four statistical headings acute appendicitis, appendicitis unqualified, other appendicitis, and other diseases of appendix, one of which (acute appendicitis) is further divided into two sub-groups by means of four digits .0 without mention of peritonitis, and .1 with peritonitis. This structure has been used throughout the classification.. Some conditions are specified and shown out separately, usually because they are frequently encountered or because they are of particular clinical interest. Other conditions are grouped together under an "other and unspecified" title. These usually 1c7 10 This is sufficiently elaborate but his original nosology further gave subheadings of the species, for example 0. Dentitionjs (a) (b) Lactantium; cutting the teeth or shedding teeth Puerilis;cutting the second set or permanent teeth (c) Adultorum; cutting the adult or wise teeth (d) Senilium; cutting teeth in advanced life or old age The need for a uniform classification of diseases for international use was recognised more than a hundred years ago. The first International Statistical Congress, held in 1853, requested William Faar and Marc d'Espine to prepare a uniform classification of causes of death applicable in-all countries. This action and subsequent developments eventually led to the adoption of the International List of Causes of Death in 1893. After the first revision in 1900, the International List of Causes of Death underwent successive decennial revisions until 1948 when a classification suitable for classifying causes of illness as well as causes of death was adopted. This dual purpose classification, known as International Ciássiuiéatjon of Diseases (I.C.D.) was modified only slightly in 1955. Structure of the International Classification of Diseases: 2. Nineteen sections of the International Classification of Diseases are currently used in New Zealand. They are 1. 2. 3. Infective and parasitic diseases Neoplasms Allergic, endocrine system, metabolic and • nutritional diseases +. Diseases of the blood and blood-forming organs 151,6 5. Mental, psychoneurotjc and personality disorders 6. Diseases of the nervous system and sense organs 7. Diseases of the circulatory system 8. Diseases of the respiratory system often even that of the varieties, I hold to be a necessary foundation of every plan of physic, whether dogmatical or empirical," said Cullen in his First Lines of the Practice of Physic (1776). The system devised by him came to be a predominant one, although many other systems were presented. An example of one of these early nineteenth century classifications is that of John Mason Good, a London physician. His classification published in 1822 contained six clases (1) Coeliaca, (2) Pneumatica, Diseases of the Respiratory System (3) Haematica, Diseases of the Sanguineous Function, including the specific fevers, visceral inflammations, supperations, (k) Neurotica, Diseases of the Nervous Function, (5) Genetica, Diseases of the Sexual Function and (6) Eccritica, or Diseases of the "Excernent" Function, included under this last heading are corpulency, dropsy, tumours, and skin diseases. Each class has orders, genera and species, as shown by the first page of the table of classification Class 1.Coeliaca. Diseases of the Digestive Function Ord. 1.Enterica. Affecting the Alimentary:Canal Gen. 1.Odontia Misdentition Spec,1.0. Dentitionis Teething 2. Dolorosa Toothache 3. Stuporis Tooth edge 4. Deformis Deformity of the teeth 5. Edentula Toothlessness 6. Incrustans Tartar of the teeth 7. Excrescens Excrescent gums 10 Lethargy 14 Livergrown 20 Meagrom and Headach 12 Measles 7 Murthered and Shot 9 Overlaid and Starved 45 Palsie 30 Plague 68 ,596 Planne t 6 Plurisie '15 Poysoned 1 Qu ins i e 35 Pickets 557 Rising of the Lights 397 Rupture 34 Scurvy 105 Shingles and Swine Pox 2 Sores, Ulcers, broken and bruised limbs 82 Spleen 14 Spotted feaver and Purples 1,929 Stopping of the Stomack 332 Stone and Strangury 98 Surfiet 1,251 Teeth and Worms 2,614 Vomiting 51 V Venn 1 Although few of these terms are likely to find their way onto a contemporary death certificate most of them will at least be meaningful to the present-day reader, who might perhaps pause and reflect with sadness upon the passing of such colourful terminology as rising of the lights, purples and griping in the guts. By way of explanation calenture is a term for tropical fever or delirium, the chrisome means a child's white robe at baptism used as a shroud if it died within a month, the lights were the lungs, Kings Evil was scrofula or tuberculosis of lymphatic glands, and impostume was a purulent swelling or abscess. This statement then is an early tabulation of causes of death made up largely of symptomatic or descriptive terms which are arranged in alphabetical order. Nosology, or the scientific classification of diseases, was cultivated zealously a hundred and fifty years ago, and was believed to be a necessary part of the knowledge required for the practical treatment of disease. "The distinction of the genera of diseases, the distinction of the species of each and bills of mortality were weekly statements in which were shown the number of christenings and burials in each parish in London, together with a statement of the causes of death. The causes of death were reported by searchers who were (to quote Graunt) Matrons, Sworn to their Office (who) repaired to the place where the dead Corps lies, and by view of the same, and by other enquiries, they examine by what disease or casualty the Corps died, Hereupon they make their report to the Parish-Clerk". The most famous bill of mortality is that for 1665, thq year of the Great Plague. The following list of causes of death has been taken from that bill Abortive and Stiliborne Aged Ague and Feaver Appoplex and Suddenly Bedrid Blasted Bleeding Bloody Flux, Scowring & Flux Burnt and Scalded Calenture Cancer, Gangrene and Fistula Canker and Thrush Childbed Chrisomes and infants Cold and Cough Collick and Winde Consumption and Tissick Convulsion and Mother Distracted Dropsie and Timpany Drowned Executed Flox and Small Pox Found dead in streets, fields etc. . French Pox Frighted Gout and Sciatica Grief Griping in the Guts Hangd & made away themselves Headmouldshot & Mould fallen Jaundies Impostume Kild by severall accidents Kings Evil Leprosie 617 1,514 5,257 116 10 5 16 185 8 .3 56 111, 625 11258 68 134 4,808 2,036 5. 1,'+78 50 21 655 20 86 23 27 46 1,288 7. il+ 110 227 46 86 2 10 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand INTERNATIONAL CLASSIFICATION OF DISEASES 1,Historical review 2. Structure of the International Classification of Diseases 3. Uses of International Classification of Diseases 3.1 Disease indexing 3.2 Statistical 4. Difference between a classification and a nomenclature 5. Abbreviated lists 6. Revisions 7. Additions and amendments 8. References 9. Further reading 9.1 Basic 9.2 Background Historical review: 1. An excellent account of the development of disease classification is given in the Introduction to the International Classification of Diseases. The account describes how an internationally accepted classification was gradually evolved and names those nosologists who made substantial contributions to its development. It is pointless to repeat here the information, already available in the code books themselves but some acquaintance with the precursors of the International Classification of Diseases is necessary before a worthwhile evaluation of the Classification can be made. The following notes are designed to supplement the information contained in the historical review and it is thought that they will be of particular interest to the, reader who does not have access to those publications in which reference is made to earlier classifications. On page x of the Introduction reference is made to the work of John Graunt who pioneered the statistical study of disease. John Graunt was a London draper who, in 1662, published • book entitled "Natural and Political Observations Mentioned in • following Index and made upon the Bills of Mortality". The j57., K IIj H' J_tp___ co .1 6 z C1 FR I It orP. ) rp ON Gq 'n. t I of S 2 I: 9. S.V.0PULMONARY VEINS VPVV 'AORTA -- -i---c CAPILLARIES RCULATION CAPILLARIES- -- .-CIPULMONARY CISYSTEMI RCULATIC ON Fig. 141 If. Fig. 3. SCAPI 31CR Fig. 1. VE HIP BO IA BRAL ISPHERE STEM LLUM L CORD. Fig. 2. RAL CANAL 147 9 Reference': 12 Cairney (John) and Cairney (J.) First studies in Anatomy and Physiology Christchurch, N.M. Peryer Ltd. 1963 V + 223 Further reading: 13 Turner (A.E.J,) A Preliminary Introduction into the study of Anatomy and Physiology Medical Record: Feb. 195+ pp 280-3, 295; May 1954, pp 305-11,3 2 0; Aug. 1954, pp 347-+9, 58; Nov. 1954, PP 384-7, 390; Feb. 1955, pp k20-3 Illustrations by courtesy N.M. Peryer Ltd., Christchurch 44 The testis contains groups of cells called interstitial cells, between the seminiferous tubules; collectively they constitute the endocrine part of the testis, and they secrete a hormone called testosterone.The ovary produces two hormones: oestradiol, secreted by the ripening follicles, and progesterone, secreted by the corpus luteum. Testosterone in the male and oestradiol in the female are responsible for the changes that take place in the body at puberty, while oestradiol and progesterone are responsible for the changes that occur in the endometrium each month throughout the reproductive years. The pancreas has groups of cells called cell islets, or the islands of Langerhans, scattered through its substance. Collectively they constitute the endocrine part of the pancreas, and they secrete the hormone insulin, which is essential for the utilisation of glucose by the tissues and also facilitates its storage in the liver. The thyroid secretes a hormone called thyroxine, which regulates the metabolism of the body generally. The parathyroids secrete a hormone called parathormone, which regulates the metabolism of calcium and phosphorus. The adrenal cortex produces two principal hormones, cortisol. and aldosterone. Cortisol, in contrast with insulin, tends to raise the level of glucose in the blood. Aldosterone controls the excretion of sodium and potassium by the kidneys, thus maintaining their proper concentration in the body. The adrenal medulla produces two hormones, adrenaline and noradrenline.The production of adrenaline is a physiological response to an emergency; it increases the heart rate, raises the blood pressure, mobilises glucose from the liver and so on. The. role of noradrenaline in the normal working of the body is not yet clear, but it is probably concerned with the control of the circulation and especially with maintaining the blood pressure at a proper level. The anterior pituitary secretes (a) a group of hormones which stimulate other endocrine organs - the thyroid, the adrenal cortex, and the gonads; . (b) the lactogenic hormone, which stimulates the mammary glands to secrete milk; (c) the growth hormone. The posterior pituitary has two hormones: (1) the anti-diuretic hormone, which acts on the kidneys to control the quantity of water put out in the urine, and (2) the oxytocic hormone, which acts on the uterus at the end of pregnancy to help expel its contents. 11W 9 The Fallopian or uterine tubes, of which there are two, each extend from the ovary to the uterus, and each serves as a duct for the corresponding ovary. When ovulation occurs, the ovum immediately enters the tube, by which it travels to the uterus. Union of the ovum and a spermatozoon to form a zygote when this happens - occurs in the Fallopian tube, and the zygote then continues the journey to the uterus, where it undergoes its further dévelopment The vagina is a tube of non-striated musc]e lined by mucous membrane, leading from the uterus to the vulva,, Menstruation is periodic physiological bleeding from the body of the uterus, occurring at intervals of approximately four weeks. Every month from puberty to the menopause (except during pregnancy) the endometrium undergoes a series of. changes in preparation for the possible arrival of a zygote, and the completion of these changes coincides with the time when a zygote, if there is one, is due to arrive. If the ovum discharged from the ovary at ovulation is not fertilised and therefore no zygote reaches the uterus, there is no means by which the changes in the endometrium can be reversed, and it now becomes necessary to shed the prepared endometrium and start anew. This is the explanation of menstruation. The endocrine glands: 11. The endocrine glands are glands without ducts. The products which they manufacture are called hormones, and these are carried in the blood to various parts of the body. The endocrine glands which exist as separate organs are (a) the thyroid, in the front of the neck, (b) four parathyroids, immediately behind the thyroid, (c) two adrenals, each at the upper end of the kidney, and (d) the pituitary, occupying a hollow in the interior of the base of the skull. The adrenal and the pituitary each consist of two parts with different functions; in the adrenal they are an outer part called the cortex and an inner part called the medulla; in the pituitary they are an anterior lobe, often referred to as the anterior pituitary, and a.posterior lobe, often referred to as the posterior pituitary. In addition, the gonads (ovary and testis) and the pancreas have endocrine functions as well as their other functions, genitals; in the male they are the penis and the scrotum, and in the female they are known collectively as the vulva. 10.1In the male (See Fig. 7.) The testes, right and left, are each situated in the corresponding half of the scrotum. They consist essentially of a large number of fine tubes called seminiferous tubules, the function of which is to form spermatozoa; this commences at puberty and is thereafter a continuous process till it comes to an end with advancing years. A fully developed spermatozoon is a single cell of a specialised type; it is motile, and has a long tail which acts as a propelling mechanism. When eventually discharged by ejaculation from the urethra, the spermatozoa are contained in a fluid called semen. The duct of the testis consists of two parts: (a) the epidiymis, a long thin tube coiled on itself to such an extent that the epididymis as a whole forms a relatively small structure along the posterior border of the testis, and (b) the vas deferens,. a thick-walled tube extending from the lower end of the epididymis to. open into the posterior urethra... The auxiliary glands of the male reproductive system. are (a) the two seminal vesicles, situated behind the bladder, and (b) the prostate, surrounding the posterior urethra. They secrete most of the fluid part of the semen. . 10.2 In the female (See Fig. 8.) The two ovaries, right and left, are situated in the pelvic cavity, one on either side. They are composed of fibrous connective tissue in which are embedded a large number of special structures called ovarian or Graafian follicles, each containing an ovum. Ovulation consists in the discharge of an ovum from the surface of• one or other ovary; it commences at puberty, and thereafter occurs once every four weeks (except during pregnancy, when the process is suspended) until the menopause. Every month a group of follicles commences to undergo a ripening process; ordinarily only one of them completes the process, and the others degenerate. The one that completes its ripening approaches the surface of the ovary, where it ruptures and discharges the ovum; the ruptured follicle is thereupon converted into another structure called a corpus luteum, which persists until the next menstrual period is due. 'Li3 The kidneys form urine by extracting substances from the blood. They act as a kind of "blood inspector" whose duty it is to maintain the proper composition of the plasma. In the performance of this function, they excrete (1) water in such quantity as will ensure that the water content of the body remains more or less constant, (2) nitrogenous waste, principally in the form of urea, though a smaller amount of it is uric acid, (3) inorganic salts to the extent necessary to keep their concentration in the plasma at its proper level. The items just enumerated are the important constituents of normal urine. The kidneys are situated on the posterior wall of the abdomen, one on each side of the vertebral column. The ureter emerges from the medial borderof the kidney; the commencement of the ureter is funnel-shaped and this part is called the Lelvis - strictly speaking, it is the pelvis of the ureter, but it is commonly referred to as the pelvis of the kidney. The bladder, situated in the pelvic cavity, is a hollow organ, with its wall composed of non-striated muscle lined by mucous membrane. The urethra emerges from it below, at a region called the neck of the bladder. The urethra has two sphincters surroupding it, an involuntary or non-striated sphincter at the neck of the bladder, and a voluntary or striated sphincter in the pelvic floor. The female urethra is about 1-iinches long, with a direct course from the neck of the bladder to the exterior.The male urethra is about 8 inches long and is divided by the striated sphincter into two parts: (a) the anterior urethra, which traverses the, and (b) the posterior urethra, which is surrounded by the prostate. The reproductive or generative system: 10. The reproductive or generative system differs in the two sexes. Reproduction depends upon the union of a male germ cell or spermatozoon with a female germ cell or ovum.The two unite to form a single cell called a fertilised ovum or zygote, and from it are produced all the organs and tissues of the future child, known early in pregnancy as the embryo and later as the foetus. The organs which house the germ cells are a pair of genital glands or onads; in the male they are called the testes, and in the female the ovaries.The parts of the reproductive system which are situated on the surface are referred to as the external 1,z There are four digestive juices: (1) saliva, secreted by the salivary glands, (2) gastric juice, secreted by numerous glands of microscopic size in the wall of the stomach, (3) pancreatic juice, secreted by the pancreas, and (+) intestinal juice, secreted by numerous glands of microscopic size in the wall of the small intestine. The digestive juices contain enzymes which carry out the digestion of proteins, carbohydrates and fats. Bile is not a digestive juice; it contains no enzymes, but it assists in the digestion and absorption of fats. The digestive process splits proteins into amino-acids, carbohydrates into glucose, and fats into glycerol and fatty acids. The absorption of these end products (as well asof other substances which do not need digestion) takes place in the small intestine, and practically the only absorption that occurs in the large intestine is the absorption of a further quantity of water. The amino-acids and glucose are absorbed into the venous blood and are, carried by a vein called the portal vein to the liver. Glycerol and fatty acids, on the other hand, are re-constituted into fats during their passage through the intestinal wall, and are carried as fats by the lymphatics to enter the veins at the root of the neck. Glucose and fat are used by the tissues for the production of energy and heat. Surplus glucose can be stored in the liver as glycogen, which can be converted back to glucose as. required. Glucose which is not needed can also be converted into fat, and surplus fat can in any case be stored as adipose tissue in various parts of the body. Amino-acids, on the other hand, cannot be stored. They are used for building the proteins of the tissues, not only during growth but also to make good the wear and tear that goes on all the time throughout life. Unwanted amino-acids (which come from the breakdown of tissue proteins as well as from any surplus in the food) are dealt with in the liver, where the nitrogenous part is converted into urea (a waste product, for excretion by the kidneys), while the remainder can be converted into glucose0 9.The urinary system (See Fig. 6.) The urinary system is-concerned with the excretion of urine. It consists of '(a) the two kidne, right and left, in which the urine is formed, (b) two tubes called the ureters, one from each kidney, which convey the urine to the bladder, (c) the bladder, where the urine is temporarily stored, and (d) a passage called the urethra, leading from the bladder to the exterior. 9 The alimentary or digstive system: 8. (See Fig. 5Y The alimentary or digestive system is concerned with the digestion of food stuffs (proteins, carbohydrates and fats) and with the absorption not only of the products of digestion but also of other substances (water, inorganic salts, and vitamins) which do not require digestion. The system consists of (a) a tube called the alimentary canal, which runs right through the body from the mouth to the anus, and (b) various glands which discharge t1ieir secretions into the alimentary canal. The part of the alimentary canal above the diaphragm comprises (1) the mouth or oral cavity, (2) the pharynx, situated behind the nose, the mouth, and the larynx, and (3) the oesophagus, which begins in the neck as a continuation of the pharynx, runs down through the thorax, and finally through the diaphragm to open into the stomach. This part Of the alimentary canal is mainly concerned with the mechanical functions of mastication (chewing) and deglutition (swallowing). The glands associated with it are three pairs of salivary glands, the ducts of which open into the mouth. The part of the alimentary canal below the diaphragm comprises (1) the stomach, a dilated part of the alimentary canal which enables us to take meals, (2) the small intestine, so called because it is smaller in calibre, though considerbly longer, than (3) the large intestine. The whole of this part of the alimentary canal is conveniently referred to as the gastro-intestinal tract. The glands associated with it are the liver, which secretes bile and has a duct called the bile duct, and the pancreas, which secretes pancreatic juice and has a duct called the pancreatic duct. The bile duct and the pancreatic duct open into the upper part of the small intestine. The gastro-intestinal tract is a tube of non-striated muscle lined by mucous membrane. The function of the muscular wall is to propel the contents onwards, which it does by waves of contraction called peristalisis. The muscle is in two layers, longitudinal and circular, and at several points the circular layer is thickened to form sphincters, which regulate the passage of the contents. the intake of air for respiration can be regulated. With the vocal cords brought together in the middle line, they can be caused to vibrate in a blast of expired air, and this is how sound is produced; variation in pitch is brought about by varying the tension of the vocal cords. The lung consists essentially of an enormous number of minute air-sacs or alveoli, together with a system of tubes connecting them to the main bronchus. After entering the lung, the main bronchus undergoes repeated subdivision, and all its branches within the lung collectively constitute the bronchial tree. The larger branches are still called bronchi, but the smallest ones are called bronchioles. To facilitate the exchange of oxygen and carbon dioxide between the air in the alveoli and the blood in the pulmonary capillaries, the barrier between the two has been reduced to a minimum and consists of practically nothing more than two layers of flat cells - the endothelium of the capillaries and a single layer of flat epithelium forming the walls of the alveoli. Because the pressure of oxygen is higher in the alveoli than in the capillary blood, oxygen passes from the air in the alveoli to the blood in the capillaries; and for a similar reason, carbon dioxide passes in the opposite direction. In consequence of these exchanges, (1) the air which is expelled at expiration contains less oxygen and more carbon dioxide than does inspired air, and (2) the blood which leaves the capillaries to enter the pulmonary veins has lost a proportion of carbon dioxide and gained a proportion of oxygen, and has thus become arterial blood. Inspiration is carried out by the action of muscles which raise the ribs and lower the diaphragm, thus increasing the capacity of the thorax. Because the capacity of the thorax is increased, air is drawn into the lungs through the air passages. In expiration the thorax returns to its former size and in consequence air .is expelled from the lungs. In,a general way, the action may be compared with drawing air into a pair of bellows and forcing it out again. The muscles that we use in respiration are voluntary muscles: the diaphragm, supplied by the two phrenic nerves, right and left, and muscles called intercostal muscles (between the ribs), supplied by nerves called intercostal nerves. Though we can, if we wish, stop breathing for a short time, respiration normally proceeds automatically and in a rhythmic manner, and this isdue to a nerve centre in the hind brain called the respiratory centre. with by the histiocytes. The respiratory system: 7. (See Fig. l) The respiratory system exists to replenish the oxygen in the blood and to enable the blood to get ridS of its unwanted carbon dioxide.The air we breathe mis called inspired airs is ordinary atmospheric air and contains about 20 5 01 oxygen and only atrace of carbon dioxide, whereas the air we breathe out, called expired air, contains about k% more of carbon dioxide and about 476 less of oxygen. Air normally enters and leaves the body through the nose, but we can of course also breathe through the mouth. In either case the air also traverses a tube called the pharynx, situated behind the nose and the mouth. The respiratory system itself begins with the larynx,which opens off the front of the pharynx, below the back of the tongue. The respiratory system consists of (a) two air reservoirs, the lungs, situated in the thorax, one on either side of the heart, and (b) a series of air passages, by which the air is conveyed to and from the lungs. The air passages comprise (a) the larynx, (b) the trachea, which ends by bifurcating into (c) two main bronchi, one for each lung. The main bronchus enters the medial surface of the lung (i.e. the surface which looks towards the middle line), and is accompanied by the pulmonary artery and two pulmonary veins; this whole group of structures constitutes the root of the lung. The air passages are lined throughout by mucous membrane, and outside this the walls are formed by pieces of cartilage together with fibrous tissue and muscle (skeletal striated in the larynx, and non-striated below this). The cartilage serves to keep the tubes open at all times. About half-way down the larynx, two folds of muc.ousmembrane, one on each side, project like shelves into its cavity. In the free border of each is a band of elastic tissue (so called on account of its elasticity), and these are the vocal cords; the space between them is the glottis. By moving the cartilages of the larynx on one another, we can move the voc-al cords nearer together or further apart; in other words, the size of the glottis can be varied by muscular action, and thus called lymphoid tissue. Corpuscles and platelets, at the end of their life span, are destroyed by cells called histiocytes, which are present in bone marrow and lymphoid tissue and also in other situations such as the liver and connective tissue in various parts of the body. The histiocytes in the spleen (which is also a lymphoid organ, and as such forms lymphocytes) play an important part in the destruction of worn-out red corpuscles. The plasma makes up rather more than half of the total volume of the blood. When blood escapes from the blood vascular system, it coagulates or clots, this being Nature's attempt to stop or minimise the bleeding. The process of coagulation is started off by the disintegration of platelets when they come into contact with damaged tissue, but what eventually happens is that fibrinogen, one of the proteins of the plasma, is converted into an insoluble substance called fibrin; this forms a network in which the corpuscles are entangled. The solid part, or clot, now consists of fibrin and corpuscles, while the fluid part which is left 'consists of plasma minus its fibrinogen, and is called serum. 6. . The lymph vascular or lymphatic system The lymph vascular or lymphatic system contains a colourless or faintly yellow fluid called lymph, which is discharged into large veins at the root of the neck. The tissues of the body are permeated by a fluid called tissue fluid, which acts as an intermediary for the exchange of substances between the blood in the capillaries and the tissue cells. It is constantly being renewed from the plasma in the capillaries, and it is constantly being removed from the tissues (a) by going back into the capillaries and (b) by being drained away by the lymphatic system. The lymphatic system commences in the tissues as numerous blind lymphatic capillaries, the contents of which come from the tissue fluid. From them the lymph is drained away by lymphatic vessels or lymphatics, which join up to form larger and larger vessels, until eventually there are only two, the thoracic duct, which opens into the veins at the root of the neck on the left side, and the right lymphatic duct, which does the same on the right side. Situated on the course of the lymphatics are small oval or beanshaped structures called lymph nodes, through which the lymph percolates. They consist of lymphoid tissue, which forms new 1tnphocyte, but they also act as filters and remove from the lymph any materials of an injurious nature, such as bacteria, which can then be dealt Ii 9 Of this time, atrial systole occupies Oal second, ventricular systole occupies 0.3 second, and for the remaining 0e 1+ second the whole heart is in diastole. Blood:. 5.1. The blood is the medium by which various substances are conveyed from one part of the body to another. Blood consists of a fluid called 1. 1asma, in which are suspended (a) a multitude of cells called blood corpuscles, which are of two kinds, red and white, and (b) other structures called platelets. .. Red corpuscles, or erythorcytes, number . 5 million to 6 million per cubic millimetre.They are cIrcular .bio-concave discs without nuclei, and their protoplasm contains a pigment called haemçglobin.Their special function is the transport of oxygen, which is carried in chemical combination with the haemoglobin. In venous blood, when a certain amount of oxygen has been given up to the tissues, they also carry part of the carbon dioxide. The rest of the carbon dioxide, and everything else that the blood transports, is carried in the plasma, White corpuscles, or leucocytes, number 5,000 to 10,000 per cubic millimetre. They are nucleated cells, and are divided into several classes according to their appearances in a stained blood film.In the first place there are two main classes, granular andaccording to the presence or absence of granules in the protoplasm of the cell. The granular leucocytes are mostly neutE2janhils. which make up about 70% of the total leucocytes, and the agranular •ones are mostly lymphocytes, which make up 20% or more of the total. The granular leucocytes constitute one of the defence mechanisms of the body; in inflammation, they migrate through the capillary walls into the tissues, where they ingest bacteria and destroy them a process called phagocytosis. The platelets number between 200,000 and +OO,OOO per cubió millimetre. They are minute fragements of protoplasm without nuclei, and they are of importance in connection with the coagulation of blood. Corpuscles and platelets are constantly being renewed, and old and worn out ones are constantly being destroyed. Red corpuscles, granular leucocytes and platelets are formed in the red marrow of bones, and lymphocytes are formed in a type of tissue The systemic circulation begins with the aorta, a single large artery carrying arterial blood from the left ventricle. From the aorta are given off a number of named arteries, which, by branching into smaller and smaller arteries, convey arterial blood to all parts of the body. The smallest arteries are called arterioles, and these open into the capillaries of the various organs and tissues. In the capillaries the blood gives off oxygen to the tissues and takes up carbon dioxide from them; it thus becomes venous blood. From the capillaries the blood is collected by veins, which join to form larger and larger veins. The venous blood is, eventually poured into the right atrium by two large veins called the superior vena cava and the inferior vena cava. The pulmonary circulation begins with a single large artery, called the pulmonary artery, carrying venous blood from the right ventricle. This soon divides into two pulmonary arteries, right and left, one for each lung. Within the lung, the artery divides into smaller and smaller arteries, and the smallest of them open into the pulmonary capillaries. In the pulmonary capillaries the blood takes up oxygen from the air in the lung and gives off its surplus carbon dioxide; it thus becomes arterial blood. From the pulmonary capillaries it is collected by veins, which unite to form larger veins; it is eventually poured into the left atrium by four pulmonary veins, two from each lung. The wall of the heart consists of cardiac muscle, lined on the inside by endothelium and covered on the outside by serous peri ' -cardium.Theusclarw isoftenpk ofasthemypcardium, and the endothelial lining is called the endocardium. At both ends of the ventricles the cardiac pump is provided with valves, produced by folding in of the endocardium, and permitting the flow of blood only in one direction. The valves at the atrio-ventricular orifices are called atrio-ventricular valves; the one on the right side is the tricuspid valve, and the one on the left side is the mitral valve. The valves at the outlet from the ventricles are called semilunar valves; the one at the opening into pulmonary artery is the pulmonary valve, and the one at the opening into the aorta is the aortic valve. Each beat of the heart consists of simultaneous contraction of the two atria, driving blood into the ventricles, followed by simultaneous contraction of the two ventricles, driving blood into the pulmonary artery and aorta, Contraction is called systole, and the relaxation which follows is called diastole. If for convenience of calculation we take a heart rate of 75 per minute, the time corresponding to each heart beat is 0,8 second, IW The blood vascular or circulatory system: (See Fig. 3.) The blood vascular or circulatory system distributes blood to all the organs and tissues of the body and brings it back again to the heart. The system consists of the heart, which acts as a pump, and the tubes called blood-vessels. The blood-vessels are of three kinds: (a) arteries, which convey blood from the heart to the tissues, (b) veins, which return the blood from the tissues to the heart, and (c) capillaries, which are numerous very fine vessels, microscopic in size, situated in the tissues themselves and forming the means of communication between the arteries and the veins. All the blood in the body is contained in the heart and blood-vessels. The heart, situated more or less in the middle of the thorax (two-thirds of it are to the left of the middle line), consists of four chambers: two atria, right and left, and two ventricles, right and left. The atria are receiving chambers; each receives blood from veins, and when it contracts, expels the blood into the corresponding ventricle. The ventricles are distributing chambers; each receivesblood from the corresponding atrium, and, when it contracts, expls the blood into arteries. Each atrium communicates with the corresponding ventricle by an atrio-ventricular orifice, but there is no communication between the right and left sides of the heart, which are separated from each other by a partition or septum. The left side of the heart contains blood which is bright red in colour; it has in a high proportion of oxygen and a relatively low proportion of carbon dioxide, and is called arterial blood. The right side of the •heart contains blood which is bluish in colour; it has in it a higher proportion of carbon dioxide than in arterial blood and a relatively low proportion of oxygen; it is called venous blood. The blood that leaves each ventricle returns to the heart by entering the atrium of the opposite side. There are thus two systems of blood-vessels: (1) the systemic circulation, connecting the left ventricle to the right atrium, and (2) the pulmonary circulation, connecting the right ventricle to the left atrium. 5. In sections of the brain or spinal cord there are two kinds of nervous tissue, which are called grey matter and white matter according to their appearance to the naked eye. Grey matter consists of an aggregation of nerve cells, and white matter consists of an aggregation of nerve fibres. Outside the central nervous system, the nerves consist of nerve fibres, and any collection of nerve cells constitutes a ganglion. In the peripheral nerves, fibres which carry impulses to the central nervous system (for example, from the skin) are called afferent fibres, and fibres which carry impulses from the central nervous system (for example, to the voluntary muscles) are called efferent fibres. A nerve may be entirely afferent or entirely efferent, or it may contain both afferent and efferent fibres and is then called a mixed nerve. Afferent fibres from the skin convey impulses which, when they reach consciousness, give rise to the sensations of touch, pain, warmth, and cold. There are also afferent fibres from muscles and tendons, and the impulses which they carry give rise to sensations which enable us to be aware of such things as the position of any part of a limb and whether an object held in the hand is heavy or light; such sensations are covered by the term muscular sense. Associated with the nervous system are the organs of the special senses of sight, hearing, smell, and taste. These are (1) the(2) the ear, (3) a specialised part of the mucous membrane of the nose called the olfactory region, and (Lt) the taste buds, microscopic in size, in the mucous membrane of the tongue. When the spinal cord is followed upwards (see Fig. 2), it becomes continuous with a part of the brain called the brain stem, and this ends above at the base of the two cerebral hemispheres (right and left), which make up the greater part of the brain. The outer layer of each cerebral hemisphere consists of grey matter called the cerebral cortex, and the cerebral cortex is the only part of the brain concerned with consciousness and with initiating voluntary movements. Projecting backwards from the brain stem, below the cerebral hemispheres, is another part of the brain called the cerebellum; it has nothing to do with consciousness, and its function is .to act as a centre for co-ordinating muscular movements which have been initiated by the cerebral cortex. The brain and spinal cord are surrounded by three membranes or meninges, which, in order from without in, are called the dura, the arachnoid, and the pia. Between the arachnoid and the pia is, the subarachnoid space, filled with a fluid called cerebro-spinal fluid. 1 called nerve impulses, which cause the muscle to contract. As seen under the microscope, a muscle consists of contractile units called nerve fibres, each of which is really an elongated cell. This type of muscular tissue is often referred to simply as voluntary muscle, but t because the muscles are mostly attached to the skeleton and because the fibres show a characteristic cross-striation when seen under the microscope, it is also called skeletal striated muscle. We may note here that there are two other types of muscular tissue, and that these are not under the control of the will. One type (which has no cross-striation) is called involuntary or non-striated muscle; it is found in the walls of hollow organs like the stomach and the bladder, and in the walls of tubes, including the arteries. Its nerve-supply comes from a part of the nervous system known as the involuntary or autonomic nervous system. The other type is found only in the wall of the heart, and is known as cardiac muscle or cardiac striated muscle. It is remarkable in possessing the property of automatic rhythmic contraction, by which, throughout life, it maintains the circulation of the blood; its nerve-supply, from the autonomic nervous system, is purely a regulating mechanism. The nervous system: +. The nervous system comprises the brain and, the spinal cord, together with all the nerves of the body. The brain is situated inside the skull and the spinal cord inside the vertebral column; together they constitute the central nervous system. The nerves arise from the central nervous system as 12 pairs from the brain, called cranial nerves, and 31 pairs from the spinal cord, called, spinal nerves; together they constitute the peripheral nervous system. The unit of structure in the nervous system is called a neurone, and a neurone consists of a nerve cell together with a long process of its protoplasm which has been drawn out to form a nerve fibre. The whole nervous system is made up of neurones, and might be compared with an extremely complicated system of electric wiring, in which each single length of wire represents a neurone. The function of neurones is to convey messages called nerve impulses, and nerve impulses travel along I the neurones in much the same way as an electric current travels along the wires in a wiring system. elsewhere red marrow persists throughout life. Red marrow is one of the blood-forming tissues, but yellow marrow consists almost entirely of fat. 3.The muscular system The muscular system comprises all the voluntary muscles of the body, that is to say, the muscles which are under the control of the will. The outstanding property of muscles is their power of contraction, so that the two ends of the muscle are brought nearer to each other. The majority of muscles are attached at both ends to bones, and pass over at least one joint. When such a muscle contracts, it moves one bone on the other, the movement taking place at the intervening joint. Every voluntary movement that we carry out in any part of the body is brought about by the contraction of muscles. Muscles make up the greater part of the substance of the limbs, which is not surprising when we reflect that the usefulness of a limb depends upon its capacity for movement. The diaphragm, which separates the thorax from the abdomen, is a muscular partition; and the walls of the abdomen are mostly composed of muscles. While the majority of muscles are attached at both ends to bone, this is not the case with all of them. In the face there are muscles which are attached at one end into the skin, and which produce changes in facial expression. The tongue consists of a mass of muscle covered by mucous membrane, to which the muscles are attached, and all the changes in the shape and position of the tongue are produced by the action of its muscles. The attachment of a muscle to bone may be a direct one, or it may take place through a cord-like or band-like structure called .a tendon, which is a white glistening structure composed of fibrous tissue. In the region of the wrist and ankle, the muscles of the forearm and leg have given place to tendons, and these tendons are surrounded by sheaths of fibrous tissue lined by synovial membrane and lubricated by synovia, so that the tendon can glide smoothly within its sheath. Muscles which are broad and sheet-like (as in the abdominal wall) have tendons which are likewise broad and sheet-like, and such tendons are called aponeuroses. Every voluntary muscle has a nerve-supply, and by this we mean that a nerve reaches the muscle from either the brain (in the case of the muscles of the head) or the spinal cord (in the case of the rest of the body). The nerve conveys the messages from the brain, 15 1 9 Though many cavities and tubes are lined by epithelium, there are some which are not. The internal lining of the heart and blood-vessels is a single layer of flat cells called endothelium, not epithelium. The heart beats inside a fibrous pericardium, and both the outer surface of the heart and the inner surface of the fibrous bag are lined by a smooth membrane called the serous pericardium;. this kind of membrane is a serous membrane, not a mucous membrane, and it consists of a layer of flat cells called mesothelium with a backing of fibrous tissue. The other serous membranes are the pleura, lining the interior of the chest wall and covering the lung, and the peritoneum, in the abdomen. Each of the serous membranes is moistened by just sufficient of a serous fluid'to prevent friction between the apposed surfaces. The osseous system or skeleton: 2. (See Fig. 1.) The osseous system orskeleton comprises all the bones of the body. Any place where two bones meet is a joint, and there are three types of joints: fibrous joints, cartilage joints, and synovial joints. In fibrous joints, as in the upper part or vault of the skull, the bones are connected by fibrous issue, and such joints (here called sutures) are quite immovable. Cartilage joints occur in the vertebral column (or spine), where there is a series of superposed segments called vertebrae, connected by discs of a gristly substance called cartilage; each such joint allows a slight amount of yielding or "give". Synovial joints are typified by the large joints of the limbs, which are freely movable. Here the bone ends are covered by a smooth layer of cartilage, and there is a joint cavity surrounded by a cylinder of fibrous tissue called the capsular ligament. The capsular ligament is lined on its deep surface by a glistening layer called syn.ovial membrane, which secretes a stickyfluid called synovia for lubricating the joint. Bones are classified, according to their shape, into long bones (as in the limbs), short bones (such as the vertebrae), flat bones (as in the vault of the skull), and irregular bones. The interior of bones is occupied by a tissue called bone marrow, of which there are two types, red and yellow. At birth, all the marrow is red marrow, but by early adult life most of the marrow in the long bones has changed to yellow marrow; PO If we make a thin section of any organ and examine it under he microscope, we find that it consists of units called cells. Each cell is composed of a living substance called protoplasm, and a small part of the protoplasm, near the centre of the cell, is different from the rest and is called the nucleus. A cell then, is a circumscribed mass of protoplasm containing a nucleus. From this point of view, the body consists of myriads of cells. The cells are in turn arranged in tissues, and a tissue is an aggregation of cells which have specialised to carry out a particular function. In all tissues there is a certain amount of material between the cells, and this is referred to as the intercellular substance. There are various different kinds of tissues, but two of them which are widely distributed throughout the body, and which form parts of many organs, are fibrous connective tissue and epithelium. Fibrous connective tissue, often spoken of simply as connective tissue or as fibrous tissue, has a large amount of intercellular substance in proportion to the cells, and the intercellular substance has thread-like structures called connective tissue fibres running through it. Fibrous tissue forms tendons and ligaments, and a variety of it which is looser in texture forms a kind of packing between muscles and around blood-vessels and nerves. Epithelium, by contrast, consists almost entirely of cells, with only a minimum of intercellular substance. It might be said to resemble brickwork with the smallest possible amount of mortar between the bricks. It covers the external surface of the body, and it lines many hollow organs and tubes. In these situations it has a backing of fibrous tissue called the corium. On the, surface of the body, the epithelium and corium (here also called the epidermis and the dermis), together form the skin; lining hollow organs and tubes, the epithelium and cerium together form a mucous membrane. The organs known as glands also consist of epithelium, which here has the power of.extracting substances from the blood and manufacturing from them a new product called a secretion. Examples are the salivary glands, which secrete saliva, and the liver, which secretes bile. The tube by which a gland discharges its secretion is called its duct. There are also glands of microscopic size, such as the sweat glands in the skin and glands in the mucous membrane of the stomach, which secrete one of the digestive juices. It 9 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY 10Introduction 2,The osseous system or skeleton 3. The muscular system 4. The nervous system 5 0The blood vascular or circulatory system 5.1 Blood 6.The lymph vascular or lymphatic system 70 8. The respiratory system The alimentary or digestive system The urinary system 9. 100 The reproductive or generative system 10.1 In the male 10.2 In the female 11. The endocrine glands 12. Reference 13. Further reading Figure 1. The skeleton 2, The brain and spinal cord 3. The circulation 4. 5. The respiratory system The alimentary canal 60 The urinary system 7, 80 The male reproductive system The female reproductive system Introduction: 1. The body, when examined by dissection, is found to consist of a number of structures called organs, such as the brain, the heart, the lungs and the stomach. The internal organs are often spoken of as viscera. The organs are for the most part arranged to form systems, and a system consists of a group of organs which co-operate in carrying out particular functions. Id 8 APPENDIX C AVAILABLEBEDREPORT As at Midnight.. ........ WardWardTotal OccupiedAVAILABLE BEDS Number TypeBedsBedsSingle Male Female Total Room 1Medical20151225 2Surgical2020---Thoracic106 3Gynaeco-3028 logical 1Surgical30251 22 135 5Medical2020---Research1082 2 6Medical3030---7ISurgical2020---- TOTAL119011721 41 7171, 18 APPENDIX B. ..HOSPITAL •Census for 24 hours ending midnight on . ../.../6.. (filled in by Medical Records) Admission and Discharge Lists attached Ward Number in ward Number admitted in Number transferred Number die- Number died in Number of •at last censuslast 24 hours-ToFromcharged inlast 24 hours patients in last 24 hrs.ware at midnight (1)(ii)(iii)(iv)(v)(vi)(vii)(viii) 2 LI 14 15 17 18 22 TOTAL NOTE: Total cola. (ii) and (iii) lesc total cola. (vi) and (vii) must equal col. (viii) and total col. (iv) must equal total col. (v).Col. (ii) must be the same as yesterday's col. (viii). Visiting Staff: TOTAL: WARD BED STATE:WARDBEDSTATE APPENDIX A (2) ...... AT MIDNIGHT ..25..2..1966.... No.ADMISSIONSDISCHARGES AND DEATHS No.TRANSFERS Remaining New Transfers from Discharges Transfers to Remaining BETWEEN fromAdmissionsOther Wardsand • Deaths Other WardsfromWARDS AND Previous Day.. .HospitalON LEAVE 1 5 - 16Mrs. J. Brown from El NAMES OF PATIENTS ADMITTED (Omit Transfers between Wards) SurnameChristian Name NAMES OF PATIENTS DISCHARGED AND DECEASED (Omit Transfers between Wards) Case Note No.SurnameChristian Name JonesWilliam. 123-61.Smith. Alfred 314-19 Soap.Joseph BrownMary 016-22.AbleWilliam SmithJane ClarkWaka 315-18 11 3-2 1 JohnsonDawn ClarkRichard WARD BED STATE:WARDBEDSTATE APPENDIX A (1) ............. WARD AT MIDNIGHT..... No.ADMISSIONSDISCHARGES AND DEATHS No.TRANSFERS H Remaining Remaining BETWEEN R NewTransfers from I to K DischargesTransfers H from InWARDS AND AdmissionsOther Wardsand DeathsOther Wards Previous DayI Hospital ON LEAVE 19 2 NAMES OF PATIENTS ADMITTED (Omit Transfers between Wards) Surname Christian Name 20Mrs. J. 1 Brown to A 2 NAMES OF PATIENTS DISCHARGED OR DECEASED (Omit Transfers between Wards) Case Note No.SurnameChristian Name DannClare 0 63- 1 9 DunnMabel 142-27FordJoseph DavieFlOrence DaviesRichard - BunnMary M.S.18 statistical cards: 6 At the end of each month the total number of male and female discharges (irrespective of age) and the total number of deaths, male and.female, also irrespective of age, are totalled and M.S.18statistjcal cards for each must be available to be sent. to the National Health Statistics Centre, The number to be saitis determined by a progressive day-to-day total being maintained on,the bed states, and the figures arrived at on the last day of the month in this respect must total the actual discharges and deaths. References: 7, Huffman (Edna K.) Manual for Medical Record Librarians pp 365-71 (U.S.A., Berwyn, Ill.) ('The census and rates computed from it') Stone (J.E.)Hospital Organisation and Management p 195 (London-Faber, 1952) Symposium:The Daily Count of Patients N.Z. Medical Record, p 8, p 16, March 1963 Furth'er reading: 8. Basic:8.1. Dawson (J.F.) Medical Records Departments: South Devon and East Cornwall Hospital Medical Record, Nov. 1950, pp 7-14, 34 Eldridge (K.J.) Admission procedure and registration of inpatients Medical Record, Nov. 1955, Richardson (A.J.) Bed states, admissions, discharges and the S.H.3 Medical Record, Feb. 1957, pp 519-24 pp 181-3 Rivers (J.S.) The 'Hymn Board' Medical Record, Feb. 1951, Bed State pp 8-1, 35 Tiltman (P.c.s.) Practical aspectsMedical Record, May 1951, of a Medical Records Department form to receive the information from the ward. Others do it by telephone and others may extract it front ward bed state. The latter is not satisfactory in the case of mixed wards as the bed state will not normally show the sex or type of bed available. The first essential is to know the bed establishment in the ward, then it is necessary to know the type of ward - medical, surgical, thoracic, gynaecological, psychiatric or mixed surgical/ thoracic, mixed medical/psychiatric, etc. - and the available beds in each category. In the case of mixed sex wards, it is essential that the numbers of female and male beds available are clearly shown. On obtaining the information this is passed to the Admission Office, the Accident and Emergency department (when acute admissions are done through this department), the Matron and Medical Superintendent. The distribution of the information may vary front hospital to hospital as well as the lay-out of the form used to relay the information, but as an example the style set out in Appendix C may be used. +.1 Classification of admissions by sex, type and category In order to have data available to complete various hospital returns, it is necessary that a record be kept of the sex of. patients admitted, the type of patients (medical, surgical, etc.) and category (adult or paediatric). This information is normally extracted at the time. of balancing admission slips and can be recorded day by day and totalled at the end of each month. In determining category of admission (adult or paediatric) the age for each category will be determined at the discretion of the, local hospital board or Medical Superintendent. The essential factor to be considered is that the age so determined remain consistent. 5.Social Security lists Most hospitals are required to notify the local Social Security Department of all adult admissions and discharges. These lists may, in some cases, be prepared by Medical Records Office from data provided to complete the daily census. Where it is necessary to supply full names, age, address and Social Security Benefit the patient is receiving, this information can be extracted from admission slips. Discharge lists can be copied from the hospital bed state. 12Z ro 2nd day of month 1st day of month DischargedDied Line M F NP FP M F ' NP FP 1 DischargedDied Line F NP FP N F MP FP 1631211 2631-21 242-32- 3631-21 3 10 51 -53 1 It will be seen that on the first day of the month only patients discharged on that day will be shown (line 2) and total (the same number) carried down to line 3. On subsequent days the previous day's total goes to line 1. The day's discharges into line 2 and new total into line 3. This continues to the last day of month when the bottom line (3) will show the total male and female adult and child discharges and deaths for the month. On the reverse of the hospital bed state may be shown the daily ward bed states with totals of admission, discharges, transfers to other wards and total remaining in hospital, this becoming the permanent record of individual ward bed tates. On this form, too, is a record of the total admissions to date, as from 12 midnight 31st March each year. Also included is the total patient days for this period. One form which has been found satisfactory for both large and small hospitals is shown at Appendix B. This is accompanied by the admission and discharge lists thus making it unnecessary to write in individual names. It will be seen also that it is self-balancing. It can be varied by putting headings for specific information at the bottom. For instance, in the case of a maternity hospital the names of visiting staff might be replaced by numbers of mothers and babies, births during past 24 hours etc. Information regarding available beds:. 140 In addition to showirg just who is in hospital, and what movements have taken place, it is essential to know at all stages just what beds, the type and sex, are available for the day's admissions, and this information is also extracted at the time of taking the day's census. Some hospitals use a separate 121 MORE ADMISSIONS THAN DISCHARGES: Example (1) Patients remaining at start of period AdmissionsDischarEes (as in A above) (as in B above) 25 4 65 20Plus New Balance 5. Admis- sions +70 Total - in hospital MORE DISCHARGES THAN ADMISSIONS: Example (ii) Patients remaining at start of period AdmissionsDischarges (as in A above) (as in B above) 20 465 25Minus New Balance L+65 5 Discnarges -f6O Total - in hospital Having obtained a balance of ward bed states, the next stage is to complete a hóspitalbed state on which is shown the names of all patients admitted to hospital (including transfers and the consultant under whom admitted). Also shown is a list of all discharges, deaths and transfers to other hospitals. Discharge list will show (a) Hospital number (b) Patient's full name (c) Patient's age (d) Number of days in hospital (e) Discharged or died On the hospital bed state is shown the total number of discharges and deaths from day to day, both adult and paediatric (this information on a monthly basis). While the lay-out of this may vary from hospital to hospital, the following will serve as examples: 8 Discharges are checked against a discharge list supplied by a central hospital source. This is compiled either from discharge slips for each patient or from notification direct to Enquiries by ward staff. Transfers to other hospitals will normally be shown on the discharge list with the name of the hospital to which transferred. Deaths will also be shown on the discharge list but annotated deceased, and if a mortuary list is supplied this is used as a double check. Transfers between wards are checked on the ward transfer list also supplied from the central hospital source. Actioning ward bed states: 3. On receipt of the ward bed states all items have to be checked and the balance corrected. The first essential check is to ensure that the figure shown as patients remaining in the ward at the start of the 24 hour period is as shown on the last ward bed state received as patients remaining after previous days admissions and discharges had been actioned. Thisis checked against the previous ward bed states. All admissions, discharges, deaths and transfers (to other hospitals) must be checked against lists, and any discrepancies on the ward r?turns checked with the Ward Sister by telephone.Transfers between wards must be checked on the list supplied and also on bed states of both wards involved. When all bed states have been checked and balanced, the following takes place A. All admissions (including transfers from other hospitals) are totalled, B. All discharges (including deaths and transfers to other hospitals) are totalled. The balance between (A) and (B) above, are either added or deleted as applicable from the previous day's hospital total to give the new balance. '9 A suitable ward bed state is shown at Appendix A. 2.1 Patients who do not influence balance (i) Patients dead on arrival (2) Still births (3) Foetal deaths who do not breathe or show any signs of life. None of the above are admitted to hospital and therefore are not discharged and will in no way affect hospital totals. 2.2 Obtaining relevant information From the medical recording point of view .- apart from ward bed states which appear more or less standard in all hospitals - different sources of information will be found from hospital to hospital, but in all cases it is essential that information supplied by the ward is accurate. Where there are discrepancies a check must be made with the ward.- although the person answering the telephone will inevitably have been off duty when the report was prepared! .,........., The question of whether the daily census is . compiled. .in. the Medical Records department or by Enquiries is an open one which,, should be decided in the light of local conditions. In some hospitals it is compiled in the Admission Office. The requirements of the departments differ. Medical Records and Admission Office primarily require to know numbers whereas Enquiries must know, individual people and is not so concerned with balancing adrnissipns and discharges against those in hospital. This balance is, however, the sum of individuals. What has to be decided for each hospital is: is it better to partly duplicate the work done by Enquiries by Medical Records or can the information required by Medical Records be effectively and consistently produced by Enquiries? Admissions can be checked if Medical Records Office is supplied with duplicate copies of all admission slips and by a hospital list of all admissions (the latter usually maintained by Orderlies' Lodge). Live births in a maternity ward are not an admission but they are admitted if transferred to a general ward (refer as above). IM 8 (B)(1) Patients discharged during the 24 hour period, including - (2) Patients who have died, (3) Patients transferred out to other hospitals, (4) Patients transferred out to other wards. When all ward bed states have been obtained, they are totalled to give the overall hospital picture of (a) (1) Total number of patients in hospital at start of 24 hour period, (2) Total number of patients admitted during the 24 hour period, including - (3) Total number of live births during the 24 hour period, (4) Total number of patients admitted on transfer from other hospitals, (5) Total number of patients transferred between wards. (b) (1) Total number of patients discharged during the period, including (2) Total number of, patients who have died during the period, (3) Total number of patients who have been transferred to other hospitals, NOTE: Still births are not recorded as either admissions or discharges. Refer 'Medicolegal aspects of medical recordkeeping' (chapter +). for policy regarding admissions of babies born in hospital. It will be seen that, by adding all admissions (including transfers in from other hospitals and live births), to the total number of patients in hospital at the start of the period, then subtracting the total number of discharges (including deaths and transfers out to other hospitals) the new total will be the number remaining in. hospital for the start of the next 24 hour, period. Patients transferred between wards in the same hospital do not affect the figures, as they are neither admissions nor discharges. 117 of little use, as a breakdown in the continuity of the return will cause near chaos. Information gathered at the time of taking the census will be the basis of many returns, some of which may not be prepared for weeks or months later. The actual method of collecting the data will vary from hospital to hospital, but the methods described in this chapter may be taken as general principles on which to base a method suitable for the reader's own hospital. Some hospitals may collect only the information required for the actual . census, while others may, at this time, extract extra details which are "stored" until required to complete reports and returns. 2.Information required There are basic requirements that will be the same in all hospitals, and the period over which the census is taken - 2+ hours -.also appears standard in all institutions. How the information is collected, recorded and checked will, however, be dependent on the method best suited to the individual hospital. The actual time for start and finish of the 24 hour period may vary from place to place, though 12 midnight to 12 midnight seems the most favoured. There is no set time actually laid -down . , but it is essential that it remain the same every day. The data to be obtained are first gathered from individual ward bed states, hospital admission slips, discharge and death• lists and hospital transfer notices. They are then totalled to give the overall picture of occurrences, bed states and hospital totals. Ward bed states will show the following (A)(1) Number of patients in the ward at the start of the 24 hour period. (2) Number of patients admitted during the 24 hour period, including - (3) Live births, (4) Patients transferred in from other hospitals, (5) Patients transferred in from other wards. Jib 8 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand HOSPITAL CENSUS TAKING 1. Introduction 2. Information required 2,1 Patients who do not influence balance 2.2 Obtaining relevant information 3. Actioning ward bed state Lf,Information regarding available beds 4.1 Classification of admissions by sex, type and category 5. Social Security lists 6. M.S.18 statistical cards 7. References 8. Further reading 8.1 Basic Appx. A. Ward Bed State Appx. B. Census Form Appx. C. Available Bed Report Introduction: 1. In considering the requirements of hospital census taking, one must consider all aspects of the need and have available a simple but efficient method of carrying out this important duty. There can be no room for mistakes. Information gathered is going to show how many patients have been admitted, been born in hospitals, transferred from other hospitals, transferred from ward to ward, been discharged, transferred to other hospitals or have died.The information will first be gathered on an individual ward basis, then assembled to give overall hospital totals. In short, all occurrences involving in_patients movements , during 24 hour periods will be noted, co-related and assembled to produce a census of the activity for the period. It is essential that the method used to collect the data is as easily understood as possible and that as many persons as possible in the department be able to perform this duty. It must be carried out every 24 hours for every day of the year. A complicated system, understood by only one or two persons, is Webb (J.) Waiting list procedure Medical Record, Feb. 1958, pp 323-5 10.2 Background 'Admissions service at Archway' Hospital & Health Management, Nov. 1962, p 1013 Lefebvre ( p .) & Issartel (M.) Reception and humanisation of the hospital (Translation from French; abstract) Hospital Abstracts, Nov. 1961, p729 Luck (J.H.) Work study as applied 3rd mt. CongressRêport, to Medical Recordspp 88-106 10.3 Associative Nursing Times, April 28, Hollinworth (J.) Kardex in a 1961, pp 520-1; psychiatric hospital. Hospital Abstracts, Aug. 1. Patients records. 1961, pp 513-4 lilt, 'Medical Records & Secretarial Services' Hospital 0 & M Service Report No. 2. Appointments systems: pp 17-19; follow up: p 20; registration of patients: pp 21-2; waiting lists: pp 22-3 HOM.S.O, 1 959, p 32 Montmarin (J. de) The mechanisa- Hospital Abstracts, Aug. tion of admission procedures 1963, p (Translation; abstract) Morgan (J.H.) Medical RecordsMedical Record, April, Departments: the Cardiff Royal1951, pp 90-5 Infirmary Myson (J.G.) Addressing machine system at the London Hospital Medical Record, Feb. 1958, pp 29+-7 Quilter (Peter) Mechanical documentation 3rd mt. Congress Report, pp 220-8 Rivers (J.S.) The 'Hymm Board' Bed State Medical Record, Feb. 1951, pp 8-11, 35 Ross (D..H.) They get the right patient in - and out Modern Hospitl, March 1962, pp 85-7; Hospital Abstracts, June 1962, p353 Sibley (E.M.) The non-profes-Hospital Forum, June 1961, sional in the admitting office pp 22-4; Hospital Abstracts, Oct. 1961 p666 Thielmann (C.F.) A methods improvement case study: four departments, one aim: find a better way Hospitals, June 1, 1961, pp 40....3; Hospital Abstracts, Oct. 1961, p 652 Tiltman (RCS.) Practical aspects of a Medical Records Department Medical Record, May 1951, PP 136-9 'Waiting list systems' (at hospitals) 1 Webb (J.) The nurse and the medical records office (Nurses' responsibility re admitting) U!' Medical Record, Aug. 1955, pp Lf7280 Nursing Mirror, July 27, 1962, pp 319- 2 0; Hospital Abstracts, Dec. 1962, p 748 Dudgeon (w.J.) Admission Procedure and registration of inpatients: In a hospital for the treatment of mental illness Medical Record, Nov. 1955, Eastham (G.) 'Offset litho' for patient documentation The Hospital, Sept. 1961, PP 576-9; Hospital Abstracts, Jan. 1962, p 31 Eldridge (K.J.) Admission procedure and registration of inpatients: In a general hospital Medical Record, Nov. 1955, pp 526-8 pp 519-24 Hospital Abstracts, June 1961, 'For patients and visitors at the Rikshospital, Oslo' (Trans. p 394 from Norwegian; abstract) The Hospital, March 1962, Frazer (E.) Mechanisation in Hospital hospital medical records pp 16 5-9; Abstracts, June, 1962, Heel (E.M.) Admitting p353 Medical Record, Feb. 19651 pp 811,83-85 Hill (P.A.) Admission procedure.Medical Record, Nov. 1955, and registration of inpatients: PP 524-6 In a specialised hospital Hospital Forum, June 1961, Horton (E.E.) The professional 22-4; Hospital-Abstracts nurse in the admitting office pp Oct. 1961, pp-665-6 London, King Edward's 'Information booklets for patients': Report of an enquiry by Hospital Fund for London, the Division of Hospital Facilities 1962, 24 pp London, Institute of Hospital Institute of Hospital Admini strators Study & Research Administrators, 19 6 3, 37 pp; Committee. Hospital waiting Hospital Abstracts, June: lists: a report 19 6 3, p 331 Medical Record, Feb. 1963 Jackson (N.V.) Mechanical registration at low cost pp 633-9 Modern Hospital, Feb. 1961, Lake (R.) & Gilliam (T.R.) pp 112-3; Hospital Abstracts, Name plates system strips red July 1961, p 462., tape from addmissions HM.S.O., 1963, 3 pp . 'Mechanical registration of patients': Abstracts of Efficienty Studies in the Hospital Service, No. 49 Mitchell (Edith N.) Pre-admission Medical Record News, questionnaire (in 'What do June 1964, p 86 YOU do?') %J1,, 7 Laurenson (J.o.) Discussion: N.Z. Hospital, Dec. 1952, 'Admitting Systems'pp 52-9 MacEachern (M.T.) Medical Records U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., in the Hospital: pp 111-17 Physicians' Record Co., 1937, xvi + 374, illus. Stone (J.E.) Hospital OrganisLondon, Faber, 1952, ation and Management, pp 196-8, xxii + 1722 778-83, 806-78 Further reading: 10. Basic: 10.1. 'An Addressing Machine System': Abstracts of Efficiency Studies in the Hospital Service, No. 12 H.M.S.0.,1961, 3 pp Anspach (M.) The hospital in Belgium with special reference to the administration of a Records Department Medical Record, May 1953, PP 154-61 Brockis (n.J.) Records developments at Southend-on-sea Hospital (Mostly concerns admitting procedures) Medical Record, Feb. 1952 pp 272-5 Brown (A.M.) The hospital preadmission system Hospital Forum, June 1961, pp 19- 2 1; Hospital Abstracts, Oct. 1961, pp 22-4 Champer (J.) Weiss Memorial cuts admitting time in half with new forms, simplified procedure Hospital Topics, April 1962, pp 41-3; Hospital Abstracts, Sept. 1962, p 567 Hospitals, Dec. 1, 1961, pp 42-3; Hospital Abstracts, May 1962, p 306 Croder (D.M.) & McManus (M.C.) Information manual smooths admission procedure Dawson (J..F.) Medical Records Departments; South Devon & East Cornwall Hospital Medical Record, Nov. 1950, pp 7-14, 34 Dickinson (Miss N.D.) AdmissionMedical Record, Nov. 1955, procedure and registration ofpp 529-32 inpatients: In a Mental Deficiency Hospital Ui Miller (R.E.) The index for Medical Record news, roentgen diagnosis Oct. 1962, pp 20-6 22+, 226-9 (Wallace & Fullmer) Tumour registry (in 'What do YOU do'?') Jnl. AA1'iPL, Aug. 1961, p 27 MacEachern (M.T.) Medical Records U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., in the Hospital, p 177, pp 205-09, Physicians' Record Co. 2 15-19 9 222-36 1937, xvi + 374, illus. 'Medical Records & Secretarial Services' Hospital 0 & M Service Report No. 2 Diagnostic index: p 25 H.M.S.0. 1959 Pedelty (N.) A Scottish Master Index Medical Record, May 1959 pp 104-5 Report of a Committee on Medical Records in N.S.W. Hospitals N.S.W. Hospitals Commn. 1960, 54 pp Serviata (Sister Mary) Expanding the name file Medical Record News, Feb. 19629 pp 13, 36 Stone (J.E.) Hospital organisation and management, pp 792-3 London, Faber, 1952, xxii + 1722 Wood (D.B,) The diagnostic and operation indices in a teaching group Medical Record, Nov. 1953, pp 264-9 6.2 Background. Doran (M.T.) The need for research in Medical Recording methods 1st mt.. CongressReport, pp 129-41 Dudley H.A.F. The consultant's need Medical Record, Nov. 1962, pp 584-6 International Study Project 1: Diagnostic Indexes and Classification 2nd mt. Congress Report, pp 59-83 Kurtz (D.L.) Examples of research in Medical Recording methods 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 143-57 6.3 Associative Booth ( p . j .) The poisons index Medical Record, May 1962, PP 520-22 Houghton (Dr. L.E.) and Jolley (J.L.) A successful experiment in Medical Research: Feature cards applied to the analysis of response to chemotherapy Medical Re 'cord, May 1961, pp 403-8 6 (Marshall, Wright, Booker, Bald & Fieber) O.P. diagnosis and operation indices (in 'What do YOU do?') Jnl AAMRL, Dec. 1961, N.Z. Standard Specification 1 4 96:1959 'Alphabetical arrangement'. Schulz (M.D.) & Wang (o,C.) A simple method of follow-up, disease indexing and filing of radiation therapy records. N.Z.Standards Institute, Private Bag, Wellington. Radiology, Nov. 1962, pp 282-k pp 8k2-7 Further reading: 6 Basic: 6.1. Barrowman (R.D.) Diagnostic indices for the smaller hospitals Medical Record, Feb. 1 95 6 , pp 31, 38 Blankenburg (I.S.de) Patient indexing in hospitals in Venezuela - use of the family index Jnl. AAMRL, June 1958, Collison (R.) Colour, shape and form Office Magazine, Nov. Coulam (Miss N.R.) Indexing of disease coding systems Medical Record, Feb. Curtis (M.R.) The comprehensive card in the long-term hospital Jnl. AAMRL, April 1 9571 pp 57-60, 80 'Efficiency in hospital indexing of the coding systems of the International Statistical Classification and Standard Nomenclature....': Report of a collaborative study Jni. AAMPL, June 'Guide to the organisation of a Hospital Medical Record Department' pp 43-50 U.S.A., Chicago, Knight (J.) The International Statistical Classification of Diseases and its uses in diagnostic indices Medical Record, Feb. pp 99-101, iik 1963,-Pp 961-3 1960 9 pp 222-3 1959, pp 95-111, 129 Ill., American Hospital Assn., 1962, vii + 83 195 6 , pp 25-28 Office equipment is properly dealt with elsewhere but a few pointers are pertinent to the present section. Cards will always play a major part in index systems, and they should be of tough, durable paper while not being too thick, bearing in mind the tendency of card files to grow rapidly. It is not good practice for staff members to have to bend down too low to gain access to the bottom drawer of the cabinet; it is bad for working and can be detrimental to accuracy in filing and searching. Assuming that a perpetual card file is in use or will be chosen for the Patient index it is recommended that cabinet construction be of metal to reduce fire danger to vital information, and that the card size be kept as small as possible as this index is the most rapidly growing of all. Ensure, however, that no information that is vital to identification of the patient or to the location of his medical record is left off and that there is reasonable space to type or write in. The card should have the capacity to record dates of at least a dozen admissions to hospital before a continuation card must be made out. Finally it is recommended that this section be read in conjunction with the chapters on 'The International Classification of Diseases' (chapter 10), 'Classification of Diseases' (chapter ii), and 'Classification of Operations' (chapter 12) which are closely related and to a certain extent interwoven topics. 5.References Anspach (N.) The hospital service in Belgium with special reference to the administration of a Records Department Medical Record, May Collison (P.) Filing and indexing Pt. 4 Cards Office Magazine, April Gogan (I.) Automatic indexes for medical evaluation Hospitals,. Aug. 1, 1961, Huffman (Edna K.) Manual for Medical Record Librarians pp 2+5-308 ('Indexing procedures') U.S.A., Berwyn, Ill., 1 953, pp 154-61 .1963, p 294 Physicians' Record Co. 1959 xxx + 604, illus. Inglis (S.) Indexing and cross- •National Hospital, Feb. indexing of disease and1961, pp 21-4; operations Hospital Abstracts, July, 1961, p 440 6 recorded with great rapidity and can later be sorted and evaluated with equal facility by other machines by means of the punched holes, doing work that would represent . a considerably greater outlay in labour by manual methods. Machine processing of medical information is done in Wellington by the National Health Statistics Centre using MS18 statistical cards which add up to a punch card index for public , hospitals throughout the country. Hospital Boards, and even individual hospitals, could use the same methods to maintain their own disease, operation or physician's indices, although the determining factor here would be cost. A central office could use computers to receive, amass and interpret information from all hospitals in New Zealand to help determine such seemingly unrelated requirements as the number of bedpans likely to be required ten years henäe to the optimum treatment for allergies. Here again cost will determine when this becomes a fact. Conclusion: k. As mentioned in the introduction, indexing is a very important section of Medical Records Office procedure, and great care must be exercised in the setting up and maintaining of each index. Whatever systems are adopted must be adhered to without variation, and it is important that staff occupied in this activity fully understand procedures and the. need for accuracy. Vital information can be lost in the files for ever and the overall value of the department to the hospital reduced if full and intelligent attention is not paid to this job. The watchwords with any index are 'Adequacy' without undue 'Excess'. Provided it can meet all demands made upon it, then it can be assumed that sufficient attention is being paid to detail. It is not properly the function of the Medical Records Officer to decide on what should or should not be recorded. However, it is definitely a responsibility of such officers to keep abreast of the trends , and shifts of emphasis in medical research so that he or she may play his or her.proper role in consultation with doctors in ensuring that the diagnostic index is kept alive and accommodating to changing conditions. tt Operation cards may be kept in a loose leaf binder with dividing cards denoting the group and subgroup headings or they may form a visible card file. The latter is as always the more easy to use, but can become embarrassing as it grows larger. By using the former method of keeping operation cards, they may be gathered into years and bound in book form for reference. 2.4 The Physician's Index As mentioned earlier in this chapter, this index may be required by some hospitals. It is simply a record of the work done by each physician or surgeon of the institution, and enables him to evaluate and analyse the results of his own work if he should desire. No hard and fast rules govern this index, which may be loose leaf or of the visible card style, with a card for each doctor arranged in alphabetical order. Detail on the card is simple, having provision for the hospital number, the disease or operation and the end result, i.e. cured, relieved, died etc. Totals-may be taken out at the end of each year. This index may be considered over and above essential office routine and would normally only be kept if it became the policy of the hospital, after requests from the medical staff for the information to be recorded. 3.Machine recording Automation has, as with most other areas of human activity, found its way into the medical record field. This is, of course, by no means a new fact and automatic indexing and sorting and evaluation of medical information by machine process has proved well adapted and of immense value in many parts of the world. 3.1 The Punch Card method of indexing Almost everyone is today familiar with the punch card and its uses in many fields and none more so than coding staffs of public hospitals throughout New Zealand who work every day with the MS18 statistical card. There is no need to go into the intricaciep of the machinery involved to grasp 'the essentials of punch card indexing.Holes are punched in the card in determined positions according to the code number of' the disease being recorded, by a, special machine designed for this function. The information, i.e. the diagnosis or operation, is thus permanently 61 Any modifications made to the use of the International Classification should not be made without careful consideration and consultation with the medical staff. At the back of Vol. 1 of the International Classification of Diseases there are lists for special tabulations which would be suitable for the small hospital. 7The Operation Index: 2.3, As far as general principles are concerned, the fundamentals of operation indexing are the same as for Disease Indexing. Local conditions may, however, be said to play a larger part in determining how wide the classification is to be, and what form the index is to take. The Operation Code: 2,3.1, If a nomenclature of operations with code. numbers is to be employed in the hospital, then a card index similar to that described for use in Disease Indexing will be employed; cards will again be filed in numerical order according to code number. and entries made in the same way on a similar card format. Small differences to note are that the column headed Physician on the disease card will become 'Surgeon' on the operation card, and 'Associated Diagnoses' would become 'Associated Operation'. Operation Indexes other than a Coded Nomenclature: 2,3,2. In its simplest form, the index may be purely alphabetical, that is all operation names that begin with 'A' being grouped together and so on. This is a method that will be found adequate in only the smallest of hospitals. It is preferable for the grouping to be anatomical or systemic, and is covered in more detail under 'The Classificatio of Operations' (chapter 12). The actual degree of subgrouping will be determined by consultation with the medical staff, taking into account the variety of surgery performed and its quantity, and the demand that is likely to be made on the records for research. A complete operation classification is given in the International Classification of Diseases adapted for Hospitals, (I.C.D.A.) CODE 385 CATARACT HOSI?ITAL NO. ASSOCIATED DIAGNOSESIDAYS STAY RESULTI DOCTOR 7293260X(10) (9) 433.1(ii) 560.0 (12) CODE 560.0 HOSPITAL NO. I ASSOCIATED D 7293260X(ik) ( 1 3)433.1(15) 1 385X(16) 15 Cured I Smith INGUINAL HERNIA NOSES M 56 DAYS STAY 115 RESULTI DOCTOR Cured ISmith The decision whether to carry out cross indexing or simple indexing must be carefully made and due consideration must be given to the question of whether, in fact, the amount of research done in the hospital is sufficient to warrant the extra time involved. Modifications can of course be envisaged whereby, in a case with multiple diagnoses only the principal disease and principal complication be cross indexed and the remainder simply indexed. 2.2.2 Group indexing In countries where the Standard Nomenclature • (an alternative to the International Classification) is in common use, some hospitals employ what is known as Group Indexing where this nomenclature has been found too detailed for local use. Under this system diseases which are related topographically and etiologically are grouped together under a modified code number. The advantage is mainly that indexing becomes simpler because there are less code numbers to deal with and there are consequently less cards in the index. Although most hospitals will find the International Classification of Diseases suitable for indexing some small hospitals may find it desirable to modify the I.C.D. by broadening the grouping a little further, where the amount of classifying and indexing is small and of less variety. Such grouping would of course apply only to internal classification in the hospital, and not to statisti'cal cards prepared for the National Health Statistics Centre. 19 6 If a patient is admitted suffering from a number of diseases, then as stated, his hospital number will ppear on the individual card for each of his diseases. The choice may be made depending on local conditions, whether or not to employ cross indexing, whereby reference is made beside each entry 10 cards of other conditions. In hospitals where little research is done or doctors are not in the habit of requesting a combination of diagnoses for study, that is, they are only interested in a particular disease and not others that the patient may also have suffered on the same admission, then a considerable amount of time may be saved by NOT cross indexing. For example, by not cross indexing a case with four diagnoses, only four entries, one on each card, will be made against sixteen entries required if the case is cross indexed, when each card will have its own entry-PLUS reference to the other three. Example of Cross Indexing Patient is diagnosed as suffering from the following four conditions 1. 2, 3, +. Diabetes Mellitus Atrial Fibrillation Cataract Inguinal Hernia Cross indexing will be carried out as follows, demonstrating how 16 entries are necessary for four diagnoses - CODE 260 HOSPITAL NO, 7293 (i) CODE 433.1 HOSPITAL NO. 7293 (5) DIABETES MELLITUS ASSOCIATED DIAGN0SES IJ DAY5 STAY 4 33.1 (2) 385X(3) I RESULT JDOCTOR 15Re-Smith lieved 560.0 (4) ATRIAL FIBRILLATION ASSOCIATED DIAGNOSES AGE DAYS STAY RESULT DOCTOR 260X(6) 385X(7) 560.0 (8) 5615Re-Smith lieved irovide space for the following items:(a) the hospital number corresponding with the patient index (b) the patient's name (c) the patient's sex (d) the patient's age (e) the number of days stay in hospital (f) the physician's name (g) whether patient survived or died (h) disease manifestation (1) associated conditions (for use if full cross indexing employed - see below) One further column may be added if desired by the medical staff: (j) Result i.e.: Cured (C); Relieved(R); or Un-relieved(U) Savings can be made by using devices such as: instead of recording sex and age as two separate entries have two columns printed on the card headed M and F respectively. Write in the age under the correct heading, for example: MF 32 23 18 19 Medical staff vary in their opinions as to what is considered necessary to be recorded, butthought must be given to including information likely to be required later for medical research or education. Before a decision on the composition of the disease: index is made current and likely future requirements should be thoroughly discussed with medical staff. Indexingf diseases Indexing of diseases can be defined as "recording on a card all essential data on each patient suffering from a particular. disease for which that card is kept. 2.2.1 Indexing and cross indexing Simple indexing (that which is not cross indexing) involves recording the data according to (a) to (j) above on the individual disease card for each condition the patient was diagnosed as having, separately and without reference one to the other. 6 there is no card in the index, is made. The consequences of failure in this way are, to say the least, highly embarrassing when one is proved wrong, and could be fatal in a serious emergency. Proportion of names to letters of alphabet: 2.1.9. Finally, in planning the space to be allotted to each letter of the alphabet in an index, it is worth remembering that, in general, there are twice as many W's as A's; twice as many B's as G's and that about one name in every five begins with the letter M or S while it is 'obvious that few begin with X or Q or even I. Whatever filing rules are laid down must be adhered to and understood by all staff if the patient index is to be the trusted servant it is supposed to be. With regard to the patient index generally, it is important that, only, information relating to identification should be recorded therein and nothing of a medical or confidential nature as the patient index, unlike the medical records themselves, is open to other non-Record staff for various reasons, and such untrained persons could unwittingly give away medical details relating to a patient which could give rise to medico-legal difficulties. The Disease Index: 2.2. The first essential in establishing and maintaining a disease index is the possession of a thorough knowledge of the nomenclature employed and a sound familiarity with coding and medical terminology. This chapter should be read in conjunction with those dealing with Classifying of Diseases and Operations (chapters 11 and 12) because indexing is simply the practical application of a disease operation classification. 'The International Classification of Diseases' is universally used throughout New Zealand and is discussed in chapter 10. The Disease Index iE usually a card file of one type or another containing as many individual cards as code numbers including fourth digit sub-categories decided upon, assembled in numerical order following the scheme of the classification. Each card will be headed with the year of admission of the patient and the title of the disease according to the Classification, together with the appropriate code number. The main body of the card will then be divided into columns that should Acourt, Adcock, Ainsworth, Allard, Anderson, Attlee, etc. The number usdd will depend on the size of the index. Too many will be a nuisance and too few of little value. Examination of your own index would suggest the proportion. 2.1.5 More than one card There is usually one card per patient but of course some, by reason of many admissions, will run to two or more. It is best to arrange these in chronological order with the card showing the first admission nearest to the front of the drawer. 2.1.6 Titles Titles such as Dr., Rev., or Father, Sister etc. are not taken to be part of the surname for filing purposes, but may be placed before the first or Christian names on the card as long as they do not take part in the sequence of letters. 2.1.7 Maiden names, etc. The legal name of a married woman is always the one used for filing though if desired for additional identification, her. husband's first name may be shown in brackets, e.g.. Mrs. Wilma Blank (James).If a women's surname changes by virtue of.1 marriage or remarriage between admissions, it is.wise to maintain two cards in the file with the later one referring to the. card bearing the previous name, e.g. Blank, Joan (nee Williams). A full cross index is provided by noting also the first card with the words 'see floW t as with: Williams, Joan (see now 'Blank'). Dates of admission will also be transferred to the new card.This procedure safeguards against the not too infrequently met occurrence of a woman patient choosing to resume her previous name.Patients of both sexes will be encountered who are known by more than one name and are wont to alternate them between. admissions. A similar type of cross reference to that just described will be of value. It is definitely unwise to erase a prior name, substituting the new one, and filing the card elsewhere in the index. 2.1.8 Different spellings In searching the master index, it should always be kept in mind that there are many and various ways of spelling some names, and as many possibilities as can be thought of by everyone in the office should be investigated before an arbitrary decision that 6 In case of doubt,, refer to the N.Z. standard specification. Foreign names: 2.1o5r Some degree of difficulty and or confusion may be expected over the indexing of some foreign names, particularly of Asiatics or Pacific Islanders, Ignoring the intricacies of foreign name structures and dealing only with the manifest results, it will be found that such patients may reverse the order of their names between admissions so that what was the 'surname' on one occasion may become or appear as the first or Christian name or names, on the next. This situation can also arise as a result of language difficulty, when the Admission Officer may find it impossible to communicate what is meant in English by the term 'surname' to the patient. While it is not feasible to suggest that all foreign names appear re-arranged at some future date, it is essential that all discovered instances be FULLY CROSS INDEXED in the Patient File. The Index must therefore contain either: (a) A duplicate card for each name variation known and each having a notation stating "SEE ALSO" and thereafter listing the others. With this method, each card must be brought up to date on each admission. or(b) One master card covering all details of admissions and discharges etc., under a selected name variant and 'dummy' cards for the others, each having a reference to the master card. Aids to location in filing: A worthwhile refinement to arranging index cards is to insert at regular intervals in each drawer taller cards bearing the surname to which they are adjacent. If the names on your. standard cards are typed near enough to the top this can be done by taping or stapling them onto a 'standard card i ll or so from the bottom. By providing a quick guide to the relative alphabetical positions within the drawer they save a great deal of time in needless thumbing through cards. For example, in the 'A' section a guide card could be set up at the names 2.1.2 Order of filing The cards must always be arranged in strict alphabetical order as in a dictionary or telephone directory. It is a matter of choice if a special drawer is. maintained for the Mc's and Mac's, otherwise these are placed in their appropriate position with other names begining with MAC.... Prefixes are treated as part of the name, e.g. Thomas A'Kempisfile as AKEMPIS, Thomas DATH, George George d'Ath Leonie de Brett DEBRETT, Leonie Maisie de la Rue DELARUE, Maisie Alexander du CroixDUCROIX, Alexander Ramon El Cortez ELCORTEZ, Ramon Helene L'Africe LAFRICE, Helene Michael la Roche LAROCHE, Michael LEFEVRE, Joan Joan le Fevre TEPAA, Ngaire Ngaire Te Paa VAAFUSU, Maatsu Maatsu Va'Afusu VANBERGEN, Hermien Hermien van Bergen VANDENBERG, Rex Rex van den Berg VANDERWAL, Thelonius Thelonius van der Wal Hermann von SturmerVONSTURMER, Hermann M' and Mc are treated as Mac, e.g. Angus M'Tavishfile asMACTAVISH, Angus' MACDONALD, Flora Flora McDonald St. is treated as if spelt in full e.g. Gordon St. John SAINTJOHN, Gordon The ones very seldom met with are best filed under the main name, e.g. Dilys ap Morgan MORGAN, Dilys ap In the case of Chinese names ascertain which is the surname or family name and file it as usual, e.g. FONG, Tom Tom Fong HOY, Fang Fang Boy There will be many instances of the same surname appearing in the index. This presents no problem and serves to illustrate the wide flexibility of the card index if the strict alphabetical sequence is simply carried on through the first names. Filing of cards is made generally easier and more accurate if the names themselves are ignored as such and simply regarded as "onesuccessionofletters". Ignore the hyphen in compound surnames. M. filing cards according to the sound of the name and not according to the spelling. It is in limited use in smaller hospitals in countries like the U.S.A. where there is an enormous variety of surnames - a prime reason for its use; in New Zealand, however, where there are relatively fewer surnames phonetic filing will not be found of great use and is not recommended, although a modified form of this system is in use in some hospitals and in the National Health Statistics Centre. Certain names are filed together, e.g. Gray and Gray, Johnson & Johnstone, Reid, Read and Reade. If the Greys and Grays are filed under Grey, a marker card is filed under Gray pointing out this fact. An advantage of this system is that the lazy researcher is more likely to find a previous reference —to 'a wrongly spelt name this way.The visible card file needs no explanation these days but it is worth noting that it has been described as 'the most flexible way of organising information yet invented' and is indeed an indispensable servant as long as it remains comparatively small. It can become an embarrassing burden as it grows ever bigger. This factor is, however, heavily outweighted by the advantage it holds over the old bound book system of indexing,. in which it is possible to group only surnames beginning with each letter of the alphabet. With the card index, however, it is possible to arrange every surname under each letter in a predestined and rapidly located position when the cards are filed in strict alphabetical order, that is, following the alphabet letter by letter through the surname and on through the first names to a fine degree of subdivision. The possible positions are therefore virtually endless. Assembling of patients' index cards in separate groups according to the year of admission is not recommended, and is a method that has been replaced by the perpetual index which contains the cards of all patients irrespective of when they were admitted and is by far the less cumbersome. It is difficult for patients to remember sufficiently exactly when. they were last admitted," therefore any system based on the year of admission is a poor one. The following points should be borne in mind when operating a patient index: Surnames: 2.1.1. The surname should always appear first on the card, followed then by the Christian or first names. it proportion of the entries against the time consumed in entering •a great many more that will never be used. Added to this basic problem is the complication, particularly in a medical index, of the very rapidly shifting emphasis on the type of demands made upon it, due to advances in medical discoveries. Early workers in this field may have been carried away in their first flush of enthusiasm with the notion of indexing everything and anything. However, over the years as techniques have developed and been refined in the hard school of experience, it has now become more a matter of tailoring the system to fit the needs of the hospital in which it is used. It is obvious, therefore, that there are a number of variables to be taken into consideration in establishing an indexing programme for a particular department in a particular hospital. An index that meets less than the demands that will be made upon it will be unsatisfactory as will the over-elaborate and top heavy system that requires a vast amount of labour to maintain but has few demands made •upon its resources. It has been said that the final test of an index is whether in fact it satisfies the medical staff who have to use it. Once an indexing procedure has been decided on, the prime concerns become completeness and accuracy within the adopted framework. A Medical Records department will invariably be judged by the manner and ease with which the information stored within its archives can be released for practical use by doctors and others, and this factor will vary in direct relation to . the.. degree of skill and attention that is applied to this section of office procedure. . 2.Indexes of the Medical Records department i. 2. 3. +. The Patient index The Disease index .1. The Operation index... The Physician's index. (Not always required to be kept by many hospitals but can be of great value to medical staff) The Patient index ,This index is the key needed to locate medical records and any other information relating to a patient held by.the Medical Records department. It is usually an arrangement of cards kept in a vertical file in strict alphabetic order, or, if desired, filed by the phonetic systems It is not proposed to describe phonetic filing in detail in this chapter. Briefly, it means 7, Medical Records Practice in New Zealand INDEXING PROCEDURES 1.Introduction Indexes of the Medical Records department 2.1 The patient or file index 2.1.1 Surnames 2.1.2 Order of filing 2.1.3 Foreign names 2,1.+ Aids to location in filing. 2.1,5 More than one card 2.1.6 Titles. 2,1.7 Maiden names etc. 2.1.8 Different spellings 2.1.9 Proportion of names to letters of alphabet 2,2 The Disease Index 2.2.1 Indexing and cross indexing 2,2.2 Group indexing 2.3 The Operation Index 2 .3.1 The operation code 2,3.2 Operation indexes other than a coded nomenclature 2.4 The Physician's Index 3.Machine recording 3.1 The punch card k.. Conclusion method of indexing 5,References 6.Further reading 6,1 Basic 6.2 Background 6.3 Associative Introduction: 1. The indexing of files, diseases and operations may well be described as a corner stone of Medical Record Office procedure. Medical records are by their nature a mass of statistical information, which must be sorted, classified, and recorded in . such a way as to render it quickly and easily accessible to doctor and research worker, who must in turn be able to rely on a high degree of accuracy. -Maintaining an index of any kind is very much a problem of balancing the time saved in finding a relatively small Kurtz (D.L.) Examples of research in Medical Recording methods 1st mt. Congress Report, pp lLf3_57 (Lincoln & Naylor) Record department administration, physical plant, functional organisation and other factors 2nd mt. Congress Report, PP 150-67 'Medical Records' N.Z. Hospital, June p 61+. Wakely (Gerald) 'What's your name and number?'... Medical Record, Feb. 1966, pp 213-216 8.3 1952, Associative Schulz (M.D.) & Wang (C.C.) A simple method of follow-up, disease index and filing of radiation therapy records Radiology, Nov. 1962 pp 81+2-7 b9 S Luck (J.H.) Work study as applied to Medical Records 3rd mt. Congress Report, Hill (Peter A.) Work study and the clinical record. 3. Filing Medical Record, Feb. McWhirter (Prof. P.) The Medical Record Service and malignant disease (includes remarks on unit system) 3rd mt. Congress Report, pp 88-106 pp 207-211 1966, PP 57-70 'Medical Records & Secretarial H.M.S.O. 1959 Services' Hospital 0 & M Service Report no. 2 p.12-14 Morgan (J.H.) Medical RecordsMedical Record, April 1951 Departments: The Cardiff Pp 90-5 Royal Infirmary Pedelty (Neil) The Copenhagen N.Z. Medical Record, Dec. 1966 County Hospital medical records pp 2 7-31, 14, 46 system Seymour (E.L.) Filing and disposition of records 1st mt. Congress Report, Seymour (E.L.) Visual Automatic filing Medical Record, June, 1951 PP 91-103 Pp 156-59 Wakely (Gerald). A question of N.Z. Medical Record, identity: a hospital identi-Sept. 1 9 6 7, pp 21 -33, 45 fication system for New Zealand Wolstejn (Mrs. E.) Medical records in hospitals in the General N.Z. Medical Record, Federation of Labour in Israel Sept. 1967, P p 1 3-20, 45; Medical Record, Feb. 1967, PP 10-13 Background: 8.2. Clarke (K.W.) The group organisation in Medical Records 1st mt. Congress Report, Doran (M.T.,) The need for research in Medical Recording methods 1st mt. Congress Report, PP 117-27 pp 129-41 Dudley (H.A.F O ) The Consultant's Medical Record, Nov. 1962 need for Medical Records PP 580-86 Fraser (Dr. A.) A Consultant's Medical Record, Nov. 1963 view of Medical Records pp 582-8 'Future use of Medical Records' Medical Record, Nov. (three views) PP 433-42 1961, 8. Further reading 8.1 Basic Balmer (N.) Colour in serial Medical Record News, Oct. 1963, numbering pp 197-9 Bothwell (P.w.) R outine, records Medical Record, Aug. 1960, and research Pts I - III pp 298, 302; Nov. 1960, PP 320-7; Feb. 1961, pp 359-6k Britton (D.B.) Filing systems - Medical Record, May 19629 aids to efficiency pp 523-30 I Brockis (R.) Supervision ofMedical Record, Nov. 1958, filing procedurespp 44-47 Brockis (R.) Tracing system Medical Record, Feb. 1956, pp 14-15, 37 Collison (R.) Filing and index- Office Magazine, April 1963, ing Pt. 4 Cards Collison (R.) Filing of tomorrow Office Methods & Machines, Dec. 1964, pp 1025-7 Collison (P.) The secrets of successful filing Office Magazine, March 1964, Chamberlain (J.) Finding the misfiles in a terminal digit system Jnl AAMRL, Aug. 1961, Coombes (PS) Getting more files into the same space Medical Record, Aug. 1957, Ferguson (P.) Supervision of filing procedures Medical Record, Nov. , 1958, 'Filing by the terminal digit method' in 'Methods at work' London Current Affairs Ltd., 1962, 101 pp. Gibbins (C.H.,) & Cashmore (V. F.) Control of appointments and records Medical Record, May 1957, 'Guide to the organisation or a Hospital Medical Record Department' pp 11-17 U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., Hadlett (E.A.) The ideal. hospital filing system Medical Record, Aug. 1955, Hunt (C.A.) A simple tracing system N.Z. Medical Record, Dec. 1964, p 13 Kurtz (Dorothy L.) Culling Medical Record News, Dec. pp 1-7 pp 396-8 pp 159, 177 p 257, 262. pp 47-8 pp 201-6 American Hospital Assn., 1962, vii + 83 pp 489-91. 1964, pp 247-50 4 5 Medical Records department'). Summary and conclusion: 6. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi) A good filing system ensures that records can be produced when wanted, Identification can be: alphabetical (not. recommended) or numerical. Numbers should be given on admission in preference to discharge or by diagnostic classification. Numbering can be: serial (not recommended); serial unit (where space is at a premium); unit (recommended). The unit number can be a digit number, or the 'New Plymouth' system or the 'Luhn code'. Filing systems are decentralised or. centralised (recommended) or a combination of both. (vii) Shelf filing can be straight numerical or terminal digit. (viii) Advantages of terminal digit are uniform expansion, easier filing and facilitates 'team' organisation of department. (ix) Arranging files up and down rather .than across makes for easier reference. . The unit number system and terminal digit filing are recommended as experience in overseas hospitals has proved their worth which has been confirmed by those New Zealand hospitals using the system. . References: 7. Huffman (Edna K.) Manual for Medical Record Librarians. Physicians' Record Co., 1 959, pp 16 7- 1 90 ('Numbering and filing medical records') Proceedings of the 1st Conference of N.Z. Medical Records Officers' Association, 1965 N.Z. Medical Record, August 1966 5.2.3 Colour coding As a guard against misfiling the record container can be colour coded. Advertisements in overseas journals advocate multiple colour coding. However exciting this might be for the decor of the department it is not practicable under New Zealand conditions. Colour coding should therefore be for the terminal digit of the primary number, i.e. 0 -9. The colours chosen should be ones which will be legible since not more than one printing should be done (refer chapter 20 'Design of forms' para 4.3).. Obviously dissimilar colours must be used for numbers which are liable to be confused at a first glance e.g. 3 and 5 or 8, 6 and 9, 9 and 0. 'Coloured adhesive tape can be used for the second digit in the primary pair and/or for the terminal digit in the secondary pair. However, tape is liable to come off and there is no point in, operating an elaborate taping system if it takes more time than searching for a misfile. Similarly, colour coding containers which stay on the shelves whilst the contents travel is pointless; it merely shows that the envelope was correctly filed in the first place. If the envelope travels with the record inside then it should be colour coded to guard against misfiling when it returns and is put into file; if the envelope stays on the shelf and the contents travel then the latter should be coloured. A folder, colour-coded, would be cheaper. 5.2.4 Misfiles Edna Huffman quotes the following: (1) Look for transpositions of the last' two digits of the number, or of the hundreds or thousands digits. (ii) Look for misfiles of t31 under '5' or 1 8' and vice versa; and of '7' or 1 8 , under' '9'. (iii) (iv) (v) Check for a certain number in the hundred group just preceding or following the number as 485 under 385 or 585, or under other similar conibinations. Check for transpositions of first and last numbers. Check the folder just before and just after the one needed. It sometimes happens that a folder is put into another folder rather than between two folders. 5.3 Tracing records Methods of recording the whereabouts of records removed from file are covered in chapter 3, para 2.2 ('Organisation of a 5 Conversion back to total running feet - 58 x 3 x 7 = 1218 ft will indicate that there is more shelving than was originally asked for, i.e. 1218 ft total instead of 980 ft. or 12.18 ft per primary number instead of 9.8 ft. It will be recalled that this was described as the ideal situation and it will be apparent that the extra shelves, whilst not lending themselves to use for the terminal digit filing, will not be wasted. In practice, what usually happens is that one is given an area and a compromise has to be reached between shelving wanted for the ideal time for which records are to be kept and the shelving that will fit in the area. Therefore, as indicated above, , the compromise will include some fixed shelving for terminal digit and some mobile shelving for straight numerical filing. How to arrange files: 5.2.2. Filing is made easier if done from top to bottom rather than along since this avoids always having to get up or bend down for one primary number. Thus assuming four 3 ft bays with 7 openings, filing along the shelves: but up and down: -z 4 z 4 ; 4 01—,7- , -,> 0____ 0) 03 6L. 10 Example: Records to be kept in terminal digit filing for 7 years. Average anticipated discharges per year = 7000 Average number of records/ft = 50 •'. Running feet of shelving required = 7 x 7000 altogether 50 or7x7000 100 for each primary 50 number = 9.8 ft Nearest multiple of 3ft above= . 1 , 2 ft .'. No. of 3ft bays required =12 x 100 3 No. of units 7 openings high = 400 = 400 7 571/7 = i.e. 58 This requirement is then worked out in terms of the filin g suitable for the area. If all are free standing and can therefore. be assembled back to back they might be in units . 9 ft. or 12 . ft . long so that access is easy: .... . '.. Units:, .3' . x !?. shelves WOMM 16 M=M" 16 mm ^ IMMMMI 14 12 58 0 Any hospital that contemplates changing over to this method of filing would have no difficulty in doing so. It is not necessary to convert old records to the system; all that is required is to set a 'deadline' and commence your new system and as readmissions are made convert the old records as required. To summarise the advantages of terminal digit filing; (i) all sections expand uniformally; (ii) annual transfer of files to storage is eliminated; (iii) filing is evenly distributed among filing clerks; (iv) reduces misfiling to a minimum. Determining how much space is needed: 5.2.1. The ideal situation is described first. Decide: for how many years are records to be kept in terminal digit filing. Calculate: (i) (ii) average anticipated discharges/year average no. of records/ft. of shelving Formula: Years of storage X average discharges- Total running feet of Records/ft.- shelving required then:Punning feet shelving - required- No. of feet required for 100- each primary number This is then taken up to the nearest multiple of 3ft. (the standard shelving unit) .. No. of 3' bays required = Nearest multiple of 3ft x 100 But shelving is so many openings high (7 recommended for fixed shelving), therefore calculate the number of units required 3ft long x 7 openings high.(Specifying 'openings' rather than 'shelves' is preferable as less ambiguous; 'shelves! could include the top, unused shelf) it can be seen that all files on each shelf must end with the primary number, as example the file quoted above would be on shelf 42. This also tends to decrease the chance of files being misfiled. Therefore, on the shelf labelled 42, assuming that numbering started at 000001, the first files will be 000042, the next 010042, and so on to 2400 1+2; the next will be 0001+2, 0101 1+2 ... 240142, 000242, 010242 ... 240242 and so through the changing secondary numbers to 006642, 016642, 026642 .... 236642, 246642. There will not be another record placed in the 1+2 shelf for another 100 numbers and not another in the 66 division of the +2 shelf for another 10,000 numbers. With terminal digit filing the shelves on average fill equally rather than at the end as is the case with numerical filing. It is essential to be able to locate a file as soon.as possible and under this method it is only a matter of seconds, once the number is known, to do this. The clerk is able to go to the right shelf and the right divider straight away and it is then easy to find a number of two digits; this is not possible in any of the other systems. Another advantage of this method is explained in detail in chapter 3 ('Organisation of a Medical Records department')., Briefly, because each section is added to equally it is possible to distribute the work in the office equally by making different clerks responsible for blocks of numbers of records - the "team' concept. The system has the disadvantage that space must be kept free for expansion and this is very difficult to do where' space is limited. The method is not suitable for use with mobile shelving and, if used where space is limited, it involves continual culling to take records not in use out of the system and into less convenient storage. This, however, does mean that each record must be looked at and long-standing misfiles can be picked up in this way. Therefore, because space is seldom unlimited, it will usually be more realistic to keep the more immediately needed records in terminal digit filing and older ones in mobile shelving or less accessible shelving filed numerically. The aim should be to have 7 years' terminal digit filing but if only 3-4 years can be kept terminal digitally the system is still worthwhile. Below this, however, it needs to be ascertained that much moving to and fro will not be involved.' S Shelf filing methods: 5. There are two ways medical records may be filed numerically on the shelves in Medical Records departments: Straight numerical method: 5.1. Firstly, there is the conventional numerical method, which has been in use by hospitals for many years. Using this method the records are filed in numerical order with a guide at least every 500 charts. If filed annually then guides should indicate where each year starts. This method has the disadvantage that current filing activity is concentrated on one or two shelves causing congestion in a large department where several people pull and replace records. It is easy to make errors by transposing digits. Terminal digit method: 5.2. Secondly, there is the less conventional method known as the terminal digit system. This method of filing has been very successful particularly in larger hospitals. Terminal digit filing is a simple but speedy and accurate method of filing. This method eliminates many possible filing errors, as it practically does away with the transposition of numbers, the commonest of errors in filing. . When filing under this method the clerk only need keep two digits in mind at the time of filing. The details of terminal digit filing can be described as follows: on admission the patient is assigned a number which is broken down into digit groups for reading from right to left. The first two digits, on the right hand side are called the primary number, the next two numbers on the left of the primary numbers are called the secondary numbers. Taking a hospital number as an example, 2 1-f66 1-f2, the number is first divided into three parts 24-.66-. - 2. The last two digits constitute the primary number. As there will be a large number of files ending with 42 this needs to be subdivided first to the secondary digits - 66 - and then according to the third group. Thus a patient with the number 246642 would be filed in the division 66 (secondary numbers ) of the 42 section (primary number) in the sequence of the third group of digits. If the terminal digit system is used, it is advisable if space permits, to have 100 filing, shelves in sets of 10. If this is practicable, connectionbetween the files; if the patient is transferred from one department to another the record is obtained by way of loan. As an example, when a patient visits the Outpatient department, the record is filed in that department. If the patient is subsequently admitted to hospital the record for that hospitalisation is filed in the Medical Records department. The patient on discharge may revisit the outpatient clinic for further treatment, in which case the record previously made by the outpatient clinic is brought forward but is not combined with the record held in Medical Records. Such a method could be detrimental to the patient and hinders efficiency, as all records concerning the patient are not immediately available at all times. Records are inclined to become duplicated which not only increases operating costs but in most cases takes up valuable filing space. For these reasons this method is being replaced by the centralised system in the majority of hospitals throughout the country. 4.2 Centralised system Under this arrangement all the medical records of the patient whether inpatient or outpatient, are filed together in . the.one department. Under the centralised system any method of numbering. as outlined above may be used. It has the advantage that all records are together.Those who prefer to keep records decentralised say that the centralised system ,means that they cannot immediately answer telephone enquiries from private practitioners about patients who have attended at their departments. This again is a matter of administrative inconvenience which is outweighed by the clinical importance of having all records in one place, Specialist departments (e.g. neurology, cardiology, teaching and research units) argue strongly that they should 'keep their own records. Generally accepted practice overseas which is , equally applicable to New , Zealand is that there is nothing to prevent a department doing this within reason provided that these records are copied (not physically abstracted) from the main record. To what extent this is done will depend on staff .and.other facilities available but the object would be to accumulate material for research and teaching and not to substitute departmental notes for the patient's medical record. Whether or not centralisation should include Accident & Emergency department records is discussed in chapter 16 ('Outpatient and Accident & Emergency department procedures'). the same month, would be impracticable in a large hosp4t•ai (over 200 beds) The 'Luhu' system: 3.3.3. This system, devised by a member of the staff of IBM, utilises the first i-i- letters of the surname, first two initials, the birthday (day of month and month and unit of year) and a machine-generated check number. If the patient is a woman 5 is added to the first digit of the day of birth. it is ' claimed to have a duplication rate of only 1 in 10,000. Thus John Montmorency Smith, born 18 August 1 938 , might have the number: SMITJM18889, the last figure being the check number. This system has to be used with data processing equiment with an attachment to generate the check number, which is a device to check against transposition or writing a wrong digit. If, for instance, the number had been written SMITJM 18389 the machine would query the number because this combination would not provide the check number 9. The system has the disadvantages that it relies on the correct and consistent spelling of a consistent surname (though a computer could be programmed to search for alternative spellings) and accurate and consistent birth dates. It is not suitable for terminal digit filing. Both the systems relying on the use of names as part of the number are particularly unsuited for hospital admission numbers in New Zealand because of the number of unmarried mothers using false surnames for social reasons, the tendency of Maoris to use Maori or Pakeha names at will and of Islanders to interchange surnames and Christian or first names and the difficult>rthat predominantly pakeha clerks have in spelling these names. Filing systems: 4. Systems of filing, apart from the numbering system, fail into two categories: decentralised or centralised, Cr S combination of both. Decentralised system:+.i. Under this arrangement the inpatient and outpatient departments have their own records and file them independently within their own department. Unless a central summary card of all attendances both inpatient and outpatient, is kept, there is no number how many patients have been in during the year. Detractors of this system stress this disadvantage, which is purely one of administrative inconvenience at the expense of the advantage of having all notes in one pack, which is a clinical one. There are different methods of allotting a number which are suitable for the unit system; these are discussed below. 3.3. 1 Digit number A single number of +, 5 or 6 digits is allotted, depending on the size of the hospital. As 6 digits can be difficult to remember one letter could be introduced, and would thus have the effect of adding 26 extra digits. This would still lend itself to terminal digit filing (see para 5.2 below) as long as it preceded the primary and secondary numbers. Errors in transcribing numbers can be lessened if they are treated as pairs of numbers 36 75 06 - as with the terminal digit filing system rather than one long number - 367506. 3.3.2 The 'New Plymouth' system This system, used satisfactorily at New Plymouth Hospital, employs the first three letters of the patient's surname, the month and last two figures of year of birth. Where any numbers are missing an X is substituted. Thus, John Smith born in August 1938 would be given the number SM1838. The advantages of this system are that as soon as the patient's surname and month and year of birth are known he can be given a number, the system is easy to operate and the records can be found if index cards etc. are missing. A further advantage is that a number can be issued by any department of the hospital as soon as name and month and year of birth are known. However, this is offset by the disadvantage that variations in spelling of surnames will involve looking in different places (Gray, Grey, Smith, Smyth etc.) and consequently the patient index has to be consulted.Further disadvantages are that the system assumes constancy in surnames which is not the case particularly with Maoris and Islanders and after a woman has married requiring reference again to the patient index for birth dates, addresses etc.; reliable dates of birth are frequently difficult to obtain. This system is not suitable for terminal digit filing. Furthermore, the system, by requiring one to search out the John Smith who was born in August 1938 from amongst all the Charles, Federick, James and Montmorency Smiths born in 57 old envelopes/tracers have to be renumbered; if 'readmitted' then reference has to be made to the index. Whichever is done this takes longer than referring to a single once-fo-al number, and chances of error increase. However, where the number of people under the same name in the patient index is not too many, reference would be from the Disease Index to the patient index and thence to the latest admission. It is good practice in this and other method 's to maintain a summary sheet at the front of the record pack showing dates of admission and discharge, diagnoses, operations and, under the serial unit numbering system, the hospital number. Although the serial unit numbering system is considerably used in New Zealand it is being replaced by the unit numbering system which is a better system. Unit numbering system: 3.3. The patient is given a number on admission or first attendance at the in- or out-patient department of the hospital and retains that number for all subsequent admissions to any department or ward with the possible exception of the Accident & Emergency and X-ray departments. If this method is employed the filing shelves must not be filled to capacity as the record is continuous and additions will be made following each readmission. The main advantage of this system is that all the records of the patient irrespective of the type of disease or disability are kept together so that the doctor treating the patient may consider the patient as a complete identity. Considered a disadvantage by those used to the serial unit system with records in annual blocks is the absence of an indication of year in the number. Consequently, it is not possible to extract records for a certain year for filing elswhere merely by looking at the number. This, however, can be an advantage in that it means that each record has to be looked at individually and random misfiles can then be picked up. This means a readjustment in work habits whereby culling is done methodically day by day rather than in an orgy at the end of the year.Another disadvantage (by comparison with the number allotted on each admission starting from 1 each year) is that one cannot see at a glance from the current hospital ment which the previous records require him to get. This disadvantage can, to a certain extent, be overcome by keeping an index card on which all the numbers are recorded; this should also show the diagnosesFurthermore, a summary card of inpatient and outpatient attendances should be used. It still involves, however, going to several-different places for previous records. It should be clear that this method is not recommended. 3.2 Serial unit numbering syste.m By this method the patient is assigned a new number on each admission and all previous records are brought up to the latest number on each readmission. If this system is used and the records for all admissions are combined, the same •procedure may be followed with the patient's index card, by showing all the previous admission numbers on the index card, and not creating a new card for each admission. When this method of numbering is used the filing shelves may be filled to capacity as the records are complete when filed. This is one of the advantages of this method of filing. It is also a disadvantage in that the temptation is, when moving records for filing elsewhere, to take an entire shelf without checking individual records which is the only way that long-standing misfiles can be found. The main disadvantage comes in referring to these records from the disease index.. To take an example: cases of chorea in females of childbearing age are required. These will be •few and therefore spread over many years. If one is found who was admitted 10 years ago and has subsequently been admitted for other reasons the latest number has to be found. As the Disease Index usually only lists surnames, initials and sex (refer chapter 6, : para 2.2) it is not practicable in the larger hospitals to search the patient index until the patient's card with the latest number is found. It will therefore be necessary to work forward from admission to admission until the latest one is found. To enable this to be done the following procedure has to be carried out for all records where there is a readmission: (i) (ii) the original envelope or a tracer has to be left in place of the number shown in the disease index; this envelope or tracer has to have either the following number, the latest number or 'readmitted' on it. If it has the following number then one looks at each succeeding envelope/tracer until the current one; if the latest number is put on then for every redmission all 5 and the unit method-s. Before determining which to use it must be decided how the number is to be allotted to the patient. This can be: (i) (ii) (iii) admission numbers. A number is allotted to a patient on admission or first attendance. This is the generally accepted method, since, for positive identification, a patient must have a number throughout his hospital stay; discharge number. The number is allotted on the patient's discharge; diagnostic classification code numbers allotted in accordance with the classification of the final diagnosis. Neither this nor the previous method is recommended because the patient does not receive a final number while he is under treatment. In the case of the diagnostic classification number system a temporary number is given while the patient is in hospital and this is changed to the diagnostic classification number for filing purposes. Thus there is no positive identification of the patient because there could be confusion between the two numbers. Serial Numbering system: 3.1. In this method the patient is assigned a new number on each admission, regardless of the number of readmissions, the number always being the next unused number in either the patient's register or the number index. Some hospitals using this method prefix the number with the year and begin at number 1 at the beginning of each year. The disadvantage of this system is that the patient's record is filed in one or more places in the filing depending on the number of times the patient is admitted. One advantage of the system is that filing takes less time, as it is not necessary to look up and bring forward previous records. This advantage is heavily outweighed in that, when the records are disturbed in this manner, more time is required for collecting all the previous notes together should they be required by the physician or surgeon. This makes the doctor reluctant to ask for all the records, and in such cases the patient may not receive the treat- (i) (ii) (iii) The medical records should be able to be produced when and where required in the minimum amount of time and with the minimum amount of effort; the system should provide safe and confidential custody of the records and be as foolproof as possible; the best use should be made of available space. 2Method As the medical records are .wanted 'for future reference' it follows that: (i) (ii) there must be a way of identifying them; they must be so located and arranged that they can be found. Identification can be: (i) alphabetical. By this method the records are kept in order one behind the other in alphabetical sequence of surnames. Because so many names are the same this has not been found a reliable method for medical records; it is,. however, necessary for indexes (refer 'Indexing procedures' - chapter 6).. (ii) numerical. If each medical record, or all those relating to one person, is given, a number, the number can be ascertained from the index and the records can be filed numerically as explained below. By 'location' is meant the choice between decentralising having records relating to a patient in different places depending on the reason for which he attended the hospital - or centralisation - having all the records relating to a. patient in one place, normally the Medical Records department. These choices are discussed below. How the records are arranged means the way in which they are physically arranged on the shelves - should they be in straight numerical order or by some other method? . . This is disOussed in para. 5 below. .. 3.Numbering systems The methods of numbering which are accepted as adequate in medical records practice today are the serial, the serial unit, 5 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand FILING SYSTEMS 1. Introduction 2, Method 3. Numbering systems 3.1 Serial numbering system 3.2 Serial unit numbering system 3.3 Unit numbering system 3 . 3.1 Digit number 3 . 3. 2 The 'New Plymouth' system 3.3.3 The 'Luhn' system k. Filing systems 4.1 Decentralised system 4.2 Centralised system 5. Shelf filing methods 5.1 Straight numerical method 5.2 Terminal digit method 5.2.1 Determining how much space is needed 5.2.2 How to arrange files 5.2.3 Colour coding 5.2.4 Misfiles 5.3 Tracing records 6. 70 80 Summary and conclusion References Further reading 8.1 Basic 8.2 Background 8.3 Associative Introduction: 1. Medical Records staff should use the following information as a guide to establishing an individual policy which would be realistic for the requirements of the patient, the doctors and the individual hospital. Some of the factors which should be considered are dealt with later. 'Filing system' is defined as the way in which you put away papers for future reference. are: Fz The requirements of a filing system for medical records Appendix B (Continued) CONSENT FOR MINOR I, .s.s...s...o.....s..s... of.......... .... ......... ...... hereby consent to the submission of my child ............ to the operation of..........................., the effect and nature of which have been explained to me. I also consent to such further or alternative operative measures as may be found to be necessary during the course of such operation and to the administration of a local or other anaestheticfor the purpose of the same. I understand an assurance has not been given that the operation will be performed by a particular surgeon. (Signed).. . . . . . •.s.. • • . DATED this . . . . . •.,*,,****'day of........ . . . . • 1 • . 19., . . . . (Read over and explained to the signatory, who stated that he/she understood the same and affixed his/her signature in my presence) . . (Witness) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . • 1 (Medical Officer) CONSENT BY PATIENT APPENDIX B. -Ie.,soe,s,,s.,,000 .0.00000 of. •............ •• ••...'. ....... hereby consent to undergo the operation of the effect and nature of which have been explained to me. I also consent to such further or alternative operative measuresas may be found to be necessary during the course of such operation and to the administration of a local or other anaesthetic for the purpose of the same. I understand an assurance has not been given that the operation will be performed by a particular surgeon. DATED this * ........ * day of..........,.............19........ (Signed).. . . . . . . . . • . • • • • • . • . • • 0• • (Read over and explained to the signatory, who stated that he/she understood the same and affixed his/her signature in my -presence). . (Witness). . . . . • .. ..• . . . . . .... . . . .-. . (MediOal Officer) CONSENT BY RELATIVES •..,............. a...,. .s.so of.............,... . •ss • • •o.o. the ........................of the above name- d, hereby also consent to such operation. DATED this. •........ .... day of........ .... o •.19....... • • 5O (Signed)... . ... . •. . . .... . . . . .HOSPITAL BOARDAPPENDIX A FORM OF CONSENT BY PATIENT I,.... .. . •oo...... .. S.. •ISIS•SS•S• . . . . .. . .. I • • • •• •• •I • S S o f............................................. hereby consent to t he operation of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . • . . . . . . . • . • . . . • . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . to be performed upon •.....SS.sS.SS.So.SSS.,.Se.SS.. •5•SSI• •.••.S•I• I acknowledge that the nature and effect of the operation have been fully explained to me. I also consent to such further or alternative operative measures as may be • found necessary during the course of such operation or during the treatment period subsequent thereto and to the administration of a local or other anaesthetic for the purpose of such operation or operations. I acknowledge that no assurance has been given that the operation will be performed by any particular surgeon. DATED the. . . , . . . . . . . . . . . . .of. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 • . . . Signed:....* .• ................. PATIENT, PARENT, GUARDIAN, RELATIVE This consent was read over by me to the signatory who acknowledged to have understood it fully and signed the same in my presence. Witness (Medical Officer) : . . . • . . . . . . . . • . . • . . . • . . . . . . . . 49 Levitt (Dr. W.M.) Infants and .Medical Record, Nov. 1951, consent to operationspp 266-7 Stone (J.E.) Hospital organisa-London, Faber, 1952, xxii + tion and management, pp 796-7,1722 1611 Background: 11.2. 'Guide to the organisation of a Hospital Medical Record Department' pp 51-8 U.S.A., Chicago, Ill., American Hospital Assn., 1962, vii + 83 McSwiney (B.A.) Hospital ethics with special reference to legal implications Medical Record,, May 1961, pp 393-7 Regan (W.A.) A lawyer evaluates the Medical Record Jnl. AAMRL, April 1961, pp 53-5 Report of a Committee on Medical Records in N.S.W. Hospitals N.S.W. Hospitals Commn., 1960, 54 pp Springer (Eric W.) You, the computer and the law Medical Record News, Feb. 1965, pp 15-16, 18 For Rubins' tests, tubal insufflation: patients admitted 2021 days after onset of previous menstruation. There are exceptions to (b) in the case of post-menopausal bleeding and persistent unceasing per vagina bleeding. It will be found, in most cases, that surgeons have, as a whole, their own individual whims which a booking clerk must take into consideration when working with them and making bookings for operation sessions. 8. Conclusion Generally speaking admissions to hospital come during the daytime, although there is always the extra rush in the early evening which normally is due to general practitioners making their rounds during the day, finding it necessary to send patients to hospital and invariably it is evening before they arrive for admission. Evening in admission office is a very busy time, going through the lists of admissions, checking with wards regarding discharges, and completing lists of both admissions and discharges for distribution throughout the hospital, and it is at this time that particular care has to be taken to ensure that all discharges are accounted for by number as well as name and that there are no discharges missed by the individual wards. It is usual to make a definite patient count with individual wards at, say, 8.30 9 o'clock each evening, by which time there will have been sufficient time elapsed to allow the wards to check their admissions and all discharges. In conclusion, the admission office duties as broadly outlined here, are not to be regarded as hard and fast, but a guide for the requirements of any particular hospital. Much admission office work is unsupervised, presents daily problems demanding initiative and good public relations and calls for the little extra beyond the normal call of duty. It will be a challenge with which the clerk who has a sense of duty and the welfare of the patient at heart will cope and thereby achieve a sense of satisfaction in a job well done. 9, References Huffman (Edna K.) Manual for Medical Record Librarians, PP 39-0 ('Record of U.S.A., Berwyn, Ill., Physicians' Record Co., xxx + 604, illus. admission,-) 110 7 major cases of surgery, most surgeons admit cases one day before operation as preliminary investigation at a clinic will have revealed any unusual features which could necessitate extra investigation time before surgery is possible. However, some common cases as outlined hereunder require extra time (a) Haemoglobin low but surgery necessary by a certain -day: 7 days pre-operative admission, (b) Diabetic condition for ordinary surgery: 3-4 days pre-operative admission, normally sufficient to enable the diabetic condition to be stabilied. Diabetic conditions for cataract extractions, however, are normally given 7 days pre-operative treatment before surgery. (c) Corneal grafts are always admitted two to three days pre-operatively for bed rest and antibiotic treatment. (d) Hiatus hernia: 3 days pre-operative treatment for physiotherapy instructions or breathing exercises before surgery. (e) Gastrectomy: normally have a 3 day pre-operative bed rest and preparation, blood tests etc. (f) Abdomino-perineal resection: usually admit 4.- 5 days pre-operatively for bowel preparation and bed rest. (h) Some surgeons prefer to do haemorrhoidectomy after a 2 day bowel preparation but generally most surgeons admit one day pre-operatively. (i) Major gynaecology operations are invariably admitted at least 2 days pre-operatively for bed rest, blood tests etc. Care is necessary when booking female patients to ensure as a general rule, that they are clear of their menstrual period for the following types of operation (a) Major Gynae. done per vagina (b) Minor Gynae. done per vagina (c) Haemorrhoidectomy (a) Varicose Veins (e) Tonsillectomy too operation list for a surgeon. 7.6.2 Medical waiting list There is usually prompt admission, if hospitalisation is deemed necessary, after the preliminary investigations are done. Unlike surgical problems, medical problems cannot often wait for an empty bed, so it is unusual to have more than a few cases waiting to be admitted under a medical category. 7.7 Bed allocations for bookings Bed allocations for surgeons and physicians vary from hospital to hospital, but generally speaking there is a nominal bed allocation per doctor or team of doctors and they are expected to work within it and only admit booking cases under their care if they are within the allocation, whether it be 10 beds or a whole ward. A surgeon or team of surgeons have a set number of operating sessions available each week ' and it is necessary for the clerk responsible for bookings to work in close co-operation with the surgeon to ensure that sufficient booked cases are available for these sessions and to avoid, where possible, wasteage of operation time. Close co-operation is necessary to ensure that any cases requiring surgery, already in wards from acute admissions, are taken into consideration when making bookings for routine operation sessions, otherwise these can be overlooked resulting in more cases than can be dealt with in a session, thereby causing unnecessary patients in a ward and thus inconvenience to a patient. In all cases, the surgeons and physicians take their turn on acute admissions and must make provision prior to their turn to be in a position to absorb acutes within their working beds. To ensure that any particular surgeon or team of surgeons do not admit more patients than is their normal quota, the daily booking state is a very helpful guide to the booking clerk to enable him to keep the surgeons and physicians advised of the position. 7.8 Operating schedule Where it is necessary to fill an operation schedule by any surgeon, on any day, it is necessary to arrange for prior admission of the various booked cases. Generally speaking, except for It'$ 7 practitioners in the area. These cases are vetted and possibly preliminary x-rays and laboratory tests done before the case is recommended for the waiting list. In all cases, any patient who required urgent surgery would be admitted direct to a ward, as an acute, and dealt with immediately. Other cases will be, as a general rule, assessed as semi-urgent or routine and placed in the appropriate categories on the waiting list. For efficient control, and to ensure that the cases longest on the list are the first ones admitted, it is wise to prepare two index cards with essential details from the clinic cards; these are filed in separate drawers, one in date order, and one in alphabetical order. The date order drawer is the working list used when making up an operation list. The alphabetical order is for control of the list should it be necessary to locate a person by name. Where a person is booked from a date order card, it is essential to withdraw the alphabetical card at the same time tb keep the list correct. Strip indexes as described in the chapter on equipment provide a good visual method of keeping this part of the waiting list since not much information is required , the second part, described below, having the main information. The waiting list index card should carry the surname, in capitals, with all Christian or first names across the top and the name of the surgeon and priority, that is, routine or semiurgent, together with the date of coming onto the waiting list. Full address and telephone number and the provisional diagnosis together with any special admission details such as availability, date, clear chest x-ray before admission, check haemoglobin up to standard before admission etc. Separate compartments should be allocated for various surgeons and subdivided male, female, with 'semi-urgent' or 'routine' under each category. Children would be treated in a similar manner. With specialised lists such as microscopic ear surgery, submucous resection, T's and A's the cards can be grouped. With a gynaecological waiting list, beside semi-urgent or routine the cards can be subdivided under major or minor surgery as well.While the above details may appear to make a complex operation of maintaining a waiting list they do allow of efficient operation and are time saving when compiling an 107 responsible for the various surgeons' patients record the next day's operation list by early evening. The layout of such a list hereunder is quite self explanatory. MR.LANCERTHEATRE 1 8.30 a.m. VII38099DOUGLAS Roslyn3ms,G.A. Pre-Med as chartE.U.A. Post Nasal Spaceed jhr pre-op XIX7205 CARP Mary60 G.A. Pre-Med as chartLaryngoscopy P.O. Polyp ed at call Vocal Cord etc. The essential distribution list would be MAIN OPERATING THEATRE BLOCK (several copies) Any detached theatres e.g. ORTHOPAEDIC, EYE, E.N.T. etc. All wards concerned Orderly Office Transport Officer (to arrange ambulance transfer of. patients if there are any detached wards concerned) (f) Surgeons' change room (g) Theatre Charge Sister (h) Medical Records (i) Medical Superintendent (j) Matron (Ic) Nursing Supervisor (1) Enquiries (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) The next-of-kin of any patient going to the theatre next day is advised of the fact by telephone during the evening. 7.6 Waiting lists Quite a considerable amount of work is involved in keeping an accurate and up to date waiting list and this, too, is most often administered in the Admission Office. 7.3 .1 Surgical waiting list If the hospital has predominantly visiting surgeons on its staff, it is likely that many names for the waiting list will be referrals direct from the surgeon's own consulting rooms. However, by far the most cases coming onto a waiting list will be patients referred to hospital surgical clinic by general JOb oc 7 EXAMPLE: DATE APRIL 1967 The following is a typical list of clinics (not listed in importance), but some hospittls will have more than this because of local specialties or because a larger centre caters for certain conditions on a regional basis, e.g. cardiology (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) (h) (1) (j) (k) (1) E.N.T. Surgical Gynaecology Ophthalmic Medical Psychiatric Dermatology Staff Orthopaedic Paediatric Rheumatology Consultation Clinic Then there is the operation hat duplicated each evening for distribution throughout the interested departments of the hospital. Each hospital has its own system of notifying regular operations for the next day. T his can include a piece of paper pinned to a notice board outside operating theatre block, a book hanging on a nail outside operating theatre block, or a blackboard on the wall outside theatre block. These are effective where there are only a few operations per day but where there are 30 - 50 operations each day it necessary to distribute duplicated sheets to the various departments concerned. To enable the operation list to be assembled a record book is kept in Admission Office in which the house surgeons (e) Medical (f) Ophthalmic etc. by totalling the admissions of each doctor covering a particular field. 7.5.4 Admissions by wards Ward analysis showing admissions to each ward for the day and/ or transfers to the wards DATE APRIL 1 ADMISSIONS TO INDIVIDUAL WARDS WARD NO. Admissions direct to ward to be shown in Black. Transfers to ward to be shown in Red. 7 This analysis is to show the turnover of patients per ward throughout the year. 7.5.5 Outpatients To enable accurate returns to be made of patients seen at various clinics each month it is important that a daily record be kept at each clinic office and that the total be submitted to Admission Office at the end of each month to enable statistical returns to be recorded. (N.B. This only applies if the Admission Office is responsible for submission of monthly statistics to the Board Office; otherwise it would be submitted by the Clinic Office to the appropriate department) 104, 7 Admisjons by visiting and full time staff: 7.5.3. Then comes analysis for (a) Acutes (b) Bookings and the number of each category for each surgeon or physician. BOOKED ADMISSION DATE APRIL U) 1967 zz 00 H 0 IiiU) Z F U) U) U) U) U) U) U)i-1 H :1 HZ U) U) U) t4 000 1 11U)H U) Z i-OZ i-i U) 00 U) U) 0 <i 0 U)H U) 0 U) H H U) U) U) U) A ca U) U) U) U) U) 0-4 U) -IU) • i—iC)C) E-iU) -1-i +) 0 (Dc1E-1 cn 1 - - — r— 2 3 ACUTE ADMISSIONS DATE APRIL U) Z U) 1967 U)00 U) U owU) U) U) U) H U) U) Cl) Cl) ,U) Cl) f) U) U) U) HZU)U)U)E4HZ00 U)--1 C) C) D0 00 U) U)z OHZi-i U) i-1.iHU) 00 U)00 U) U) <- U)-0 U) U)1-' 4) Q <1 U) H H Cl) U) U) U) U) U) a) a H 1 2 3 With this particular analysis it is possible to give a daily, monthly or yearly total of admissions under any particular specialist group., i.e. (a) (b) (c) (d) Gynaecology Surgery Orthopaedic Paediatric DAILY DEATHS DATE SURGICALMEDICAL INFECTIOUS T.B. APRIL )ULT I CHILD ADUL4CRILD II ADTTL4(TTTT.n tflTTT,9Ii DAILY friil lciIIc.ii Iciil Tl I-I I,iIl-iIrjl i,-il-I -1ITOTAL 1zIIxt . I:I iilI ui <i çi: Ii-.3I Ii-1 fr fr l I I 1967 IIII I 1 2 3 Lf Note: These can, of course, be combined into a single return. 7.5. 2 Days stay discharged patients and numbers remaining List showing Discharged Patients' days stay Deceased Patients' days stay Remaining-in Patients EXAMPLE: I.UMVIAININU IN APRIL 1967 I 2 3 7 (a) Male(e) Medical (b) Female(f) Surgical (c) Adult(g) Infectious (d) Child(h) T.B. EXAMPLE: DAILY ADMISSIONS DATESURGICAL MEDICAL INFECTIOUS T.B. ADULT HILD ADULT CHILD ADULT HILD ADULT HILD APRIL NIx:!fx] cii I:1ci :, .rx D A I LY TOTAL 'cx:i.cx:i 1967 I 2 3 1 etc. DAILY DISCHARGES DATESURGICAL MEDICAL INFECTIOUS T.B. ADULT6HILD ADULEICHILD ADUL[LHILD ADUITLHILD P1 1967 lo lxi DAILY TOTAL 3. List to analyse number of beds in each ward under individual surgeons and physicians, or under surgical or medical teams whichever system is in force in the particular hospital. Distribution (a) Medical Superintendent (b) Admitting Officer (c) Admission Officer A permanent register must be maintained with the previous day admissions recorded and the previous dayb discharges and/or deaths noted in red with the date for each also noted. This procedure is one where extreme care is necessary to ensure accuracy. Discharges, to be particularly checked by number as well as names. This record is compiled from ward lists. This register should record as a minimum: date of admission; patient's hospital number; surname; Christian or first name; sex; birth date; age; race (as for M.S.18 card); ward; diagnosis (this is only recorded after patient is discharged orhas died);, doctor under whose care the patient is admitted; date of die-.. charge or death. For enquiry purposes it is essential to maintain an index,, in alphabetical order, of all patients in hospitals admission to'bè immediately added and discharges and deaths taken out as soon as.. advised from the wards. For control purposes it is an essential to keep an index in ward order maintained as at midnight on, esob,: day. . In order to assist the bed control and allocation of beds : for admissions, both acute and bookings, it is essential to maintain. a ward indicator. To keep this accurate, it is necessary tohave., the co-operation of ward staff, to advise immediately any diecharges or deaths. Admissions can be added as routine...:., 7.5 Statistics The sectional analyses outlined hereunder are undertaken in order to facilitate answers to various requests for statistics by eBoard Office and the Health Department. In some hospitals part or all of these records will be kept by the Medical Records Department or Enquiries or by a separate statistics by office. 7.5.1 Admissions, discharges and deaths Records must be kept of Admissions, Discharges and Deaths analysed toindicate - (ok, the patient is being admitted is advised of the arrival of the patient to ensure there is no delay in the commencement of treatment. The doctor is advised by telephone or the doctor's call light or colour system, the former being used if the doctor's whereabouts is known and the latter if the doctor is in circulation around the wards. It is a wise precaution to note the time of despatch of a patient to a ward and further to note the time the house surgeon is advised of the arrival of the patient. In the latter case unless the house surgeon is spoken to personally, it is necessary to indicate the fact that a message was passed via, say a ward sister, by indicating the ward telephone number with an M.. e.g. 703(M) 2,1+5 pm0 Daily returns: 7.1+. The daily lists for the information of various sections are briefly 1, Admission and discharge lists. Distribution should normally beto(a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) (h) (i) (j) Medical Superintendent Matron Medical Records Office Social Security Department X-ray Department Admission Office District Nursing Service Theatre A. & E. Department Board Office 2, Daily bed state as at midnight each day,. Distribution (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) (h) Medical Superintendent Matron Nursing Supervisor Dietitian Laundry Linen Keeper Admission Officer Board Office Medical Records Office (Note: There is no Health Department 'requirement for this to be done at midnight; it can be done at whatever time the Board or hospital administration decide. This is covered in chapter 8 'Hospital Census Taking'), 7. Admission Office routine 71 Identification of patients Identity bracelets for patients are in general use throughout New Zealand; these bracelets are usually of plastic, designed to take a small card with the patient's name and hospital number; they are worn on the wrist and are designed to be worn by the patient throughout his or her stay in hospital. Depending on hospital policy the bracelet will either be put on by Admission Office staff when the patient presents himself for admission or by ward staff. Points for and against; - there is sometimes objection to Admission Office staff touching patients; - Admission Office staff could put a bracelet on too tight and this might not be seen for some time with possible adverse effects; - the bracelets are usually difficult to put on and conse• quently the operation is time-consuming; this can cause some delay in the Admission Office on a busy morning; - if the bracelet is not put on until the patient reaches the ward mistakes in identity can occur, particularly if two patients arrive in the ward at the same time; - if a new bracelet iswanted this can easily be got and prepared at the Admission Office whereas the ward would have to wait for it. • 7.2 Patients' case notes As it is necessary to check that the details on, the patient identificationform are correct and to add the time of arrival to this it follows that, whichever system of documentation isused,. the patient's basic case notes will be in the Admission Office when he arrives. • The patient should be escorted to the ward by an orderly who should carry the case notes in an envelope. If it is necessary to send the patient to the ward on his own and for him to carry the case notes there these should be in a closed envelope. 7.3 Notification of House Surgeon Firstly, after the patient has been despatched to the ward it is necessary to ensure that the house surgeon under whose care 4 7 together. A specimen of an acceptable form is shown, hereunder and is self explanatory: NAME OF HOSPITAL ....... . •eao•ee.e..e..•..e...,. give my consent for operation to be performed on myself, which may include — is .... * (1) Termination of my present pregnancy. * (2) Termination of my present pregnancy and sterilisation. I fully understand that as a result of this operation I am unlikely to become pregnant, * (3) Sterilisation. I fully understand that as a result of this operation I am unlikely to become pregnant. ' (+) Removal of one or both ovaries if it is found advisable at the time of operation. Signed..............,........,.,.., • D at e Witness- ...... . . •C....,....c.....,. c.,'..e.á......., Address and Occupation ...... ,.,.,... ... ....,,. ........ .,.,,.-., • • ••• CCC ......0•0C Cessec OS S •000 S .........0 •CS 50CC S000000Ce I, . . . . . . . •. . , .. . ., . . . so • , . • . . . o..G. give my consent for an operation to be performed on my wife ......... which may include — * (1) Termination of my wife's present pregnancy. * (2) Termination of my wife's present pregnancy and sterilisation. I fully understand that as a result of this operation my wife is unlikely to become pregnant. • * (3) Sterilisation. I fully understand that as a result of - • •this operation my wife is unlikely to become pregnant. (k) Removal of one or bothovaries if it 'i s ' found advisable at the time of operation. Signed ••0006C•0000•.*.....,O..,...... Date Witness........... Address and Occupation •••O•••••O•SO.....01 ... ............................... ....O.,..... * Delete -whichever is inapplicable. Both patient and husband - must initial each deletion. 97 Where it is impossible to locate the next-of-kin or a minor or an unconscious person and an urgent operation is immedijely necessary, the Medical Superintendent or his deputy can, and usually will, authorise such treatment, after first satisfying himself that all possible efforts have been made to locate the next-of-kin. 6.2 Patients from Boarding Schools It is usual for the Principal or similar official to obtain at the time of admission to their establishment, from the legal next-of-kin, permission for authority to consent for any treatment should it . be necessary for the person to be admitted to hospital. Where the operative procedure is of a major nature it is usual to obtain personal consent from the next-of-kin. 6.3 Armed Forces In the Armed Forces, the Commanding Officer of a minor can give permission for necessary emergency operative treatment. It is customary for relatives to be advised promptly-when treatment is deemed necessary and their consent obtained before commencing such treatment, . 6.4 Prisons A minor admitted from Her Majesty's Prisons, and similar institutions, is placed in the same category as Armed Forces,. and the Superintendent is permitted to give permission for emergency operative treatment, but where possible, the next-of-kin are to be asked for their formal consent..... 6.5 Patients from a mental hospital . The Medical Superintendent of a mental hospital is the , legal guardian of all patients, other than voluntary patients, and as such, is permitted to sign consent for any operation, but he invariably obtains consent from the next-of-kin or nearest relative for the operative procedure. Voluntary patients in mental hospitals are admitted to public hospitals in the normal way as normal patients. . 6.6 Termination of pregnancy etc. Operations for termination of pregnancy, removal.of ovaries or sterilisation must be consented to by both the husband and the wife 7 Another important fact to note is if the admission is the result of . a motor accident or an accident at work. In the former case, it is merely necessary to state yes or no. If there are subsequent court proceedings or there is an insurance claim, the cost of the stay in hospital may be the subject of a claim refundable to the Board. In the case of an admission due to an accident at work or sickness or disability, due to the nature of the work it is essential to obtain the employer's name and address, as all cases are covered by the Workers' Compensation Act and cost of treatment will be the subject of a claim. (Refer chapter 15) Particular care should be taken when completing pre-admission details with these cases as there can be a considerable amount of money involved to maintain a patient in hospital. Consent for treatment: 6. General: 6.1. The form in use in most hospitals in New Zealand 'is given in chapter + ('Medico-legal aspects of Medical Records Keening'). Consent may be given as follows (a) A single adult of legal age (21 years) can give such permission for himself or herself. Where an adult is over 16 but under 21 and living away from home his or her consent would be sufficient to a reasonable operation. (b) A married man can. give permission for himself or his wife or child irrespective of his age. (c) A married woman can give permission for herself, her husband or child irrespective of her age. (d) Permission for treatment for operation on a minor (under the age of 21 years) can be given by the next-of-kin and this can be either parents, or foster parents if the child has been legally adopted,or by the person concerned if over 16 (see (a) above). (e) Where parents are unavailable a brother or sister if over the age of 21 years can give consent (but see also (a) above). 5.2 The detail of a doctor referring a patient for admission to hospital Many general practitioners work in conjunction with a partner or by arrangement with another doctor to cover evening calls and/ or weekend calls and it is often that a patient will be admitted to hospital as an acute with a reference note from a doctor other than his. or her normal doctor. In this case, it is wise to state clearly the name of the referring doctor as well as the name of the regular practitioner. This necessity is to enable both doctors to obtain a report on the patient upon his or her discharge from hospital. It is usual for the name of the doctor on duty at the reception desk or Accident and Emergency department to be stated on the Patient Identification form as on occasions, he or she may have to investigate the patient before admission, and can give information to the doctor under' whose care the patient is finally admitted. Various institutions have their own internal arrangements for allocating acute admissions and bookings admitted under the care of Specialists. It is necessary to have the date of any previous admission,, whether as an inpatient or an outpatient, to enable the old records to be obtained from Medical Records and despatched to the wards with a patient. Another necessary point is whether the patient is ordinarily a resident of New Zealand and, if not, the date of arrival in New Zealand and whether he intends staying permanently in the country or whether the stay is of limited duration. These details are essential, because unless a person is resident in New Zealand. for two years or more, he is not entitled as of right, to receive free treatment in hospital under the Social Security Act. If the intention is that the patient is to remain permanently in New Zealand even though of recent arrival, the normal practice is that he is treated as a resident of the country but where the stay in the country is of short duration and unless the patient is covered by reciprocal Social Security Benefits, e.g. from England, Scotland, Northern Ireland or Wales, it is necessary that the patient be charged for stay in hospital at the ruling daily rate for the particular institution. In the case of visiting seamen the name of the ship concerned and the owners or agents must be obtained since the latter are responsible for payment, even where the country concerned has reciprocal Social Security benefits with New Zealand. 9 Ilia 7 especially acutes, there are many instances where it is necessary to communicate urgently with the next-of-kin, checking diet, preadmission symptoms, advice of impending operation, permission for anaesthetic etc., and it is vitally necessary to obtain this information. Naturally, not all people havea telephone installed in their own home, but it is unusual to find a neighbourwho is not prepared to pass a message when it concerns a hospital matter. There are times, however, when at short notice, it is impossible to get a message to the next-of-kin by normal channels and it will be found that the police are always co-operative, if the circumstances warrant asking for their assistance. In country districts in particular, the police know the locality and can organise the relaying of a message promptly and efficiently. The relationship of the next-of-kin should always be stated. Upon admission the patient states who he or she wishes to be known as his or her next-of-kin and the hospital staff have a moral obligation to honour this, even though, in point of fact the person named, may not be the legal next-of-kin. At all hospitals the next-of-kin, as specified on the pre-admission form of a patient, can interview the House Surgeon under whose care the patient was admitted, at certain specified times, and care should always be taken that a person presenting himself to interview a doctor concerning the patient is the person named as the next-of-kin on the pre-admission form. Where the person is not the next-of-kin and he has no written permission to interview the doctor and yet the details seem reasonable, it is wise to phone the next-of-kin for confirmation that the doctor may grant an interview. Special details regarding telephone exchange names: 51. Many large centres have small sub-exchanges which operate from but through the main exchange and it is essential to record the exact name of any exchange or sub-exchange when asking for a telephone number. In obtaining telephone numbers to communicate with a next-of-kin it is'frequently helpful if there is an alternative number through whom a message can be sent in the event of the next-of-kin being unobtainable. It is also essential that telephone numbers at work as well as at home be recorded, hospital be lengthy, it is likely that the age could step up a year and not be noticed. Some hospitals insist on the birth date being stated for all patients being admitted and this information can often be valuable, if accurately stated, for identification purposes, particularly if the place of birth is included. However, for various reasons, mistakes are frequently made in quoting 'birth dates. It is unwise, therefore, to base any system solely on this information. Statement of sex of a patient is essential as some Christian or first names do not readily indicate whether the patient is male or female. Whether a patient is Maori, Islander or of other race is required for statistical purposes and could be useful for treatment. A Maori is defined as being of half blood or more. It should be noted, however, that it is important to ask a patient whether he is Maori, Islander or European, rather than guessing, since considerable importance is attached to the work done on Maori health and the health problems. of Islanders are of increasing concern. Marital status, that is married, single, widowed, divorced or. separated is necessary to help determine who is the next-of-kin and who is likely to be interested in the condition . , of the patient should the patient, or those accompanying him, be unable to give this information.The true importance of marital status becomes evident upon the decease of a patient or where the condition of a patient may necessitate committal to a mental hospital. Religion is important because most of the major religions have a permanent clergyman attached to the larger hospitals.. These clergymen are daily advised of members of their faith admittedto, or discharged from, hospital. .. While knowing the occupation of a patient may not be essential for their treatment, it is necessary from a statistical point of view as required by the Health Department. Industry data are needed when occupation data are not precise, e.g. machinist, packer, supervisor. The date of admission is obviously essential and the time of admission to the hospital is important to check on possible treatment delays after the arrival of the patient in hospital. Next-of-kin: Where possible the name and address of the nextof-kin should be accurately recorded, together with a day and night telephone number and exchange name. With admissions, 7 Admission particulars: 5. Details obtained by an admission clerk from a patient or the next-of-kin of a patient being admitted to hospital form a very necessary and important part of the records which are used extensively during a patient's stay in hospital. Firstly, the hospital number is essential on every form used throughout various departments of the hospital, e.g. (a) specimens of blood sent to the laboratory (b) x-rays, etc, and these forms can only be positively identified by a number. Various institutions have special ways of numbering to suit their individual requirements but one method becoming increasingly used, due to its flexibility and ease of filing, once the chart is returned to Medical Records, is the unit number, more details of which are to be found in chapter .5 ('Filing Systems'). It is essential that all names, surnames and Christian or first names, should be correctly recorded in order to avoid confusion at a later stage when many similar names may be found in the patient index. Full Christian or first names should always be obtained and recorded. Maiden names should also be obtained. In the case of Maoris and Islanders particularly, the question "are you, or have you been, known by any other name(s)?" should be asked, as often Maori and European names are used by the same person at different times, or different family names are used. The address from which a patient is admitted should be stated and can quite often be useful for reference purposes after a patient has been discharged, but it should not he obtained at the exnense of a permanent address which should be accurately stated on every form - number of street, road arid its name • In country districts where frequently rural delivery numbers, e.g. are stated, it should be borne in mind that every road has a name or number and to state rural delivery number is really not sufficient, one main reason being that in the event of District Nurses having to follow-up with dressings after a patient has been discharged from hospital, a district number does not give much help, so a road name or number should always be insisted upon and can usually be obtained if, the above explanation is given. Age is the age of The reason frequently always important and particularly with children under 10 years, it is advisable to state their birth date. is that the dosage of a drug to be administered is based on a child's age and should their stay in With pre-registration details as required on a pre-admission form can be obtained when the clinic card is prepared at the time of attendance at an Outpatient Clinic. If the admission ismade within a matter of weeks it is usually safe to prepare the preadmission form from the clinic card details. However, where there is some time lag in arranging a booking, to ensure accuracy, it is preferable that the relevant details be supplied by a patient or next-of-kin on an appropriate form when accepting an admission date and time. Particulars of what the patient will need in hospital, arrangements regarding custody of property, laundry, visiting hours etc. should be sent at this time. To ensure a . prompt reply to the offer of a booking, it is wise to enclose a business reply envelope with each and every notification. It should be noted, that a franked or stamped and addressed envelope could be used, but there is always a number of notifications not replied to and there would be a total loss of the franking or stamp concerned. With a business reply permit envelope, only returned envelopes would be subject to postage cost, plus one cent each extra for the permit.. It is an advantage to arrange as many admission bookings as possible by telephone in order to ensure that.there is a minimum number of defaulters.When the telephone is used, it is also possible to have a definite check as to coughs and.colds, sores and infectious contacts, menstrual period if it applies, and alternative dates can be arranged easily. Even the use of toll calls is warranted for. admission bookings in order to prevent "theatre time" wastage due to the non-arrival of bookings. However, it is still advisable to send written confirmation together with information regarding admission mentioned above. /+. Documentation of patients Mechanical aids to assist with accurate documentation of a patient upon admission to hospital are installed in a number of the larger hospitals in New Zealand and their principle is outlined in the chapter on equipment. Their use should ensure accurate identification of all papers with a particular patient and save considerable time for medical and nursing teams in the wards. hospital administration will function smoothly. .At.this stage we Will assume that admissions are being done through a central office. Definition of admissions: 2. Admissions are either Booked which means that they will have been admitted from the waiting list following attendance at an outpatient clinic. ('Waiting list' on M.S.18) Acute which means immediate admission. In some hospitals all such admissions go through the Accident and Emergency Department, (and acute admissions include admissions from this department); in others, admission may be arranged by the General Practitioner with the Registrar concerned. ('Emergency' on M.S.18) Pre-admission procedures: Obviously no pre-admission details can be taken for acute cases. The information required is obtained: (i) (ii) (iii) by a clerk from the Admission Office going to the patient and obtaining the necessary details from him;or, by this being done by a nurse and passed to the Admission Office;or, by relatives or friends accompanying the patient coming to the Admission office and giving patient's details. . . In the case of booked patients, admission details: can either be obtained when the patient presents himself for admission or they can be got before this happens ('pre-registration If details are taken at the time of . admission this has the advantage that the information is up-to-date and Is extracted from the patient by a person trained to do it. On the other. hand, it does mean keeping the patient waiting in the Admission Office while this is done and until the necessary papers are prepared which have to accompany him to the ward. 3. 1. Introduction The Admission Office in any large hospital brings staff into close co-operation with the public, the nursing staff in wards and medical staff. The staff of the Admission Office therefore needs to be carefully selected and trained to enable them to carry out their duties for the welfare of the patient as well as co-operating in every possible way with the various departments that exist to make up an efficient hospital. The Admission Office is the original source of all identifying data in Medical' Records which must be' detailed and accurate at all times. It should be remembered that when a patient is admitted to hospital, legal responsibility is automatically accepted for' the care and treatment of the individual, and safe custody of his or her personal effects, and these facts should always be borne in mind by all staff in their dealings with the public. When it has been decided that a person is to be admitted to hospital for treatment as a patient, either as an 'acute' or as a 'booking' the next contact with the hospital will be when the patient appears at the hospital Admission Office or receives a form for pre-registration. It is the duty of Admission Office staff to smooth the way by treating the patient with every courtesy and consideration, and giving prompt attention to necessary formalities before despatching the patient to a ward. There is, as yet, no set system adopted for admission,.' procedure in the various hospitals throughout the country. Those in use are mainly based on , local requirements and 'all work quite well in their own way. .'•' ' Naturally the requirements for a 200 bed hospital are not going to be so detailed as for the large hospitals of 600-800 bed capacity. With the smaller hospital, admission office hours can be restricted to 8.30 - 5 p.m. on five or six days a week with the nursing staff filling in essentials at other times. With the larger hospitals the admission office should be staffed 21+ hours a day every day of the year in order to cater, for up to an average of 1+5-50 patients per day. With such a daily average, there could be daily totals of 80 or more admissions depending on the spread of 'bookings' and 'acutes'. The larger the hospital, the more departments there are to be kept advised of daily admissions and discharges so that the Medical Records Practice in New Zealand ADMISSION OFFICE PROCEDURE 1. Introduction 2. Definition of admissions 3. Pre-admission procedures +. Documentation of patients 5. Admission particulars 5.1 Special details regarding telephone exchange names 5.2 The detail of a doctor referring a patient for admission to hospital 6..- ' Consent for treatment 6,1 General 6.2 Patients from Boarding Schools 6.3 Armed Forces 6.4 Prisons 6.5 Patient from a Mental Hospital 6.6 Termination of pregnancy etc. 70 Admission office routine 7.1 Identification of patients 7.2 Patients' case notes 7.3 Notification of House Surgeon 7.4 Daily returns 7.5 Statistics •7.5.1 Admissions, discharges and deaths 7.5. 2 Days stay discharged patients and numbers remaining Admissions by visiting and full time staff 7.5.3 7.5.4 Admissions by ward 7.5.5 Outpatients 7.6 Waiting lists •7.6.1 Surgical waiting list 7.6.2 Medical waiting list 7.7 Bed allocations for bookings 7.8 Operating schedule 8. Conclusion 9. References 10. Further reading 10.1 Basic 10.2 Background 10,3 Associative laws of this country. Finally, it should be the aim of all concerned with the admission and discharge of patients to see that everything possible is done to reduce the worries and fears of patients on arrival and while in hospital. Remember that good public relations may save misunderstanding by the patient and unnecessary legal proceedings. 10, References Acts: Births and Deaths Registration, 1951; Coroner's, 1951; Health 1956; Hospitals, 1957; Mental Defectives, 1911; Tuberculosis, 1948. 'Consents to Surgical Operation', New Zealand Hospital, June 1957 Hayt, Emmanuel, Hayt, Lillian R. and Groeschei, August H. Law of hospital, physician and patient. 2nd ed. U.S.A., New York, Hospital Textbook Co., 1952. Regulations: Cremation, 1939; Health (Infirm and Neglected Persons), 1958 Searby, G.W. Consents to Operations. New Zealand Hospital, Sept. 1960 Searby, G.W. General law affecting hospitals. New Zealand Hospital Officers' Association lecture notes. 11. Further reading 11.1 Basic Brown (R.J.) Some legal problems in the practice of Medical Records Medical Record, Aug. 1953, pp 189-94 Haydon-Baillie (M.) Medicolegal aspects of Medical Records Medical Record, Feb. 1954, pp 290-95 Huffman (Edna K.) Manual for Medical Record Librarians, PP 397-427 ('Legal aspects of medical records') U.S.A.,.Berwyn, Ill., Physicians' Record Co., 1959, xxx + 604 illus. Letourneau (Dr. c.u.) Who owns the Medical Record? Jnl. AAMRL, Dec. 1958, pp 221-3 1 260 TWE the approval, and these records will be accepted as evidence. (See Section 5 of the Evidence Amendment Act, 1952), Medical records are generally used in court on the following occasions 1. 2. Insurance cases Personal injury suits (see also under Workers' Compensation Act, 1956) 30 Malpractice suits k. Will cases 5. Divorce cases 6. Criminal cases There may be other reasons for producing the medical records in court. This necessitates the careful keeping of all the medical documents whether the patient was treated as an inpatient, an outpatient or at home. The Social Security Act 1963 provides that if a person has good grounds to claim compensation or damages and fails without good reason to take steps to enforce his claim, he may be personally liable to pay the cost of his treatment at hospital. Summary: 9. The Medical Records Officer must naturally look to the Medical Superintendent of the hospital for guidance and instruction on all matters medico-legal while the Medical Superintendent may seek legal advice from his board. By the same token the staff in a Medical Records department should receive instruction from the Medical Records Officer on all aspects of keeping medical documents and any medico-legal problems. As custodians of the medical records, the Medical Records staff should be fully aware of their responsibility to the hospital, hospital board and community as a whole. The Medical Records Officer •whose responsibility it is to supervise the Medical Records department should ensure that all those employed within the department are fully conversant with the rules regarding disclosure of information. It should be clearly understood, that the medical record as an order of business is the property of the hospital, while the personal data contained in the record are considered as a confidential or privileged communication and therefore the property of the patient. It is compiled, preserved and protected from unauthorised inspection for the benefit of the patient, the hospital and the physician as required by the 8.The medical record in court If a hospital record is to be used as evidence in court proceedings, it must of necessity be admitted or received by the court and properly identified by a witness. Hospital records may be accepted as evidence and allowed to be entered as an exhibit on the grounds that reliance can be placed on the written memoranda made in the regular course of business of an institution, and that there would be no reason for making false entries at that time. The chief value of a medical record is that it is an unbiased statement inasmuch as the doctors and others concerned in making the record at the time of the patient's hospitalisation have no interest in any subsequent litigation, except, of course, when the patient himself sues the hospital. Because of the possibility of each patient being a potential court case, careful recording of the medical findings is of primary importance. Notation of the complete findings upon examination and the exact status of the patient on admission should be set forth, together with a report of the patient's progress while in hospital. Occasionally mistakes are made in writing medical records. If this is noticed at once, the error may be lined through and the correction made immediately following. If an error has been erased or crossed through and the correction written above, without an accompanying signature And date, there is no assurance that the correction was not made at a later date. Thus doubt is created as to the validity of the entire record. When a medical record has been presented during a court session, it will be held by the Registrar of the court while the case is sub judice, and following judgement will be held in the court files and will be released only upon application by Counsel for the party requiring production of the record duly consented to by Counsel for the other party. It must be kept in mind that medical records may be needed in some research projects or a further admission of the patient at the time that they are being retained by the court. Wherepossible, and there is sufficient time after receipt of the subpoena, photo copies should be made of the original medical record. To cover the admissibility of microfilmed records as evidence in court it is necessary to have obtained an Order in Council signed by the Clerk of the Executive Council. The usual practice is for the hospital board to apply to the Council when it decides on a policy of microfilming medical records and when the Order has been approved or gazetted the original documents may be destroyed. The Order in Council will allow the hospital board to produce microfilmed records in court at any time subsequential to 1 If cremation is required the Cremation Form-would be completed with the Death Certificate and also signed by the medical officer concerned. It would then be passed to the funeral director for transmission to the Medical -Referee. (See Cremation Regulations 1 939 (reprinted 1 9 4 9). Reference No. 194 9/122, Clause 5, 6 and 8). The relatives are notified of the death by the medical officer or ward sister who also arranges for the removal of the body to the hospital mortuary. When considered necessary or advisable, a medical officer will request permission from the next-of-kin for a post mortem examination. As stated previously if the death was the result of an accident or occurred under circumstances of suspicion a Coroner's Inquest may be required and the Coroner's Pathologist will carry out any necessary postmortem examination. (See Section 10, Coroners Act 1951). In the event of the death of a patient who has been resident in a mental health hospital, the following information may be required by the coroner: (i) (ii) cause of death; last seen alive - where, when, by whom and under what circumstances; (iii) who examined after death; (iv) was a post mortem held? If a patient dies from infectious disease, a notation should be made on the Death Label attached to the body and also on the back of . the medical certificate of causes of death issued persuant to Section 55 of the Births and Deaths Registration Act 1 951.This enables the funeraldirector and others to take all due precautions. It is also necessary to notify the Medical Officer of Health or his deputy. (See Section 70-87 Health Act 1956) The handing over of the effects of a deceased patient can be made only on the production of Probate or Letters of Administration or other acceptable evidence of the claimant's legal authority. Until this authority is produced the effects should remain in the custody of the Secretary, the House Manager, or other Senior Administrative Staff. (See Section 15 0 Hospitals Act, 1 957, relating to payments without probate where the amount in possession of the deceased did not exceed £200). 44 The deponent being duly sworn saith:My name is •....(in full)..... I am a duly qualified and registered medical practitioner employed by the ...... Board as a ****.(state house surgeon or otherwise)..... The .....(man or woman)...., known to me as ...(name in full) aged. . . . . . .yrs. 0s•• •of . . . . . . . (address)..... ....... was admitted to .....(name of hospital)....... time on......... date....900 year, following an accident when ........ • • • . . . . . . .0 • • ( medical findings) . . . . • • . • . •• •0 In my opinion death was due to Type name of doctor Qualifications Taken and sworn this0.....0day of ......... 19...., at before me. Coroner Note: the medical practitioner signs the deposition at the inquest. A copy of the deposition should be kept in the medical record. All still-births (i.e. born dead after the expiration .of the 28th week of pregnancy) must be notified to the Registrar of Births as required in the case of,the live birth. A still-birth is registered in the same manner as a live birth but no entry is made in the death register.. Where a medical practitioner is in attendance at the birth of a still-born child he is required by Section 20 of the Births and Deaths Registration Act 1951 to issue and deliver to the Registrar of Births a medical certificate setting out, to the best of his knowledge and belief, the causes of the still-birth and such other details as the Registrar-General may require. A medical certificate is similarly required to be issued in respect of an early foetal death occurring after, the 20th week of pregnancy but before the expiration of the 28th week. It is of interest that in the case where no medical practitioner was in attendance at the confinement but a midwife was, the certificate required to be issued under Section 20 should be issued by the midwife. It should be noted also, that still-births require the normal burial procedure to be completed by the parents. Lf would be recorded within the case notes. Hospitals which treat patients with electric shock therapy require a consent form to be completed for this purpose and always kept in the case notes. Regulations regarding discharge or death of patients: 7. Should the patient decide to leave hospital against the advice of the medical staff concerned, he is requested to sign a form absolving the hospital authorities from any liability for personal damage or injury caused by this unauthorised action or complications arising therefrom. The Medical Officer of Health requires advice on all tuberculosis cases discharged from hospital. It is also a common procedure to notify the discharge date of any patient who has been treated with an infectious disease as listed under the Health Act, 1956. (See Regulation' 17 of the Tuberculosis Regulations, 1951). Where a patient dies in hospital and has been attended by a registered medical practitioner the practitioner is required by Section 25 of the Births and Deaths Registration Act 1951 to issue forthwith a medical certificate stating the causes of death and such other particulars as may be required by the Registrar-General and make such certificate available to the funeral director. If in the opinion of the medical practitioner death has occurred under circumstances of suspicion, he should immediately report the case to the Coroner and refrain from issuing a medical certificate. A medical certificate should not be issued where the medical practitioner has reasonable cause to suspect that the deceased person has died either a violent or an unnatural death unless the Coroner decides that no inquest is necessary. In the event of an inquest the Coroner may require a deposi tion from the medical practitioner who attended the patient. The deposition should be set out as follows - L2 6.Authorisation for operations A written consent for operation and administration of anaesthetics should always be obtained from the patient and filed with the medical record. Some hospitals have a consent form on the back of the chart front or admission order and routinely secure an authorisation on admission of all patients. If this is done, another consent form should be completed just prior to the operaion, and after the nature of the proposed operation has been fully explained to the patient or in the case of a minor, to the parent or guardian.It is always a wise policy to have a medical officer's signature as witness to the patient's authorisation.The Form of Consent as adopted by the North Canterbury Hospital Board has now become the accepted layout by hospital boards. An example of this form is shown at Appendix A. Alternative wording, which gives the same sense, together with consent by relatives and consent for a minor are shown in Appendix B. Procedure may vary in accident or other cases where the patient is unable to give consent. Mr. G.W. Searby has fully covered this aspect in his 'General Law Affecting Hospitals'. In dealing with consents of patients to operations, S.R. Speller, in his 'Law Relating to Hospitals', draws attention to certain operations not rendered valid by the patient's consent which he classifies as operations without medical need. He quotes "Any operation not required on medical grounds which inflicts bodily injury on the person undergoing it is illegal and may be the subject of a criminal charge, notwithstanding the consent of the person operated upon", and again "Although an operation for sterilisation does not inflict a manifest injury, as does the amputation of a limb, it none the less constitutes a most serious bodily injury and one in respect of which a criminal charge may follow unless performed for the sake of the health of the patient". In all such cases, a surgeon who intends operating will safeguard himself by taking a second and a third opinion which should be recorded in writing before such an operation is performed, and the opinions held in the hospital medical record. Where religious doctrines conflict with medical practice such as the giving of blood transfusions, special care is necessary in recording a consent. Other circumstances could be the termination of pregnancy or sterilisation. Special conditions may apply when a donor, a normal healthy person, is admitted to hospital to enable transplantation to be carried out on a donee, or a foetal transfusion found necessary in an unusual maternity case, and additional consent procedure L'I " In those cases where a baby is transferred to the premature unit of another hospital and the mother remains a patient at the first hospital the baby is to be recorded as a patient from the date of admission. H It is strongly recommended, however, that some form of admission procedure should be carried out for newly born infants, expecially where a unit record is used. It is important to and Deaths Registration must be notified to the in a city or borough or note that, under Section 10 Act 1951 a birth occurring Registrar of Births within within 7 days in any Other of the Births in a hospital 48 hours if case. The hospital authorities are also responsible for notifying the Registrar where a child is born outside the hospital (say, in an ambulance) and is immediately admitted to.the hospital. Admission to a mental hospital: 5. A patient may be admitted to a mental health hospital in three ways, as a voluntary boarder, as an informal admission or as a committal. When it is considered that a patient should be committed to a mental health hospital application may be made to a Magistrate by any person not under the age of 21 years, but under the circumstances of a patient 'committed from a general hospital, application would be completed either by a relative of the patient or the Medical Superintendent. Two medical certificates are required to comply with the Mental Health Act and these would be completed by the medical attendant to the patient and another registered medical practitioner. Relatives would be interviewed either by the Medical Superintendent or a Senior Medical Officer. If the relatives are agreeable to the patient's committal, the application form is completed and signed by the nextof-kin. In other cases the application would be made out and signed by the Medical. Superintendent or his deputy. On being signed by the Magistrate, the application form •then becomes the reception order form. It is important to note that the application with the two medical certificates must be forwarded to the Magistrate's Court and the application form signed by the Magistrate within 48 hours of the patient being received at the mental health hospital.. (See Sections 3-15 Mental Health Act, 1 911 and emergency admissions under section 8 of the Mental Health Amendment Act, 1928) 4', treating infectious cases. All cases must be reported even though the disease be only suspected and not necessarily diagnosed as notifiable.A list of notifiable conditions is always available from the District Medical Officer of Health. It will be seen from the list that not all infectious cases are notifiable, including venereal disease. See Sections 70/87 and 88/92 Health Act, 1956. The procedure of advising the Local Authority is carried out by the Medical Officer of Health unless arranged otherwise. (Refer also to chapter 14 on 'Notification of Diseases') Patients may be admitted to hospital when they are found to be infirm and have no help. Admissions in this category are known as committals the details of which are laid down under Section 126 of the Health Act 1956 and in the Health (Infirm and Neglected Persons) Regulations 1958. Committals under this Act are comparatively rare.Under the procedure laid down in such cases an appropriate application is made to the Magistrate's Court •without the necessity of giving any notice to the person proposed : to be committed since that person is usually in a condition where notice of the proceedings would serve no purpose. On being satisfied of the merits of the application the Magistrate will make an order directing that the person be committed to a named hospital. This order cannot be questioned by the hospital and becomes the authority for admitting the patient. The hospital is entitled to a sealed copy of the order which should be filed with the patient's records. When a baby is born in hospital or is admitted to hospital immediately after birth some form of admission procedure is necessary for administrative purposes. Health Department regulations, however, state:Infants (except premature babies cared for in a premature baby unit) newly born and remaining in a maternity hospital, ward or annexe after the discharge of the mother should not be recorded as admissions, notwithstanding that they may be receiving treatment which would warrant their classification as patients; but if transferred to a general hospital or ward they should be recorded as admissions thereto in the ordinary way. Premature babies cared for in a premature unit should not be recorded as patients while the mother is also a patient; but where they are retained in a premature unit these babies should be counted as patients for the period they are cared for in the unit after the discharge of the mother, although they will not be occupying 'available' beds. (5) For the purposes of this section, the term "repre- sentative", in respect of any patient, means his executor or administrator or any dependant within the meaning of the Workers' Compensation-Act 1956 if the patient is dead, or one of his parents or his guardian if the patient is an infant; and, in any other case where the patient is unable to give consent, means a person appearing to the Medical Superintendent of the hospital to be lawfully acting on behalf of the patient or in his interests. •(6) Every person who acts in contravention of the provisions of this section camiits an offence and shall be liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding fifty pounds. Statutory provisions regarding admission of patients: The statutory. authorities for duties relating to the admission of patients to hospital are indirectly covered in Sections k and 55 Hospitals Act, 1 957. It is at this stage that the statutory requirements relating to the notification of Infectious Disease, Tuberculosis etc., must be considered. Following admission to a ward it is the duty of the Ward Medical Officer to advise the Medical Superintendent or the Medical Records Officer acting on behalf of the Medical Superintendent, of any such cases as soon as diagnoses are suspected or confirmed. The usual procedure is for the Medical Records Officer to check the provisional diagnosis on all admission cards daily and on behalf of the Ward Medical Officer inform the District Medical Officer of Health by telephone. A written list of all suspected cases or provisionally confirmed cases is then passed to the Ward Medical Officer for verification,The Ward Medical Officer must return the list to the Medical Records Officer weekly to enable details to be transcribed onto the official form which is provided by the Medical Officer of Health for the purpose of notification. It should be noted that it is the responsibility of the Ward Medical Officer to notify any cases within the meaning of the regulations and the Medical Records Officer acts only as an intermediary in all cases. Beside details of the patient, the form forwarded to the Medical Officer of Health must show the provisional diagnosis, the final diagnosis if known, have a aerial number and be signed by the Medical Superintendent. Advice forms are forwarded to the Medical Officer of Health weekly where the hospital is 5. (3) (d) Information required in the course of his official duties by any officer of the Department of Health, the Department of Justice, the Social Security Department, the Navy Department, the Army Department, or the Air Department, or by any officer of any of Her Majesty's Forces, or by any constable: (e) Information required by any person pursuant to the provisions of any Act: (g) Information , briefly describing the nature of the injuries of a patient suffering from the results of an accident, if the information is given within twenty-four hours after the patient's admission to hospital and is.'given by the Medical Superintendent of the hospital, or by any other medical officer, authorised by the Medical Superintendent, to any person authorised by the editor or publisher of any registered newspaper authorised by the editor or publisher of any registered newspaper to collect information for publication in that newspaper: (h) Information required by such other persons or class of persons in such circumstances and subject to such conditionâ as the Minister may from time to time prescribe by notice in writing. Nothing in this section shall be deemed to prohibit the use or disclosure of any information concerning a patient's condition or treatment for the purposes of the advancement of medical knowledge or research: Provided that where any such disclosure is made in any publication-no disclosure shall be made of the name, initials, or identity of the patient, and where any such disclosure is made in any other way every person , to whom the disclosure is made who is not employed by the Board shall in respect of the information'so disclosed be subject to the provisions of this section in the same manner and to the same extent as if he were employed by the Board. (4) Nothing in this section shall derogate from section eight of the Evidence Act 1908 or any other enactment or rule of law relating to evidence in any criminal or civil proceeding. 57 / If the record is to be used for purposes of research or other scientific investigation as authorised by law, permission is not necessary from the patient, but the use of such a record must be subject to the statutory provisions. Where specific cases are to be quoted in a publication, even though identification data are not noted, consent should be obtained from the Medical Superintendent, and also, as a matter of courtesy, from the attending physician. Information from the medical record is constantly asked for by insurance agencies before paying claims to the Insured. The hospital must have written and properly signed and dated authorisation before releasing a report. It is the practice of some insurance companies to have the insured sign a form of authorisation on taking out a policy. No authorisation dated prior to the date of hospitalisation should be accepted by the hospital. Statutory regulations on the disclosure of medical information: 4.1 Hospitals Act, 1957 62 Non-disclosure of medical information - (1) Subject to the provisions of this section, no person employed by a Board (whether as an honorary or part-time medical officer or otherwise) shall give to any person no employed by the Board any information concerning the condition or treatment of any patient in any institution without the prior consent of the patient or his representative, whether the patient is still in the institution or not, (2) Nothing in this section shall apply with respect to (a) Information in general terms concerning the condition of the patient on the day on which the information is given: (b) Information communicated by a member of the medical staff of the hospital to the nextof-kin or other near relative of the patient In accordance with the recognised customs of medical practice: (c) Information required in connection with the further treatment of the patient: should he ask for one.This eliminates the necessity of consulting the hospital record after the patient has been discharged and facilitates follow-up of the patient in the doctor's office. However, it should be noted that this form of disclosure must be treated with caution, and only initiated when provision is made by the Medical Superintendent for such a system. Requests for confidential information concerning a patient's records are frequently received from Government Departments. Some of these requests are made in person by representatives and others are received through the mail. Unless release of such information has written authorisation or is fully covered by statute it should not be made available. Information as to the name of the patient, the address, and the dates of admission and discharge may be released as such data are not usually considered confidential. Beside the provisions of Section 62 of the hospitals Act 1957 it should be noted that Section 13 of the War Pensions Act 1954 and Regulation 3 of the War Pensions Regulations 1956 specifically cover any Government Officer requesting medical records on behalf of the War Pensions Appeal Board. The records may be made available to the Appeal Board on written demand without the authority of the patient but the demand should show on its face that the records are required for the purposes of the War Pensions Act. Numerous welfare organisations make inquiries which may be official and solely for the benefit of the patient, but unless they are specifically covered by statute, the information should not be disclosed to them without proper authorisation from the patient and the approval of the Medical Superintendent. The Health Department is interested in the control of disease which includes , the means of prevention of disease and injury, and the promotion of health.In these activities the hospital is bound by law as well as ethical responsibility to co-operate to the fullest extent.However, when releasing any information care must be taken to ascertain whether the record is to be used as an impersonal document or as a personal document. If it is to be used as personal information, authority should be obtained from the patient and the Medical Superintendent. To give an example of personal information, notification of a poison case may be quoted where a neurotic patient has attempted suicide, and information as to why the patient took the poison is passed to the Medical Officer of Health. Such additional advice is not required under the Health Act, 1956. Sc 1 Privileged communication: 3. Although statutes within New Zealand fully set out the penalties for unauthorised release of information from a patient's record, many persons having access to hospital records fail to observe the principles of privileged communication. Confidential information given by a patient to his physician must be regarded as privileged. Unless the patient has waived claim of privilege of the medical record by giving written authorisation for the inspection of the record or release of information as covered by the statutory provisions, no information may be divulged at any time. After death of the patient the claim of privilege may be waived by the patient's executor or next of kin. Medical records containing identification data, diagnoses and other pertinent data are sometimes allowed away from the hospital for various purposes. Great care must be taken in permitting practices which might involve a violation of the privileged character of the medical record. The practice of allowing medical records to be taken to homes or offices where they may be viewed by unauthorised persons must be considered as unacceptable and condemned by those having custody of the records. Disclosure of medical information: If a visiting physician requests access to the medical record of a former patient, he is usually given the record to peruse, but only as a courtesy by the hospital and not as a matter of right. It must be fully accepted that medical practitioners are well aware of the canons of professional secrecy and that it is permitted under statute to pass on information required in connection with the further treatment of the patient. To be absolutely correct from the legal point of view, a medical practitioner should maintain personal records of his patients and these should be kept in his office. Where a patient changes to another medical practitioner, it is not unusual for that medical practitioner to ask the hospital for a full report on the patient. The information is given to the medical practitioner on the understanding that it is for the further treatment of the patient. Some hospital medical record departments make it a practice to send a duplicate copy of the records to the medical practitioner in the form of a precis or summary for hisown personal file. If the patient changes his medical practitioner a copy of the summary is readily available to forward to him, 34. k. 2. Property rights Medical records are kept primarily for the benefit of the patient but the question may arise as to who has the legal Hght to custody.The case notes and all documents of patients treated in the hospital are the property of the Hospital Board (or Hospital Management Committee). They cannot become the property of the medical practitioner making them but remain under the control of the hospital.To elaborate further on this question, Mr. S.R. Speller in his book 'Law Relating to Hospitals and Kindred Institutions' quotes ".... whether it be a private or general ward patient, it seems clear that the patient has no claim to the medical notes or reports which are simply in furtherance of the treatment for which he has either contracted or with which he is being provided by the hospital". Putting it another way the American authors Hayt and Hayt in their textbook 'Law of Hospital' point out the property right of the hospital in the following words " The hospital record is the property of the institution as is the register of a hotel .... records are the property of the hospital which has the right to their possession and custody; it is no more the property of the patient than the merchant's book is the property of the customer". In addition to being kept for the benefit of the patient, the medical records are kept as a guide to consultants, for education and research, for the protection of the attending physicians against claims of malpractice, and for the protection of the hospital against criticism together with claims for injuries or damage. It is not in the patient's interest to see his record and any patient requesting information should do so through his physician. Upon receipt of written authorisation from the patient it is permissible for the legal representative acting on behalf of the, patient or other acceptable person, to receive a full report from the medical record. However, the hospital may be required to produce its records upon subpoena. Usually this is a Subpoena Duces Tecum or a Summons to Witness to produce, which directs the custodian of the records to appear in a given court on a date and at an hour designated in the subpoena or summons. After receipt of the subpoena all records specifically enumerated in it must be produced in court at the time and place designated, or the person subpoenaed is liable for contempt of court. When the medical record is retained by the court it. is necessary for the hospital to apply to the Registrar of the Court for its return. k Medical Records Practice in New Zealand MEDICO-LEGAL ASPECTS OF MEDICAL RECORDS KEEPING 1. Introduction 2. ProDertv rights 3. Privileged communication Lf. Disclosure of medical information 4.1 Statutory Regulations on the disclosure of medical information 50 Statutory provisions regarding admission of patients 5.1 Admission to a mental health hospital 6. Authorisation for operations 7.. Regulations regarding discharge or .death of patients 8. The medical record in Court 9. Summary .10. References 11. Further reading 11.1 Basic 11.2 Background Appendix A Form Of consent by patient Appendix B Consent by patient; consent by relatives;. consent for minor Introduction: 1. The improvement of hospital administration during this century has been accompanied by legislation which clearly defines the duties and responsibilities of all staff connected with the compilation and keeping of a patient's medical record. This is particularly so within New Zealand where every effort has been made to cover by law all aspects of medical jurisprudence.Hospital officers in their own interests as well as the hospital's should be fully familiar with the Hospitals Act and all the provisions pertaining to medical record keeping.. File No. Name todate Fig. 2. A permanent index card 1.- 2 APPENDIX A File No.772240 Name of patientBROWN Joseph Robert LocationWard 9 Date Out 12/8/65 am pm 12120 Taken Byname of person Fig. 1. The simple index card These cards may be headed up to suit machine addressing. The name of the patient may also precede that of the file number. Fig. 3. The 'record out' guide. Protrudes over the •end of records on a shelf. Departments using steel filing cabinets would design guide to protrude above the top of the records. 83 Associative 'Controlling Staff' in London, Current Affairs Ltd., 'Methods at Work' pp 47-511962, 101 pp 8.4 Light Relief Pose (Ian) Robert's Rules of Unparlimentary Procedure III The Phenomenon of Records Canadian Medical Assn. Jnl. 17 Aug. 19 6 3 9 pp 308-9 Tiltman (R.c.s.) Practical aspects of a Medical Records department Medical Record, May 1951, PP 136-9 Backround: 8.2. Bothwell ( p .w.) Routine, records and research Pts. I - III Medical Record, Aug. 1960, pp 2 98-30 2 ; Nov. 1960 PP 320-7; Feb. 1961, pp 359-64 Clarke (K.W.) The group organisation in Medical Records 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 117-27 Clayton (J.P.) Recent trends N..Z. Hospital, March 1954, in Medical Research and thepp 69-70 effects upon Hospital Medical Records Clyne (Max B.) The threeLancet,.6 June 1964, faces of Joan: diagnosticpp 1270-2 and therapeutic levels in general practice Doran (M.T.) The need for research in Medical Recording methods 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 129-41 Fraser (Dr. A.) A consultant's view of Medical Records Medical Record,Nov. 1963, Pp 583-8 Grant (John, edit.) Work sampling Medical Record News, April 1964 9 pp 51-2 ., 72-4 1st mt. Congress Report, pp 143-57. Kurtz (D.L.) Examples of research in Medical Recording methods (Lincoln & Naylor) Record department administration, physical plant, functional organisation and other factors 2nd mt. Congress Report, PP 150-67 Rowan (D.J.) A working formula for better human relations JnlAAMRL, Dec. .1961, p 255 Schenthal, Sweeney, Nettle- Jnl. American Medical Assn., ton & Yoder. Clinical appli- Oct. 12, 19639 pp 1,01-5 cation of Electronic Data Processing Apparatus. III System for Processing of Medical Records Hargrave (A.) Application of Work Study to Medical Records Service Medical Record, Feb. 1962, pp 1+78-86 Hill (Peter E.) Work study and the clinical record 2. Organisation, the key to efficiency Medical Record, Nov. 1965, PP 175-82 Incomplete notes: how to deal with (in 'What do YOU do?') Medical Record News,. Dec. 1965, pp 322-4 Jackson (N.V.) Departmental Medical Record, Feb. 1961, Routine - requests forpp 373-4 Information Luck, J.F. Work study as 3rd mt. Congress Report, applied to Medical Records pp 88-106 Luck (J.H.) Work study inMedical Record, Aug, 1959 relation to a Medical Records Department 'Medical StenographersH.M.S.O., 1961,4 pp Department': Abstracts of Efficiency Studies in the Hospital Service, No. 10 Melvan (M.) Medical recordMedical Record News, deficiency formFeb. 1966, pp 20-2 Meyer (Sister M.Y.) Methods Jnl AAMRL, Feb. 1957,, improvement and the Medical pp 7-11, 16 Record Librarian Medical Record News, (Oviatt, Kurtz, Price, April 1962, pp 82-1+, 90-1 Schultz, Mitchell & Baumann) After hours office supervision (in 'What do YOU do?') Report of a Committee on Medical Records in N.S.W. Hospitals N.S.W. Hospitals Commn., 1960, 54 pp Seymour (E.L.) Filing and1st mt. Congress Report, disposition of recordspp 91-103 Sheetz O.K.) OrientationJnl AAMPL, Oct. 1960, of the employeepp 183-4, 208-9 Stone (J.E.) Hospital organ- London, Faber, 1952, xxii + isation and management,1722 pp 801-4, 814-18 N 3 smoothly regardless of how competent the Medical Records Officer is himself, He/she is not a one man/woman department but. a person who can co-relate and supervise the daily activities and weld them into an efficient unit of the hospital service. Developments in medicine and in the application of data processing equipment to the medical record field demand that the Medical Records Officer adjust his thinking to change. The next two decades will see a complete change in methods of recording, storing and referring to patient data; to serve his hospital the Medical Records Officer must keep abreast of developments. References: 7. Huffman (Edna) Manual for Medical Record Librarians. Physicians' Record Co. 1959- pp +31-5 8 ('Organisation and management of a Medical Records department') Further reading.: 8. Basic: 8,1. 26 (Baumann, Smith, Cole & Medziuà) Measuring productivity in Medical Record activities (in 'What do YOU do?') Medical Record News, Oct. 1963 Brockis (R.J.) Tracing system Medical Record, Feb. 1956, Brown (R.J.) Simple 'job, analysis in a Hospital 'Records Department, Medical Record, Aug. 195+, (Carter, Chamberlain, Dunne, Mitchell, Odam & Eugene,) Requests for medical records (in 'What. do. YOU do?') Jnl, AAMRL, April 19619 pp 80-2 Coulam (N.R.) Economy of effort in Medical Record keeping Medical Record, Feb. 1963, pp 216-8 pp 1+15, 37 pp 350-58 pp 615-.25 hospital or to reveal certain, aspects of their medical history to the examining practitioner because "they are afraid of what the girls in the office might say". Fortunately in most cases such statements are only an excuse to cover up some underlying motive; however, they do serve to show how essential it is for all members of the medical records staff, however junior, to display absolute integrity. Whilst a person cannot be held responsible for her, or his, family background this aspect has to be taken into consideration, particularly in the smaller communities, when considering applications for positions in the Medical Records department. Also it is wise to point out to new staff, who have not had previous hospital experience, that non-disclosure of information includes next-of-kin and other members of the hospital staff; this is an important matter which is sometimes overlooked. Loyalty not only to information regarding patients but also to the medical profession and the hospital itself should at all times, both during working hours and in private life, be maintained. It is also necessary for the senior medical records staff to have an intelligent, but not presumptuous, understanding of medical science. In the smaller hospitals it is very difficult for staff wishing to increase their ability in this field but if personal relationships are good most members of the medical staff are only too willing to be helpful. Private reading and study are also most valuable and in most cases, where there is a training school library, tutor sisters are willing to lend books which although written in extensive nursing detail, can be most useful. The Medical Records Officer himself is directly responsible for the efficiency of his department and no chapter dealing with the present subject would be complete without assessing the abilities and training necessary for the holding of such a position. He will be regarded by his board as a senior member of the staff, with a sound, complete and detailed knowledge of medical records systems. Able to lead and supervise the department in all its various aspects of daily work, enthusiastic and capable of infecting his staff with enthusiasm and to command the respect and confidence of medical staff, other heads of departments, his superiors,.'and his own staff, he must be flexible to meet the ever changing demands of medicine and board policy. His training, probably of necessity, is of an "on the job" type but should be on as broad a basis as possible not only to maintain an efficient department, but to be able to meet additional responsibilities if necessary and to give advice and assistance when required. Personnel selection and management play a large part in maintaining efficiency, and only a reliable and happy staff can keep a department functioning 3 Medical Records Officer and the staff concerned asked to meet the committee. Such a committee can also give hacking to Medical Records department procedures designed to keep records available. For instance, it is a good policy to insist that nurses requiring notes for case studies do their study in the department and usually that not more than 20 records be taken out at a time for research by medical staff. If a Medical Records committee is aware of the reasons for wanting such rules and endorses them their acceptance within the hospital will be that much easier. Responsibility to medical staff and staff qualifications: 6. During comparatively recent years the medical profesèion has come to realise and acknowledge that specialised clerical aid in the handling of medical records is a necessity, and to this end the technical side Of medical records work has been handed over to a staff of trained para-medical persons. This in turn has placed on this staff a strong challenge to professional loyalty and created positions of special trust within the hospital organisation. The need for personal integrity in these positions cannot be overstressed. It is opportune to quote here from the Pledge of the American Association of Medical Record Librarians: "Moreover, I pledge myself to give out no information concerning a patient from any other source, to any person whatsoever, except upon order from the chief executive officer of the institution which I may be serving ..... 't The final responsibility for the completed, factual and accurate medical record rests with the attending physician or surgeon with the assistance of other hospital personnel. He knows the facts and is competent to interpret them as they apply to the person being treated. His co-operation and assistance will produce an adequate, scientific and authoritative record. Tact, understanding and consideration of medical staff's problems on the part of the Medical Records department will help establish a climate conducive to good medical recording thus laying a firm basis for better patient care in the future and adequate statistical data for research programmes.. This element of medical work tends if anything to be enhanced in the hospitals serving smaller communities where unfortunately there is a tendency for everyone to know everyone else's business. It has been known for patients to express reluctance to enter possibly for a day in rotation because otherwise there are too many interruptions. In addition, the teams would have routine department jobs shared between them, such as census, operation lists, notifiable disease lists etc. This type of organisation allows each team to vary its work according to requirements and inclinations. By making each team responsible for certain blocks, of numbers it imposes on the team an obligation to know at all times where the records in its section are 5. Relationship with other departments In a hospital as with any other complex organisation, it is important to appreciate the problems, and the work involved, of other sections of the staff. A Medical Records Officer may look with dismay at an admission record that is lacking in some personal details of the patient, and feel that the Admitting Officer is not doing his job properly. It might not occur to him that the Admitting Officer could have, been in the difficult position of having to admit an unconscious patient, accompanied by some person who could not supply all these personal details. The reverse also applies - an Admitting Officer could feel that the Medical Records Officer is wanting some information that is not really required. The best way to solve these problems is to show the reason why a certain procedure is adopted, or why a particular set of questions require answers, by personal approach to the people concerned. The Medical Records Officer's working relationship is closest with the Medical Superintendent to whom he is usually responsible for his work even if, as a member of the administrative staff, he comes under the House Manager. Normally, the Medical Records Officer will discuss problems with the medical or other staff concerned, referring to the Medical Superintendent matters of principle or seeking his backing where necessary. AMedical Records Committee, usually with the Medical Superintendent as chairman and the Medical Records Officer as secretary and with representation from part-time visiting staff and full-time medical staff and possibly nurses is recommended. This should meet monthly or every other month for the purpose of examining problems in connection with medical records. Cases of delay in completion of records can be brought forward by the 23 3 ment, and may be subdivided to allocate which jobs are performed by particular members of the staff. This manual should be' reviewed from time to time, as the addition of new procedures, the deletion of others, or changes in staff may call for some revision. In any job, it is a good policy to be always on the lookout for ways and means to do it better, faster and with less effort. Medical Records is no exception to this, and the staff within the department should be encouraged to make suggestions for ways and means to improve any of the many -jobs that are carried out within the department. Even the most junior member of the staff should be asked for ideas; they may come up with something that routine bound older members have constantly missed. It is important to train staff to be proficient in as many phases of medical records work as possible. This safeguards the department in the event of staff being away due to sickness or holidays, as the work of the department must continue. An office whe .re the staff of equal capabilities change duties periodically is also advantageous, as a clerk who is constantly pulling and filing records, or indexing, can become bored with the routine nature of such work. Such boredom can lead to lack of care, and then mistakes occur, such as misfiling, which is probably the most time consuming error to rectify in a Medical Records department. The 'team' concept: 4.1. Mention is made in para 5.2, chapter 5 ('Filing systems') that terminal digit filing facilitates the orgànisation of the office in teams. An alternative to changing clerks from one job to another for variety of experience and interest is to make them responsible for everything for a certain section of records. This can be done with the terminal digit filing method by dividing the department up into teams responsible for records ending in certain numbers. For instance, a hospital with 12,000 discharges a year might be divided into 3 teams, team A being responsible for charts with primary numbers 00-32, team B 33-66 and team C 6-99. Teams of two each are usually best; they would have responsibility for all the operations connected with the record stacking., filing, coding, typing MS18 statistical cards etc. although it is usually better to have pulling done by one person, z2 In order to assist medical and nursing staff to find a record when the department is not staffed by Medical Records personnel, it is useful to 'have a plan displayed, showing where to find patient index cards, where files of a certain number are, and where to find records that may be housed in another room. Access should only be by obtaining a key from the Head Orderly's office on signature. An 'after hours' book is essential. In this book, a note is made of any record removed after hours. It should show the date and time of removal, where the record has gone' to, and who took it. It is also necessary to have a large notice plainly telling staff what to do when taking a record. k. Organisation of staff, V The variation of size of hospitals throughout the country naturally makes a considerable difference in the number of staff •required to operate a Medical Records department. In small hospitals, one person may be responsible for admissions, records, medical typing, and a host of other duties. Moving up the dcale, there are separate Records departments, manned by one person, to the major hospitals with a large staff, including clerks who specialise in one particular sphere of medical records work, such as coding, workers' compensation, cancer registration, and index clerks, as well as clerks who are responsible for pulling and refiling case notes. The majority of jobs in a Medical Records department are learned by experience and tuition from other staff within the department. An exception might be a coder, who could have attended a training course organised by the National 'Health Statistics Centre. Next to the officer in' charge of the Medical, Records department, the position of coder must be regarded as a key one, by virtue' of the time it takes to reach what may be regarded as maximum efficiency. However, this does not mean that the coder is more important for the efficient working of a Records department than, say, a filing clerk, as all records staff should be regarded as part of a team. In organising the distribution of work, the Medical Records Officer must ensure that his staff fully understand the nature of a particular job, how it is done, and why it is done. To this end it is a wise policy to draw up a procedure manual. This details all the different jobs done by the Records Depart- Ii 3 2.5. The patient index: This must be accurate and correctly filed according to whatever system is in use in.the hospital. It is a timesaving device to include all names pronounced in the same way but spelt differently in the index together, e.g. Gray,. Grey, Hardie, Hardy, Heard, Herd, Hird. The important thing to note is that all staff must know what system is used and follow it exactly. .. . • . An efficient department: 2.6 The work done by the Medical Recordsdepartment may vary between hospitals. For instance, in larger: hospitals most include the medical typists as part of the department but in some this will be a separate department; in smaller hospitals, medical records will be part of the functions -of the office.. Whether 'Medical Records' is a complete department or part of one clerk it must do its job promptly and efficiently. If it gets known as 'the filing' then it is relegated tothe status of a dustbin - and probably looks like one. To. be'efficient a department should look efficient. ..•.. Hours of.coveràge for Medical Records department: •The normal working week for the majority ofNew Zealanders is Monday to Friday. However, many public services have to maintain their service for twenty-four hours a day, seven days a week, although such service may be .on a reduced scale at weekends, and at night. A hospital issucha.service. To assess the hours of coverage for the Medical Records department, it is reasonable to assume that if there is a constant call for records outside the normal working hours, then the department should be staffed to deal with the work. This problem is mainly one for the large hospitals. Staff may work on a roster basis, and have regular change of shifts, covering other departments where possible, e.g. Admitting. PO .3. 2.3.2 Referring to medical records Different methods of keeping track of medical records are described in chapter 5 ('Filing systems'). However, there has to be a policy regarding the use of medical records for study or research. The medical record must, as we have seen, 'be quickly brought into service if a patient is readmitted'. This cannot be done if it is in the rooms of a member of the visiting staff, in a resident's or nurse's room. Therefore, a policy along the following lines should be adopted and have the authority of the Medical Superintendent: (i) in a new department or one where space is available, study cubicles should be available for medical and nursing staff to refer to records, to study them or to use them for research; (ii) generally speaking, not more than 20 records should be put out for study or research at a time, another 20 being put out when these are returned; (iii) as space is usually short, a compromise has to be reached usually with records for visiting staff being put in their lounge, those for resident staff in their office and nurses being required to study records in the Medical Records department. 2,4. Confidential nature of records. The question of maintaining the confidential nature in all matters relating to a patient's medical record has been emphasised in all publications relating to Medical Records practice. All enquiries for information from a medical record for insurance, workers' compensation, or legal purposes should be through the Medical Superintendent. An authority to divulge such information must be signed by the patient. Enquiries from a Registered Medical Practitioner about past history that may assist the practitioner in arriving at a diagnosis for a current illness are not regarded as a breach of confidence. '1.9 3 Hospital MEDICAL RECORDS DEPARTMENT Dr. Patient:Hosp.. No.__________ Please:1. Discharge letter 2. Discharge summary 3. Sign front sheet k Final diagnosis 5. Operation. note 6. See x-ray report. 7. See pathology report 8. See P.M. report Put - out at your request.. • Quick action by you will help us to give prompt service Date .../.../6.. The required message is circled or ticked. 2.3 Identification of reports with a patient A number of report forms, particularly laboratory and x-ray reports, will not be available until after the patient has been discharged from hospital. It is essential that these reports be seen by the doctor in charge of the case or his House Surgeon who should initial all reports, indicating that he hasseen them; this should be rule of the hospital. The report should be attached to the record with a note to the doctor concerned drawing his attention to it. Before filing with the medical record, reports should be identified by the patient's name as well as hospital number, as belonging to that record. It is possible to have people with the same name, and only one number different on a file, if, for example, a father and son were admitted as a result of a motor vehicle accident. We could get Reginald Brown No. 123456, and his son'Reginald James Brown 123+57, both admitted to a hospital for the first time, and being allocated adjacent file numbers,. 2 .3.1 Notes to medical staff The Medical Records department frequently has to bring the attention of medical staff to deficiencies in a medical record or is asked to put out a record for a doctor's attention. , Nothing looks so indicative of a sloppily run department as putting these out with a scrap of paper with a scrawled note on it. Any hospital Medical Records department can have a supply of standard notes to be pinned on the front of the record, even if these are only duplicated. The note could be along the following lines: 11 3 A. The guide is the same height as the folder it replaces, and about two inches longer. It is also advantageous to be of a contrasting colour to the normal record folders. A plastic pocket on the side of the guide holds-an index. card much the same as the simple index card (see Fig. 3, Appendix A). The guide must be made from a durable grade of cardboard. The main disadvantage of this type of location check is its use in a Records department that may have records stored some distance from the • main working area; obviously one does not know that the record is out until going to the file to find it. B. A simple lined manilla card of contrasting colour and longer (or higher) than the case notes. When a medical record is removed from the files the following details are written on the manilla card - hospital number,, patient's name, where the notes are taken to, and the date taken (signature of the person taking can be added), the card is then placed in, the location of the record. When the record is re-filed, the 'record out' card is removed and a line put through the last entry, hence it is ready for reuse. This has the advantage that it is simple to use, inexpensive and useful when records are filed in different places. It has the same disadvantage as that described under 'A' above. (iv) 'Kardex' type One can also use a card in a Kardex type drawer or folder either as an individual mark-out or for, say, 10 charts.This works quite well as a tracer of records up until the MS18 statistical card has been typed and action on the record has been completed. For use with the unit system it has been found unsatisfactory when referring to older notes. (b) A location index card.This system may have several variations, and providing all staff of.the hospital who may be called upon to remove medical records from the Records department follow the simple procedures, an adequate location check is . assured. (i) A simple index card (See Fig. 1, Appendix A) This is a 5" x 3" card headed with the patient's name, hospital number, location, and, date removed. A line should also be provided for the signature. of the person. removing the record from file, as this procedure establishes the authority of the person taking the record. It is a good policy to use two cabinets for this type of card, one strictly for admissions, and the other for all others, such as clinics', research, etc. After discharge from hospital, some patients will be followed, up at clinics for . changes of dressings, suture removal etc., and the index card used to denote an admission for such a patient may be transferred to the 'other records out' box. The date of such a change should be noted on the card. When the records are returned , to file, these index cards are destroyed. (ii) A permanent index' crd (See Fig : 2, Appendix A) This card is used in the same manner as the one previously described. It is kept under the front of the folder of the record while the record is in file, and may be stored in a cabinet when the record is removed. The only advantages over the simple' index card are (1) it may be headed up with the patient's personal details when the original record is compiled, thus saving a little time by not having to make up a card each time the records are removed, (2) it gives a brief history of the movement of the record between different departments, which is often useful. (iii) The 'record out' guide When a medical , record is removed from its place in the file, it is replaced by a guide. Two kinds are suggested: .. /1 3 been taken from the department has gone to. Several methods of 'booking out' records may be used, some of which follow Tracer methods: .2.2.1. (a) An alphabetical indexed book When a patient is admitted, the despatch of his or her records to the ward is recorded by entering in the book particulars such as, for example, in the case of a Mr. John Adams admitted to Ward 9 on 5 July, 1965 Date & time file sent to ward 6/7/65 10.30 a.m. NameFilePrevious notes Ward Adams, John 123+5 .0/c 9 Date file sent to ward. This date may not be the admission date, as the previous record may be very old, and housed some distance from the Records department, and not brought up to date until the following day. In the case of an evening admission the record maynot be despatched to the ward until the following day. Under the column headed 'Previous notes', it is useful to show very briefly the type of records that go to the ward. An example of terms abbreviated can be: (i) 0/c, an old case. This means that the patient has old inpatient records, and they have been sent' to the ward. (ii) O.P.D.This means that the only previous records cover attendance as an outpatient or the patient was examined at a specialist clinic prior to coming to hospital as a booked admission and the records have been sent to the ward. (iii) A simple. dash - could denote that the 'patient has, no previous history of attending the hospital, and that a new folder for his medical record has been headed up and despatched to the ward0 Noting the ward number serves as a location checc. records stored there; if a room has to be in another building, an attempt should be made to select one that is close to a member of the clerical staff in that building, so that a telephone call to that person can recall the record into use. The policy should be that the oldest records (i.e. the ones where the patients have not been admitted for the greatest number of years) should be less accessible than the more recent ones, if two or more storage rooms have to be used. The methods used to select the records over a.certain age can be readily worked out by the Records staff of the hospital concerned. Tightly packed records can lead to damage and the chance of misfiles increases. Space requirements vary in different hospitals depending on the degree of detail used. Instead of taking an arbitrary figure to cover all eventualities it is better to count a few shelves to see how many records you get per foot. You could find this varying as much as 30 to a foot between, say, open maternity cases and a medical admission in a teaching hospital. When organising the working space and storage capacity of the Records department, care should be taken to have sufficient shelving or drawer space free to accommodate records in current use, such as recent discharges awaiting discharge letters, reports, coding and indexing etc. Outward and returned clinic records should be kept in their own marked shelves for the interim period between clinic sessions for the outward records, and the re-filing of returns. All records awaiting action (discharge records, clinic records) should be immediately sorted into the alphabetical order of the surnames of the patients, or the numerical order of the hospital numbers or filed in pigeon holes under the House Surgeon or visiting staff. Strict observance of this procedure enables clerical staff to be more accurate when refiling, they can quickly locate a particular record should it be required, it leads to a tidy office, with consequent improved morale and greater productivity.Even the newest member of the staff will be fully conversant with the-office routine in a short time. On the other hand, sloppy storage of records awaiting action such as heaping them on desks, on the floor, or in any odd space that may be vacant, will lead to these records being mislaid,.and creates an air of confusion in the department. Good housekeeping is a must in a well organised Medical Records department. 2.2 Knowing the exact location of medical records It is essential that the staff of a Medical Records department have some means of knowing where a medical record that has 13 3 (ii) To ensure that all reports and forms can be identified with the patient to whom they apply, and that they are filed correctly. (iii) To ensure that the confidential nature of a patient's medical record is maintained. (iv) To maintain an accurate patient index (refer chapter 6 'Indexing procedures'). (v) To operate a disease index, and any other indexes that will usefully serve the staff of the hospital, such as operation index, radiotherapy index,, cancer register etc. (while a disease index is essential for all hospitals, other indexes may or may not be used depending on the size of hospital and scope of treatment). Depending also on the size of the hospital the cancer register may be a part-time job for a Medical Records staff member, a full-time job for a Medical Records clerk or be kept outside Medical Records by separate staff (who are, however, dependent for their information on Medical Records). (vi) To enjoy the confidence of medical, technical, and administrative members of the staff by the prompt and efficient execution of all duties rightly assigned to the department. Within the broad scope of these six headings, all Medical Records departments should operate. Storage and protection: 2.1. The majority if not all hospitals' Records departments reach a stage where the volume of records becomes such that, the rehousing, destruction or microfilming of the older records becomes necessary. The pros and cons of microfilming are dealt with in chapter 19 ('Retention of medical records). The question of how long, records are to be kept is also covered in the same. chapter.. . Rehousing can usually be achieved within the hospital, and careful consideration should be given to the proposed location, keeping the following important points in mind: the new room should be clean, well ventilated, dry and have no extremes of temperature, such as pipes from the steam reticulation system nor be an extremely cold room. If the room is in thesame block asthe main Records department, then the Records. staff, are in a position to handle any calls 'on medical it Depending upon the size of the hospital, there will be a considerable variation in the number of people employed within a Medical Records department. Indeed, there may be many differences. between the duties performed by Medical Records staff from one hospital to another. The layout of different. departments within a building, or group of buildings that comprise the hospital, will influence the type of work, and scope of duties of-Medical Records personnel. The generally accepted formula of the close proximity of Admitting Office, Medical Records department, Outpatient department, Medical Officers' Lounge and library, is ideal. However, many New Zealand hospitals (and those of other countries' too), started life as comparatively small institutions, and have grown stage by stage as the community they serve has grown. Naturally, such buildings cannot be continuously enlarged as one structure, .. and the end product is often a group of buildings with Medical Records, Outpatient, Admission Office, and Medical Officers' rooms widely separated. • Against this background therefore, we may have a modern hospital, with a specially designed Medical Records department, with adequate accommodation for storing many years' medical records;or an older type of building, with the Records department housed in converted rooms, and 'storehouses' for case notes situated in several different places within the hospital. Hospitals in New Zealand vary in size from about 900 beds down to 50 beds or less in country centres. Naturally the management and organisation of a Medical Records department' is going to, differ greatly with such a wide variation in hospitals. However, let us examine the function of a Medical Records department with a view to finding a 'common denominator', some basis applicable to all hospitals regardless of size or age. The function of a Medical Records department:. 2. This basis is (j) To store and protect the medical records of all patients in such a manner that they can be quickly brought into - service if a patient is readmitted, or if the patient is to be seen at a clinic, and to know the exact location if out of the department. 11 3 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand ORGANISATION OF A MEDICAL RECORDS DEPARTMENT 1. 2. Introduction The function of a Medical Records department 2.1 Storage and protection 2.2 Knowing the exact location of notes 2.2.1 Tracer methods 2.3 Identification of reports with a patient 2. 3. 1 Notes to medical staff 2.3.2 Referring to medical records .2.4 Confidential nature of records 2.5 The Patient Index 2.6 An efficient department 3. Hours of coverage for a Medical Records department 4. Organisation of staff 14.1 The 'team' concept. 5. Relationship with other departments 6. Responsibility to medical staff and staff qualifications 7. References 8. Further reading 8.1 Basic 8.2 Background 8.3 Associative 8.4 Light relie . Appendix A. Marking out cards Introduction: 1. This chapter covers organisation .in outline. It will be apparent that the object of most of this manual is to cover this subject in great detail. Specifically, the chapters covering aspects of organisation in a Medical Records department are: 51 'Filing systems'; 6, 'Indexing procedures'; 8, 'Hospital census taking'; 10, 'International classification of diseases'; 11, 'The classification of diseases'; 12, 'The classification of operations'; 14 1 'Notification of diseases'; 15, 'Workers' compensation'; 17, 'Cancer registration'; 18 'Follow-up methods'; 19, 'Retention of medical records'; 21, 'Planning a Medical Records department'-. to Social Security department concerning admissions to hospital; dealing with enquiries about War Pensioners and letters from G.Ps. concerning patients. This work is delegated to members of his staff as necessary. It will thus be seen that the necessity for an efficient Medical Records department is essential to the successful administration of our New . Zealand Hospitals. 8. Conclusion Other questions may be asked about the medical record "Who owns a medical record?" "Who has access to a medical record?" These questions are all answered in other parts of this manual, and I earnestly recommend that all Medical Records Officers and their staffs make a careful study of this manual and so qualify themselves in the very important work they should be doing accurately and well in our New Zealand Hospitals. Finally, I feel this manual, with some sections dealing with admission procedures, planning a new department, filing systems, form design and the role of Medical Records departments in the hospital organisation should prove of interest to Hospital Medical Superintendents and Board Secr.etaries,.in. . . future planning. The contribution of the medical record to medical research: 6.1 Hospital records are, of course, not kept for research purposes primarily, but rather for the care of ill individuals. Nevertheless the medical record is a storehouse of knowledge concerning the patient. Collected together these records contain a mass of data on all phases of morbidity. Hospital data are able to yield important clues as to the factors which underlie or are associated with disease. For example, cigarette smoking associated with lung cancer was first suspected from hospital studies. It was only later that the validity of the association was confirmed by controlled prospective studies.. Many examples can be cited of retrospective studies of cancer in which hospitalised cases and matched controls have been used in search of attributes associated with disease. Hospital data, it has been demonstrated, can be used to study associations between various diseases appearing in the patient. To extract and analyse medical files in hospitals and clinids is not an easy task, demanding extra effort and imaginativeness on the part of the Medical Records Officer. A good Medical Records Officer should not only be able to assist medical men doing research work, but should be thinking in terms of initiating studies of his own after consultation perhaps with interested medical staff. The purpose of the Medical Records department: 7. I have been asked "what do Medical Records staffs do?" or "what is the purpose of running a special department for medical records?" . . . I can only quote from my own fairly lengthy experience in one Hospital Board.A Medical Records Officer in charge of a department in a large hospital is responsible for the smooth running of a fairly large staff. This may include the admission office, accident and emergency department, receptionists, all medical and surgical typists and secretaries, hospital bed census clerks, filing and coding clerks. His responsibilities include the production of statistical returnsto the Board's administration staff for annual reports; supplying day-to-day data to the Superintendentin-Chief on bed states, average days stay and any other information required that assists in running .a large hospital; statistical returns to the'Public Health Statistician; correspondence to insurance companies and lawyers re accident claims and workers' compensation; daily returns alterations to the diagnosis or findings on the case can be made. It is the Medical Records Officer's duty to see that every medical record contains the complete findings on the case. This can only be done if fully trained staffs are doing this important work, When Medical Records staffs have studied and understood the many excellent sections in this manual the more qualified they will become and will not only take a greater interest in their work but will be of greater. help to the medical staffs they work with. 6. Use of a medical record after patient's discharge or death I have often been asked what is the use of a medical record after a patient's discharge or death? The medical record is, of course, of the greatest assistance in the event of the patient's readmission to hospital. To the House Surgeon examining a. patient for the first time the particulars in a good medical record of a previous admission are invaluable.To learn what treatment and drugs a patient has been on previously is vital.Reference to any allergies to drugs and antibiotics could possibly be a life saver. I am told that in at least one hospital the reference to any allergies isaiways written in bold marzipan ink on thecasenote cover. This is the first thing noticed by the sister or doctor attending - an excellent idea which should be copied by all . . .. other hospitals. As mentioned above, ideally the medical record should contain in one pack all inpatient and outpatient notes. 1t is important that any doctor examining a patient should be able to get from the notes all previous medical history - people's memories are notoriously unreliable and it is poor practice to keep clinic outpatient records divorced from inpatient ones. The medical record is also used in connection with cases for negligent treatment. If an assertion is made that a certain. drug or treatment was or was not ordered or given the medica. record, as the document written at the time, is looked at for the answer. New Zealand's small population and its isolation from more heavily populated parts of the world make it an ideal country for medical research. In recent years more and more research is being carried out and well written medical records are of the greatest use to medical staffs working on the increase or otherwise of certain diseases in New Zealand. 7 2 Drugs prescribed, nursing instructions, temperature charts and other treatment given are recorded on the appropriate forms that go to make up-the case notes. What a completed medical record looks like: k. "Now what does the completed record look like?" The style of forms used varies in different hospitals, but the general set-up is much the same. The patient identification form shows the full name, address and age of the patient, where born, race (usually Maori or non-Maori), next-of--kin.The patient's hospital number is usually shown in the top right hand corner. Below is shown the disease or diseases diagnosed and operations, if any. The order of diseases is set out to conform to the Ms18 statistical card sent to the National Health Statistics Centre in Wellington. The continuation sheets show particulars of the patient's illness and course of treatment from admission until discharge or death.This record is followed by all the other forms used to record the different tests done. The temperature chart and nursing notes are usually the last sheets in. the patient's case notes. In most hospitals on the discharge or completion of treatment of a patient a summary giving a history of the course of the patient's illness and treatment while in hospital is sent to the patient's own doctor, with recommendations for the after care of the patient. A copy of this letter is usually attached to the medical record for filing. This is a good practice as a concise summary is very useful for quick reference to the case if necessary and will probably give enough information without reading through all the pages of the medical record (which are available if more detailed research is required. ) The Medical _RecordsOfficer's place in the comLetionof the medical record: 5, Now where does the Medical Records Officer come into the compilation of a medical record? As a matter of fact he has little to do with it at all. However, the trained Medical Records Officer must be able to read the medical record intelligently and learn to look out for a missing report that may possibly alter the diagnosis. His duty then is to take the report, show it to the doctor in charge of the case so that any In New Zealand patients are usually admitted under a member of the visiting staff who is assisted by the whole time staff, e.g. Registrars and House Surgeons. Radiotherapists, Radiologists and other members of the whole time staff are called in as consultants in a great number of cases. All these people make a contribution to the medical record of the patient. 3. What good case notes should contain At this stage we must ask ourselves "What should good case notes contain?" The notes should show as clearly as possible the patient's past history, both as an inpatient and outpatient, if the patient has had previous hospital treatment. This information should be obtained if possible from the patient or from a near relative. The symptoms complained of should be carefully recorded. Patients usually bring to the hospital a letter from their own doctor, giving a history of the illness with, perhaps, a provisional diagnosis. In the case of acute or accident admissions the position is more difficult and the immediate requirements for the case must be attended to first because the patient is probably not in a fit state for questioning.However, if relatives are present, information can be obtained about the acute attack or accident. On admission to the ward the patient is first examined by the House Surgeon. Following the examination, his findings are carefully recorded on the forms that go to make up the full case notes. Depending on the type of illness various tests are taken, e.g. blood, urine, sputum etc. and forwarded to the Pathology department to be reported on. All reports are sent back to the wards and must be attached to the case notes promptly. In number of cases requisitions are sent to Pathology, Biochemistry, Microbiology X-ray departments and for other technical examinations for their reports on a particular case. So it can soon be seen how the case notes are built into a fairly complete history of any particular case. Where surgery is performed the operation sheet should be fully written up, preferably by the surgeon himself, showing the procedure and findings; all biopsy or histology reports must also be attached to case notes as soon as received from the Pathology department. In some of the larger hospitals the operation report is dictated by the surgeon to his secretary who types the report on the Operation Sheet. It 2 Medical Records Practice in New Zealand INTRODUCTION:THE MEDICAL RECORD AND ITS USES I • Preamble 2. What a medical record is 3. What good case notes should contain k. What a completed medical record looks like 5. The Medical Records Officer's place in the compilation of the medical record 6. Use of a medical record after the patient's discharge or death 6.1 The contribution of the medical record to medical research 7. The purpose of the Medical Records department 8. Conclusion Preamble: 1. The readers of this manual on Medical Records Practice in New Zealand will, or should, find the various sections of great assistance and interest in the daily running of a Medical Records department.When reading the different sections on medical record keeping and other subjects, it is necessary to consider and ask the question: "What is a medical record?" Reference to the glossary of terms (chapter 2 9) will give the definition of a medical record: the completed case notes, the case notes being what is defined in the following paragraph whenreferred to whilst the patient is in hospital. What a medical record is: 2. The medical record is a narrative on paper of the patient's medical history, present complaint, examination findings and treatment given. Ideally, it contains in the one pack all inpatient and outpatient treatment for the patient. Unfortunately, because house surgeons are often inadequately trained in record taking, many records fall short of the ideal and far too many are inadequate and would be of very limited use on readmission or if another doctor took over treatment. The content of the record depends to a large extent, also, on the ability of the patient to give a history of past illnesses and treatment.The doctor examining a patient has his task made more difficult if the patient is not very intelligent. -2- The first reference number which is underlined refers to the chapter number, the second to the paragraph within the chapter. Thus: Hospital cancer register, operation of 17-s- 3 HOSPITAL CENSUS TAKING.8 l+Finding a reference Separate pages are not numbered,. the number appearing at, the top right hand corner being that of the chapter,. thus permitting . the. easy replacement of out-dated material. Locate the chapter required. from the top right hand corner, then the paragraph from the paragraph reference number which always appears on the outside of the. page... Gerald Wakely Editor Medical Records Practice in New Zealand HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL 1. Scope 2. Organisation 3. Index 1, Finding a reference I Scope: 1. The manual's purpose is threefold: (a) ' a working source of reference on medical records and related practices under New Zeálànd conditions; (b) a basic text for education in medical records and related procedures; (c) a guide for those in charge of departments, and others concerned, in the fields of .organisation, equipment and planning.. As circumstances change in different hospitals the manual is intended to-be used as a guide to working out asuitable method for, a particular situation; it does not lay down standard procedures to be followed in all hospitals except where all hospitals make the same returns, e.g.. MS18 statistical cards and MS3 8 cancer site cards. . Organisation: 2. Chapter headings indicate the. scope of each,chapter. Reference should be made to the index, however, for mention of a subject in other chapters. ... .. Inde;,Chapter headings only are in CAPITALS, all other references in lower case.. 2. 3. Medical Records Practice in New Zealand CONTENTS How to use this manual I Introduction: the medical record and its uses 2 Organisation of a Medical Records department 3 Medico-legal aspects of medical records keeping Filing systems Indexing procedures. Admission Office procedure Hospital census taking Anatomy and physiology International Classification of Diseases The classification of diseases 7 8 9 10 11. The classification of operations Medical terminology Notification of diseases Workers' compensation 5 6 12 13 14 15 Outpatient and Accident & Emergency department procedures 16 Cancer case registration and cancer statistics 17 Follow-up methods 18 Retention of medical records 19 Design of forms 20 Planning a Medical Records department 21 Hospital morbidity statistics 22 Glossary of terms 23 References Index - S Contributors-,- S S C., 7 MED:CAL-s L.URARY 1::L(